Home | History | Annotate | Line # | Download | only in bfd
      1   1.1  christos /* PowerPC-specific support for 32-bit ELF
      2  1.12  christos    Copyright (C) 1994-2025 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
      3   1.1  christos    Written by Ian Lance Taylor, Cygnus Support.
      4   1.1  christos 
      5   1.1  christos    This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
      6   1.1  christos 
      7   1.1  christos    This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
      8   1.1  christos    it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
      9   1.1  christos    the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
     10   1.1  christos    (at your option) any later version.
     11   1.1  christos 
     12   1.1  christos    This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
     13   1.1  christos    but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
     14   1.1  christos    MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
     15   1.1  christos    GNU General Public License for more details.
     16   1.1  christos 
     17   1.1  christos    You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
     18   1.1  christos    along with this program; if not, write to the
     19   1.1  christos    Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor,
     20   1.1  christos    Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA.  */
     21   1.1  christos 
     22  1.10  christos /* The assembler should generate a full set of section symbols even
     23  1.10  christos    when they appear unused.  The linux kernel build tool recordmcount
     24  1.10  christos    needs them.  */
     25  1.10  christos #define TARGET_KEEP_UNUSED_SECTION_SYMBOLS true
     26   1.1  christos 
     27   1.1  christos #include "sysdep.h"
     28   1.1  christos #include <stdarg.h>
     29   1.1  christos #include "bfd.h"
     30   1.1  christos #include "bfdlink.h"
     31   1.1  christos #include "libbfd.h"
     32   1.1  christos #include "elf-bfd.h"
     33   1.1  christos #include "elf/ppc.h"
     34   1.1  christos #include "elf32-ppc.h"
     35   1.1  christos #include "elf-vxworks.h"
     36   1.1  christos #include "dwarf2.h"
     37   1.7  christos #include "opcode/ppc.h"
     38   1.1  christos 
     39   1.9  christos /* All users of this file have bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd, sec) == 1.  */
     40   1.9  christos #define OCTETS_PER_BYTE(ABFD, SEC) 1
     41   1.9  christos 
     42   1.1  christos typedef enum split16_format_type
     43   1.1  christos {
     44   1.1  christos   split16a_type = 0,
     45   1.1  christos   split16d_type
     46   1.1  christos }
     47   1.1  christos split16_format_type;
     48   1.1  christos 
     49   1.1  christos /* RELA relocations are used here.  */
     50   1.1  christos 
     51   1.1  christos static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc
     52   1.1  christos   (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
     53   1.1  christos static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc
     54   1.1  christos   (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
     55   1.1  christos 
     56   1.1  christos /* Branch prediction bit for branch taken relocs.  */
     57   1.1  christos #define BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT 0x200000
     58   1.1  christos /* Mask to set RA in memory instructions.  */
     59   1.1  christos #define RA_REGISTER_MASK 0x001f0000
     60   1.1  christos /* Value to shift register by to insert RA.  */
     61   1.1  christos #define RA_REGISTER_SHIFT 16
     62   1.1  christos 
     63   1.1  christos /* The name of the dynamic interpreter.  This is put in the .interp
     64   1.1  christos    section.  */
     65   1.1  christos #define ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER "/usr/lib/ld.so.1"
     66   1.1  christos 
     67   1.1  christos /* For old-style PLT.  */
     68   1.1  christos /* The number of single-slot PLT entries (the rest use two slots).  */
     69   1.1  christos #define PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES 8192
     70   1.1  christos 
     71   1.1  christos /* For new-style .glink and .plt.  */
     72   1.1  christos #define GLINK_PLTRESOLVE 16*4
     73   1.7  christos #define GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE(htab, h)					\
     74   1.7  christos   ((4*4									\
     75   1.7  christos     + (h != NULL							\
     76   1.7  christos        && h == htab->tls_get_addr					\
     77   1.7  christos        && !htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt ? 8*4 : 0)			\
     78   1.7  christos     + (1u << htab->params->plt_stub_align) - 1)				\
     79   1.7  christos    & -(1u << htab->params->plt_stub_align))
     80   1.1  christos 
     81   1.1  christos /* VxWorks uses its own plt layout, filled in by the static linker.  */
     82   1.1  christos 
     83   1.1  christos /* The standard VxWorks PLT entry.  */
     84   1.1  christos #define VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE 32
     85   1.1  christos static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_plt_entry
     86   1.1  christos     [VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
     87   1.1  christos   {
     88   1.7  christos     0x3d800000, /* lis	   r12,0		 */
     89   1.7  christos     0x818c0000, /* lwz	   r12,0(r12)		 */
     90   1.7  christos     0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr   r12			 */
     91   1.7  christos     0x4e800420, /* bctr				 */
     92   1.7  christos     0x39600000, /* li	   r11,0		 */
     93   1.7  christos     0x48000000, /* b	   14 <.PLT0resolve+0x4> */
     94   1.7  christos     0x60000000, /* nop				 */
     95   1.7  christos     0x60000000, /* nop				 */
     96   1.1  christos   };
     97   1.1  christos static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt_entry
     98   1.1  christos     [VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
     99   1.1  christos   {
    100   1.1  christos     0x3d9e0000, /* addis r12,r30,0 */
    101   1.1  christos     0x818c0000, /* lwz	 r12,0(r12) */
    102   1.1  christos     0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr r12 */
    103   1.1  christos     0x4e800420, /* bctr */
    104   1.1  christos     0x39600000, /* li	 r11,0 */
    105   1.1  christos     0x48000000, /* b	 14 <.PLT0resolve+0x4> 14: R_PPC_REL24 .PLTresolve */
    106   1.1  christos     0x60000000, /* nop */
    107   1.1  christos     0x60000000, /* nop */
    108   1.1  christos   };
    109   1.1  christos 
    110   1.1  christos /* The initial VxWorks PLT entry.  */
    111   1.1  christos #define VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE 32
    112   1.1  christos static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_plt0_entry
    113   1.1  christos     [VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
    114   1.1  christos   {
    115   1.7  christos     0x3d800000, /* lis	   r12,0	*/
    116   1.7  christos     0x398c0000, /* addi	   r12,r12,0	*/
    117   1.7  christos     0x800c0008, /* lwz	   r0,8(r12)	*/
    118   1.7  christos     0x7c0903a6, /* mtctr   r0		*/
    119   1.7  christos     0x818c0004, /* lwz	   r12,4(r12)	*/
    120   1.7  christos     0x4e800420, /* bctr			*/
    121   1.7  christos     0x60000000, /* nop			*/
    122   1.7  christos     0x60000000, /* nop			*/
    123   1.1  christos   };
    124   1.1  christos static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt0_entry
    125   1.1  christos     [VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
    126   1.1  christos   {
    127   1.1  christos     0x819e0008, /* lwz	 r12,8(r30) */
    128   1.7  christos     0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr r12	    */
    129   1.1  christos     0x819e0004, /* lwz	 r12,4(r30) */
    130   1.7  christos     0x4e800420, /* bctr		    */
    131   1.7  christos     0x60000000, /* nop		    */
    132   1.7  christos     0x60000000, /* nop		    */
    133   1.7  christos     0x60000000, /* nop		    */
    134   1.7  christos     0x60000000, /* nop		    */
    135   1.1  christos   };
    136   1.1  christos 
    137   1.1  christos /* For executables, we have some additional relocations in
    138   1.1  christos    .rela.plt.unloaded, for the kernel loader.  */
    139   1.1  christos 
    140   1.1  christos /* The number of non-JMP_SLOT relocations per PLT0 slot. */
    141   1.1  christos #define VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS 3
    142   1.1  christos /* The number of relocations in the PLTResolve slot. */
    143   1.1  christos #define VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS 2
    144   1.7  christos /* The number of relocations in the PLTResolve slot when creating
    145   1.1  christos    a shared library. */
    146   1.1  christos #define VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS_SHLIB 0
    147   1.1  christos 
    148   1.1  christos /* Some instructions.  */
    149   1.1  christos #define ADDIS_11_11	0x3d6b0000
    150   1.1  christos #define ADDIS_11_30	0x3d7e0000
    151   1.1  christos #define ADDIS_12_12	0x3d8c0000
    152   1.1  christos #define ADDI_11_11	0x396b0000
    153   1.1  christos #define ADD_0_11_11	0x7c0b5a14
    154   1.1  christos #define ADD_3_12_2	0x7c6c1214
    155   1.1  christos #define ADD_11_0_11	0x7d605a14
    156   1.1  christos #define B		0x48000000
    157   1.3  christos #define BA		0x48000002
    158   1.1  christos #define BCL_20_31	0x429f0005
    159   1.1  christos #define BCTR		0x4e800420
    160   1.1  christos #define BEQLR		0x4d820020
    161   1.1  christos #define CMPWI_11_0	0x2c0b0000
    162   1.1  christos #define LIS_11		0x3d600000
    163   1.1  christos #define LIS_12		0x3d800000
    164   1.1  christos #define LWZU_0_12	0x840c0000
    165   1.1  christos #define LWZ_0_12	0x800c0000
    166   1.1  christos #define LWZ_11_3	0x81630000
    167   1.1  christos #define LWZ_11_11	0x816b0000
    168   1.1  christos #define LWZ_11_30	0x817e0000
    169   1.1  christos #define LWZ_12_3	0x81830000
    170   1.1  christos #define LWZ_12_12	0x818c0000
    171   1.1  christos #define MR_0_3		0x7c601b78
    172   1.1  christos #define MR_3_0		0x7c030378
    173   1.1  christos #define MFLR_0		0x7c0802a6
    174   1.1  christos #define MFLR_12		0x7d8802a6
    175   1.1  christos #define MTCTR_0		0x7c0903a6
    176   1.1  christos #define MTCTR_11	0x7d6903a6
    177   1.1  christos #define MTLR_0		0x7c0803a6
    178   1.1  christos #define NOP		0x60000000
    179   1.1  christos #define SUB_11_11_12	0x7d6c5850
    180   1.1  christos 
    181   1.1  christos /* Offset of tp and dtp pointers from start of TLS block.  */
    182   1.1  christos #define TP_OFFSET	0x7000
    183   1.1  christos #define DTP_OFFSET	0x8000
    184   1.1  christos 
    185   1.1  christos /* The value of a defined global symbol.  */
    186   1.1  christos #define SYM_VAL(SYM) \
    187   1.1  christos   ((SYM)->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma	\
    188   1.1  christos    + (SYM)->root.u.def.section->output_offset		\
    189   1.1  christos    + (SYM)->root.u.def.value)
    190   1.1  christos 
    191   1.9  christos /* Relocation HOWTO's.  */
    193   1.9  christos /* Like other ELF RELA targets that don't apply multiple
    194   1.9  christos    field-altering relocations to the same localation, src_mask is
    195   1.9  christos    always zero and pcrel_offset is the same as pc_relative.
    196   1.9  christos    PowerPC can always use a zero bitpos, even when the field is not at
    197   1.9  christos    the LSB.  For example, a REL24 could use rightshift=2, bisize=24
    198   1.9  christos    and bitpos=2 which matches the ABI description, or as we do here,
    199   1.9  christos    rightshift=0, bitsize=26 and bitpos=0.  */
    200   1.9  christos #define HOW(type, size, bitsize, mask, rightshift, pc_relative, \
    201   1.9  christos 	    complain, special_func)				\
    202   1.9  christos   HOWTO (type, rightshift, size, bitsize, pc_relative, 0,	\
    203  1.10  christos 	 complain_overflow_ ## complain, special_func,		\
    204   1.9  christos 	 #type, false, 0, mask, pc_relative)
    205   1.1  christos 
    206   1.1  christos static reloc_howto_type *ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_max];
    207   1.1  christos 
    208   1.1  christos static reloc_howto_type ppc_elf_howto_raw[] = {
    209  1.10  christos   /* This reloc does nothing.  */
    210   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_NONE, 0, 0, 0, 0, false, dont,
    211   1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    212   1.1  christos 
    213  1.10  christos   /* A standard 32 bit relocation.  */
    214   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_ADDR32, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont,
    215   1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    216   1.1  christos 
    217   1.1  christos   /* An absolute 26 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.
    218  1.10  christos      FIXME: we don't check that, we just clear them.  */
    219   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_ADDR24, 4, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, false, signed,
    220   1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    221   1.1  christos 
    222  1.10  christos   /* A standard 16 bit relocation.  */
    223   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, bitfield,
    224   1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    225   1.1  christos 
    226  1.10  christos   /* A 16 bit relocation without overflow.  */
    227   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
    228   1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    229   1.1  christos 
    230  1.10  christos   /* The high order 16 bits of an address.  */
    231   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
    232   1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    233   1.1  christos 
    234   1.1  christos   /* The high order 16 bits of an address, plus 1 if the contents of
    235  1.10  christos      the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number, is negative.  */
    236   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
    237   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
    238   1.1  christos 
    239   1.1  christos   /* An absolute 16 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.
    240  1.10  christos      FIXME: we don't check that, we just clear them.  */
    241   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14, 4, 16, 0xfffc, 0, false, signed,
    242   1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    243   1.1  christos 
    244   1.1  christos   /* An absolute 16 bit branch, for which bit 10 should be set to
    245   1.1  christos      indicate that the branch is expected to be taken.	The lower two
    246  1.10  christos      bits must be zero.  */
    247   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN, 4, 16, 0xfffc, 0, false, signed,
    248   1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    249   1.1  christos 
    250   1.1  christos   /* An absolute 16 bit branch, for which bit 10 should be set to
    251   1.1  christos      indicate that the branch is not expected to be taken.  The lower
    252  1.10  christos      two bits must be zero.  */
    253   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN, 4, 16, 0xfffc, 0, false, signed,
    254   1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    255   1.1  christos 
    256  1.10  christos   /* A relative 26 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.  */
    257   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_REL24, 4, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, true, signed,
    258   1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    259   1.1  christos 
    260  1.10  christos   /* A relative 16 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.  */
    261   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_REL14, 4, 16, 0xfffc, 0, true, signed,
    262   1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    263   1.1  christos 
    264   1.1  christos   /* A relative 16 bit branch.  Bit 10 should be set to indicate that
    265   1.1  christos      the branch is expected to be taken.  The lower two bits must be
    266  1.10  christos      zero.  */
    267   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN, 4, 16, 0xfffc, 0, true, signed,
    268   1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    269   1.1  christos 
    270   1.1  christos   /* A relative 16 bit branch.  Bit 10 should be set to indicate that
    271   1.1  christos      the branch is not expected to be taken.  The lower two bits must
    272  1.10  christos      be zero.  */
    273   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN, 4, 16, 0xfffc, 0, true, signed,
    274   1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    275   1.1  christos 
    276   1.1  christos   /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16, but referring to the GOT table entry for the
    277  1.10  christos      symbol.  */
    278   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GOT16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
    279   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    280   1.1  christos 
    281   1.1  christos   /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, but referring to the GOT table entry for
    282  1.10  christos      the symbol.  */
    283   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
    284   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    285   1.1  christos 
    286   1.1  christos   /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, but referring to the GOT table entry for
    287  1.10  christos      the symbol.  */
    288   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
    289   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    290   1.1  christos 
    291   1.1  christos   /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, but referring to the GOT table entry for
    292  1.10  christos      the symbol.  */
    293   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
    294   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    295   1.1  christos 
    296   1.1  christos   /* Like R_PPC_REL24, but referring to the procedure linkage table
    297  1.10  christos      entry for the symbol.  */
    298   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_PLTREL24, 4, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, true, signed,
    299   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    300   1.1  christos 
    301   1.1  christos   /* This is used only by the dynamic linker.  The symbol should exist
    302   1.1  christos      both in the object being run and in some shared library.  The
    303   1.1  christos      dynamic linker copies the data addressed by the symbol from the
    304   1.1  christos      shared library into the object, because the object being
    305  1.10  christos      run has to have the data at some particular address.  */
    306   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_COPY, 4, 32, 0, 0, false, dont,
    307   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    308   1.1  christos 
    309   1.1  christos   /* Like R_PPC_ADDR32, but used when setting global offset table
    310  1.10  christos      entries.  */
    311   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GLOB_DAT, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont,
    312   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    313   1.1  christos 
    314  1.10  christos   /* Marks a procedure linkage table entry for a symbol.  */
    315   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_JMP_SLOT, 4, 32, 0, 0, false, dont,
    316   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    317   1.1  christos 
    318   1.1  christos   /* Used only by the dynamic linker.  When the object is run, this
    319   1.1  christos      longword is set to the load address of the object, plus the
    320  1.10  christos      addend.  */
    321   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_RELATIVE, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont,
    322   1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    323   1.1  christos 
    324   1.1  christos   /* Like R_PPC_REL24, but uses the value of the symbol within the
    325   1.1  christos      object rather than the final value.  Normally used for
    326  1.10  christos      _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_.  */
    327   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_LOCAL24PC, 4, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, true, signed,
    328   1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    329   1.1  christos 
    330  1.10  christos   /* Like R_PPC_ADDR32, but may be unaligned.  */
    331   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_UADDR32, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont,
    332   1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    333   1.1  christos 
    334  1.10  christos   /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16, but may be unaligned.  */
    335   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_UADDR16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, bitfield,
    336   1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    337   1.1  christos 
    338  1.10  christos   /* 32-bit PC relative */
    339   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_REL32, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, true, dont,
    340   1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    341   1.1  christos 
    342   1.1  christos   /* 32-bit relocation to the symbol's procedure linkage table.
    343  1.10  christos      FIXME: not supported.  */
    344   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_PLT32, 4, 32, 0, 0, false, dont,
    345   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    346   1.1  christos 
    347   1.1  christos   /* 32-bit PC relative relocation to the symbol's procedure linkage table.
    348  1.10  christos      FIXME: not supported.  */
    349   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_PLTREL32, 4, 32, 0, 0, true, dont,
    350   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    351   1.1  christos 
    352   1.1  christos   /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, but referring to the PLT table entry for
    353  1.10  christos      the symbol.  */
    354   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
    355   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    356   1.1  christos 
    357   1.1  christos   /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, but referring to the PLT table entry for
    358  1.10  christos      the symbol.  */
    359   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
    360   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    361   1.1  christos 
    362   1.1  christos   /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, but referring to the PLT table entry for
    363  1.10  christos      the symbol.  */
    364   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
    365   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    366   1.1  christos 
    367   1.1  christos   /* A sign-extended 16 bit value relative to _SDA_BASE_, for use with
    368  1.10  christos      small data items.  */
    369   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_SDAREL16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
    370   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    371   1.1  christos 
    372  1.10  christos   /* 16-bit section relative relocation.  */
    373   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
    374   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    375   1.1  christos 
    376  1.10  christos   /* 16-bit lower half section relative relocation.  */
    377   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
    378   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    379   1.1  christos 
    380  1.10  christos   /* 16-bit upper half section relative relocation.  */
    381   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
    382   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    383   1.1  christos 
    384  1.10  christos   /* 16-bit upper half adjusted section relative relocation.  */
    385   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
    386   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    387   1.1  christos 
    388  1.10  christos   /* Marker relocs for TLS.  */
    389   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_TLS, 4, 32, 0, 0, false, dont,
    390   1.9  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    391  1.10  christos 
    392   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_TLSGD, 4, 32, 0, 0, false, dont,
    393   1.9  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    394  1.10  christos 
    395   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_TLSLD, 4, 32, 0, 0, false, dont,
    396   1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    397   1.7  christos 
    398  1.10  christos   /* Marker relocs on inline plt call instructions.  */
    399   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_PLTSEQ, 4, 32, 0, 0, false, dont,
    400   1.9  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    401  1.10  christos 
    402   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_PLTCALL, 4, 32, 0, 0, false, dont,
    403   1.7  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    404   1.1  christos 
    405   1.1  christos   /* Computes the load module index of the load module that contains the
    406  1.10  christos      definition of its TLS sym.  */
    407   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_DTPMOD32, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont,
    408   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    409   1.1  christos 
    410   1.1  christos   /* Computes a dtv-relative displacement, the difference between the value
    411   1.1  christos      of sym+add and the base address of the thread-local storage block that
    412  1.10  christos      contains the definition of sym, minus 0x8000.  */
    413   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL32, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont,
    414   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    415   1.1  christos 
    416  1.10  christos   /* A 16 bit dtprel reloc.  */
    417   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
    418   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    419   1.1  christos 
    420  1.10  christos   /* Like DTPREL16, but no overflow.  */
    421   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
    422   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    423   1.1  christos 
    424  1.10  christos   /* Like DTPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits.  */
    425   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
    426   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    427   1.1  christos 
    428  1.10  christos   /* Like DTPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits.  */
    429   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
    430   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    431   1.1  christos 
    432   1.1  christos   /* Computes a tp-relative displacement, the difference between the value of
    433  1.10  christos      sym+add and the value of the thread pointer (r13).  */
    434   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_TPREL32, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont,
    435   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    436   1.1  christos 
    437  1.10  christos   /* A 16 bit tprel reloc.  */
    438   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
    439   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    440   1.1  christos 
    441  1.10  christos   /* Like TPREL16, but no overflow.  */
    442   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
    443   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    444   1.1  christos 
    445  1.10  christos   /* Like TPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits.  */
    446   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
    447   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    448   1.1  christos 
    449  1.10  christos   /* Like TPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits.  */
    450   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
    451   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    452   1.1  christos 
    453   1.1  christos   /* Allocates two contiguous entries in the GOT to hold a tls_index structure,
    454   1.1  christos      with values (sym+add)@dtpmod and (sym+add)@dtprel, and computes the offset
    455  1.10  christos      to the first entry.  */
    456   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
    457   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    458   1.1  christos 
    459  1.10  christos   /* Like GOT_TLSGD16, but no overflow.  */
    460   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
    461   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    462   1.1  christos 
    463  1.10  christos   /* Like GOT_TLSGD16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits.  */
    464   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
    465   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    466   1.1  christos 
    467  1.10  christos   /* Like GOT_TLSGD16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits.  */
    468   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
    469   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    470   1.1  christos 
    471   1.1  christos   /* Allocates two contiguous entries in the GOT to hold a tls_index structure,
    472   1.1  christos      with values (sym+add)@dtpmod and zero, and computes the offset to the
    473  1.10  christos      first entry.  */
    474   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
    475   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    476   1.1  christos 
    477  1.10  christos   /* Like GOT_TLSLD16, but no overflow.  */
    478   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
    479   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    480   1.1  christos 
    481  1.10  christos   /* Like GOT_TLSLD16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits.  */
    482   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
    483   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    484   1.1  christos 
    485  1.10  christos   /* Like GOT_TLSLD16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits.  */
    486   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
    487   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    488   1.1  christos 
    489   1.1  christos   /* Allocates an entry in the GOT with value (sym+add)@dtprel, and computes
    490  1.10  christos      the offset to the entry.  */
    491   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
    492   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    493   1.1  christos 
    494  1.10  christos   /* Like GOT_DTPREL16, but no overflow.  */
    495   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
    496   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    497   1.1  christos 
    498  1.10  christos   /* Like GOT_DTPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits.  */
    499   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
    500   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    501   1.1  christos 
    502  1.10  christos   /* Like GOT_DTPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits.  */
    503   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
    504   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    505   1.1  christos 
    506   1.1  christos   /* Allocates an entry in the GOT with value (sym+add)@tprel, and computes the
    507  1.10  christos      offset to the entry.  */
    508   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
    509   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    510   1.1  christos 
    511  1.10  christos   /* Like GOT_TPREL16, but no overflow.  */
    512   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
    513   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    514   1.1  christos 
    515  1.10  christos   /* Like GOT_TPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits.  */
    516   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
    517   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    518   1.1  christos 
    519  1.10  christos   /* Like GOT_TPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits.  */
    520   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
    521   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    522   1.1  christos 
    523   1.1  christos   /* The remaining relocs are from the Embedded ELF ABI, and are not
    524   1.1  christos      in the SVR4 ELF ABI.  */
    525   1.1  christos 
    526  1.10  christos   /* 32 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol.  */
    527   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont,
    528   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    529   1.1  christos 
    530  1.10  christos   /* 16 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol.  */
    531   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
    532   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    533   1.1  christos 
    534  1.10  christos   /* 16 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol.  */
    535   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
    536   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    537   1.1  christos 
    538  1.10  christos   /* The high order 16 bits of the addend minus the symbol.  */
    539   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
    540   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    541   1.1  christos 
    542   1.1  christos   /* The high order 16 bits of the result of the addend minus the address,
    543   1.1  christos      plus 1 if the contents of the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number,
    544  1.10  christos      is negative.  */
    545   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, false, dont,
    546   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    547   1.1  christos 
    548   1.1  christos   /* 16 bit value resulting from allocating a 4 byte word to hold an
    549   1.1  christos      address in the .sdata section, and returning the offset from
    550  1.10  christos      _SDA_BASE_ for that relocation.  */
    551   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
    552   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    553   1.1  christos 
    554   1.1  christos   /* 16 bit value resulting from allocating a 4 byte word to hold an
    555   1.1  christos      address in the .sdata2 section, and returning the offset from
    556  1.10  christos      _SDA2_BASE_ for that relocation.  */
    557   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
    558   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    559   1.1  christos 
    560   1.1  christos   /* A sign-extended 16 bit value relative to _SDA2_BASE_, for use with
    561  1.10  christos      small data items.	 */
    562   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
    563   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    564   1.1  christos 
    565   1.1  christos   /* Relocate against either _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_, filling in the 16 bit
    566   1.1  christos      signed offset from the appropriate base, and filling in the register
    567  1.10  christos      field with the appropriate register (0, 2, or 13).  */
    568   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA21, 4, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
    569   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    570   1.1  christos 
    571   1.1  christos   /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF */
    572   1.1  christos   /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16 */
    573   1.1  christos   /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO */
    574   1.1  christos   /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI */
    575   1.1  christos   /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA */
    576   1.1  christos   /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD */
    577   1.1  christos 
    578   1.1  christos   /* PC relative relocation against either _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_, filling
    579   1.1  christos      in the 16 bit signed offset from the appropriate base, and filling in the
    580  1.10  christos      register field with the appropriate register (0, 2, or 13).  */
    581   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
    582   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    583   1.1  christos 
    584  1.10  christos   /* A relative 8 bit branch.  */
    585   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL8, 2, 8, 0xff, 1, true, signed,
    586   1.3  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    587   1.1  christos 
    588  1.10  christos   /* A relative 15 bit branch.  */
    589   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL15, 4, 16, 0xfffe, 0, true, signed,
    590   1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    591   1.3  christos 
    592  1.10  christos   /* A relative 24 bit branch.  */
    593   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL24, 4, 25, 0x1fffffe, 0, true, signed,
    594   1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    595   1.1  christos 
    596  1.10  christos   /* The 16 LSBS in split16a format.  */
    597   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_LO16A, 4, 16, 0x1f07ff, 0, false, dont,
    598   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    599   1.1  christos 
    600  1.10  christos   /* The 16 LSBS in split16d format.  */
    601   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_LO16D, 4, 16, 0x3e007ff, 0, false, dont,
    602   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    603   1.1  christos 
    604  1.10  christos   /* Bits 16-31 split16a format.  */
    605   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HI16A, 4, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, false, dont,
    606   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    607   1.1  christos 
    608  1.10  christos   /* Bits 16-31 split16d format.  */
    609   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HI16D, 4, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, false, dont,
    610   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    611   1.1  christos 
    612  1.10  christos   /* Bits 16-31 (High Adjusted) in split16a format.  */
    613   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HA16A, 4, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, false, dont,
    614   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    615   1.1  christos 
    616  1.10  christos   /* Bits 16-31 (High Adjusted) in split16d format.  */
    617   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HA16D, 4, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, false, dont,
    618   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    619   1.3  christos 
    620   1.3  christos   /* This reloc is like R_PPC_EMB_SDA21 but only applies to e_add16i
    621   1.3  christos      instructions.  If the register base is 0 then the linker changes
    622  1.10  christos      the e_add16i to an e_li instruction.  */
    623   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDA21, 4, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
    624   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    625   1.3  christos 
    626  1.10  christos   /* Like R_PPC_VLE_SDA21 but ignore overflow.  */
    627   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO, 4, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, dont,
    628   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    629   1.1  christos 
    630  1.10  christos   /* The 16 LSBS relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16a format.  */
    631   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A, 4, 16, 0x1f07ff, 0, false, dont,
    632   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    633   1.1  christos 
    634  1.10  christos   /* The 16 LSBS relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16d format.  */
    635   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D, 4, 16, 0x3e007ff, 0, false, dont,
    636   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    637   1.1  christos 
    638  1.10  christos   /* Bits 16-31 relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16a format.  */
    639   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A, 4, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, false, dont,
    640   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    641   1.1  christos 
    642  1.10  christos   /* Bits 16-31 relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16d format.  */
    643   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D, 4, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, false, dont,
    644   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    645   1.1  christos 
    646  1.10  christos   /* Bits 16-31 (HA) relative to _SDA_BASE split16a format.  */
    647   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A, 4, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, false, dont,
    648   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    649   1.1  christos 
    650  1.10  christos   /* Bits 16-31 (HA) relative to _SDA_BASE split16d format.  */
    651   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D, 4, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, false, dont,
    652   1.7  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    653   1.7  christos 
    654  1.10  christos   /* e_li split20 format.  */
    655   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20, 4, 20, 0x1f7fff, 0, false, dont,
    656   1.9  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    657  1.10  christos 
    658   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_IRELATIVE, 4, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, false, dont,
    659   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    660   1.1  christos 
    661  1.10  christos   /* A 16 bit relative relocation.  */
    662   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_REL16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, true, signed,
    663   1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    664   1.1  christos 
    665  1.10  christos   /* A 16 bit relative relocation without overflow.  */
    666   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_REL16_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, true, dont,
    667   1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    668   1.1  christos 
    669  1.10  christos   /* The high order 16 bits of a relative address.  */
    670   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_REL16_HI, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, true, dont,
    671   1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    672   1.1  christos 
    673   1.1  christos   /* The high order 16 bits of a relative address, plus 1 if the contents of
    674  1.10  christos      the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number, is negative.  */
    675   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_REL16_HA, 2, 16, 0xffff, 16, true, dont,
    676   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
    677   1.3  christos 
    678  1.10  christos   /* Like R_PPC_REL16_HA but for split field in addpcis.  */
    679   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_REL16DX_HA, 4, 16, 0x1fffc1, 16, true, signed,
    680   1.3  christos        ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
    681   1.7  christos 
    682  1.10  christos   /* A split-field reloc for addpcis, non-relative (gas internal use only).  */
    683   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_16DX_HA, 4, 16, 0x1fffc1, 16, false, signed,
    684   1.7  christos        ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
    685   1.1  christos 
    686  1.10  christos   /* GNU extension to record C++ vtable hierarchy.  */
    687   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT, 0, 0, 0, 0, false, dont,
    688   1.1  christos        NULL),
    689   1.1  christos 
    690  1.10  christos   /* GNU extension to record C++ vtable member usage.  */
    691   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY, 0, 0, 0, 0, false, dont,
    692   1.1  christos        NULL),
    693   1.1  christos 
    694  1.10  christos   /* Phony reloc to handle AIX style TOC entries.  */
    695   1.9  christos   HOW (R_PPC_TOC16, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, false, signed,
    696   1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    697   1.1  christos };
    698   1.1  christos 
    699   1.1  christos /* Initialize the ppc_elf_howto_table, so that linear accesses can be done.  */
    701   1.1  christos 
    702   1.1  christos static void
    703   1.1  christos ppc_elf_howto_init (void)
    704   1.1  christos {
    705   1.1  christos   unsigned int i, type;
    706   1.1  christos 
    707   1.1  christos   for (i = 0;
    708   1.1  christos        i < sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw) / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw[0]);
    709   1.1  christos        i++)
    710   1.1  christos     {
    711   1.1  christos       type = ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].type;
    712   1.1  christos       if (type >= (sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_table)
    713   1.1  christos 		   / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_table[0])))
    714   1.1  christos 	abort ();
    715   1.1  christos       ppc_elf_howto_table[type] = &ppc_elf_howto_raw[i];
    716   1.1  christos     }
    717   1.1  christos }
    718   1.1  christos 
    719   1.1  christos static reloc_howto_type *
    720   1.1  christos ppc_elf_reloc_type_lookup (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
    721   1.1  christos 			   bfd_reloc_code_real_type code)
    722   1.1  christos {
    723   1.1  christos   enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r;
    724   1.1  christos 
    725   1.1  christos   /* Initialize howto table if not already done.  */
    726   1.1  christos   if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
    727   1.1  christos     ppc_elf_howto_init ();
    728   1.1  christos 
    729   1.1  christos   switch (code)
    730   1.1  christos     {
    731   1.1  christos     default:
    732   1.1  christos       return NULL;
    733   1.1  christos 
    734   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_NONE:		r = R_PPC_NONE;			break;
    735   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_32:			r = R_PPC_ADDR32;		break;
    736   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA26:		r = R_PPC_ADDR24;		break;
    737   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_DS:
    738   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_16:			r = R_PPC_ADDR16;		break;
    739   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_LO_DS:
    740   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_LO16:		r = R_PPC_ADDR16_LO;		break;
    741   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_HI16:		r = R_PPC_ADDR16_HI;		break;
    742   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S:		r = R_PPC_ADDR16_HA;		break;
    743   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16:		r = R_PPC_ADDR14;		break;
    744   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16_BRTAKEN:	r = R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN;	break;
    745   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16_BRNTAKEN:	r = R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN;	break;
    746   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B26:		r = R_PPC_REL24;		break;
    747   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16:		r = R_PPC_REL14;		break;
    748   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16_BRTAKEN:	r = R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN;	break;
    749   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16_BRNTAKEN:	r = R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN;	break;
    750   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT16_DS:
    751   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_16_GOTOFF:		r = R_PPC_GOT16;		break;
    752   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS:
    753   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_LO16_GOTOFF:		r = R_PPC_GOT16_LO;		break;
    754   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_GOTOFF:		r = R_PPC_GOT16_HI;		break;
    755   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_GOTOFF:	r = R_PPC_GOT16_HA;		break;
    756   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_24_PLT_PCREL:	r = R_PPC_PLTREL24;		break;
    757   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_COPY:		r = R_PPC_COPY;			break;
    758   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GLOB_DAT:	r = R_PPC_GLOB_DAT;		break;
    759   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_LOCAL24PC:	r = R_PPC_LOCAL24PC;		break;
    760   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_32_PCREL:		r = R_PPC_REL32;		break;
    761   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_32_PLTOFF:		r = R_PPC_PLT32;		break;
    762   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_32_PLT_PCREL:	r = R_PPC_PLTREL32;		break;
    763   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS:
    764   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_LO16_PLTOFF:		r = R_PPC_PLT16_LO;		break;
    765   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_PLTOFF:		r = R_PPC_PLT16_HI;		break;
    766   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_PLTOFF:	r = R_PPC_PLT16_HA;		break;
    767   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_GPREL16:		r = R_PPC_SDAREL16;		break;
    768   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_SECTOFF_DS:
    769   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_16_BASEREL:		r = R_PPC_SECTOFF;		break;
    770   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO_DS:
    771   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_LO16_BASEREL:	r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO;		break;
    772   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_BASEREL:	r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI;		break;
    773   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_BASEREL:	r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA;		break;
    774   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_CTOR:		r = R_PPC_ADDR32;		break;
    775   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
    776   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TOC16:		r = R_PPC_TOC16;		break;
    777   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLS:		r = R_PPC_TLS;			break;
    778   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLSGD:		r = R_PPC_TLSGD;		break;
    779   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLSLD:		r = R_PPC_TLSLD;		break;
    780   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPMOD:		r = R_PPC_DTPMOD32;		break;
    781   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_DS:
    782   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16:		r = R_PPC_TPREL16;		break;
    783   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS:
    784   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_LO:	r = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO;		break;
    785   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_HI:	r = R_PPC_TPREL16_HI;		break;
    786   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_HA:	r = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA;		break;
    787   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL:		r = R_PPC_TPREL32;		break;
    788   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_DS:
    789   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16:	r = R_PPC_DTPREL16;		break;
    790   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
    791   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:	r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO;		break;
    792   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_HI:	r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI;		break;
    793   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:	r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA;		break;
    794   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL:		r = R_PPC_DTPREL32;		break;
    795   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16;		break;
    796   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO;	break;
    797   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI;	break;
    798   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA;	break;
    799   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16;		break;
    800   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO;	break;
    801   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI;	break;
    802   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA;	break;
    803   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16;		break;
    804   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO;	break;
    805   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI;	break;
    806   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA;	break;
    807   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:	r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16;		break;
    808   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:	r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO;	break;
    809   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI:	r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI;	break;
    810   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:	r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA;	break;
    811   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR32:	r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32;		break;
    812   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16:	r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16;		break;
    813   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO:	r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO;	break;
    814   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI:	r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI;	break;
    815   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:	r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA;	break;
    816   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDAI16:	r = R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16;		break;
    817   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16:	r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16;		break;
    818   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL:	r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL;		break;
    819   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA21:	r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA21;		break;
    820   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_MRKREF:	r = R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF;		break;
    821   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16:	r = R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16;		break;
    822   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO:	r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO;		break;
    823   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI:	r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI;		break;
    824   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:	r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA;		break;
    825   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD:	r = R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD;		break;
    826   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELSDA:	r = R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA;		break;
    827   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL8:	r = R_PPC_VLE_REL8;		break;
    828   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL15:	r = R_PPC_VLE_REL15;		break;
    829   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL24:	r = R_PPC_VLE_REL24;		break;
    830   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_LO16A:	r = R_PPC_VLE_LO16A;		break;
    831   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_LO16D:	r = R_PPC_VLE_LO16D;		break;
    832   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HI16A:	r = R_PPC_VLE_HI16A;		break;
    833   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HI16D:	r = R_PPC_VLE_HI16D;		break;
    834   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HA16A:	r = R_PPC_VLE_HA16A;		break;
    835   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HA16D:	r = R_PPC_VLE_HA16D;		break;
    836   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDA21:	r = R_PPC_VLE_SDA21;		break;
    837   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO:	r = R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO;		break;
    838   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A:
    839   1.1  christos       r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A;
    840   1.1  christos       break;
    841   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D:
    842   1.1  christos       r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D;
    843   1.1  christos       break;
    844   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A:
    845   1.1  christos       r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A;
    846   1.1  christos       break;
    847   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D:
    848   1.1  christos       r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D;
    849   1.1  christos       break;
    850   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A:
    851   1.1  christos       r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A;
    852   1.1  christos       break;
    853   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D:
    854   1.1  christos       r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D;
    855   1.1  christos       break;
    856   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_16_PCREL:		r = R_PPC_REL16;		break;
    857   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_LO16_PCREL:		r = R_PPC_REL16_LO;		break;
    858   1.7  christos     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_PCREL:		r = R_PPC_REL16_HI;		break;
    859   1.3  christos     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_PCREL:	r = R_PPC_REL16_HA;		break;
    860   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_16DX_HA:		r = R_PPC_16DX_HA;		break;
    861   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_REL16DX_HA:	r = R_PPC_REL16DX_HA;		break;
    862   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_INHERIT:	r = R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT;	break;
    863   1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_ENTRY:	r = R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY;		break;
    864   1.1  christos     }
    865   1.1  christos 
    866   1.1  christos   return ppc_elf_howto_table[r];
    867   1.1  christos };
    868   1.1  christos 
    869   1.1  christos static reloc_howto_type *
    870   1.1  christos ppc_elf_reloc_name_lookup (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
    871   1.1  christos 			   const char *r_name)
    872   1.1  christos {
    873   1.1  christos   unsigned int i;
    874   1.1  christos 
    875   1.1  christos   for (i = 0;
    876   1.1  christos        i < sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw) / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw[0]);
    877   1.1  christos        i++)
    878   1.1  christos     if (ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].name != NULL
    879   1.1  christos 	&& strcasecmp (ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].name, r_name) == 0)
    880   1.1  christos       return &ppc_elf_howto_raw[i];
    881   1.1  christos 
    882   1.1  christos   return NULL;
    883   1.1  christos }
    884   1.1  christos 
    885  1.10  christos /* Set the howto pointer for a PowerPC ELF reloc.  */
    886   1.7  christos 
    887   1.1  christos static bool
    888   1.1  christos ppc_elf_info_to_howto (bfd *abfd,
    889   1.1  christos 		       arelent *cache_ptr,
    890   1.3  christos 		       Elf_Internal_Rela *dst)
    891   1.3  christos {
    892   1.1  christos   unsigned int r_type;
    893   1.1  christos 
    894   1.1  christos   /* Initialize howto table if not already done.  */
    895   1.1  christos   if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
    896   1.3  christos     ppc_elf_howto_init ();
    897   1.3  christos 
    898   1.3  christos   r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (dst->r_info);
    899   1.7  christos   if (r_type >= R_PPC_max)
    900   1.7  christos     {
    901   1.7  christos       /* xgettext:c-format */
    902   1.3  christos       _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: unsupported relocation type %#x"),
    903  1.10  christos 			  abfd, r_type);
    904   1.3  christos       bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
    905   1.7  christos       return false;
    906   1.3  christos     }
    907   1.1  christos 
    908   1.1  christos   cache_ptr->howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
    909   1.1  christos 
    910   1.7  christos   /* Just because the above assert didn't trigger doesn't mean that
    911   1.1  christos      ELF32_R_TYPE (dst->r_info) is necessarily a valid relocation.  */
    912   1.7  christos   if (cache_ptr->howto == NULL)
    913   1.7  christos     {
    914   1.7  christos       /* xgettext:c-format */
    915   1.1  christos       _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: unsupported relocation type %#x"),
    916   1.1  christos 			  abfd, r_type);
    917  1.10  christos       bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
    918   1.1  christos 
    919   1.7  christos       return false;
    920  1.10  christos     }
    921   1.1  christos 
    922   1.1  christos   return true;
    923   1.1  christos }
    924   1.1  christos 
    925   1.1  christos /* Handle the R_PPC_ADDR16_HA and R_PPC_REL16_HA relocs.  */
    926   1.7  christos 
    927   1.1  christos static bfd_reloc_status_type
    928   1.1  christos ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc (bfd *abfd,
    929   1.7  christos 			 arelent *reloc_entry,
    930   1.1  christos 			 asymbol *symbol,
    931   1.1  christos 			 void *data,
    932   1.1  christos 			 asection *input_section,
    933   1.1  christos 			 bfd *output_bfd,
    934   1.3  christos 			 char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
    935   1.3  christos {
    936   1.3  christos   enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
    937   1.3  christos   long insn;
    938   1.1  christos   bfd_size_type octets;
    939   1.1  christos   bfd_vma value;
    940   1.1  christos 
    941   1.1  christos   if (output_bfd != NULL)
    942   1.1  christos     {
    943   1.1  christos       reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
    944   1.1  christos       return bfd_reloc_ok;
    945   1.3  christos     }
    946   1.3  christos 
    947   1.3  christos   reloc_entry->addend += 0x8000;
    948   1.3  christos   r_type = reloc_entry->howto->type;
    949   1.3  christos   if (r_type != R_PPC_REL16DX_HA)
    950   1.3  christos     return bfd_reloc_continue;
    951   1.3  christos 
    952   1.3  christos   value = 0;
    953   1.3  christos   if (!bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
    954   1.3  christos     value = symbol->value;
    955   1.3  christos   value += (reloc_entry->addend
    956   1.3  christos 	    + symbol->section->output_offset
    957   1.3  christos 	    + symbol->section->output_section->vma);
    958   1.3  christos   value -= (reloc_entry->address
    959   1.3  christos 	    + input_section->output_offset
    960   1.3  christos 	    + input_section->output_section->vma);
    961   1.9  christos   value >>= 16;
    962  1.10  christos 
    963  1.10  christos   octets = reloc_entry->address * OCTETS_PER_BYTE (abfd, input_section);
    964  1.10  christos   if (!bfd_reloc_offset_in_range (reloc_entry->howto, abfd,
    965  1.10  christos 				  input_section, octets))
    966   1.3  christos     return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
    967   1.3  christos 
    968   1.3  christos   insn = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
    969   1.3  christos   insn &= ~0x1fffc1;
    970   1.3  christos   insn |= (value & 0xffc1) | ((value & 0x3e) << 15);
    971   1.1  christos   bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
    972   1.1  christos   return bfd_reloc_ok;
    973   1.1  christos }
    974   1.1  christos 
    975   1.1  christos static bfd_reloc_status_type
    976   1.1  christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc (bfd *abfd,
    977   1.1  christos 			 arelent *reloc_entry,
    978   1.1  christos 			 asymbol *symbol,
    979   1.1  christos 			 void *data,
    980   1.1  christos 			 asection *input_section,
    981   1.1  christos 			 bfd *output_bfd,
    982   1.1  christos 			 char **error_message)
    983   1.1  christos {
    984   1.1  christos   /* If this is a relocatable link (output_bfd test tells us), just
    985   1.1  christos      call the generic function.  Any adjustment will be done at final
    986   1.1  christos      link time.  */
    987   1.1  christos   if (output_bfd != NULL)
    988   1.1  christos     return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
    989   1.1  christos 				  input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
    990  1.11  christos 
    991  1.11  christos   if (error_message != NULL)
    992   1.1  christos     *error_message = bfd_asprintf (_("generic linker can't handle %s"),
    993   1.1  christos 				     reloc_entry->howto->name);
    994   1.1  christos   return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
    995   1.1  christos }
    996   1.1  christos 
    997   1.1  christos /* Sections created by the linker.  */
    999   1.1  christos 
   1000   1.1  christos typedef struct elf_linker_section
   1001   1.1  christos {
   1002   1.1  christos   /* Pointer to the bfd section.  */
   1003   1.1  christos   asection *section;
   1004   1.1  christos   /* Section name.  */
   1005   1.1  christos   const char *name;
   1006   1.1  christos   /* Associated bss section name.  */
   1007   1.1  christos   const char *bss_name;
   1008   1.1  christos   /* Associated symbol name.  */
   1009   1.1  christos   const char *sym_name;
   1010   1.1  christos   /* Associated symbol.  */
   1011   1.1  christos   struct elf_link_hash_entry *sym;
   1012   1.1  christos } elf_linker_section_t;
   1013   1.1  christos 
   1014   1.1  christos /* Linked list of allocated pointer entries.  This hangs off of the
   1015   1.1  christos    symbol lists, and provides allows us to return different pointers,
   1016   1.1  christos    based on different addend's.  */
   1017   1.1  christos 
   1018   1.1  christos typedef struct elf_linker_section_pointers
   1019   1.1  christos {
   1020   1.1  christos   /* next allocated pointer for this symbol */
   1021   1.1  christos   struct elf_linker_section_pointers *next;
   1022   1.1  christos   /* offset of pointer from beginning of section */
   1023   1.1  christos   bfd_vma offset;
   1024   1.1  christos   /* addend used */
   1025   1.1  christos   bfd_vma addend;
   1026   1.1  christos   /* which linker section this is */
   1027   1.1  christos   elf_linker_section_t *lsect;
   1028   1.1  christos } elf_linker_section_pointers_t;
   1029   1.1  christos 
   1030   1.1  christos struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata
   1031   1.1  christos {
   1032   1.1  christos   struct elf_obj_tdata elf;
   1033   1.1  christos 
   1034   1.1  christos   /* A mapping from local symbols to offsets into the various linker
   1035   1.1  christos      sections added.  This is index by the symbol index.  */
   1036   1.1  christos   elf_linker_section_pointers_t **linker_section_pointers;
   1037   1.1  christos 
   1038   1.1  christos   /* Flags used to auto-detect plt type.  */
   1039   1.1  christos   unsigned int makes_plt_call : 1;
   1040   1.1  christos   unsigned int has_rel16 : 1;
   1041   1.1  christos };
   1042   1.1  christos 
   1043   1.1  christos #define ppc_elf_tdata(bfd) \
   1044   1.1  christos   ((struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata *) (bfd)->tdata.any)
   1045   1.1  christos 
   1046   1.1  christos #define elf_local_ptr_offsets(bfd) \
   1047   1.1  christos   (ppc_elf_tdata (bfd)->linker_section_pointers)
   1048   1.1  christos 
   1049   1.1  christos #define is_ppc_elf(bfd) \
   1050   1.1  christos   (bfd_get_flavour (bfd) == bfd_target_elf_flavour \
   1051   1.1  christos    && elf_object_id (bfd) == PPC32_ELF_DATA)
   1052  1.10  christos 
   1053   1.1  christos /* Override the generic function because we store some extras.  */
   1054   1.1  christos 
   1055  1.12  christos static bool
   1056   1.1  christos ppc_elf_mkobject (bfd *abfd)
   1057   1.1  christos {
   1058   1.6  christos   return bfd_elf_allocate_object (abfd, sizeof (struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata));
   1059   1.6  christos }
   1060  1.10  christos 
   1061   1.6  christos /* When defaulting arch/mach, decode apuinfo to find a better match.  */
   1062   1.6  christos 
   1063   1.6  christos bool
   1064   1.6  christos _bfd_elf_ppc_set_arch (bfd *abfd)
   1065   1.6  christos {
   1066   1.6  christos   unsigned long mach = 0;
   1067   1.6  christos   asection *s;
   1068   1.6  christos   unsigned char *contents;
   1069   1.6  christos 
   1070   1.6  christos   if (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 32
   1071   1.6  christos       && bfd_big_endian (abfd))
   1072   1.6  christos     {
   1073   1.6  christos 
   1074   1.6  christos       for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
   1075   1.6  christos 	if ((elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_flags & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
   1076   1.6  christos 	  break;
   1077   1.6  christos       if (s != NULL)
   1078   1.6  christos 	mach = bfd_mach_ppc_vle;
   1079   1.6  christos     }
   1080   1.6  christos 
   1081   1.9  christos   if (mach == 0)
   1082   1.9  christos     {
   1083  1.11  christos       s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
   1084   1.9  christos       if (s != NULL
   1085   1.6  christos 	  && s->size >= 24
   1086   1.6  christos 	  && (s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) != 0
   1087   1.6  christos 	  && bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, s, &contents))
   1088   1.6  christos 	{
   1089   1.6  christos 	  unsigned int apuinfo_size = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + 4);
   1090   1.6  christos 	  unsigned int i;
   1091   1.6  christos 
   1092   1.6  christos 	  for (i = 20; i < apuinfo_size + 20 && i + 4 <= s->size; i += 4)
   1093   1.6  christos 	    {
   1094   1.6  christos 	      unsigned int val = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + i);
   1095   1.6  christos 	      switch (val >> 16)
   1096   1.6  christos 		{
   1097   1.6  christos 		case PPC_APUINFO_PMR:
   1098   1.6  christos 		case PPC_APUINFO_RFMCI:
   1099   1.6  christos 		  if (mach == 0)
   1100   1.6  christos 		    mach = bfd_mach_ppc_titan;
   1101   1.6  christos 		  break;
   1102   1.6  christos 
   1103   1.6  christos 		case PPC_APUINFO_ISEL:
   1104   1.6  christos 		case PPC_APUINFO_CACHELCK:
   1105   1.6  christos 		  if (mach == bfd_mach_ppc_titan)
   1106   1.6  christos 		    mach = bfd_mach_ppc_e500mc;
   1107   1.6  christos 		  break;
   1108   1.6  christos 
   1109   1.6  christos 		case PPC_APUINFO_SPE:
   1110   1.6  christos 		case PPC_APUINFO_EFS:
   1111   1.7  christos 		case PPC_APUINFO_BRLOCK:
   1112   1.6  christos 		  if (mach != bfd_mach_ppc_vle)
   1113   1.6  christos 		    mach = bfd_mach_ppc_e500;
   1114   1.6  christos 		  break;
   1115   1.6  christos 
   1116   1.6  christos 		case PPC_APUINFO_VLE:
   1117   1.6  christos 		  mach = bfd_mach_ppc_vle;
   1118   1.6  christos 		  break;
   1119   1.6  christos 
   1120   1.6  christos 		default:
   1121   1.6  christos 		  mach = -1ul;
   1122   1.6  christos 		}
   1123   1.6  christos 	    }
   1124   1.6  christos 	  free (contents);
   1125   1.6  christos 	}
   1126   1.6  christos     }
   1127   1.6  christos 
   1128   1.6  christos   if (mach != 0 && mach != -1ul)
   1129   1.6  christos     {
   1130   1.6  christos       const bfd_arch_info_type *arch;
   1131   1.6  christos 
   1132   1.6  christos       for (arch = abfd->arch_info->next; arch; arch = arch->next)
   1133   1.6  christos 	if (arch->mach == mach)
   1134   1.6  christos 	  {
   1135   1.6  christos 	    abfd->arch_info = arch;
   1136  1.10  christos 	    break;
   1137   1.6  christos 	  }
   1138   1.6  christos     }
   1139   1.1  christos   return true;
   1140   1.6  christos }
   1141   1.1  christos 
   1142  1.10  christos /* Fix bad default arch selected for a 32 bit input bfd when the
   1143   1.1  christos    default is 64 bit.  Also select arch based on apuinfo.  */
   1144   1.1  christos 
   1145   1.6  christos static bool
   1146  1.10  christos ppc_elf_object_p (bfd *abfd)
   1147   1.6  christos {
   1148   1.6  christos   if (!abfd->arch_info->the_default)
   1149   1.1  christos     return true;
   1150   1.1  christos 
   1151   1.1  christos   if (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 64)
   1152   1.1  christos     {
   1153   1.1  christos       Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdr = elf_elfheader (abfd);
   1154   1.1  christos 
   1155   1.1  christos       if (i_ehdr->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS32)
   1156   1.1  christos 	{
   1157   1.1  christos 	  /* Relies on arch after 64 bit default being 32 bit default.  */
   1158   1.1  christos 	  abfd->arch_info = abfd->arch_info->next;
   1159   1.6  christos 	  BFD_ASSERT (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 32);
   1160   1.1  christos 	}
   1161   1.1  christos     }
   1162   1.1  christos   return _bfd_elf_ppc_set_arch (abfd);
   1163   1.1  christos }
   1164  1.10  christos 
   1165   1.1  christos /* Function to set whether a module needs the -mrelocatable bit set.  */
   1166   1.1  christos 
   1167   1.1  christos static bool
   1168   1.1  christos ppc_elf_set_private_flags (bfd *abfd, flagword flags)
   1169   1.1  christos {
   1170   1.1  christos   BFD_ASSERT (!elf_flags_init (abfd)
   1171  1.10  christos 	      || elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags == flags);
   1172  1.10  christos 
   1173   1.1  christos   elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags = flags;
   1174   1.1  christos   elf_flags_init (abfd) = true;
   1175   1.1  christos   return true;
   1176   1.1  christos }
   1177  1.10  christos 
   1178   1.1  christos /* Support for core dump NOTE sections.  */
   1179   1.1  christos 
   1180   1.1  christos static bool
   1181   1.1  christos ppc_elf_grok_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   1182   1.1  christos {
   1183   1.1  christos   int offset;
   1184   1.1  christos   unsigned int size;
   1185   1.1  christos 
   1186  1.10  christos   switch (note->descsz)
   1187   1.1  christos     {
   1188   1.1  christos     default:
   1189   1.1  christos       return false;
   1190   1.3  christos 
   1191   1.1  christos     case 268:		/* Linux/PPC.  */
   1192   1.1  christos       /* pr_cursig */
   1193   1.3  christos       elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = bfd_get_16 (abfd, note->descdata + 12);
   1194   1.1  christos 
   1195   1.1  christos       /* pr_pid */
   1196   1.1  christos       elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 24);
   1197   1.1  christos 
   1198   1.1  christos       /* pr_reg */
   1199   1.1  christos       offset = 72;
   1200   1.1  christos       size = 192;
   1201   1.1  christos 
   1202   1.1  christos       break;
   1203   1.1  christos     }
   1204   1.1  christos 
   1205   1.1  christos   /* Make a ".reg/999" section.  */
   1206   1.1  christos   return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
   1207  1.10  christos 					  size, note->descpos + offset);
   1208   1.1  christos }
   1209   1.1  christos 
   1210   1.1  christos static bool
   1211   1.1  christos ppc_elf_grok_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   1212   1.1  christos {
   1213  1.10  christos   switch (note->descsz)
   1214   1.1  christos     {
   1215   1.1  christos     default:
   1216   1.3  christos       return false;
   1217   1.1  christos 
   1218   1.3  christos     case 128:		/* Linux/PPC elf_prpsinfo.  */
   1219   1.1  christos       elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
   1220   1.3  christos 	= bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 16);
   1221   1.1  christos       elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
   1222   1.1  christos 	= _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 32, 16);
   1223   1.1  christos       elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
   1224   1.1  christos 	= _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 48, 80);
   1225   1.1  christos     }
   1226   1.1  christos 
   1227   1.1  christos   /* Note that for some reason, a spurious space is tacked
   1228   1.1  christos      onto the end of the args in some (at least one anyway)
   1229   1.3  christos      implementations, so strip it off if it exists.  */
   1230   1.1  christos 
   1231   1.1  christos   {
   1232   1.1  christos     char *command = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command;
   1233   1.1  christos     int n = strlen (command);
   1234   1.1  christos 
   1235   1.1  christos     if (0 < n && command[n - 1] == ' ')
   1236  1.10  christos       command[n - 1] = '\0';
   1237   1.1  christos   }
   1238   1.1  christos 
   1239   1.1  christos   return true;
   1240   1.1  christos }
   1241   1.1  christos 
   1242   1.1  christos static char *
   1243   1.1  christos ppc_elf_write_core_note (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz, int note_type, ...)
   1244   1.1  christos {
   1245   1.1  christos   switch (note_type)
   1246   1.1  christos     {
   1247   1.1  christos     default:
   1248   1.1  christos       return NULL;
   1249   1.7  christos 
   1250   1.1  christos     case NT_PRPSINFO:
   1251   1.1  christos       {
   1252   1.1  christos 	char data[128] ATTRIBUTE_NONSTRING;
   1253   1.1  christos 	va_list ap;
   1254   1.1  christos 
   1255   1.9  christos 	va_start (ap, note_type);
   1256   1.7  christos 	memset (data, 0, sizeof (data));
   1257   1.9  christos 	strncpy (data + 32, va_arg (ap, const char *), 16);
   1258   1.7  christos #if GCC_VERSION == 8000 || GCC_VERSION == 8001
   1259   1.7  christos 	DIAGNOSTIC_PUSH;
   1260   1.7  christos 	/* GCC 8.0 and 8.1 warn about 80 equals destination size with
   1261   1.7  christos 	   -Wstringop-truncation:
   1262   1.7  christos 	   https://gcc.gnu.org/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=85643
   1263   1.1  christos 	 */
   1264   1.9  christos 	DIAGNOSTIC_IGNORE_STRINGOP_TRUNCATION;
   1265   1.7  christos #endif
   1266   1.7  christos 	strncpy (data + 48, va_arg (ap, const char *), 80);
   1267   1.1  christos #if GCC_VERSION == 8000 || GCC_VERSION == 8001
   1268   1.1  christos 	DIAGNOSTIC_POP;
   1269   1.1  christos #endif
   1270   1.1  christos 	va_end (ap);
   1271   1.1  christos 	return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   1272   1.1  christos 				   "CORE", note_type, data, sizeof (data));
   1273   1.1  christos       }
   1274   1.1  christos 
   1275   1.1  christos     case NT_PRSTATUS:
   1276   1.1  christos       {
   1277   1.1  christos 	char data[268];
   1278   1.1  christos 	va_list ap;
   1279   1.1  christos 	long pid;
   1280   1.1  christos 	int cursig;
   1281   1.1  christos 	const void *greg;
   1282   1.1  christos 
   1283   1.1  christos 	va_start (ap, note_type);
   1284   1.1  christos 	memset (data, 0, 72);
   1285   1.1  christos 	pid = va_arg (ap, long);
   1286   1.1  christos 	bfd_put_32 (abfd, pid, data + 24);
   1287   1.1  christos 	cursig = va_arg (ap, int);
   1288   1.1  christos 	bfd_put_16 (abfd, cursig, data + 12);
   1289   1.1  christos 	greg = va_arg (ap, const void *);
   1290   1.1  christos 	memcpy (data + 72, greg, 192);
   1291   1.1  christos 	memset (data + 264, 0, 4);
   1292   1.1  christos 	va_end (ap);
   1293   1.1  christos 	return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   1294   1.1  christos 				   "CORE", note_type, data, sizeof (data));
   1295   1.1  christos       }
   1296   1.1  christos     }
   1297   1.3  christos }
   1298   1.1  christos 
   1299   1.1  christos static flagword
   1300   1.1  christos ppc_elf_lookup_section_flags (char *flag_name)
   1301   1.1  christos {
   1302   1.1  christos 
   1303   1.1  christos   if (!strcmp (flag_name, "SHF_PPC_VLE"))
   1304   1.1  christos     return SHF_PPC_VLE;
   1305   1.1  christos 
   1306   1.1  christos   return 0;
   1307   1.1  christos }
   1308   1.1  christos 
   1309   1.1  christos /* Return address for Ith PLT stub in section PLT, for relocation REL
   1310   1.1  christos    or (bfd_vma) -1 if it should not be included.  */
   1311   1.1  christos 
   1312   1.1  christos static bfd_vma
   1313   1.1  christos ppc_elf_plt_sym_val (bfd_vma i ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   1314   1.1  christos 		     const asection *plt ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   1315   1.1  christos 		     const arelent *rel)
   1316   1.1  christos {
   1317   1.1  christos   return rel->address;
   1318   1.1  christos }
   1319   1.1  christos 
   1320   1.1  christos /* Handle a PowerPC specific section when reading an object file.  This
   1321  1.10  christos    is called when bfd_section_from_shdr finds a section with an unknown
   1322   1.1  christos    type.  */
   1323   1.1  christos 
   1324   1.1  christos static bool
   1325   1.1  christos ppc_elf_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd,
   1326   1.1  christos 			   Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr,
   1327   1.1  christos 			   const char *name,
   1328   1.1  christos 			   int shindex)
   1329   1.1  christos {
   1330   1.1  christos   asection *newsect;
   1331  1.10  christos   flagword flags;
   1332   1.1  christos 
   1333   1.1  christos   if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
   1334  1.10  christos     return false;
   1335   1.1  christos 
   1336   1.1  christos   newsect = hdr->bfd_section;
   1337   1.1  christos   flags = 0;
   1338   1.1  christos   if (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXCLUDE)
   1339   1.1  christos     flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
   1340   1.1  christos 
   1341  1.10  christos   if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_ORDERED)
   1342  1.10  christos     flags |= SEC_SORT_ENTRIES;
   1343  1.10  christos 
   1344  1.10  christos   if (startswith (name, ".PPC.EMB"))
   1345  1.10  christos     name += 8;
   1346  1.10  christos   if (startswith (name, ".sbss")
   1347  1.10  christos       || startswith (name, ".sdata"))
   1348  1.10  christos     flags |= SEC_SMALL_DATA;
   1349   1.1  christos 
   1350   1.1  christos   return (flags == 0
   1351   1.1  christos 	  || bfd_set_section_flags (newsect, newsect->flags | flags));
   1352   1.1  christos }
   1353  1.10  christos 
   1354   1.1  christos /* Set up any other section flags and such that may be necessary.  */
   1355   1.1  christos 
   1356   1.1  christos static bool
   1357   1.1  christos ppc_elf_fake_sections (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   1358   1.1  christos 		       Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr,
   1359   1.1  christos 		       asection *asect)
   1360   1.1  christos {
   1361  1.10  christos   if ((asect->flags & SEC_SORT_ENTRIES) != 0)
   1362   1.1  christos     shdr->sh_type = SHT_ORDERED;
   1363   1.1  christos 
   1364   1.1  christos   return true;
   1365   1.1  christos }
   1366   1.1  christos 
   1367   1.1  christos /* If we have .sbss2 or .PPC.EMB.sbss0 output sections, we
   1368   1.1  christos    need to bump up the number of section headers.  */
   1369   1.1  christos 
   1370   1.1  christos static int
   1371   1.1  christos ppc_elf_additional_program_headers (bfd *abfd,
   1372   1.1  christos 				    struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
   1373   1.1  christos {
   1374   1.1  christos   asection *s;
   1375   1.1  christos   int ret = 0;
   1376   1.1  christos 
   1377   1.1  christos   s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".sbss2");
   1378   1.1  christos   if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
   1379   1.1  christos     ++ret;
   1380   1.1  christos 
   1381   1.1  christos   s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".PPC.EMB.sbss0");
   1382   1.1  christos   if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
   1383   1.1  christos     ++ret;
   1384   1.1  christos 
   1385   1.3  christos   return ret;
   1386   1.1  christos }
   1387  1.10  christos 
   1388   1.1  christos /* Modify the segment map for VLE executables.  */
   1389   1.1  christos 
   1390   1.1  christos bool
   1391   1.7  christos ppc_elf_modify_segment_map (bfd *abfd,
   1392   1.1  christos 			    struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
   1393   1.1  christos {
   1394   1.1  christos   struct elf_segment_map *m;
   1395   1.1  christos 
   1396   1.1  christos   /* At this point in the link, output sections have already been sorted by
   1397   1.1  christos      LMA and assigned to segments.  All that is left to do is to ensure
   1398   1.1  christos      there is no mixing of VLE & non-VLE sections in a text segment.
   1399   1.3  christos      If we find that case, we split the segment.
   1400   1.1  christos      We maintain the original output section order.  */
   1401   1.7  christos 
   1402  1.10  christos   for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
   1403   1.7  christos     {
   1404   1.7  christos       struct elf_segment_map *n;
   1405   1.7  christos       size_t amt;
   1406   1.7  christos       unsigned int j, k;
   1407   1.1  christos       unsigned int p_flags;
   1408   1.1  christos 
   1409   1.7  christos       if (m->p_type != PT_LOAD || m->count == 0)
   1410   1.1  christos 	continue;
   1411   1.7  christos 
   1412   1.7  christos       for (p_flags = PF_R, j = 0; j != m->count; ++j)
   1413   1.7  christos 	{
   1414   1.7  christos 	  if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
   1415   1.7  christos 	    p_flags |= PF_W;
   1416   1.7  christos 	  if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
   1417   1.7  christos 	    {
   1418   1.7  christos 	      p_flags |= PF_X;
   1419   1.7  christos 	      if ((elf_section_flags (m->sections[j]) & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
   1420   1.7  christos 		p_flags |= PF_PPC_VLE;
   1421   1.7  christos 	      break;
   1422   1.7  christos 	    }
   1423   1.7  christos 	}
   1424   1.7  christos       if (j != m->count)
   1425   1.1  christos 	while (++j != m->count)
   1426   1.7  christos 	  {
   1427   1.7  christos 	    unsigned int p_flags1 = PF_R;
   1428   1.7  christos 
   1429   1.7  christos 	    if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
   1430   1.7  christos 	      p_flags1 |= PF_W;
   1431   1.7  christos 	    if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
   1432   1.7  christos 	      {
   1433   1.7  christos 		p_flags1 |= PF_X;
   1434   1.7  christos 		if ((elf_section_flags (m->sections[j]) & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
   1435   1.7  christos 		  p_flags1 |= PF_PPC_VLE;
   1436   1.7  christos 		if (((p_flags1 ^ p_flags) & PF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
   1437   1.7  christos 		  break;
   1438   1.7  christos 	      }
   1439   1.7  christos 	    p_flags |= p_flags1;
   1440   1.7  christos 	  }
   1441   1.7  christos       /* If we're splitting a segment which originally contained rw
   1442   1.7  christos 	 sections then those sections might now only be in one of the
   1443   1.7  christos 	 two parts.  So always set p_flags if splitting, even if we
   1444   1.7  christos 	 are being called for objcopy with p_flags_valid set.  */
   1445   1.7  christos       if (j != m->count || !m->p_flags_valid)
   1446   1.7  christos 	{
   1447   1.7  christos 	  m->p_flags_valid = 1;
   1448   1.1  christos 	  m->p_flags = p_flags;
   1449   1.1  christos 	}
   1450   1.7  christos       if (j == m->count)
   1451   1.1  christos 	continue;
   1452   1.1  christos 
   1453   1.1  christos       /* Sections 0..j-1 stay in this (current) segment,
   1454   1.1  christos 	 the remainder are put in a new segment.
   1455   1.1  christos 	 The scan resumes with the new segment.  */
   1456   1.1  christos 
   1457   1.1  christos       amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
   1458  1.10  christos       amt += (m->count - j - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
   1459   1.1  christos       n = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
   1460   1.1  christos       if (n == NULL)
   1461   1.1  christos 	return false;
   1462   1.1  christos 
   1463   1.7  christos       n->p_type = PT_LOAD;
   1464   1.7  christos       n->count = m->count - j;
   1465   1.7  christos       for (k = 0; k < n->count; ++k)
   1466   1.1  christos 	n->sections[k] = m->sections[j + k];
   1467   1.1  christos       m->count = j;
   1468   1.1  christos       m->p_size_valid = 0;
   1469   1.1  christos       n->next = m->next;
   1470  1.10  christos       m->next = n;
   1471   1.1  christos     }
   1472   1.1  christos 
   1473   1.1  christos   return true;
   1474   1.1  christos }
   1475   1.1  christos 
   1476   1.1  christos /* Add extra PPC sections -- Note, for now, make .sbss2 and
   1477   1.1  christos    .PPC.EMB.sbss0 a normal section, and not a bss section so
   1478   1.1  christos    that the linker doesn't crater when trying to make more than
   1479   1.1  christos    2 sections.  */
   1480   1.6  christos 
   1481   1.6  christos static const struct bfd_elf_special_section ppc_elf_special_sections[] =
   1482   1.6  christos {
   1483   1.6  christos   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"), 0, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
   1484   1.6  christos   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sbss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
   1485   1.6  christos   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sbss2"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
   1486   1.6  christos   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sdata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
   1487   1.6  christos   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sdata2"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
   1488   1.6  christos   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tags"), 0, SHT_ORDERED, SHF_ALLOC },
   1489   1.6  christos   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (APUINFO_SECTION_NAME), 0, SHT_NOTE, 0 },
   1490   1.1  christos   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".PPC.EMB.sbss0"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
   1491   1.1  christos   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".PPC.EMB.sdata0"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
   1492   1.1  christos   { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
   1493  1.10  christos };
   1494   1.7  christos 
   1495   1.1  christos /* This is what we want for new plt/got.  */
   1496   1.1  christos static const struct bfd_elf_special_section ppc_alt_plt =
   1497   1.7  christos   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"),		   0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC };
   1498   1.1  christos 
   1499   1.1  christos static const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
   1500   1.1  christos ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
   1501   1.1  christos {
   1502   1.1  christos   const struct bfd_elf_special_section *ssect;
   1503   1.1  christos 
   1504   1.1  christos   /* See if this is one of the special sections.  */
   1505   1.1  christos   if (sec->name == NULL)
   1506   1.1  christos     return NULL;
   1507   1.1  christos 
   1508   1.1  christos   ssect = _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name, ppc_elf_special_sections,
   1509   1.1  christos 					sec->use_rela_p);
   1510   1.1  christos   if (ssect != NULL)
   1511   1.1  christos     {
   1512   1.1  christos       if (ssect == ppc_elf_special_sections && (sec->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
   1513   1.1  christos 	ssect = &ppc_alt_plt;
   1514   1.1  christos       return ssect;
   1515   1.1  christos     }
   1516   1.1  christos 
   1517   1.1  christos   return _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec);
   1518   1.1  christos }
   1519   1.1  christos 
   1520   1.1  christos /* Very simple linked list structure for recording apuinfo values.  */
   1522   1.1  christos typedef struct apuinfo_list
   1523   1.1  christos {
   1524   1.1  christos   struct apuinfo_list *next;
   1525   1.1  christos   unsigned long value;
   1526  1.10  christos }
   1527   1.1  christos apuinfo_list;
   1528   1.1  christos 
   1529   1.1  christos static apuinfo_list *head;
   1530   1.1  christos static bool apuinfo_set;
   1531   1.1  christos 
   1532  1.10  christos static void
   1533   1.1  christos apuinfo_list_init (void)
   1534   1.1  christos {
   1535   1.1  christos   head = NULL;
   1536   1.1  christos   apuinfo_set = false;
   1537   1.1  christos }
   1538   1.1  christos 
   1539   1.1  christos static void
   1540   1.1  christos apuinfo_list_add (unsigned long value)
   1541   1.1  christos {
   1542   1.1  christos   apuinfo_list *entry = head;
   1543   1.1  christos 
   1544   1.1  christos   while (entry != NULL)
   1545   1.1  christos     {
   1546   1.1  christos       if (entry->value == value)
   1547   1.1  christos 	return;
   1548   1.1  christos       entry = entry->next;
   1549   1.1  christos     }
   1550   1.1  christos 
   1551   1.1  christos   entry = bfd_malloc (sizeof (* entry));
   1552   1.1  christos   if (entry == NULL)
   1553   1.1  christos     return;
   1554   1.1  christos 
   1555   1.1  christos   entry->value = value;
   1556   1.1  christos   entry->next  = head;
   1557   1.1  christos   head = entry;
   1558   1.1  christos }
   1559   1.1  christos 
   1560   1.1  christos static unsigned
   1561   1.1  christos apuinfo_list_length (void)
   1562   1.1  christos {
   1563   1.1  christos   apuinfo_list *entry;
   1564   1.1  christos   unsigned long count;
   1565   1.1  christos 
   1566   1.1  christos   for (entry = head, count = 0;
   1567   1.1  christos        entry;
   1568   1.1  christos        entry = entry->next)
   1569   1.1  christos     ++ count;
   1570   1.1  christos 
   1571   1.1  christos   return count;
   1572   1.1  christos }
   1573   1.1  christos 
   1574   1.1  christos static inline unsigned long
   1575   1.1  christos apuinfo_list_element (unsigned long number)
   1576   1.1  christos {
   1577   1.1  christos   apuinfo_list * entry;
   1578   1.1  christos 
   1579   1.1  christos   for (entry = head;
   1580   1.1  christos        entry && number --;
   1581   1.1  christos        entry = entry->next)
   1582   1.1  christos     ;
   1583   1.1  christos 
   1584   1.1  christos   return entry ? entry->value : 0;
   1585   1.1  christos }
   1586   1.1  christos 
   1587   1.1  christos static void
   1588   1.1  christos apuinfo_list_finish (void)
   1589   1.1  christos {
   1590   1.1  christos   apuinfo_list *entry;
   1591   1.1  christos 
   1592   1.1  christos   for (entry = head; entry;)
   1593   1.1  christos     {
   1594   1.1  christos       apuinfo_list *next = entry->next;
   1595   1.1  christos       free (entry);
   1596   1.1  christos       entry = next;
   1597   1.1  christos     }
   1598   1.1  christos 
   1599   1.1  christos   head = NULL;
   1600   1.1  christos }
   1601   1.1  christos 
   1602   1.1  christos /* Scan the input BFDs and create a linked list of
   1603   1.1  christos    the APUinfo values that will need to be emitted.  */
   1604   1.1  christos 
   1605   1.1  christos static void
   1606   1.1  christos ppc_elf_begin_write_processing (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
   1607   1.1  christos {
   1608   1.1  christos   bfd *ibfd;
   1609   1.1  christos   asection *asec;
   1610   1.1  christos   char *buffer = NULL;
   1611   1.1  christos   bfd_size_type largest_input_size = 0;
   1612   1.1  christos   unsigned i;
   1613   1.1  christos   unsigned long length;
   1614   1.1  christos   const char *error_message = NULL;
   1615   1.1  christos 
   1616   1.1  christos   if (link_info == NULL)
   1617   1.1  christos     return;
   1618   1.3  christos 
   1619   1.1  christos   apuinfo_list_init ();
   1620   1.1  christos 
   1621   1.1  christos   /* Read in the input sections contents.  */
   1622   1.1  christos   for (ibfd = link_info->input_bfds; ibfd; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
   1623   1.1  christos     {
   1624   1.1  christos       unsigned long datum;
   1625   1.1  christos 
   1626   1.7  christos       asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
   1627   1.7  christos       if (asec == NULL)
   1628   1.1  christos 	continue;
   1629   1.1  christos 
   1630   1.1  christos       /* xgettext:c-format */
   1631   1.1  christos       error_message = _("corrupt %s section in %pB");
   1632  1.10  christos       length = asec->size;
   1633   1.1  christos       if (length < 20)
   1634   1.1  christos 	goto fail;
   1635  1.10  christos 
   1636   1.1  christos       apuinfo_set = true;
   1637   1.1  christos       if (largest_input_size < asec->size)
   1638   1.1  christos 	{
   1639   1.1  christos 	  free (buffer);
   1640   1.1  christos 	  largest_input_size = asec->size;
   1641   1.1  christos 	  buffer = bfd_malloc (largest_input_size);
   1642   1.1  christos 	  if (!buffer)
   1643  1.11  christos 	    return;
   1644   1.1  christos 	}
   1645   1.7  christos 
   1646   1.7  christos       if (bfd_seek (ibfd, asec->filepos, SEEK_SET) != 0
   1647   1.1  christos 	  || (bfd_read (buffer, length, ibfd) != length))
   1648   1.1  christos 	{
   1649   1.1  christos 	  /* xgettext:c-format */
   1650   1.1  christos 	  error_message = _("unable to read in %s section from %pB");
   1651   1.1  christos 	  goto fail;
   1652   1.1  christos 	}
   1653   1.1  christos 
   1654   1.1  christos       /* Verify the contents of the header.  Note - we have to
   1655   1.1  christos 	 extract the values this way in order to allow for a
   1656   1.1  christos 	 host whose endian-ness is different from the target.  */
   1657   1.1  christos       datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer);
   1658   1.1  christos       if (datum != sizeof APUINFO_LABEL)
   1659   1.1  christos 	goto fail;
   1660   1.1  christos 
   1661   1.1  christos       datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 8);
   1662   1.1  christos       if (datum != 0x2)
   1663   1.1  christos 	goto fail;
   1664   1.1  christos 
   1665   1.1  christos       if (strcmp (buffer + 12, APUINFO_LABEL) != 0)
   1666   1.1  christos 	goto fail;
   1667   1.1  christos 
   1668   1.1  christos       /* Get the number of bytes used for apuinfo entries.  */
   1669   1.1  christos       datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 4);
   1670   1.1  christos       if (datum + 20 != length)
   1671   1.1  christos 	goto fail;
   1672   1.1  christos 
   1673   1.1  christos       /* Scan the apuinfo section, building a list of apuinfo numbers.  */
   1674   1.1  christos       for (i = 0; i < datum; i += 4)
   1675   1.1  christos 	apuinfo_list_add (bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 20 + i));
   1676   1.1  christos     }
   1677   1.1  christos 
   1678   1.1  christos   error_message = NULL;
   1679   1.1  christos 
   1680   1.1  christos   if (apuinfo_set)
   1681   1.1  christos     {
   1682   1.1  christos       /* Compute the size of the output section.  */
   1683   1.1  christos       unsigned num_entries = apuinfo_list_length ();
   1684   1.9  christos 
   1685   1.1  christos       /* Set the output section size, if it exists.  */
   1686   1.1  christos       asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
   1687   1.7  christos 
   1688   1.7  christos       if (asec && !bfd_set_section_size (asec, 20 + num_entries * 4))
   1689   1.1  christos 	{
   1690   1.1  christos 	  ibfd = abfd;
   1691   1.1  christos 	  /* xgettext:c-format */
   1692   1.1  christos 	  error_message = _("warning: unable to set size of %s section in %pB");
   1693  1.10  christos 	}
   1694   1.1  christos     }
   1695   1.1  christos 
   1696   1.7  christos  fail:
   1697   1.1  christos   free (buffer);
   1698   1.1  christos 
   1699   1.1  christos   if (error_message)
   1700   1.1  christos     _bfd_error_handler (error_message, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME, ibfd);
   1701   1.1  christos }
   1702  1.10  christos 
   1703   1.1  christos /* Prevent the output section from accumulating the input sections'
   1704   1.1  christos    contents.  We have already stored this in our linked list structure.  */
   1705   1.1  christos 
   1706   1.1  christos static bool
   1707   1.1  christos ppc_elf_write_section (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   1708   1.1  christos 		       struct bfd_link_info *link_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   1709   1.1  christos 		       asection *asec,
   1710   1.1  christos 		       bfd_byte *contents ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
   1711   1.1  christos {
   1712   1.1  christos   return apuinfo_set && strcmp (asec->name, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME) == 0;
   1713   1.1  christos }
   1714   1.9  christos 
   1715   1.1  christos /* Finally we can generate the output section.  */
   1716   1.1  christos 
   1717   1.1  christos static void
   1718   1.1  christos ppc_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd)
   1719   1.1  christos {
   1720   1.1  christos   bfd_byte *buffer;
   1721   1.1  christos   asection *asec;
   1722   1.1  christos   unsigned i;
   1723   1.1  christos   unsigned num_entries;
   1724   1.1  christos   bfd_size_type length;
   1725   1.1  christos 
   1726   1.1  christos   asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
   1727   1.1  christos   if (asec == NULL)
   1728   1.1  christos     return;
   1729   1.1  christos 
   1730   1.1  christos   if (!apuinfo_set)
   1731   1.1  christos     return;
   1732   1.1  christos 
   1733   1.1  christos   length = asec->size;
   1734   1.1  christos   if (length < 20)
   1735   1.1  christos     return;
   1736   1.7  christos 
   1737   1.7  christos   buffer = bfd_malloc (length);
   1738   1.1  christos   if (buffer == NULL)
   1739   1.1  christos     {
   1740   1.1  christos       _bfd_error_handler
   1741   1.1  christos 	(_("failed to allocate space for new APUinfo section"));
   1742   1.1  christos       return;
   1743   1.1  christos     }
   1744   1.1  christos 
   1745   1.1  christos   /* Create the apuinfo header.  */
   1746   1.1  christos   num_entries = apuinfo_list_length ();
   1747   1.1  christos   bfd_put_32 (abfd, sizeof APUINFO_LABEL, buffer);
   1748   1.1  christos   bfd_put_32 (abfd, num_entries * 4, buffer + 4);
   1749   1.1  christos   bfd_put_32 (abfd, 0x2, buffer + 8);
   1750   1.1  christos   strcpy ((char *) buffer + 12, APUINFO_LABEL);
   1751   1.1  christos 
   1752   1.1  christos   length = 20;
   1753   1.1  christos   for (i = 0; i < num_entries; i++)
   1754   1.1  christos     {
   1755   1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (abfd, apuinfo_list_element (i), buffer + length);
   1756   1.7  christos       length += 4;
   1757   1.1  christos     }
   1758   1.1  christos 
   1759   1.7  christos   if (length != asec->size)
   1760   1.1  christos     _bfd_error_handler (_("failed to compute new APUinfo section"));
   1761   1.1  christos 
   1762   1.1  christos   if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, asec, buffer, (file_ptr) 0, length))
   1763   1.1  christos     _bfd_error_handler (_("failed to install new APUinfo section"));
   1764   1.1  christos 
   1765   1.9  christos   free (buffer);
   1766  1.10  christos 
   1767   1.9  christos   apuinfo_list_finish ();
   1768   1.9  christos }
   1769   1.9  christos 
   1770   1.9  christos static bool
   1771   1.9  christos ppc_elf_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd)
   1772   1.1  christos {
   1773  1.10  christos   ppc_final_write_processing (abfd);
   1774   1.1  christos   return _bfd_elf_final_write_processing (abfd);
   1775   1.1  christos }
   1776   1.7  christos 
   1777   1.1  christos static bool
   1779  1.10  christos is_nonpic_glink_stub (bfd *abfd, asection *glink, bfd_vma off)
   1780   1.1  christos {
   1781   1.1  christos   bfd_byte buf[4 * 4];
   1782   1.1  christos 
   1783   1.1  christos   if (!bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf, off, sizeof buf))
   1784   1.1  christos     return false;
   1785   1.1  christos 
   1786   1.1  christos   return ((bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 0) & 0xffff0000) == LIS_11
   1787  1.10  christos 	  && (bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 4) & 0xffff0000) == LWZ_11_11
   1788   1.1  christos 	  && bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 8) == MTCTR_11
   1789   1.1  christos 	  && bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 12) == BCTR);
   1790   1.1  christos }
   1791   1.1  christos 
   1792   1.1  christos static bool
   1793   1.1  christos section_covers_vma (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, asection *section, void *ptr)
   1794   1.1  christos {
   1795   1.1  christos   bfd_vma vma = *(bfd_vma *) ptr;
   1796   1.1  christos   return ((section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
   1797   1.1  christos 	  && section->vma <= vma
   1798   1.1  christos 	  && vma < section->vma + section->size);
   1799   1.1  christos }
   1800   1.1  christos 
   1801  1.10  christos static long
   1802   1.1  christos ppc_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (bfd *abfd, long symcount, asymbol **syms,
   1803   1.1  christos 			      long dynsymcount, asymbol **dynsyms,
   1804   1.1  christos 			      asymbol **ret)
   1805   1.7  christos {
   1806   1.1  christos   bool (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bool);
   1807   1.1  christos   asection *plt, *relplt, *dynamic, *glink;
   1808   1.9  christos   bfd_vma glink_vma = 0;
   1809   1.1  christos   bfd_vma resolv_vma = 0;
   1810   1.1  christos   bfd_vma stub_off;
   1811   1.1  christos   asymbol *s;
   1812   1.1  christos   arelent *p;
   1813   1.1  christos   size_t count, i, stub_delta;
   1814   1.1  christos   size_t size;
   1815   1.1  christos   char *names;
   1816   1.1  christos   bfd_byte buf[4];
   1817   1.1  christos 
   1818   1.1  christos   *ret = NULL;
   1819   1.1  christos 
   1820   1.1  christos   if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0)
   1821   1.1  christos     return 0;
   1822   1.1  christos 
   1823   1.1  christos   if (dynsymcount <= 0)
   1824   1.1  christos     return 0;
   1825   1.1  christos 
   1826   1.1  christos   relplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rela.plt");
   1827   1.1  christos   if (relplt == NULL)
   1828   1.1  christos     return 0;
   1829   1.1  christos 
   1830   1.1  christos   plt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".plt");
   1831   1.1  christos   if (plt == NULL)
   1832   1.1  christos     return 0;
   1833   1.1  christos 
   1834   1.1  christos   /* Call common code to handle old-style executable PLTs.  */
   1835   1.1  christos   if (elf_section_flags (plt) & SHF_EXECINSTR)
   1836   1.1  christos     return _bfd_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (abfd, symcount, syms,
   1837  1.11  christos 					  dynsymcount, dynsyms, ret);
   1838  1.11  christos 
   1839   1.1  christos   /* If this object was prelinked, the prelinker stored the address
   1840   1.1  christos      of .glink at got[1].  If it wasn't prelinked, got[1] will be zero.  */
   1841   1.1  christos   dynamic = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
   1842   1.1  christos   if (dynamic != NULL
   1843   1.1  christos       && (dynamic->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) != 0)
   1844   1.1  christos     {
   1845   1.1  christos       bfd_byte *dynbuf, *extdyn, *extdynend;
   1846   1.1  christos       size_t extdynsize;
   1847   1.1  christos       void (*swap_dyn_in) (bfd *, const void *, Elf_Internal_Dyn *);
   1848   1.1  christos 
   1849   1.1  christos       if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, dynamic, &dynbuf))
   1850  1.11  christos 	return -1;
   1851  1.11  christos 
   1852  1.11  christos       extdynsize = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_dyn;
   1853   1.1  christos       swap_dyn_in = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->swap_dyn_in;
   1854   1.1  christos 
   1855   1.1  christos       for (extdyn = dynbuf, extdynend = dynbuf + dynamic->size;
   1856   1.1  christos 	   (size_t) (extdynend - extdyn) >= extdynsize;
   1857   1.1  christos 	   extdyn += extdynsize)
   1858   1.1  christos 	{
   1859   1.1  christos 	  Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
   1860   1.1  christos 	  (*swap_dyn_in) (abfd, extdyn, &dyn);
   1861   1.1  christos 
   1862   1.1  christos 	  if (dyn.d_tag == DT_NULL)
   1863   1.1  christos 	    break;
   1864   1.1  christos 
   1865   1.1  christos 	  if (dyn.d_tag == DT_PPC_GOT)
   1866   1.1  christos 	    {
   1867   1.1  christos 	      unsigned int g_o_t = dyn.d_un.d_val;
   1868   1.1  christos 	      asection *got = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got");
   1869   1.1  christos 	      if (got != NULL
   1870   1.1  christos 		  && bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, got, buf,
   1871   1.1  christos 					       g_o_t - got->vma + 4, 4))
   1872   1.1  christos 		glink_vma = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
   1873   1.1  christos 	      break;
   1874   1.1  christos 	    }
   1875   1.1  christos 	}
   1876   1.1  christos       free (dynbuf);
   1877   1.1  christos     }
   1878   1.1  christos 
   1879   1.1  christos   /* Otherwise we read the first plt entry.  */
   1880   1.1  christos   if (glink_vma == 0)
   1881   1.1  christos     {
   1882   1.1  christos       if (bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, plt, buf, 0, 4))
   1883   1.1  christos 	glink_vma = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
   1884   1.1  christos     }
   1885   1.1  christos 
   1886   1.1  christos   if (glink_vma == 0)
   1887   1.1  christos     return 0;
   1888   1.1  christos 
   1889   1.1  christos   /* The .glink section usually does not survive the final
   1890   1.1  christos      link; search for the section (usually .text) where the
   1891   1.1  christos      glink stubs now reside.  */
   1892   1.1  christos   glink = bfd_sections_find_if (abfd, section_covers_vma, &glink_vma);
   1893   1.1  christos   if (glink == NULL)
   1894   1.1  christos     return 0;
   1895   1.1  christos 
   1896   1.1  christos   /* Determine glink PLT resolver by reading the relative branch
   1897   1.1  christos      from the first glink stub.  */
   1898   1.1  christos   if (bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf,
   1899   1.1  christos 				glink_vma - glink->vma, 4))
   1900   1.1  christos     {
   1901   1.1  christos       unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
   1902   1.1  christos 
   1903   1.1  christos       /* The first glink stub may either branch to the resolver ...  */
   1904   1.1  christos       insn ^= B;
   1905   1.1  christos       if ((insn & ~0x3fffffc) == 0)
   1906   1.1  christos 	resolv_vma = glink_vma + (insn ^ 0x2000000) - 0x2000000;
   1907   1.1  christos 
   1908   1.1  christos       /* ... or fall through a bunch of NOPs.  */
   1909   1.1  christos       else if ((insn ^ B ^ NOP) == 0)
   1910   1.1  christos 	for (i = 4;
   1911   1.1  christos 	     bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf,
   1912   1.1  christos 				       glink_vma - glink->vma + i, 4);
   1913   1.1  christos 	     i += 4)
   1914   1.1  christos 	  if (bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf) != NOP)
   1915   1.1  christos 	    {
   1916  1.11  christos 	      resolv_vma = glink_vma + i;
   1917   1.1  christos 	      break;
   1918   1.1  christos 	    }
   1919   1.1  christos     }
   1920   1.7  christos 
   1921   1.7  christos   count = NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (&elf_section_data (relplt)->this_hdr);
   1922   1.7  christos   /* If the stubs are those for -shared/-pie then we might have
   1923   1.7  christos      multiple stubs for each plt entry.  If that is the case then
   1924   1.7  christos      there is no way to associate stubs with their plt entries short
   1925   1.7  christos      of figuring out the GOT pointer value used in the stub.
   1926   1.7  christos      The offsets tested here need to cover all possible values of
   1927   1.7  christos      GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE for other than __tls_get_addr_opt.  */
   1928   1.1  christos   stub_off = glink_vma - glink->vma;
   1929   1.1  christos   for (stub_delta = 16; stub_delta <= 32; stub_delta += 8)
   1930   1.1  christos     if (is_nonpic_glink_stub (abfd, glink, stub_off - stub_delta))
   1931  1.10  christos       break;
   1932   1.1  christos   if (stub_delta > 32)
   1933   1.1  christos     return 0;
   1934   1.1  christos 
   1935   1.1  christos   slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
   1936   1.1  christos   if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, relplt, dynsyms, true))
   1937   1.1  christos     return -1;
   1938   1.1  christos 
   1939   1.1  christos   size = count * sizeof (asymbol);
   1940   1.1  christos   p = relplt->relocation;
   1941   1.1  christos   for (i = 0; i < count; i++, p++)
   1942   1.1  christos     {
   1943   1.1  christos       size += strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name) + sizeof ("@plt");
   1944   1.1  christos       if (p->addend != 0)
   1945   1.1  christos 	size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8;
   1946   1.1  christos     }
   1947   1.1  christos 
   1948   1.1  christos   size += sizeof (asymbol) + sizeof ("__glink");
   1949   1.1  christos 
   1950   1.1  christos   if (resolv_vma)
   1951   1.1  christos     size += sizeof (asymbol) + sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve");
   1952   1.7  christos 
   1953   1.1  christos   s = *ret = bfd_malloc (size);
   1954   1.3  christos   if (s == NULL)
   1955   1.3  christos     return -1;
   1956   1.1  christos 
   1957   1.1  christos   stub_off = glink_vma - glink->vma;
   1958   1.1  christos   names = (char *) (s + count + 1 + (resolv_vma != 0));
   1959   1.7  christos   p = relplt->relocation + count - 1;
   1960   1.7  christos   for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
   1961   1.7  christos     {
   1962   1.1  christos       size_t len;
   1963   1.1  christos 
   1964   1.1  christos       stub_off -= stub_delta;
   1965   1.1  christos       if (strcmp ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, "__tls_get_addr_opt") == 0)
   1966   1.1  christos 	stub_off -= 32;
   1967   1.1  christos       *s = **p->sym_ptr_ptr;
   1968   1.1  christos       /* Undefined syms won't have BSF_LOCAL or BSF_GLOBAL set.  Since
   1969   1.7  christos 	 we are defining a symbol, ensure one of them is set.  */
   1970   1.1  christos       if ((s->flags & BSF_LOCAL) == 0)
   1971   1.1  christos 	s->flags |= BSF_GLOBAL;
   1972   1.1  christos       s->flags |= BSF_SYNTHETIC;
   1973   1.1  christos       s->section = glink;
   1974   1.1  christos       s->value = stub_off;
   1975   1.1  christos       s->name = names;
   1976   1.1  christos       s->udata.p = NULL;
   1977   1.1  christos       len = strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name);
   1978   1.1  christos       memcpy (names, (*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, len);
   1979   1.1  christos       names += len;
   1980   1.1  christos       if (p->addend != 0)
   1981   1.1  christos 	{
   1982   1.1  christos 	  memcpy (names, "+0x", sizeof ("+0x") - 1);
   1983   1.1  christos 	  names += sizeof ("+0x") - 1;
   1984   1.1  christos 	  bfd_sprintf_vma (abfd, names, p->addend);
   1985   1.3  christos 	  names += strlen (names);
   1986   1.1  christos 	}
   1987   1.1  christos       memcpy (names, "@plt", sizeof ("@plt"));
   1988   1.1  christos       names += sizeof ("@plt");
   1989   1.1  christos       ++s;
   1990   1.1  christos       --p;
   1991   1.1  christos     }
   1992   1.1  christos 
   1993   1.1  christos   /* Add a symbol at the start of the glink branch table.  */
   1994   1.1  christos   memset (s, 0, sizeof *s);
   1995   1.1  christos   s->the_bfd = abfd;
   1996   1.1  christos   s->flags = BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_SYNTHETIC;
   1997   1.1  christos   s->section = glink;
   1998   1.1  christos   s->value = glink_vma - glink->vma;
   1999   1.1  christos   s->name = names;
   2000   1.1  christos   memcpy (names, "__glink", sizeof ("__glink"));
   2001   1.1  christos   names += sizeof ("__glink");
   2002   1.1  christos   s++;
   2003   1.1  christos   count++;
   2004   1.1  christos 
   2005   1.1  christos   if (resolv_vma)
   2006   1.1  christos     {
   2007   1.1  christos       /* Add a symbol for the glink PLT resolver.  */
   2008   1.1  christos       memset (s, 0, sizeof *s);
   2009   1.1  christos       s->the_bfd = abfd;
   2010   1.1  christos       s->flags = BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_SYNTHETIC;
   2011   1.1  christos       s->section = glink;
   2012   1.1  christos       s->value = resolv_vma - glink->vma;
   2013   1.1  christos       s->name = names;
   2014   1.1  christos       memcpy (names, "__glink_PLTresolve", sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve"));
   2015   1.1  christos       names += sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve");
   2016   1.1  christos       s++;
   2017   1.1  christos       count++;
   2018   1.1  christos     }
   2019   1.1  christos 
   2020   1.1  christos   return count;
   2021   1.1  christos }
   2022   1.1  christos 
   2023   1.1  christos /* The following functions are specific to the ELF linker, while
   2025   1.1  christos    functions above are used generally.  They appear in this file more
   2026   1.1  christos    or less in the order in which they are called.  eg.
   2027   1.1  christos    ppc_elf_check_relocs is called early in the link process,
   2028   1.1  christos    ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections is one of the last functions
   2029   1.1  christos    called.  */
   2030   1.1  christos 
   2031   1.1  christos /* Track PLT entries needed for a given symbol.  We might need more
   2032   1.1  christos    than one glink entry per symbol when generating a pic binary.  */
   2033   1.1  christos struct plt_entry
   2034   1.1  christos {
   2035   1.1  christos   struct plt_entry *next;
   2036   1.1  christos 
   2037   1.1  christos   /* -fPIC uses multiple GOT sections, one per file, called ".got2".
   2038   1.1  christos      This field stores the offset into .got2 used to initialise the
   2039   1.1  christos      GOT pointer reg.  It will always be at least 32768.  (Current
   2040   1.1  christos      gcc always uses an offset of 32768, but ld -r will pack .got2
   2041   1.1  christos      sections together resulting in larger offsets).  */
   2042   1.1  christos   bfd_vma addend;
   2043   1.1  christos 
   2044   1.1  christos   /* The .got2 section.  */
   2045   1.1  christos   asection *sec;
   2046   1.1  christos 
   2047   1.1  christos   /* PLT refcount or offset.  */
   2048   1.1  christos   union
   2049   1.1  christos     {
   2050   1.1  christos       bfd_signed_vma refcount;
   2051   1.1  christos       bfd_vma offset;
   2052   1.7  christos     } plt;
   2053   1.7  christos 
   2054   1.7  christos   /* .glink stub offset.  */
   2055   1.1  christos   bfd_vma glink_offset;
   2056   1.1  christos };
   2057   1.1  christos 
   2058   1.1  christos /* Of those relocs that might be copied as dynamic relocs, this
   2059   1.1  christos    function selects those that must be copied when linking a shared
   2060   1.1  christos    library or PIE, even when the symbol is local.  */
   2061   1.1  christos 
   2062   1.1  christos static int
   2063   1.7  christos must_be_dyn_reloc (struct bfd_link_info *info,
   2064   1.7  christos 		   enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
   2065   1.7  christos {
   2066   1.7  christos   switch (r_type)
   2067   1.1  christos     {
   2068   1.1  christos     default:
   2069   1.1  christos       /* Only relative relocs can be resolved when the object load
   2070   1.1  christos 	 address isn't fixed.  DTPREL32 is excluded because the
   2071   1.1  christos 	 dynamic linker needs to differentiate global dynamic from
   2072   1.1  christos 	 local dynamic __tls_index pairs when PPC_OPT_TLS is set.  */
   2073   1.1  christos       return 1;
   2074   1.1  christos 
   2075   1.1  christos     case R_PPC_REL24:
   2076   1.1  christos     case R_PPC_REL14:
   2077   1.1  christos     case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
   2078   1.1  christos     case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
   2079   1.1  christos     case R_PPC_REL32:
   2080   1.1  christos       return 0;
   2081   1.7  christos 
   2082   1.7  christos     case R_PPC_TPREL32:
   2083   1.7  christos     case R_PPC_TPREL16:
   2084   1.1  christos     case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
   2085   1.1  christos     case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
   2086   1.1  christos     case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
   2087   1.1  christos       /* These relocations are relative but in a shared library the
   2088   1.1  christos 	 linker doesn't know the thread pointer base.  */
   2089   1.1  christos       return bfd_link_dll (info);
   2090   1.1  christos     }
   2091   1.1  christos }
   2092   1.1  christos 
   2093   1.3  christos /* If ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS is non-zero, the linker will try to avoid
   2094   1.3  christos    copying dynamic variables from a shared lib into an app's dynbss
   2095   1.3  christos    section, and instead use a dynamic relocation to point into the
   2096   1.3  christos    shared lib.  */
   2097   1.3  christos #define ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS 1
   2098   1.3  christos 
   2099   1.3  christos /* Used to track dynamic relocations for local symbols.  */
   2100   1.3  christos struct ppc_dyn_relocs
   2101   1.3  christos {
   2102   1.3  christos   struct ppc_dyn_relocs *next;
   2103   1.3  christos 
   2104   1.3  christos   /* The input section of the reloc.  */
   2105   1.3  christos   asection *sec;
   2106   1.3  christos 
   2107   1.3  christos   /* Total number of relocs copied for the input section.  */
   2108   1.1  christos   unsigned int count : 31;
   2109   1.1  christos 
   2110   1.1  christos   /* Whether this entry is for STT_GNU_IFUNC symbols.  */
   2111   1.1  christos   unsigned int ifunc : 1;
   2112   1.1  christos };
   2113   1.1  christos 
   2114   1.1  christos /* PPC ELF linker hash entry.  */
   2115   1.1  christos 
   2116   1.1  christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry
   2117   1.1  christos {
   2118   1.1  christos   struct elf_link_hash_entry elf;
   2119   1.7  christos 
   2120   1.7  christos   /* If this symbol is used in the linker created sections, the processor
   2121   1.7  christos      specific backend uses this field to map the field into the offset
   2122   1.7  christos      from the beginning of the section.  */
   2123   1.7  christos   elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_pointer;
   2124   1.7  christos 
   2125   1.9  christos   /* Contexts in which symbol is used in the GOT.
   2126   1.7  christos      Bits are or'd into the mask as the corresponding relocs are
   2127   1.7  christos      encountered during check_relocs, with TLS_TLS being set when any
   2128   1.7  christos      of the other TLS bits are set.  tls_optimize clears bits when
   2129   1.7  christos      optimizing to indicate the corresponding GOT entry type is not
   2130   1.7  christos      needed.  If set, TLS_TLS is never cleared.  tls_optimize may also
   2131   1.7  christos      set TLS_GDIE when a GD reloc turns into an IE one.
   2132   1.7  christos      These flags are also kept for local symbols.  */
   2133   1.9  christos #define TLS_TLS		 1	/* Any TLS reloc.  */
   2134   1.7  christos #define TLS_GD		 2	/* GD reloc. */
   2135   1.7  christos #define TLS_LD		 4	/* LD reloc. */
   2136   1.7  christos #define TLS_TPREL	 8	/* TPREL reloc, => IE. */
   2137   1.7  christos #define TLS_DTPREL	16	/* DTPREL reloc, => LD. */
   2138   1.7  christos #define TLS_MARK	32	/* __tls_get_addr call marked. */
   2139   1.7  christos #define TLS_GDIE	64	/* GOT TPREL reloc resulting from GD->IE. */
   2140   1.7  christos   unsigned char tls_mask;
   2141   1.1  christos 
   2142   1.1  christos   /* The above field is also used to mark function symbols.  In which
   2143   1.1  christos      case TLS_TLS will be 0.  */
   2144   1.3  christos #define PLT_IFUNC	 2	/* STT_GNU_IFUNC.  */
   2145   1.3  christos #define PLT_KEEP	 4	/* inline plt call requires plt entry.  */
   2146   1.3  christos #define NON_GOT        256	/* local symbol plt, not stored.  */
   2147   1.3  christos 
   2148   1.3  christos   /* Nonzero if we have seen a small data relocation referring to this
   2149   1.1  christos      symbol.  */
   2150   1.1  christos   unsigned char has_sda_refs : 1;
   2151   1.1  christos 
   2152   1.1  christos   /* Flag use of given relocations.  */
   2153   1.1  christos   unsigned char has_addr16_ha : 1;
   2154   1.1  christos   unsigned char has_addr16_lo : 1;
   2155   1.1  christos };
   2156   1.1  christos 
   2157   1.1  christos #define ppc_elf_hash_entry(ent) ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) (ent))
   2158   1.1  christos 
   2159   1.3  christos /* PPC ELF linker hash table.  */
   2160   1.3  christos 
   2161   1.3  christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table
   2162   1.1  christos {
   2163   1.1  christos   struct elf_link_hash_table elf;
   2164   1.1  christos 
   2165   1.1  christos   /* Various options passed from the linker.  */
   2166   1.1  christos   struct ppc_elf_params *params;
   2167   1.1  christos 
   2168   1.1  christos   /* Short-cuts to get to dynamic linker sections.  */
   2169   1.7  christos   asection *glink;
   2170   1.7  christos   asection *dynsbss;
   2171   1.1  christos   asection *relsbss;
   2172   1.1  christos   elf_linker_section_t sdata[2];
   2173   1.1  christos   asection *sbss;
   2174   1.1  christos   asection *glink_eh_frame;
   2175   1.1  christos   asection *pltlocal;
   2176   1.1  christos   asection *relpltlocal;
   2177   1.1  christos 
   2178   1.1  christos   /* The (unloaded but important) .rela.plt.unloaded on VxWorks.  */
   2179   1.1  christos   asection *srelplt2;
   2180   1.1  christos 
   2181   1.1  christos   /* Shortcut to __tls_get_addr.  */
   2182   1.1  christos   struct elf_link_hash_entry *tls_get_addr;
   2183   1.1  christos 
   2184   1.1  christos   /* The bfd that forced an old-style PLT.  */
   2185   1.1  christos   bfd *old_bfd;
   2186   1.1  christos 
   2187   1.1  christos   /* TLS local dynamic got entry handling.  */
   2188   1.1  christos   union {
   2189   1.1  christos     bfd_signed_vma refcount;
   2190   1.1  christos     bfd_vma offset;
   2191   1.1  christos   } tlsld_got;
   2192   1.1  christos 
   2193   1.1  christos   /* Offset of branch table to PltResolve function in glink.  */
   2194   1.1  christos   bfd_vma glink_pltresolve;
   2195   1.1  christos 
   2196   1.1  christos   /* Size of reserved GOT entries.  */
   2197   1.1  christos   unsigned int got_header_size;
   2198   1.7  christos   /* Non-zero if allocating the header left a gap.  */
   2199   1.7  christos   unsigned int got_gap;
   2200   1.7  christos 
   2201   1.7  christos   /* The type of PLT we have chosen to use.  */
   2202   1.7  christos   enum ppc_elf_plt_type plt_type;
   2203   1.7  christos 
   2204   1.7  christos   /* Whether there exist local gnu indirect function resolvers,
   2205   1.7  christos      referenced by dynamic relocations.  */
   2206   1.7  christos   unsigned int local_ifunc_resolver:1;
   2207   1.7  christos   unsigned int maybe_local_ifunc_resolver:1;
   2208   1.7  christos 
   2209   1.1  christos   /* Set if tls optimization is enabled.  */
   2210   1.1  christos   unsigned int do_tls_opt:1;
   2211   1.1  christos 
   2212   1.1  christos   /* Set if inline plt calls should be converted to direct calls.  */
   2213   1.1  christos   unsigned int can_convert_all_inline_plt:1;
   2214   1.1  christos 
   2215   1.1  christos   /* The size of PLT entries.  */
   2216   1.1  christos   int plt_entry_size;
   2217   1.1  christos   /* The distance between adjacent PLT slots.  */
   2218   1.1  christos   int plt_slot_size;
   2219   1.1  christos   /* The size of the first PLT entry.  */
   2220   1.1  christos   int plt_initial_entry_size;
   2221   1.1  christos };
   2222   1.1  christos 
   2223   1.9  christos /* Rename some of the generic section flags to better document how they
   2224   1.9  christos    are used for ppc32.  The flags are only valid for ppc32 elf objects.  */
   2225   1.9  christos 
   2226   1.1  christos /* Nonzero if this section has TLS related relocations.  */
   2227   1.7  christos #define has_tls_reloc sec_flg0
   2228   1.7  christos 
   2229   1.7  christos /* Nonzero if this section has a call to __tls_get_addr lacking marker
   2230   1.1  christos    relocs.  */
   2231   1.1  christos #define nomark_tls_get_addr sec_flg1
   2232   1.1  christos 
   2233  1.10  christos   /* Flag set when PLTCALL relocs are detected.  */
   2234  1.10  christos #define has_pltcall sec_flg2
   2235  1.10  christos 
   2236   1.1  christos /* Get the PPC ELF linker hash table from a link_info structure.  */
   2237   1.1  christos 
   2238   1.1  christos #define ppc_elf_hash_table(p) \
   2239   1.1  christos   ((is_elf_hash_table ((p)->hash)					\
   2240   1.1  christos     && elf_hash_table_id (elf_hash_table (p)) == PPC32_ELF_DATA)	\
   2241   1.1  christos    ? (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *) (p)->hash : NULL)
   2242   1.1  christos 
   2243   1.1  christos /* Create an entry in a PPC ELF linker hash table.  */
   2244   1.1  christos 
   2245   1.1  christos static struct bfd_hash_entry *
   2246   1.1  christos ppc_elf_link_hash_newfunc (struct bfd_hash_entry *entry,
   2247   1.1  christos 			   struct bfd_hash_table *table,
   2248   1.1  christos 			   const char *string)
   2249   1.1  christos {
   2250   1.1  christos   /* Allocate the structure if it has not already been allocated by a
   2251   1.1  christos      subclass.  */
   2252   1.1  christos   if (entry == NULL)
   2253   1.1  christos     {
   2254   1.1  christos       entry = bfd_hash_allocate (table,
   2255   1.1  christos 				 sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry));
   2256   1.1  christos       if (entry == NULL)
   2257   1.1  christos 	return entry;
   2258   1.1  christos     }
   2259   1.1  christos 
   2260   1.1  christos   /* Call the allocation method of the superclass.  */
   2261   1.1  christos   entry = _bfd_elf_link_hash_newfunc (entry, table, string);
   2262   1.1  christos   if (entry != NULL)
   2263   1.1  christos     {
   2264   1.1  christos       ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->linker_section_pointer = NULL;
   2265   1.1  christos       ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->tls_mask = 0;
   2266   1.1  christos       ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->has_sda_refs = 0;
   2267   1.1  christos     }
   2268   1.1  christos 
   2269   1.1  christos   return entry;
   2270   1.1  christos }
   2271   1.1  christos 
   2272   1.7  christos /* Create a PPC ELF linker hash table.  */
   2273   1.7  christos 
   2274   1.1  christos static struct bfd_link_hash_table *
   2275   1.1  christos ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
   2276   1.1  christos {
   2277   1.1  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *ret;
   2278   1.1  christos   static struct ppc_elf_params default_params
   2279   1.1  christos     = { PLT_OLD, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 12, 0, 0, 0 };
   2280   1.1  christos 
   2281  1.12  christos   ret = bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table));
   2282   1.1  christos   if (ret == NULL)
   2283   1.1  christos     return NULL;
   2284   1.1  christos 
   2285   1.1  christos   if (!_bfd_elf_link_hash_table_init (&ret->elf, abfd,
   2286   1.1  christos 				      ppc_elf_link_hash_newfunc,
   2287   1.1  christos 				      sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry)))
   2288   1.1  christos     {
   2289   1.1  christos       free (ret);
   2290   1.1  christos       return NULL;
   2291   1.1  christos     }
   2292   1.3  christos 
   2293   1.3  christos   ret->elf.init_plt_refcount.refcount = 0;
   2294   1.1  christos   ret->elf.init_plt_refcount.glist = NULL;
   2295   1.1  christos   ret->elf.init_plt_offset.offset = 0;
   2296   1.1  christos   ret->elf.init_plt_offset.glist = NULL;
   2297   1.1  christos 
   2298   1.1  christos   ret->params = &default_params;
   2299   1.1  christos 
   2300   1.1  christos   ret->sdata[0].name = ".sdata";
   2301   1.1  christos   ret->sdata[0].sym_name = "_SDA_BASE_";
   2302   1.1  christos   ret->sdata[0].bss_name = ".sbss";
   2303   1.1  christos 
   2304   1.1  christos   ret->sdata[1].name = ".sdata2";
   2305   1.1  christos   ret->sdata[1].sym_name = "_SDA2_BASE_";
   2306   1.1  christos   ret->sdata[1].bss_name = ".sbss2";
   2307   1.1  christos 
   2308   1.1  christos   ret->plt_entry_size = 12;
   2309   1.3  christos   ret->plt_slot_size = 8;
   2310   1.3  christos   ret->plt_initial_entry_size = 72;
   2311   1.3  christos 
   2312   1.3  christos   return &ret->elf.root;
   2313   1.3  christos }
   2314   1.3  christos 
   2315   1.3  christos /* Hook linker params into hash table.  */
   2316   1.3  christos 
   2317   1.3  christos void
   2318   1.7  christos ppc_elf_link_params (struct bfd_link_info *info, struct ppc_elf_params *params)
   2319   1.3  christos {
   2320   1.3  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   2321   1.1  christos 
   2322   1.1  christos   if (htab)
   2323  1.10  christos     htab->params = params;
   2324   1.1  christos   params->pagesize_p2 = bfd_log2 (params->pagesize);
   2325   1.1  christos }
   2326   1.1  christos 
   2327   1.1  christos /* Create .got and the related sections.  */
   2328   1.1  christos 
   2329  1.10  christos static bool
   2330   1.1  christos ppc_elf_create_got (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
   2331   1.1  christos {
   2332  1.10  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
   2333   1.1  christos 
   2334   1.1  christos   if (!_bfd_elf_create_got_section (abfd, info))
   2335   1.1  christos     return false;
   2336   1.7  christos 
   2337   1.7  christos   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   2338   1.9  christos   if (htab->elf.target_os != is_vxworks)
   2339  1.10  christos     {
   2340   1.1  christos       /* The powerpc .got has a blrl instruction in it.  Mark it
   2341   1.1  christos 	 executable.  */
   2342  1.10  christos       flagword flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_CODE | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
   2343   1.1  christos 			| SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
   2344   1.1  christos       if (!bfd_set_section_flags (htab->elf.sgot, flags))
   2345   1.3  christos 	return false;
   2346   1.3  christos     }
   2347   1.3  christos 
   2348   1.3  christos   return true;
   2349  1.10  christos }
   2350   1.3  christos 
   2351   1.3  christos /* Create a special linker section, used for R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16 and
   2352   1.3  christos    R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16 pointers.  These sections become part of .sdata
   2353   1.3  christos    and .sdata2.  Create _SDA_BASE_ and _SDA2_BASE too.  */
   2354   1.3  christos 
   2355   1.3  christos static bool
   2356   1.3  christos ppc_elf_create_linker_section (bfd *abfd,
   2357   1.3  christos 			       struct bfd_link_info *info,
   2358   1.3  christos 			       flagword flags,
   2359   1.3  christos 			       elf_linker_section_t *lsect)
   2360   1.3  christos {
   2361   1.3  christos   asection *s;
   2362  1.10  christos 
   2363   1.3  christos   flags |= (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
   2364   1.3  christos 	    | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
   2365   1.3  christos 
   2366   1.3  christos   s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, lsect->name, flags);
   2367   1.3  christos   if (s == NULL)
   2368   1.3  christos     return false;
   2369   1.3  christos   lsect->section = s;
   2370  1.10  christos 
   2371   1.3  christos   /* Define the sym on the first section of this name.  */
   2372  1.10  christos   s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, lsect->name);
   2373   1.3  christos 
   2374   1.3  christos   lsect->sym = _bfd_elf_define_linkage_sym (abfd, info, s, lsect->sym_name);
   2375  1.10  christos   if (lsect->sym == NULL)
   2376   1.1  christos     return false;
   2377   1.1  christos   lsect->sym->root.u.def.value = 0x8000;
   2378   1.1  christos   return true;
   2379   1.1  christos }
   2380   1.1  christos 
   2381   1.7  christos static bool
   2382   1.1  christos ppc_elf_create_glink (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
   2383   1.1  christos {
   2384   1.1  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   2385   1.1  christos   asection *s;
   2386   1.1  christos   flagword flags;
   2387   1.7  christos   int p2align;
   2388   1.7  christos 
   2389   1.7  christos   flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_CODE | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
   2390   1.1  christos 	   | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
   2391   1.9  christos   s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".glink", flags);
   2392  1.10  christos   htab->glink = s;
   2393   1.1  christos   p2align = htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? 6 : 4;
   2394   1.1  christos   if (p2align < htab->params->plt_stub_align)
   2395   1.1  christos     p2align = htab->params->plt_stub_align;
   2396   1.1  christos   if (s == NULL
   2397   1.1  christos       || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s, p2align))
   2398   1.1  christos     return false;
   2399   1.1  christos 
   2400   1.1  christos   if (!info->no_ld_generated_unwind_info)
   2401   1.9  christos     {
   2402  1.10  christos       flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
   2403   1.1  christos 	       | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
   2404   1.1  christos       s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".eh_frame", flags);
   2405   1.1  christos       htab->glink_eh_frame = s;
   2406   1.1  christos       if (s == NULL
   2407   1.7  christos 	  || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s, 2))
   2408   1.1  christos 	return false;
   2409   1.9  christos     }
   2410  1.10  christos 
   2411   1.1  christos   flags = SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
   2412   1.1  christos   s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".iplt", flags);
   2413   1.1  christos   htab->elf.iplt = s;
   2414   1.1  christos   if (s == NULL
   2415   1.7  christos       || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s, 4))
   2416   1.1  christos     return false;
   2417   1.9  christos 
   2418  1.10  christos   flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
   2419   1.3  christos 	   | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
   2420   1.7  christos   s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.iplt", flags);
   2421   1.7  christos   htab->elf.irelplt = s;
   2422   1.7  christos   if (s == NULL
   2423   1.7  christos       || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (s, 2))
   2424   1.7  christos     return false;
   2425   1.7  christos 
   2426   1.9  christos   /* Local plt entries.  */
   2427  1.10  christos   flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD
   2428   1.7  christos 	   | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
   2429   1.7  christos   htab->pltlocal = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".branch_lt",
   2430   1.7  christos 						       flags);
   2431   1.7  christos   if (htab->pltlocal == NULL
   2432   1.7  christos       || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->pltlocal, 2))
   2433   1.7  christos     return false;
   2434   1.7  christos 
   2435   1.7  christos   if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   2436   1.9  christos     {
   2437  1.10  christos       flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY
   2438   1.7  christos 	       | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
   2439   1.7  christos       htab->relpltlocal
   2440   1.3  christos 	= bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.branch_lt", flags);
   2441   1.3  christos       if (htab->relpltlocal == NULL
   2442  1.10  christos 	  || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->relpltlocal, 2))
   2443   1.3  christos 	return false;
   2444   1.3  christos     }
   2445   1.3  christos 
   2446  1.10  christos   if (!ppc_elf_create_linker_section (abfd, info, 0,
   2447   1.3  christos 				      &htab->sdata[0]))
   2448  1.10  christos     return false;
   2449   1.1  christos 
   2450   1.1  christos   if (!ppc_elf_create_linker_section (abfd, info, SEC_READONLY,
   2451   1.1  christos 				      &htab->sdata[1]))
   2452   1.1  christos     return false;
   2453   1.1  christos 
   2454   1.1  christos   return true;
   2455  1.10  christos }
   2456   1.1  christos 
   2457   1.1  christos /* We have to create .dynsbss and .rela.sbss here so that they get mapped
   2458   1.1  christos    to output sections (just like _bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections has
   2459   1.1  christos    to create .dynbss and .rela.bss).  */
   2460   1.1  christos 
   2461   1.1  christos static bool
   2462   1.1  christos ppc_elf_create_dynamic_sections (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
   2463   1.1  christos {
   2464   1.7  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
   2465   1.1  christos   asection *s;
   2466  1.10  christos   flagword flags;
   2467   1.1  christos 
   2468   1.1  christos   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   2469  1.10  christos 
   2470   1.1  christos   if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL
   2471   1.1  christos       && !ppc_elf_create_got (abfd, info))
   2472   1.1  christos     return false;
   2473  1.10  christos 
   2474   1.1  christos   if (!_bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections (abfd, info))
   2475   1.1  christos     return false;
   2476   1.1  christos 
   2477   1.1  christos   if (htab->glink == NULL
   2478   1.1  christos       && !ppc_elf_create_glink (abfd, info))
   2479  1.10  christos     return false;
   2480   1.1  christos 
   2481   1.3  christos   s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".dynsbss",
   2482   1.1  christos 					  SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
   2483   1.1  christos   htab->dynsbss = s;
   2484   1.1  christos   if (s == NULL)
   2485   1.1  christos     return false;
   2486   1.1  christos 
   2487   1.1  christos   if (! bfd_link_pic (info))
   2488   1.9  christos     {
   2489  1.10  christos       flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
   2490   1.1  christos 	       | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
   2491   1.1  christos       s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.sbss", flags);
   2492  1.10  christos       htab->relsbss = s;
   2493   1.1  christos       if (s == NULL
   2494  1.10  christos 	  || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s, 2))
   2495   1.1  christos 	return false;
   2496   1.7  christos     }
   2497   1.1  christos 
   2498   1.1  christos   if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks
   2499   1.1  christos       && !elf_vxworks_create_dynamic_sections (abfd, info, &htab->srelplt2))
   2500   1.1  christos     return false;
   2501   1.9  christos 
   2502   1.1  christos   s = htab->elf.splt;
   2503   1.1  christos   flags = SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
   2504   1.1  christos   if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS)
   2505   1.1  christos     /* The VxWorks PLT is a loaded section with contents.  */
   2506   1.1  christos     flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY;
   2507   1.1  christos   return bfd_set_section_flags (s, flags);
   2508   1.1  christos }
   2509   1.1  christos 
   2510   1.1  christos /* Copy the extra info we tack onto an elf_link_hash_entry.  */
   2511   1.1  christos 
   2512   1.1  christos static void
   2513   1.1  christos ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
   2514   1.1  christos 			      struct elf_link_hash_entry *dir,
   2515   1.1  christos 			      struct elf_link_hash_entry *ind)
   2516   1.1  christos {
   2517   1.1  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *edir, *eind;
   2518   1.1  christos 
   2519   1.7  christos   edir = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) dir;
   2520   1.7  christos   eind = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) ind;
   2521   1.1  christos 
   2522   1.1  christos   edir->tls_mask |= eind->tls_mask;
   2523   1.7  christos   edir->has_sda_refs |= eind->has_sda_refs;
   2524   1.1  christos 
   2525   1.1  christos   if (edir->elf.versioned != versioned_hidden)
   2526   1.1  christos     edir->elf.ref_dynamic |= eind->elf.ref_dynamic;
   2527   1.7  christos   edir->elf.ref_regular |= eind->elf.ref_regular;
   2528   1.7  christos   edir->elf.ref_regular_nonweak |= eind->elf.ref_regular_nonweak;
   2529   1.7  christos   edir->elf.non_got_ref |= eind->elf.non_got_ref;
   2530   1.7  christos   edir->elf.needs_plt |= eind->elf.needs_plt;
   2531  1.10  christos   edir->elf.pointer_equality_needed |= eind->elf.pointer_equality_needed;
   2532   1.1  christos 
   2533  1.10  christos   /* If we were called to copy over info for a weak sym, that's all.  */
   2534   1.1  christos   if (eind->elf.root.type != bfd_link_hash_indirect)
   2535   1.1  christos     return;
   2536   1.1  christos 
   2537   1.1  christos   if (ind->dyn_relocs != NULL)
   2538   1.1  christos     {
   2539   1.1  christos       if (dir->dyn_relocs != NULL)
   2540  1.10  christos 	{
   2541   1.1  christos 	  struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
   2542   1.1  christos 	  struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
   2543   1.1  christos 
   2544  1.10  christos 	  /* Add reloc counts against the indirect sym to the direct sym
   2545   1.1  christos 	     list.  Merge any entries against the same section.  */
   2546   1.1  christos 	  for (pp = &ind->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
   2547   1.1  christos 	    {
   2548   1.1  christos 	      struct elf_dyn_relocs *q;
   2549   1.1  christos 
   2550   1.1  christos 	      for (q = dir->dyn_relocs; q != NULL; q = q->next)
   2551   1.1  christos 		if (q->sec == p->sec)
   2552   1.1  christos 		  {
   2553   1.1  christos 		    q->pc_count += p->pc_count;
   2554   1.1  christos 		    q->count += p->count;
   2555  1.10  christos 		    *pp = p->next;
   2556   1.1  christos 		    break;
   2557   1.1  christos 		  }
   2558  1.10  christos 	      if (q == NULL)
   2559  1.10  christos 		pp = &p->next;
   2560   1.1  christos 	    }
   2561   1.1  christos 	  *pp = dir->dyn_relocs;
   2562   1.1  christos 	}
   2563   1.1  christos 
   2564   1.1  christos       dir->dyn_relocs = ind->dyn_relocs;
   2565   1.1  christos       ind->dyn_relocs = NULL;
   2566   1.1  christos     }
   2567   1.1  christos 
   2568   1.1  christos   /* Copy over the GOT refcount entries that we may have already seen to
   2569   1.1  christos      the symbol which just became indirect.  */
   2570   1.1  christos   edir->elf.got.refcount += eind->elf.got.refcount;
   2571   1.1  christos   eind->elf.got.refcount = 0;
   2572   1.1  christos 
   2573   1.1  christos   /* And plt entries.  */
   2574   1.1  christos   if (eind->elf.plt.plist != NULL)
   2575   1.1  christos     {
   2576   1.1  christos       if (edir->elf.plt.plist != NULL)
   2577   1.1  christos 	{
   2578   1.1  christos 	  struct plt_entry **entp;
   2579   1.1  christos 	  struct plt_entry *ent;
   2580   1.1  christos 
   2581   1.1  christos 	  for (entp = &eind->elf.plt.plist; (ent = *entp) != NULL; )
   2582   1.1  christos 	    {
   2583   1.1  christos 	      struct plt_entry *dent;
   2584   1.1  christos 
   2585   1.1  christos 	      for (dent = edir->elf.plt.plist; dent != NULL; dent = dent->next)
   2586   1.1  christos 		if (dent->sec == ent->sec && dent->addend == ent->addend)
   2587   1.1  christos 		  {
   2588   1.1  christos 		    dent->plt.refcount += ent->plt.refcount;
   2589   1.1  christos 		    *entp = ent->next;
   2590   1.1  christos 		    break;
   2591   1.1  christos 		  }
   2592   1.1  christos 	      if (dent == NULL)
   2593   1.1  christos 		entp = &ent->next;
   2594   1.1  christos 	    }
   2595   1.1  christos 	  *entp = edir->elf.plt.plist;
   2596   1.1  christos 	}
   2597   1.1  christos 
   2598   1.1  christos       edir->elf.plt.plist = eind->elf.plt.plist;
   2599   1.1  christos       eind->elf.plt.plist = NULL;
   2600   1.1  christos     }
   2601   1.1  christos 
   2602   1.1  christos   if (eind->elf.dynindx != -1)
   2603   1.1  christos     {
   2604   1.1  christos       if (edir->elf.dynindx != -1)
   2605   1.1  christos 	_bfd_elf_strtab_delref (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr,
   2606   1.1  christos 				edir->elf.dynstr_index);
   2607   1.1  christos       edir->elf.dynindx = eind->elf.dynindx;
   2608   1.1  christos       edir->elf.dynstr_index = eind->elf.dynstr_index;
   2609   1.1  christos       eind->elf.dynindx = -1;
   2610   1.1  christos       eind->elf.dynstr_index = 0;
   2611  1.10  christos     }
   2612   1.1  christos }
   2613   1.1  christos 
   2614   1.1  christos /* Hook called by the linker routine which adds symbols from an object
   2615   1.1  christos    file.  We use it to put .comm items in .sbss, and not .bss.  */
   2616   1.1  christos 
   2617   1.1  christos static bool
   2618   1.1  christos ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook (bfd *abfd,
   2619   1.1  christos 			 struct bfd_link_info *info,
   2620   1.1  christos 			 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
   2621   1.3  christos 			 const char **namep ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   2622   1.1  christos 			 flagword *flagsp ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   2623   1.1  christos 			 asection **secp,
   2624   1.1  christos 			 bfd_vma *valp)
   2625   1.1  christos {
   2626   1.1  christos   if (sym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON
   2627   1.1  christos       && !bfd_link_relocatable (info)
   2628   1.1  christos       && is_ppc_elf (info->output_bfd)
   2629   1.1  christos       && sym->st_size <= elf_gp_size (abfd))
   2630   1.1  christos     {
   2631   1.1  christos       /* Common symbols less than or equal to -G nn bytes are automatically
   2632  1.10  christos 	 put into .sbss.  */
   2633   1.1  christos       struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
   2634   1.1  christos 
   2635   1.1  christos       htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   2636   1.1  christos       if (htab->sbss == NULL)
   2637   1.1  christos 	{
   2638   1.1  christos 	  flagword flags = SEC_IS_COMMON | SEC_SMALL_DATA | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
   2639   1.1  christos 
   2640   1.1  christos 	  if (!htab->elf.dynobj)
   2641  1.10  christos 	    htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
   2642   1.1  christos 
   2643   1.1  christos 	  htab->sbss = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (htab->elf.dynobj,
   2644   1.1  christos 							   ".sbss",
   2645   1.1  christos 							   flags);
   2646   1.1  christos 	  if (htab->sbss == NULL)
   2647   1.1  christos 	    return false;
   2648  1.10  christos 	}
   2649   1.1  christos 
   2650   1.1  christos       *secp = htab->sbss;
   2651   1.1  christos       *valp = sym->st_size;
   2652   1.1  christos     }
   2653   1.1  christos 
   2654   1.1  christos   return true;
   2655   1.1  christos }
   2656   1.1  christos 
   2657   1.1  christos /* Find a linker generated pointer with a given addend and type.  */
   2659   1.1  christos 
   2660   1.1  christos static elf_linker_section_pointers_t *
   2661   1.1  christos elf_find_pointer_linker_section
   2662   1.1  christos   (elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_pointers,
   2663   1.1  christos    bfd_vma addend,
   2664   1.1  christos    elf_linker_section_t *lsect)
   2665   1.1  christos {
   2666   1.1  christos   for ( ; linker_pointers != NULL; linker_pointers = linker_pointers->next)
   2667   1.1  christos     if (lsect == linker_pointers->lsect && addend == linker_pointers->addend)
   2668  1.10  christos       return linker_pointers;
   2669   1.3  christos 
   2670   1.3  christos   return NULL;
   2671   1.3  christos }
   2672   1.3  christos 
   2673   1.1  christos /* Allocate a pointer to live in a linker created section.  */
   2674   1.1  christos 
   2675   1.1  christos static bool
   2676   1.1  christos elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (bfd *abfd,
   2677   1.1  christos 				     elf_linker_section_t *lsect,
   2678   1.1  christos 				     struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
   2679   1.1  christos 				     const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
   2680   1.1  christos {
   2681   1.1  christos   elf_linker_section_pointers_t **ptr_linker_section_ptr = NULL;
   2682   1.1  christos   elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_ptr;
   2683   1.1  christos   unsigned long r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
   2684   1.1  christos   bfd_size_type amt;
   2685   1.1  christos 
   2686   1.1  christos   BFD_ASSERT (lsect != NULL);
   2687   1.1  christos 
   2688   1.1  christos   /* Is this a global symbol?  */
   2689   1.1  christos   if (h != NULL)
   2690   1.1  christos     {
   2691  1.10  christos       struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh;
   2692   1.1  christos 
   2693   1.1  christos       /* Has this symbol already been allocated?  If so, our work is done.  */
   2694   1.1  christos       eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
   2695   1.1  christos       if (elf_find_pointer_linker_section (eh->linker_section_pointer,
   2696   1.1  christos 					   rel->r_addend,
   2697   1.1  christos 					   lsect))
   2698   1.1  christos 	return true;
   2699   1.1  christos 
   2700   1.1  christos       ptr_linker_section_ptr = &eh->linker_section_pointer;
   2701   1.1  christos     }
   2702   1.1  christos   else
   2703   1.1  christos     {
   2704   1.1  christos       BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (abfd));
   2705   1.1  christos 
   2706   1.1  christos       /* Allocation of a pointer to a local symbol.  */
   2707   1.1  christos       elf_linker_section_pointers_t **ptr = elf_local_ptr_offsets (abfd);
   2708   1.1  christos 
   2709   1.1  christos       /* Allocate a table to hold the local symbols if first time.  */
   2710   1.1  christos       if (!ptr)
   2711   1.1  christos 	{
   2712  1.10  christos 	  unsigned int num_symbols = elf_symtab_hdr (abfd).sh_info;
   2713   1.1  christos 
   2714   1.1  christos 	  amt = num_symbols;
   2715   1.1  christos 	  amt *= sizeof (elf_linker_section_pointers_t *);
   2716   1.1  christos 	  ptr = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
   2717   1.1  christos 
   2718   1.1  christos 	  if (!ptr)
   2719   1.1  christos 	    return false;
   2720   1.1  christos 
   2721  1.10  christos 	  elf_local_ptr_offsets (abfd) = ptr;
   2722   1.1  christos 	}
   2723   1.1  christos 
   2724   1.1  christos       /* Has this symbol already been allocated?  If so, our work is done.  */
   2725   1.1  christos       if (elf_find_pointer_linker_section (ptr[r_symndx],
   2726   1.1  christos 					   rel->r_addend,
   2727   1.1  christos 					   lsect))
   2728   1.1  christos 	return true;
   2729   1.1  christos 
   2730   1.1  christos       ptr_linker_section_ptr = &ptr[r_symndx];
   2731   1.1  christos     }
   2732   1.1  christos 
   2733  1.10  christos   /* Allocate space for a pointer in the linker section, and allocate
   2734   1.1  christos      a new pointer record from internal memory.  */
   2735   1.1  christos   BFD_ASSERT (ptr_linker_section_ptr != NULL);
   2736   1.1  christos   amt = sizeof (elf_linker_section_pointers_t);
   2737   1.1  christos   linker_section_ptr = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
   2738   1.1  christos 
   2739   1.1  christos   if (!linker_section_ptr)
   2740   1.9  christos     return false;
   2741  1.10  christos 
   2742   1.1  christos   linker_section_ptr->next = *ptr_linker_section_ptr;
   2743   1.1  christos   linker_section_ptr->addend = rel->r_addend;
   2744   1.1  christos   linker_section_ptr->lsect = lsect;
   2745   1.1  christos   *ptr_linker_section_ptr = linker_section_ptr;
   2746   1.1  christos 
   2747   1.1  christos   if (!bfd_set_section_alignment (lsect->section, 2))
   2748   1.1  christos     return false;
   2749   1.1  christos   linker_section_ptr->offset = lsect->section->size;
   2750   1.1  christos   lsect->section->size += 4;
   2751   1.1  christos 
   2752  1.10  christos #ifdef DEBUG
   2753   1.1  christos   fprintf (stderr,
   2754   1.1  christos 	   "Create pointer in linker section %s, offset = %ld, section size = %ld\n",
   2755   1.1  christos 	   lsect->name, (long) linker_section_ptr->offset,
   2756   1.1  christos 	   (long) lsect->section->size);
   2757   1.1  christos #endif
   2758   1.1  christos 
   2759   1.1  christos   return true;
   2760   1.1  christos }
   2761   1.1  christos 
   2762   1.1  christos static struct plt_entry **
   2763   1.7  christos update_local_sym_info (bfd *abfd,
   2764   1.1  christos 		       Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
   2765   1.1  christos 		       unsigned long r_symndx,
   2766   1.1  christos 		       int tls_type)
   2767   1.1  christos {
   2768   1.1  christos   bfd_signed_vma *local_got_refcounts = elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd);
   2769   1.1  christos   struct plt_entry **local_plt;
   2770   1.1  christos   unsigned char *local_got_tls_masks;
   2771   1.1  christos 
   2772   1.1  christos   if (local_got_refcounts == NULL)
   2773   1.1  christos     {
   2774   1.1  christos       bfd_size_type size = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
   2775   1.1  christos 
   2776   1.1  christos       size *= (sizeof (*local_got_refcounts)
   2777   1.1  christos 	       + sizeof (*local_plt)
   2778   1.1  christos 	       + sizeof (*local_got_tls_masks));
   2779   1.7  christos       local_got_refcounts = bfd_zalloc (abfd, size);
   2780   1.7  christos       if (local_got_refcounts == NULL)
   2781   1.7  christos 	return NULL;
   2782   1.1  christos       elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd) = local_got_refcounts;
   2783   1.1  christos     }
   2784   1.1  christos 
   2785   1.1  christos   local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_refcounts + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
   2786  1.10  christos   local_got_tls_masks = (unsigned char *) (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
   2787   1.1  christos   local_got_tls_masks[r_symndx] |= tls_type & 0xff;
   2788   1.1  christos   if ((tls_type & NON_GOT) == 0)
   2789   1.1  christos     local_got_refcounts[r_symndx] += 1;
   2790   1.1  christos   return local_plt + r_symndx;
   2791   1.1  christos }
   2792   1.1  christos 
   2793   1.1  christos static bool
   2794   1.1  christos update_plt_info (bfd *abfd, struct plt_entry **plist,
   2795   1.1  christos 		 asection *sec, bfd_vma addend)
   2796   1.1  christos {
   2797   1.1  christos   struct plt_entry *ent;
   2798   1.1  christos 
   2799  1.10  christos   if (addend < 32768)
   2800   1.1  christos     sec = NULL;
   2801   1.1  christos   for (ent = *plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
   2802  1.10  christos     if (ent->sec == sec && ent->addend == addend)
   2803   1.1  christos       break;
   2804   1.1  christos   if (ent == NULL)
   2805   1.1  christos     {
   2806   1.1  christos       size_t amt = sizeof (*ent);
   2807   1.1  christos       ent = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
   2808   1.1  christos       if (ent == NULL)
   2809   1.1  christos 	return false;
   2810  1.10  christos       ent->next = *plist;
   2811   1.1  christos       ent->sec = sec;
   2812   1.1  christos       ent->addend = addend;
   2813   1.1  christos       ent->plt.refcount = 0;
   2814   1.1  christos       *plist = ent;
   2815   1.1  christos     }
   2816   1.1  christos   ent->plt.refcount += 1;
   2817   1.1  christos   return true;
   2818   1.1  christos }
   2819   1.1  christos 
   2820   1.1  christos static struct plt_entry *
   2821   1.1  christos find_plt_ent (struct plt_entry **plist, asection *sec, bfd_vma addend)
   2822   1.1  christos {
   2823   1.1  christos   struct plt_entry *ent;
   2824   1.1  christos 
   2825   1.1  christos   if (addend < 32768)
   2826  1.10  christos     sec = NULL;
   2827   1.1  christos   for (ent = *plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
   2828   1.1  christos     if (ent->sec == sec && ent->addend == addend)
   2829   1.1  christos       break;
   2830   1.1  christos   return ent;
   2831   1.1  christos }
   2832   1.1  christos 
   2833   1.1  christos static bool
   2834   1.1  christos is_branch_reloc (enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
   2835   1.1  christos {
   2836   1.1  christos   return (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
   2837   1.1  christos 	  || r_type == R_PPC_LOCAL24PC
   2838   1.7  christos 	  || r_type == R_PPC_REL24
   2839   1.7  christos 	  || r_type == R_PPC_REL14
   2840   1.7  christos 	  || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN
   2841   1.7  christos 	  || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN
   2842   1.7  christos 	  || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR24
   2843   1.7  christos 	  || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14
   2844  1.10  christos 	  || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN
   2845   1.7  christos 	  || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN
   2846   1.7  christos 	  || r_type == R_PPC_VLE_REL24);
   2847   1.7  christos }
   2848   1.7  christos 
   2849   1.7  christos /* Relocs on inline plt call sequence insns prior to the call.  */
   2850   1.7  christos 
   2851   1.1  christos static bool
   2852   1.1  christos is_plt_seq_reloc (enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
   2853  1.10  christos {
   2854  1.10  christos   return (r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA
   2855  1.10  christos 	  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
   2856  1.10  christos 	  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
   2857  1.10  christos 	  || r_type == R_PPC_PLTSEQ);
   2858  1.10  christos }
   2859  1.10  christos 
   2860  1.10  christos /* Like bfd_reloc_offset_in_range but without a howto.  Return true
   2861  1.10  christos    iff a field of SIZE bytes at OFFSET is within SEC limits.  */
   2862   1.1  christos 
   2863   1.1  christos static bool
   2864   1.1  christos offset_in_range (asection *sec, bfd_vma offset, size_t size)
   2865   1.7  christos {
   2866   1.7  christos   return offset <= sec->size && size <= sec->size - offset;
   2867   1.7  christos }
   2868   1.1  christos 
   2869   1.1  christos static void
   2870   1.1  christos bad_shared_reloc (bfd *abfd, enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
   2871   1.1  christos {
   2872   1.1  christos   _bfd_error_handler
   2873   1.1  christos     /* xgettext:c-format */
   2874   1.1  christos     (_("%pB: relocation %s cannot be used when making a shared object"),
   2875   1.1  christos      abfd,
   2876   1.1  christos      ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type]->name);
   2877  1.10  christos   bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
   2878   1.1  christos }
   2879   1.1  christos 
   2880   1.1  christos /* Look through the relocs for a section during the first phase, and
   2881   1.1  christos    allocate space in the global offset table or procedure linkage
   2882   1.1  christos    table.  */
   2883   1.1  christos 
   2884   1.1  christos static bool
   2885   1.1  christos ppc_elf_check_relocs (bfd *abfd,
   2886   1.1  christos 		      struct bfd_link_info *info,
   2887   1.1  christos 		      asection *sec,
   2888   1.1  christos 		      const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs)
   2889   1.1  christos {
   2890   1.1  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
   2891   1.3  christos   Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
   2892  1.10  christos   struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
   2893   1.1  christos   const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
   2894   1.1  christos   const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel_end;
   2895   1.7  christos   asection *got2, *sreloc;
   2896   1.1  christos   struct elf_link_hash_entry *tga;
   2897   1.1  christos 
   2898   1.1  christos   if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
   2899   1.1  christos     return true;
   2900   1.1  christos 
   2901   1.1  christos #ifdef DEBUG
   2902   1.1  christos   _bfd_error_handler ("ppc_elf_check_relocs called for section %pA in %pB",
   2903   1.1  christos 		      sec, abfd);
   2904   1.1  christos #endif
   2905   1.1  christos 
   2906   1.1  christos   BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (abfd));
   2907   1.1  christos 
   2908   1.1  christos   /* Initialize howto table if not already done.  */
   2909   1.1  christos   if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
   2910   1.1  christos     ppc_elf_howto_init ();
   2911  1.10  christos 
   2912   1.1  christos   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   2913   1.1  christos   if (htab->glink == NULL)
   2914  1.10  christos     {
   2915   1.1  christos       if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
   2916   1.1  christos 	htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
   2917   1.1  christos       if (!ppc_elf_create_glink (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
   2918   1.1  christos 	return false;
   2919   1.1  christos     }
   2920   1.1  christos   tga = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr",
   2921   1.1  christos 			      false, false, true);
   2922   1.1  christos   symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
   2923   1.1  christos   sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
   2924   1.1  christos   got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got2");
   2925   1.1  christos   sreloc = NULL;
   2926  1.10  christos 
   2927   1.1  christos   rel_end = relocs + sec->reloc_count;
   2928   1.3  christos   for (rel = relocs; rel < rel_end; rel++)
   2929   1.7  christos     {
   2930   1.7  christos       unsigned long r_symndx;
   2931   1.1  christos       enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
   2932   1.1  christos       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
   2933   1.1  christos       Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
   2934  1.10  christos       int tls_type;
   2935  1.10  christos       struct plt_entry **ifunc;
   2936  1.10  christos       struct plt_entry **pltent;
   2937  1.10  christos       bfd_vma addend;
   2938  1.10  christos 
   2939  1.10  christos       r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
   2940   1.1  christos       if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
   2941   1.1  christos 	{
   2942   1.1  christos 	  h = NULL;
   2943   1.1  christos 	  isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->elf.sym_cache, abfd, r_symndx);
   2944   1.1  christos 	  if (isym == NULL)
   2945   1.1  christos 	    return false;
   2946  1.10  christos 	}
   2947   1.1  christos       else
   2948   1.1  christos 	{
   2949   1.1  christos 	  h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
   2950   1.1  christos 	  while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
   2951   1.1  christos 		 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
   2952   1.1  christos 	    h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
   2953   1.7  christos 	  isym = NULL;
   2954   1.1  christos 	}
   2955   1.1  christos 
   2956   1.1  christos       /* If a relocation refers to _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_, create the .got.
   2957   1.1  christos 	 This shows up in particular in an R_PPC_ADDR32 in the eabi
   2958   1.1  christos 	 startup code.  */
   2959  1.10  christos       if (h != NULL
   2960   1.1  christos 	  && htab->elf.sgot == NULL
   2961   1.1  christos 	  && strcmp (h->root.root.string, "_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_") == 0)
   2962   1.1  christos 	{
   2963   1.1  christos 	  if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
   2964   1.1  christos 	    htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
   2965   1.3  christos 	  if (!ppc_elf_create_got (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
   2966  1.10  christos 	    return false;
   2967  1.10  christos 	  BFD_ASSERT (h == htab->elf.hgot);
   2968  1.10  christos 	}
   2969  1.10  christos 
   2970  1.10  christos       tls_type = 0;
   2971  1.10  christos       r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
   2972  1.10  christos       ifunc = NULL;
   2973  1.10  christos       if (h != NULL)
   2974  1.10  christos 	{
   2975   1.1  christos 	  if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
   2976   1.3  christos 	    {
   2977   1.1  christos 	      h->needs_plt = 1;
   2978   1.3  christos 	      ifunc = &h->plt.plist;
   2979   1.1  christos 	    }
   2980   1.7  christos 	}
   2981   1.1  christos       else if (htab->elf.target_os != is_vxworks)
   2982  1.10  christos 	{
   2983   1.1  christos 	  if (ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
   2984   1.1  christos 	    {
   2985   1.1  christos 	      /* Set PLT_IFUNC flag for this sym, no GOT entry yet.  */
   2986   1.1  christos 	      ifunc = update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
   2987   1.3  christos 					     NON_GOT | PLT_IFUNC);
   2988   1.7  christos 	      if (ifunc == NULL)
   2989   1.7  christos 		return false;
   2990   1.7  christos 
   2991   1.7  christos 	      /* STT_GNU_IFUNC symbols must have a PLT entry;
   2992   1.1  christos 		 In a non-pie executable even when there are
   2993   1.7  christos 		 no plt calls.  */
   2994   1.3  christos 	      if (!bfd_link_pic (info)
   2995   1.7  christos 		  || is_branch_reloc (r_type)
   2996   1.7  christos 		  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
   2997   1.7  christos 		  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
   2998   1.7  christos 		  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA)
   2999   1.7  christos 		{
   3000   1.7  christos 		  addend = 0;
   3001   1.7  christos 		  if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24)
   3002   1.3  christos 		    ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->makes_plt_call = 1;
   3003  1.10  christos 		  if (bfd_link_pic (info)
   3004   1.1  christos 		      && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
   3005   1.1  christos 			  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
   3006   1.1  christos 			  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
   3007   1.1  christos 			  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
   3008  1.10  christos 		    addend = rel->r_addend;
   3009   1.1  christos 		  if (!update_plt_info (abfd, ifunc, got2, addend))
   3010   1.1  christos 		    return false;
   3011   1.1  christos 		}
   3012   1.1  christos 	    }
   3013   1.1  christos 	}
   3014   1.1  christos 
   3015   1.1  christos       if (htab->elf.target_os != is_vxworks
   3016   1.1  christos 	  && is_branch_reloc (r_type)
   3017   1.1  christos 	  && h != NULL
   3018   1.1  christos 	  && h == tga)
   3019   1.1  christos 	{
   3020   1.1  christos 	  if (rel != relocs
   3021   1.9  christos 	      && (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_TLSGD
   3022   1.1  christos 		  || ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_TLSLD))
   3023   1.1  christos 	    /* We have a new-style __tls_get_addr call with a marker
   3024  1.10  christos 	       reloc.  */
   3025   1.1  christos 	    ;
   3026   1.1  christos 	  else
   3027   1.1  christos 	    /* Mark this section as having an old-style call.  */
   3028   1.1  christos 	    sec->nomark_tls_get_addr = 1;
   3029   1.1  christos 	}
   3030   1.7  christos 
   3031   1.7  christos       switch (r_type)
   3032   1.7  christos 	{
   3033   1.7  christos 	case R_PPC_TLSGD:
   3034   1.7  christos 	case R_PPC_TLSLD:
   3035  1.10  christos 	  /* These special tls relocs tie a call to __tls_get_addr with
   3036   1.7  christos 	     its parameter symbol.  */
   3037   1.7  christos 	  if (h != NULL)
   3038   1.7  christos 	    ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK;
   3039   1.1  christos 	  else
   3040   1.1  christos 	    if (!update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
   3041   1.1  christos 					NON_GOT | TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK))
   3042   1.1  christos 	      return false;
   3043   1.1  christos 	  break;
   3044   1.1  christos 
   3045   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_PLTSEQ:
   3046   1.1  christos 	  break;
   3047   1.1  christos 
   3048   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
   3049   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
   3050   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
   3051   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
   3052   1.1  christos 	  tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
   3053   1.1  christos 	  goto dogottls;
   3054   1.1  christos 
   3055   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
   3056   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
   3057   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
   3058   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
   3059   1.7  christos 	  tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
   3060   1.1  christos 	  goto dogottls;
   3061   1.1  christos 
   3062   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
   3063   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
   3064   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
   3065   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
   3066   1.1  christos 	  if (bfd_link_dll (info))
   3067   1.1  christos 	    info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
   3068   1.1  christos 	  tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
   3069   1.1  christos 	  goto dogottls;
   3070   1.1  christos 
   3071   1.7  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:
   3072   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:
   3073   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI:
   3074   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
   3075   1.1  christos 	  tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
   3076   1.1  christos 	dogottls:
   3077   1.1  christos 	  sec->has_tls_reloc = 1;
   3078   1.1  christos 	  /* Fall through.  */
   3079   1.7  christos 
   3080   1.1  christos 	  /* GOT16 relocations */
   3081   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT16:
   3082   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT16_LO:
   3083   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT16_HI:
   3084  1.10  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT16_HA:
   3085   1.1  christos 	  /* This symbol requires a global offset table entry.  */
   3086   1.1  christos 	  if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL)
   3087   1.1  christos 	    {
   3088   1.1  christos 	      if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
   3089   1.1  christos 		htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
   3090   1.1  christos 	      if (!ppc_elf_create_got (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
   3091   1.1  christos 		return false;
   3092   1.1  christos 	    }
   3093   1.1  christos 	  if (h != NULL)
   3094  1.10  christos 	    {
   3095   1.1  christos 	      h->got.refcount += 1;
   3096   1.1  christos 	      ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= tls_type;
   3097   1.1  christos 	    }
   3098   1.3  christos 	  else
   3099   1.1  christos 	    /* This is a global offset table entry for a local symbol.  */
   3100   1.1  christos 	    if (!update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx, tls_type))
   3101  1.10  christos 	      return false;
   3102   1.1  christos 
   3103   1.1  christos 	  /* We may also need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
   3104   1.1  christos 	     an ifunc.  */
   3105   1.1  christos 	  if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
   3106   1.1  christos 	    {
   3107   1.3  christos 	      if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
   3108   1.3  christos 		return false;
   3109   1.3  christos 	    }
   3110  1.10  christos 	  break;
   3111   1.1  christos 
   3112   1.1  christos 	  /* Indirect .sdata relocation.  */
   3113  1.10  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16:
   3114  1.10  christos 	  htab->sdata[0].sym->ref_regular = 1;
   3115   1.1  christos 	  if (!elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (abfd, &htab->sdata[0],
   3116   1.1  christos 						    h, rel))
   3117   1.1  christos 	    return false;
   3118   1.1  christos 	  if (h != NULL)
   3119   1.1  christos 	    {
   3120   1.9  christos 	      ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = true;
   3121   1.1  christos 	      h->non_got_ref = true;
   3122   1.1  christos 	    }
   3123  1.10  christos 	  break;
   3124   1.1  christos 
   3125   1.3  christos 	  /* Indirect .sdata2 relocation.  */
   3126   1.3  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16:
   3127   1.3  christos 	  if (!bfd_link_executable (info))
   3128  1.10  christos 	    {
   3129   1.1  christos 	      bad_shared_reloc (abfd, r_type);
   3130   1.1  christos 	      return false;
   3131  1.10  christos 	    }
   3132  1.10  christos 	  htab->sdata[1].sym->ref_regular = 1;
   3133   1.1  christos 	  if (!elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (abfd, &htab->sdata[1],
   3134   1.1  christos 						    h, rel))
   3135   1.1  christos 	    return false;
   3136   1.3  christos 	  if (h != NULL)
   3137   1.3  christos 	    {
   3138   1.7  christos 	      ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = true;
   3139   1.3  christos 	      h->non_got_ref = true;
   3140   1.1  christos 	    }
   3141   1.1  christos 	  break;
   3142   1.1  christos 
   3143   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_SDAREL16:
   3144   1.1  christos 	  htab->sdata[0].sym->ref_regular = 1;
   3145   1.1  christos 	  /* Fall through.  */
   3146   1.1  christos 
   3147   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A:
   3148  1.10  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D:
   3149  1.10  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A:
   3150   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D:
   3151   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A:
   3152   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D:
   3153   1.1  christos 	  if (h != NULL)
   3154   1.1  christos 	    {
   3155   1.1  christos 	      ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = true;
   3156   1.1  christos 	      h->non_got_ref = true;
   3157   1.1  christos 	    }
   3158   1.1  christos 	  break;
   3159   1.1  christos 
   3160   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_REL8:
   3161   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_REL15:
   3162   1.7  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_REL24:
   3163   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_LO16A:
   3164   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_LO16D:
   3165   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_HI16A:
   3166   1.9  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_HI16D:
   3167   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_HA16A:
   3168   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_HA16D:
   3169  1.10  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20:
   3170   1.1  christos 	  break;
   3171   1.3  christos 
   3172   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL:
   3173   1.1  christos 	  if (!bfd_link_executable (info))
   3174  1.10  christos 	    {
   3175  1.10  christos 	      bad_shared_reloc (abfd, r_type);
   3176   1.1  christos 	      return false;
   3177   1.1  christos 	    }
   3178   1.1  christos 	  htab->sdata[1].sym->ref_regular = 1;
   3179   1.1  christos 	  if (h != NULL)
   3180   1.1  christos 	    {
   3181   1.1  christos 	      ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = true;
   3182   1.1  christos 	      h->non_got_ref = true;
   3183   1.1  christos 	    }
   3184   1.1  christos 	  break;
   3185  1.10  christos 
   3186  1.10  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO:
   3187   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21:
   3188   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_SDA21:
   3189   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA:
   3190   1.1  christos 	  if (h != NULL)
   3191   1.1  christos 	    {
   3192   1.1  christos 	      ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = true;
   3193   1.1  christos 	      h->non_got_ref = true;
   3194   1.1  christos 	    }
   3195   1.1  christos 	  break;
   3196  1.10  christos 
   3197   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32:
   3198   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16:
   3199   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO:
   3200   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI:
   3201   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:
   3202   1.7  christos 	  if (h != NULL)
   3203   1.7  christos 	    h->non_got_ref = true;
   3204   1.7  christos 	  break;
   3205   1.7  christos 
   3206   1.7  christos 	case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
   3207   1.7  christos 	  if (h == NULL)
   3208   1.7  christos 	    break;
   3209   1.1  christos 	  ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->makes_plt_call = 1;
   3210   1.1  christos 	  goto pltentry;
   3211   1.1  christos 
   3212   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
   3213   1.1  christos 	  sec->has_pltcall = 1;
   3214   1.7  christos 	  /* Fall through.  */
   3215   1.1  christos 
   3216   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_PLT32:
   3217   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_PLTREL32:
   3218   1.3  christos 	case R_PPC_PLT16_LO:
   3219   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_PLT16_HI:
   3220   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
   3221   1.7  christos 	pltentry:
   3222   1.7  christos #ifdef DEBUG
   3223   1.7  christos 	  fprintf (stderr, "Reloc requires a PLT entry\n");
   3224  1.10  christos #endif
   3225   1.7  christos 	  /* This symbol requires a procedure linkage table entry.  */
   3226   1.7  christos 	  if (h == NULL)
   3227   1.1  christos 	    {
   3228   1.7  christos 	      pltent = update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
   3229   1.7  christos 					      NON_GOT | PLT_KEEP);
   3230   1.1  christos 	      if (pltent == NULL)
   3231   1.7  christos 		return false;
   3232   1.1  christos 	    }
   3233   1.7  christos 	  else
   3234   1.7  christos 	    {
   3235   1.7  christos 	      if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
   3236   1.7  christos 		ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= PLT_KEEP;
   3237   1.7  christos 	      h->needs_plt = 1;
   3238   1.7  christos 	      pltent = &h->plt.plist;
   3239   1.7  christos 	    }
   3240   1.7  christos 	  addend = 0;
   3241  1.10  christos 	  if (bfd_link_pic (info)
   3242   1.1  christos 	      && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
   3243   1.1  christos 		  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
   3244   1.1  christos 		  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
   3245   1.1  christos 		  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
   3246   1.1  christos 	    addend = rel->r_addend;
   3247   1.1  christos 	  if (!update_plt_info (abfd, pltent, got2, addend))
   3248   1.1  christos 	    return false;
   3249   1.1  christos 	  break;
   3250   1.1  christos 
   3251   1.1  christos 	  /* The following relocations don't need to propagate the
   3252   1.1  christos 	     relocation if linking a shared object since they are
   3253   1.1  christos 	     section relative.  */
   3254   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF:
   3255   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO:
   3256   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI:
   3257   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA:
   3258   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16:
   3259   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:
   3260   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI:
   3261   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:
   3262   1.3  christos 	case R_PPC_TOC16:
   3263   1.1  christos 	  break;
   3264   1.1  christos 
   3265   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL16:
   3266   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL16_LO:
   3267   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL16_HI:
   3268   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
   3269   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA:
   3270   1.1  christos 	  ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->has_rel16 = 1;
   3271   1.1  christos 	  break;
   3272   1.1  christos 
   3273   1.1  christos 	  /* These are just markers.  */
   3274   1.7  christos 	case R_PPC_TLS:
   3275   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF:
   3276   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_NONE:
   3277   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_max:
   3278   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_RELAX:
   3279   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_RELAX_PLT:
   3280   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24:
   3281   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_16DX_HA:
   3282   1.1  christos 	  break;
   3283   1.1  christos 
   3284   1.1  christos 	  /* These should only appear in dynamic objects.  */
   3285   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_COPY:
   3286   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GLOB_DAT:
   3287   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT:
   3288   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_RELATIVE:
   3289   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_IRELATIVE:
   3290   1.1  christos 	  break;
   3291   1.1  christos 
   3292   1.1  christos 	  /* These aren't handled yet.  We'll report an error later.  */
   3293   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR30:
   3294   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16:
   3295   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO:
   3296   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI:
   3297   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:
   3298   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD:
   3299   1.1  christos 	  break;
   3300   1.1  christos 
   3301  1.10  christos 	  /* This refers only to functions defined in the shared library.  */
   3302  1.10  christos 	case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
   3303  1.10  christos 	  if (h != NULL && h == htab->elf.hgot && htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
   3304  1.10  christos 	    {
   3305   1.1  christos 	      htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
   3306   1.1  christos 	      htab->old_bfd = abfd;
   3307   1.1  christos 	    }
   3308   1.1  christos 	  if (h != NULL
   3309   1.1  christos 	      && ifunc != NULL
   3310   1.1  christos 	      && !update_plt_info (abfd, ifunc, NULL, 0))
   3311  1.10  christos 	    return false;
   3312   1.1  christos 	  break;
   3313   1.1  christos 
   3314   1.1  christos 	  /* This relocation describes the C++ object vtable hierarchy.
   3315   1.1  christos 	     Reconstruct it for later use during GC.  */
   3316   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT:
   3317   1.9  christos 	  if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtinherit (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_offset))
   3318  1.10  christos 	    return false;
   3319   1.1  christos 	  break;
   3320   1.1  christos 
   3321  1.10  christos 	  /* This relocation describes which C++ vtable entries are actually
   3322  1.10  christos 	     used.  Record for later use during GC.  */
   3323  1.10  christos 	case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY:
   3324  1.10  christos 	  if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtentry (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_addend))
   3325   1.7  christos 	    return false;
   3326   1.1  christos 	  break;
   3327   1.1  christos 
   3328   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
   3329   1.7  christos 	case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
   3330   1.1  christos 	  sec->has_tls_reloc = 1;
   3331   1.1  christos 	  /* Fall through.  */
   3332   1.1  christos 	  /* We shouldn't really be seeing TPREL32.  */
   3333   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_TPREL32:
   3334   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_TPREL16:
   3335   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
   3336   1.1  christos 	  if (bfd_link_dll (info))
   3337   1.1  christos 	    info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
   3338   1.1  christos 	  goto dodyn;
   3339   1.1  christos 
   3340   1.1  christos 	  /* Nor these.  */
   3341   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_DTPMOD32:
   3342   1.3  christos 	case R_PPC_DTPREL32:
   3343   1.1  christos 	  goto dodyn;
   3344   1.1  christos 
   3345   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL32:
   3346   1.1  christos 	  if (h == NULL
   3347   1.1  christos 	      && got2 != NULL
   3348   1.1  christos 	      && (sec->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0
   3349   1.1  christos 	      && bfd_link_pic (info)
   3350   1.1  christos 	      && htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
   3351   1.1  christos 	    {
   3352   1.1  christos 	      /* Old -fPIC gcc code has .long LCTOC1-LCFx just before
   3353   1.1  christos 		 the start of a function, which assembles to a REL32
   3354   1.1  christos 		 reference to .got2.  If we detect one of these, then
   3355   1.1  christos 		 force the old PLT layout because the linker cannot
   3356   1.1  christos 		 reliably deduce the GOT pointer value needed for
   3357   1.1  christos 		 PLT call stubs.  */
   3358   1.1  christos 	      asection *s;
   3359   1.1  christos 
   3360   1.1  christos 	      s = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
   3361   1.1  christos 	      if (s == got2)
   3362   1.1  christos 		{
   3363   1.1  christos 		  htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
   3364   1.1  christos 		  htab->old_bfd = abfd;
   3365   1.1  christos 		}
   3366   1.1  christos 	    }
   3367   1.1  christos 	  if (h == NULL || h == htab->elf.hgot)
   3368   1.1  christos 	    break;
   3369   1.1  christos 	  /* fall through */
   3370   1.1  christos 
   3371   1.3  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR32:
   3372   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR16:
   3373   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO:
   3374   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR16_HI:
   3375   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
   3376  1.10  christos 	case R_PPC_UADDR32:
   3377   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_UADDR16:
   3378   1.1  christos 	  if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
   3379   1.1  christos 	    {
   3380   1.1  christos 	      /* We may need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
   3381   1.3  christos 		 a function defined in a dynamic object.  */
   3382   1.3  christos 	      if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
   3383   1.3  christos 		return false;
   3384   1.3  christos 
   3385   1.1  christos 	      /* We may need a copy reloc too.  */
   3386   1.1  christos 	      h->non_got_ref = 1;
   3387   1.1  christos 	      h->pointer_equality_needed = 1;
   3388   1.1  christos 	      if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA)
   3389   1.1  christos 		ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha = 1;
   3390   1.1  christos 	      if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_LO)
   3391   1.1  christos 		ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo = 1;
   3392   1.1  christos 	    }
   3393   1.1  christos 	  goto dodyn;
   3394   1.1  christos 
   3395   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL24:
   3396   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL14:
   3397   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
   3398   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
   3399   1.1  christos 	  if (h == NULL)
   3400   1.1  christos 	    break;
   3401   1.1  christos 	  if (h == htab->elf.hgot)
   3402   1.1  christos 	    {
   3403   1.1  christos 	      if (htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
   3404   1.1  christos 		{
   3405   1.1  christos 		  htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
   3406   1.1  christos 		  htab->old_bfd = abfd;
   3407   1.1  christos 		}
   3408   1.1  christos 	      break;
   3409   1.3  christos 	    }
   3410   1.1  christos 	  /* fall through */
   3411   1.1  christos 
   3412   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR24:
   3413   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR14:
   3414   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
   3415  1.10  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
   3416   1.1  christos 	  if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
   3417   1.1  christos 	    {
   3418   1.1  christos 	      /* We may need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
   3419   1.1  christos 		 a function defined in a dynamic object.  */
   3420  1.10  christos 	      h->needs_plt = 1;
   3421  1.10  christos 	      if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
   3422  1.10  christos 		return false;
   3423  1.10  christos 	      break;
   3424  1.10  christos 	    }
   3425  1.10  christos 
   3426  1.10  christos 	dodyn:
   3427  1.10  christos 	  /* Set up information for symbols that might need dynamic
   3428  1.10  christos 	     relocations.  At this point in linking we have read all
   3429  1.10  christos 	     the input files and resolved most symbols, but have not
   3430  1.10  christos 	     yet decided whether symbols are dynamic or finalized
   3431  1.10  christos 	     symbol flags.  In some cases we might be setting dynamic
   3432  1.10  christos 	     reloc info for symbols that do not end up needing such.
   3433  1.10  christos 	     That's OK, adjust_dynamic_symbol and allocate_dynrelocs
   3434  1.10  christos 	     work together with this code.  */
   3435   1.1  christos 	  if ((h != NULL
   3436   1.1  christos 	       && !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
   3437   1.1  christos 	      || (bfd_link_pic (info)
   3438   1.1  christos 		  && (h != NULL
   3439   1.1  christos 		      ? !bfd_is_abs_symbol (&h->root)
   3440   1.1  christos 		      : isym->st_shndx != SHN_ABS)
   3441   1.1  christos 		  && must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type)))
   3442   1.1  christos 	    {
   3443   1.1  christos #ifdef DEBUG
   3444   1.1  christos 	      fprintf (stderr,
   3445   1.1  christos 		       "ppc_elf_check_relocs needs to "
   3446   1.1  christos 		       "create relocation for %s\n",
   3447   1.1  christos 		       (h && h->root.root.string
   3448   1.1  christos 			? h->root.root.string : "<unknown>"));
   3449  1.10  christos #endif
   3450   1.1  christos 	      if (sreloc == NULL)
   3451   1.1  christos 		{
   3452  1.10  christos 		  if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
   3453   1.1  christos 		    htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
   3454   1.1  christos 
   3455   1.1  christos 		  sreloc = _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_reloc_section
   3456   1.1  christos 		    (sec, htab->elf.dynobj, 2, abfd, /*rela?*/ true);
   3457   1.1  christos 
   3458   1.1  christos 		  if (sreloc == NULL)
   3459   1.3  christos 		    return false;
   3460   1.3  christos 		}
   3461   1.3  christos 
   3462  1.10  christos 	      /* If this is a global symbol, we count the number of
   3463   1.3  christos 		 relocations we need for this symbol.  */
   3464   1.3  christos 	      if (h != NULL)
   3465   1.3  christos 		{
   3466   1.3  christos 		  struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
   3467   1.3  christos 		  struct elf_dyn_relocs **rel_head;
   3468  1.10  christos 
   3469   1.3  christos 		  rel_head = &h->dyn_relocs;
   3470   1.3  christos 		  p = *rel_head;
   3471   1.3  christos 		  if (p == NULL || p->sec != sec)
   3472   1.3  christos 		    {
   3473   1.3  christos 		      p = bfd_alloc (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof *p);
   3474   1.3  christos 		      if (p == NULL)
   3475   1.3  christos 			return false;
   3476   1.3  christos 		      p->next = *rel_head;
   3477   1.3  christos 		      *rel_head = p;
   3478   1.1  christos 		      p->sec = sec;
   3479   1.1  christos 		      p->count = 0;
   3480   1.1  christos 		      p->pc_count = 0;
   3481   1.1  christos 		    }
   3482   1.1  christos 		  p->count += 1;
   3483   1.1  christos 		  if (!must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type))
   3484   1.3  christos 		    p->pc_count += 1;
   3485   1.3  christos 		}
   3486  1.10  christos 	      else
   3487   1.1  christos 		{
   3488   1.1  christos 		  /* Track dynamic relocs needed for local syms too.
   3489   1.1  christos 		     We really need local syms available to do this
   3490   1.1  christos 		     easily.  Oh well.  */
   3491   1.1  christos 		  struct ppc_dyn_relocs *p;
   3492   1.1  christos 		  struct ppc_dyn_relocs **rel_head;
   3493   1.1  christos 		  bool is_ifunc;
   3494   1.1  christos 		  asection *s;
   3495   1.3  christos 		  void *vpp;
   3496  1.10  christos 
   3497   1.3  christos 		  s = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
   3498   1.3  christos 		  if (s == NULL)
   3499   1.3  christos 		    s = sec;
   3500   1.3  christos 
   3501   1.3  christos 		  vpp = &elf_section_data (s)->local_dynrel;
   3502   1.3  christos 		  rel_head = (struct ppc_dyn_relocs **) vpp;
   3503   1.3  christos 		  is_ifunc = ifunc != NULL;
   3504  1.10  christos 		  p = *rel_head;
   3505   1.3  christos 		  if (p != NULL && p->sec == sec && p->ifunc != is_ifunc)
   3506   1.3  christos 		    p = p->next;
   3507   1.3  christos 		  if (p == NULL || p->sec != sec || p->ifunc != is_ifunc)
   3508   1.3  christos 		    {
   3509   1.3  christos 		      p = bfd_alloc (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof *p);
   3510   1.3  christos 		      if (p == NULL)
   3511   1.3  christos 			return false;
   3512   1.1  christos 		      p->next = *rel_head;
   3513   1.1  christos 		      *rel_head = p;
   3514   1.1  christos 		      p->sec = sec;
   3515   1.1  christos 		      p->ifunc = is_ifunc;
   3516   1.1  christos 		      p->count = 0;
   3517   1.1  christos 		    }
   3518   1.1  christos 		  p->count += 1;
   3519  1.10  christos 		}
   3520   1.1  christos 	    }
   3521   1.1  christos 
   3522   1.7  christos 	  break;
   3523   1.7  christos 	}
   3524  1.10  christos     }
   3525   1.7  christos 
   3526   1.1  christos   return true;
   3527   1.7  christos }
   3528   1.1  christos 
   3529   1.1  christos /* Warn for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP attributes between IBFD
   3531  1.10  christos    and OBFD, and merge non-conflicting ones.  */
   3532  1.10  christos bool
   3533  1.10  christos _bfd_elf_ppc_merge_fp_attributes (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
   3534  1.10  christos {
   3535  1.10  christos   bfd *obfd = info->output_bfd;
   3536  1.10  christos   obj_attribute *in_attr, *in_attrs;
   3537  1.10  christos   obj_attribute *out_attr, *out_attrs;
   3538  1.10  christos   bool ret = true;
   3539  1.10  christos   bool warn_only;
   3540  1.10  christos 
   3541  1.10  christos   /* We only warn about shared library mismatches, because common
   3542   1.1  christos      libraries advertise support for a particular long double variant
   3543   1.1  christos      but actually support more than one variant.  For example, glibc
   3544   1.1  christos      typically supports 128-bit IBM long double in the shared library
   3545   1.1  christos      but has a compatibility static archive for 64-bit long double.
   3546   1.1  christos      The linker doesn't have the smarts to see that an app using
   3547   1.1  christos      object files marked as 64-bit long double call the compatibility
   3548   1.7  christos      layer objects and only from there call into the shared library.  */
   3549   1.1  christos   warn_only = (ibfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0;
   3550   1.1  christos 
   3551   1.7  christos   in_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (ibfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
   3552   1.7  christos   out_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (obfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
   3553   1.7  christos 
   3554   1.7  christos   in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP];
   3555   1.7  christos   out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP];
   3556   1.7  christos 
   3557   1.7  christos   if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i)
   3558   1.7  christos     {
   3559  1.10  christos       int in_fp = in_attr->i & 3;
   3560  1.10  christos       int out_fp = out_attr->i & 3;
   3561  1.10  christos       static bfd *last_fp, *last_ld;
   3562  1.10  christos 
   3563  1.10  christos       if (in_fp == 0)
   3564  1.10  christos 	;
   3565   1.7  christos       else if (out_fp == 0)
   3566   1.7  christos 	{
   3567   1.7  christos 	  if (!warn_only)
   3568   1.7  christos 	    {
   3569   1.7  christos 	      out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
   3570   1.7  christos 	      out_attr->i ^= in_fp;
   3571   1.7  christos 	      last_fp = ibfd;
   3572  1.10  christos 	    }
   3573   1.7  christos 	}
   3574   1.7  christos       else if (out_fp != 2 && in_fp == 2)
   3575   1.7  christos 	{
   3576   1.7  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler
   3577   1.7  christos 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   3578   1.7  christos 	    (_("%pB uses hard float, %pB uses soft float"),
   3579   1.7  christos 	     last_fp, ibfd);
   3580  1.10  christos 	  ret = warn_only;
   3581   1.7  christos 	}
   3582   1.7  christos       else if (out_fp == 2 && in_fp != 2)
   3583   1.7  christos 	{
   3584   1.7  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler
   3585   1.7  christos 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   3586   1.7  christos 	    (_("%pB uses hard float, %pB uses soft float"),
   3587   1.7  christos 	     ibfd, last_fp);
   3588  1.10  christos 	  ret = warn_only;
   3589   1.7  christos 	}
   3590   1.7  christos       else if (out_fp == 1 && in_fp == 3)
   3591   1.7  christos 	{
   3592   1.7  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler
   3593   1.7  christos 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   3594   1.7  christos 	    (_("%pB uses double-precision hard float, "
   3595   1.7  christos 	       "%pB uses single-precision hard float"), last_fp, ibfd);
   3596  1.10  christos 	  ret = warn_only;
   3597   1.7  christos 	}
   3598   1.7  christos       else if (out_fp == 3 && in_fp == 1)
   3599   1.7  christos 	{
   3600   1.7  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler
   3601   1.7  christos 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   3602   1.1  christos 	    (_("%pB uses double-precision hard float, "
   3603   1.7  christos 	       "%pB uses single-precision hard float"), ibfd, last_fp);
   3604   1.7  christos 	  ret = warn_only;
   3605  1.10  christos 	}
   3606  1.10  christos 
   3607  1.10  christos       in_fp = in_attr->i & 0xc;
   3608  1.10  christos       out_fp = out_attr->i & 0xc;
   3609  1.10  christos       if (in_fp == 0)
   3610  1.10  christos 	;
   3611   1.7  christos       else if (out_fp == 0)
   3612   1.7  christos 	{
   3613   1.7  christos 	  if (!warn_only)
   3614   1.7  christos 	    {
   3615   1.7  christos 	      out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
   3616   1.7  christos 	      out_attr->i ^= in_fp;
   3617   1.7  christos 	      last_ld = ibfd;
   3618  1.10  christos 	    }
   3619   1.7  christos 	}
   3620   1.7  christos       else if (out_fp != 2 * 4 && in_fp == 2 * 4)
   3621   1.7  christos 	{
   3622   1.7  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler
   3623   1.7  christos 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   3624   1.7  christos 	    (_("%pB uses 64-bit long double, "
   3625   1.7  christos 	       "%pB uses 128-bit long double"), ibfd, last_ld);
   3626  1.10  christos 	  ret = warn_only;
   3627   1.7  christos 	}
   3628   1.7  christos       else if (in_fp != 2 * 4 && out_fp == 2 * 4)
   3629   1.7  christos 	{
   3630   1.7  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler
   3631   1.7  christos 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   3632   1.7  christos 	    (_("%pB uses 64-bit long double, "
   3633   1.7  christos 	       "%pB uses 128-bit long double"), last_ld, ibfd);
   3634  1.10  christos 	  ret = warn_only;
   3635   1.7  christos 	}
   3636   1.7  christos       else if (out_fp == 1 * 4 && in_fp == 3 * 4)
   3637   1.7  christos 	{
   3638   1.7  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler
   3639   1.7  christos 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   3640   1.7  christos 	    (_("%pB uses IBM long double, "
   3641   1.7  christos 	       "%pB uses IEEE long double"), last_ld, ibfd);
   3642  1.10  christos 	  ret = warn_only;
   3643   1.7  christos 	}
   3644   1.7  christos       else if (out_fp == 3 * 4 && in_fp == 1 * 4)
   3645   1.7  christos 	{
   3646   1.7  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler
   3647   1.7  christos 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   3648   1.7  christos 	    (_("%pB uses IBM long double, "
   3649   1.7  christos 	       "%pB uses IEEE long double"), ibfd, last_ld);
   3650   1.1  christos 	  ret = warn_only;
   3651   1.7  christos 	}
   3652   1.7  christos     }
   3653   1.7  christos 
   3654   1.7  christos   if (!ret)
   3655   1.7  christos     {
   3656  1.10  christos       out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
   3657   1.7  christos       bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
   3658   1.7  christos     }
   3659   1.7  christos   return ret;
   3660   1.7  christos }
   3661   1.7  christos 
   3662  1.10  christos /* Merge object attributes from IBFD into OBFD.  Warn if
   3663   1.7  christos    there are conflicting attributes.  */
   3664   1.7  christos static bool
   3665  1.10  christos ppc_elf_merge_obj_attributes (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
   3666   1.7  christos {
   3667   1.7  christos   bfd *obfd;
   3668   1.7  christos   obj_attribute *in_attr, *in_attrs;
   3669   1.7  christos   obj_attribute *out_attr, *out_attrs;
   3670   1.1  christos   bool ret;
   3671   1.1  christos 
   3672   1.1  christos   if (!_bfd_elf_ppc_merge_fp_attributes (ibfd, info))
   3673   1.1  christos     return false;
   3674   1.1  christos 
   3675  1.10  christos   obfd = info->output_bfd;
   3676   1.1  christos   in_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (ibfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
   3677   1.1  christos   out_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (obfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
   3678   1.7  christos 
   3679   1.7  christos   /* Check for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector attributes and
   3680   1.7  christos      merge non-conflicting ones.  */
   3681   1.1  christos   in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector];
   3682   1.7  christos   out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector];
   3683   1.7  christos   ret = true;
   3684   1.7  christos   if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i)
   3685   1.1  christos     {
   3686   1.7  christos       int in_vec = in_attr->i & 3;
   3687   1.7  christos       int out_vec = out_attr->i & 3;
   3688   1.7  christos       static bfd *last_vec;
   3689   1.1  christos 
   3690   1.1  christos       if (in_vec == 0)
   3691   1.1  christos 	;
   3692   1.1  christos       else if (out_vec == 0)
   3693   1.1  christos 	{
   3694   1.1  christos 	  out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
   3695   1.7  christos 	  out_attr->i = in_vec;
   3696   1.1  christos 	  last_vec = ibfd;
   3697   1.7  christos 	}
   3698   1.7  christos       /* For now, allow generic to transition to AltiVec or SPE
   3699   1.7  christos 	 without a warning.  If GCC marked files with their stack
   3700   1.7  christos 	 alignment and used don't-care markings for files which are
   3701   1.7  christos 	 not affected by the vector ABI, we could warn about this
   3702   1.7  christos 	 case too.  */
   3703   1.7  christos       else if (in_vec == 1)
   3704   1.7  christos 	;
   3705   1.7  christos       else if (out_vec == 1)
   3706   1.7  christos 	{
   3707   1.7  christos 	  out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
   3708   1.7  christos 	  out_attr->i = in_vec;
   3709   1.7  christos 	  last_vec = ibfd;
   3710  1.10  christos 	}
   3711   1.7  christos       else if (out_vec < in_vec)
   3712   1.7  christos 	{
   3713   1.7  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler
   3714   1.7  christos 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   3715   1.7  christos 	    (_("%pB uses AltiVec vector ABI, %pB uses SPE vector ABI"),
   3716   1.7  christos 	     last_vec, ibfd);
   3717   1.7  christos 	  out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
   3718   1.7  christos 	  ret = false;
   3719  1.10  christos 	}
   3720   1.7  christos       else if (out_vec > in_vec)
   3721   1.1  christos 	{
   3722   1.1  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler
   3723   1.1  christos 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   3724   1.1  christos 	    (_("%pB uses AltiVec vector ABI, %pB uses SPE vector ABI"),
   3725   1.1  christos 	     ibfd, last_vec);
   3726   1.1  christos 	  out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
   3727   1.1  christos 	  ret = false;
   3728   1.1  christos 	}
   3729   1.7  christos     }
   3730   1.7  christos 
   3731   1.7  christos   /* Check for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return attributes
   3732   1.7  christos      and merge non-conflicting ones.  */
   3733   1.7  christos   in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return];
   3734   1.1  christos   out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return];
   3735   1.7  christos   if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i)
   3736   1.7  christos     {
   3737   1.7  christos       int in_struct = in_attr->i & 3;
   3738   1.7  christos       int out_struct = out_attr->i & 3;
   3739   1.7  christos       static bfd *last_struct;
   3740   1.7  christos 
   3741   1.7  christos       if (in_struct == 0 || in_struct == 3)
   3742   1.7  christos        ;
   3743   1.7  christos       else if (out_struct == 0)
   3744   1.7  christos 	{
   3745   1.7  christos 	  out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
   3746   1.7  christos 	  out_attr->i = in_struct;
   3747   1.7  christos 	  last_struct = ibfd;
   3748  1.10  christos 	}
   3749   1.7  christos       else if (out_struct < in_struct)
   3750   1.7  christos 	{
   3751   1.7  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler
   3752   1.7  christos 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   3753   1.7  christos 	    (_("%pB uses r3/r4 for small structure returns, "
   3754   1.7  christos 	       "%pB uses memory"), last_struct, ibfd);
   3755   1.7  christos 	  out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
   3756   1.7  christos 	  ret = false;
   3757  1.10  christos 	}
   3758   1.7  christos       else if (out_struct > in_struct)
   3759   1.7  christos 	{
   3760   1.7  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler
   3761   1.7  christos 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   3762   1.7  christos 	    (_("%pB uses r3/r4 for small structure returns, "
   3763  1.10  christos 	       "%pB uses memory"), ibfd, last_struct);
   3764   1.1  christos 	  out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
   3765   1.1  christos 	  ret = false;
   3766   1.1  christos 	}
   3767   1.7  christos     }
   3768   1.1  christos   if (!ret)
   3769   1.1  christos     {
   3770   1.1  christos       bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
   3771   1.1  christos       return false;
   3772   1.1  christos     }
   3773  1.10  christos 
   3774   1.7  christos   /* Merge Tag_compatibility attributes and any common GNU ones.  */
   3775   1.1  christos   return _bfd_elf_merge_object_attributes (ibfd, info);
   3776   1.7  christos }
   3777   1.1  christos 
   3778   1.1  christos /* Merge backend specific data from an object file to the output
   3779  1.10  christos    object file when linking.  */
   3780   1.1  christos 
   3781   1.1  christos static bool
   3782  1.10  christos ppc_elf_merge_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
   3783   1.1  christos {
   3784   1.1  christos   bfd *obfd = info->output_bfd;
   3785   1.7  christos   flagword old_flags;
   3786  1.10  christos   flagword new_flags;
   3787   1.1  christos   bool error;
   3788   1.7  christos 
   3789  1.10  christos   if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd) || !is_ppc_elf (obfd))
   3790  1.10  christos     return true;
   3791  1.10  christos 
   3792  1.10  christos   /* Check if we have the same endianness.  */
   3793   1.1  christos   if (! _bfd_generic_verify_endian_match (ibfd, info))
   3794   1.1  christos     return false;
   3795   1.1  christos 
   3796   1.1  christos   if (!ppc_elf_merge_obj_attributes (ibfd, info))
   3797   1.1  christos     return false;
   3798   1.1  christos 
   3799  1.10  christos   if ((ibfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
   3800   1.1  christos     return true;
   3801   1.1  christos 
   3802   1.1  christos   new_flags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
   3803   1.1  christos   old_flags = elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags;
   3804   1.1  christos   if (!elf_flags_init (obfd))
   3805   1.1  christos     {
   3806   1.1  christos       /* First call, no flags set.  */
   3807   1.1  christos       elf_flags_init (obfd) = true;
   3808   1.1  christos       elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags = new_flags;
   3809   1.1  christos     }
   3810   1.1  christos 
   3811   1.1  christos   /* Compatible flags are ok.  */
   3812  1.10  christos   else if (new_flags == old_flags)
   3813   1.1  christos     ;
   3814   1.1  christos 
   3815   1.1  christos   /* Incompatible flags.  */
   3816  1.10  christos   else
   3817   1.7  christos     {
   3818   1.7  christos       /* Warn about -mrelocatable mismatch.  Allow -mrelocatable-lib
   3819   1.1  christos 	 to be linked with either.  */
   3820   1.1  christos       error = false;
   3821   1.1  christos       if ((new_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE) != 0
   3822   1.1  christos 	  && (old_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)) == 0)
   3823   1.1  christos 	{
   3824  1.10  christos 	  error = true;
   3825   1.7  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler
   3826   1.7  christos 	    (_("%pB: compiled with -mrelocatable and linked with "
   3827   1.1  christos 	       "modules compiled normally"), ibfd);
   3828   1.1  christos 	}
   3829   1.1  christos       else if ((new_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)) == 0
   3830   1.1  christos 	       && (old_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE) != 0)
   3831   1.1  christos 	{
   3832   1.1  christos 	  error = true;
   3833   1.1  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler
   3834   1.1  christos 	    (_("%pB: compiled normally and linked with "
   3835   1.1  christos 	       "modules compiled with -mrelocatable"), ibfd);
   3836   1.1  christos 	}
   3837   1.1  christos 
   3838   1.1  christos       /* The output is -mrelocatable-lib iff both the input files are.  */
   3839   1.1  christos       if (! (new_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB))
   3840   1.1  christos 	elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags &= ~EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB;
   3841   1.1  christos 
   3842   1.1  christos       /* The output is -mrelocatable iff it can't be -mrelocatable-lib,
   3843   1.1  christos 	 but each input file is either -mrelocatable or -mrelocatable-lib.  */
   3844   1.1  christos       if (! (elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)
   3845   1.1  christos 	  && (new_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE))
   3846   1.1  christos 	  && (old_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE)))
   3847   1.1  christos 	elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE;
   3848   1.1  christos 
   3849   1.1  christos       /* Do not warn about eabi vs. V.4 mismatch, just or in the bit if
   3850   1.1  christos 	 any module uses it.  */
   3851  1.10  christos       elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= (new_flags & EF_PPC_EMB);
   3852   1.7  christos 
   3853   1.7  christos       new_flags &= ~(EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_EMB);
   3854   1.7  christos       old_flags &= ~(EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_EMB);
   3855   1.7  christos 
   3856   1.7  christos       /* Warn about any other mismatches.  */
   3857   1.1  christos       if (new_flags != old_flags)
   3858   1.1  christos 	{
   3859   1.1  christos 	  error = true;
   3860   1.1  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler
   3861   1.1  christos 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   3862  1.10  christos 	    (_("%pB: uses different e_flags (%#x) fields "
   3863   1.1  christos 	       "than previous modules (%#x)"),
   3864   1.1  christos 	     ibfd, new_flags, old_flags);
   3865   1.1  christos 	}
   3866  1.10  christos 
   3867   1.1  christos       if (error)
   3868   1.1  christos 	{
   3869  1.10  christos 	  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
   3870   1.7  christos 	  return false;
   3871   1.7  christos 	}
   3872   1.7  christos     }
   3873   1.7  christos 
   3874   1.3  christos   return true;
   3875   1.7  christos }
   3876  1.10  christos 
   3877   1.7  christos static bfd_reloc_status_type
   3878   1.9  christos ppc_elf_vle_split16 (bfd *input_bfd,
   3879   1.7  christos 		     asection *input_section,
   3880  1.10  christos 		     unsigned long offset,
   3881  1.10  christos 		     bfd_byte *loc,
   3882   1.7  christos 		     bfd_vma value,
   3883   1.9  christos 		     split16_format_type split16_format,
   3884   1.7  christos 		     bool fixup)
   3885   1.7  christos {
   3886   1.7  christos   unsigned int insn, opcode;
   3887   1.7  christos 
   3888   1.7  christos   if (!offset_in_range (input_section, offset, 4))
   3889   1.7  christos     return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
   3890   1.7  christos   insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, loc);
   3891   1.7  christos   opcode = insn & E_OPCODE_MASK;
   3892   1.7  christos   if (opcode == E_OR2I_INSN
   3893   1.7  christos       || opcode == E_AND2I_DOT_INSN
   3894   1.7  christos       || opcode == E_OR2IS_INSN
   3895   1.7  christos       || opcode == E_LIS_INSN
   3896   1.7  christos       || opcode == E_AND2IS_DOT_INSN)
   3897   1.7  christos     {
   3898   1.7  christos       if (split16_format != split16a_type)
   3899   1.7  christos 	{
   3900   1.7  christos 	  if (fixup)
   3901   1.7  christos 	    split16_format = split16a_type;
   3902   1.7  christos 	  else
   3903   1.7  christos 	    _bfd_error_handler
   3904   1.7  christos 	      /* xgettext:c-format */
   3905   1.7  christos 	      (_("%pB(%pA+0x%lx): expected 16A style relocation on 0x%08x insn"),
   3906   1.7  christos 	       input_bfd, input_section, offset, opcode);
   3907   1.7  christos 	}
   3908   1.7  christos     }
   3909   1.7  christos   else if (opcode == E_ADD2I_DOT_INSN
   3910   1.7  christos 	   || opcode == E_ADD2IS_INSN
   3911   1.7  christos 	   || opcode == E_CMP16I_INSN
   3912   1.7  christos 	   || opcode == E_MULL2I_INSN
   3913   1.7  christos 	   || opcode == E_CMPL16I_INSN
   3914   1.7  christos 	   || opcode == E_CMPH16I_INSN
   3915   1.7  christos 	   || opcode == E_CMPHL16I_INSN)
   3916   1.7  christos     {
   3917   1.7  christos       if (split16_format != split16d_type)
   3918   1.7  christos 	{
   3919   1.7  christos 	  if (fixup)
   3920   1.9  christos 	    split16_format = split16d_type;
   3921   1.9  christos 	  else
   3922   1.9  christos 	    _bfd_error_handler
   3923   1.9  christos 	      /* xgettext:c-format */
   3924   1.9  christos 	      (_("%pB(%pA+0x%lx): expected 16D style relocation on 0x%08x insn"),
   3925   1.9  christos 	       input_bfd, input_section, offset, opcode);
   3926   1.9  christos 	}
   3927   1.9  christos     }
   3928   1.9  christos   if (split16_format == split16a_type)
   3929   1.9  christos     {
   3930   1.9  christos       insn &= ~((0xf800 << 5) | 0x7ff);
   3931   1.9  christos       insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 5;
   3932   1.9  christos       if ((insn & E_LI_MASK) == E_LI_INSN)
   3933   1.9  christos 	{
   3934   1.9  christos 	  /* Hack for e_li.  Extend sign.  */
   3935   1.9  christos 	  insn &= ~(0xf0000 >> 5);
   3936   1.7  christos 	  insn |= (-(value & 0x8000) & 0xf0000) >> 5;
   3937   1.7  christos 	}
   3938  1.10  christos     }
   3939   1.7  christos   else
   3940   1.1  christos     {
   3941   1.7  christos       insn &= ~((0xf800 << 10) | 0x7ff);
   3942   1.7  christos       insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 10;
   3943   1.1  christos     }
   3944   1.7  christos   insn |= value & 0x7ff;
   3945   1.1  christos   bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, loc);
   3946   1.3  christos   return bfd_reloc_ok;
   3947   1.7  christos }
   3948   1.7  christos 
   3949   1.7  christos static void
   3950   1.7  christos ppc_elf_vle_split20 (bfd *output_bfd, bfd_byte *loc, bfd_vma value)
   3951   1.7  christos {
   3952   1.7  christos   unsigned int insn;
   3953   1.3  christos 
   3954   1.3  christos   insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc);
   3955   1.1  christos   /* We have an li20 field, bits 17..20, 11..15, 21..31.  */
   3956   1.1  christos   /* Top 4 bits of value to 17..20.  */
   3957   1.1  christos   insn |= (value & 0xf0000) >> 5;
   3958   1.1  christos   /* Next 5 bits of the value to 11..15.  */
   3959   1.1  christos   insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 5;
   3960   1.1  christos   /* And the final 11 bits of the value to bits 21 to 31.  */
   3961   1.1  christos   insn |= value & 0x7ff;
   3962   1.3  christos   bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, insn, loc);
   3963   1.1  christos }
   3964   1.1  christos 
   3965   1.1  christos 
   3966   1.1  christos /* Choose which PLT scheme to use, and set .plt flags appropriately.
   3968   1.1  christos    Returns -1 on error, 0 for old PLT, 1 for new PLT.  */
   3969   1.1  christos int
   3970   1.1  christos ppc_elf_select_plt_layout (bfd *output_bfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   3971   1.1  christos 			   struct bfd_link_info *info)
   3972   1.1  christos {
   3973   1.3  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
   3974   1.1  christos   flagword flags;
   3975   1.3  christos 
   3976   1.1  christos   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   3977   1.1  christos 
   3978  1.10  christos   if (htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
   3979   1.1  christos     {
   3980   1.1  christos       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
   3981   1.1  christos 
   3982   1.1  christos       if (htab->params->plt_style == PLT_OLD)
   3983   1.7  christos 	htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
   3984   1.1  christos       else if (bfd_link_pic (info)
   3985   1.1  christos 	       && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
   3986   1.1  christos 	       && (h = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "_mcount",
   3987   1.1  christos 					     false, false, true)) != NULL
   3988   1.1  christos 	       && (h->type == STT_FUNC
   3989   1.1  christos 		   || h->needs_plt)
   3990   1.1  christos 	       && h->ref_regular
   3991   1.1  christos 	       && !(SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
   3992   1.1  christos 		    || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h)))
   3993   1.1  christos 	{
   3994   1.3  christos 	  /* Profiling of shared libs (and pies) is not supported with
   3995   1.1  christos 	     secure plt, because ppc32 does profiling before a
   3996   1.1  christos 	     function prologue and a secure plt pic call stubs needs
   3997   1.1  christos 	     r30 to be set up.  */
   3998   1.1  christos 	  htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
   3999   1.1  christos 	}
   4000   1.1  christos       else
   4001   1.1  christos 	{
   4002   1.3  christos 	  bfd *ibfd;
   4003   1.1  christos 	  enum ppc_elf_plt_type plt_type = htab->params->plt_style;
   4004   1.1  christos 
   4005   1.1  christos 	  /* Look through the reloc flags left by ppc_elf_check_relocs.
   4006   1.1  christos 	     Use the old style bss plt if a file makes plt calls
   4007   1.1  christos 	     without using the new relocs, and if ld isn't given
   4008   1.1  christos 	     --secure-plt and we never see REL16 relocs.  */
   4009   1.1  christos 	  if (plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
   4010   1.1  christos 	    plt_type = PLT_OLD;
   4011   1.1  christos 	  for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
   4012   1.1  christos 	    if (is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
   4013   1.1  christos 	      {
   4014   1.1  christos 		if (ppc_elf_tdata (ibfd)->has_rel16)
   4015   1.1  christos 		  plt_type = PLT_NEW;
   4016   1.1  christos 		else if (ppc_elf_tdata (ibfd)->makes_plt_call)
   4017  1.11  christos 		  {
   4018   1.1  christos 		    plt_type = PLT_OLD;
   4019  1.11  christos 		    htab->old_bfd = ibfd;
   4020  1.11  christos 		    break;
   4021  1.11  christos 		  }
   4022  1.11  christos 	      }
   4023  1.11  christos 	  htab->plt_type = plt_type;
   4024  1.11  christos 	}
   4025  1.11  christos     }
   4026  1.11  christos   if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
   4027  1.11  christos     {
   4028  1.11  christos       if (!info->user_warn_rwx_segments)
   4029  1.11  christos 	info->no_warn_rwx_segments = 1;
   4030   1.1  christos       if (htab->params->plt_style == PLT_NEW
   4031   1.1  christos 	  || (htab->params->plt_style != PLT_OLD
   4032   1.1  christos 	      && !info->no_warn_rwx_segments))
   4033   1.1  christos 	{
   4034   1.1  christos 	  if (htab->old_bfd != NULL)
   4035   1.1  christos 	    _bfd_error_handler (_("bss-plt forced due to %pB"), htab->old_bfd);
   4036   1.1  christos 	  else
   4037   1.1  christos 	    _bfd_error_handler (_("bss-plt forced by profiling"));
   4038   1.1  christos 	}
   4039   1.1  christos     }
   4040   1.7  christos 
   4041   1.9  christos   BFD_ASSERT (htab->plt_type != PLT_VXWORKS);
   4042   1.1  christos 
   4043   1.1  christos   if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
   4044   1.1  christos     {
   4045   1.7  christos       flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
   4046   1.9  christos 	       | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
   4047   1.1  christos 
   4048   1.1  christos       /* The new PLT is a loaded section.  */
   4049   1.1  christos       if (htab->elf.splt != NULL
   4050   1.1  christos 	  && !bfd_set_section_flags (htab->elf.splt, flags))
   4051   1.1  christos 	return -1;
   4052   1.1  christos 
   4053   1.9  christos       /* The new GOT is not executable.  */
   4054   1.1  christos       if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL
   4055   1.1  christos 	  && !bfd_set_section_flags (htab->elf.sgot, flags))
   4056   1.1  christos 	return -1;
   4057   1.1  christos     }
   4058   1.1  christos   else
   4059   1.1  christos     {
   4060   1.1  christos       /* Stop an unused .glink section from affecting .text alignment.  */
   4061   1.1  christos       if (htab->glink != NULL
   4062   1.1  christos 	  && !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->glink, 0))
   4063   1.1  christos 	return -1;
   4064   1.1  christos     }
   4065   1.1  christos   return htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW;
   4066   1.1  christos }
   4067   1.1  christos 
   4068   1.1  christos /* Return the section that should be marked against GC for a given
   4070   1.1  christos    relocation.  */
   4071   1.1  christos 
   4072   1.1  christos static asection *
   4073   1.1  christos ppc_elf_gc_mark_hook (asection *sec,
   4074   1.1  christos 		      struct bfd_link_info *info,
   4075   1.1  christos 		      Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
   4076   1.1  christos 		      struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
   4077   1.1  christos 		      Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
   4078   1.1  christos {
   4079   1.1  christos   if (h != NULL)
   4080  1.10  christos     switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
   4081   1.7  christos       {
   4082   1.7  christos       case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT:
   4083   1.7  christos       case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY:
   4084   1.7  christos 	return NULL;
   4085   1.7  christos       }
   4086   1.7  christos 
   4087   1.7  christos   return _bfd_elf_gc_mark_hook (sec, info, rel, h, sym);
   4088   1.1  christos }
   4089   1.7  christos 
   4090   1.1  christos static bool
   4091   1.7  christos get_sym_h (struct elf_link_hash_entry **hp,
   4092   1.7  christos 	   Elf_Internal_Sym **symp,
   4093   1.7  christos 	   asection **symsecp,
   4094   1.7  christos 	   unsigned char **tls_maskp,
   4095   1.1  christos 	   Elf_Internal_Sym **locsymsp,
   4096   1.7  christos 	   unsigned long r_symndx,
   4097   1.7  christos 	   bfd *ibfd)
   4098   1.7  christos {
   4099   1.7  christos   Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
   4100   1.1  christos 
   4101   1.7  christos   if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
   4102   1.7  christos     {
   4103   1.1  christos       struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
   4104   1.7  christos       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
   4105   1.7  christos 
   4106   1.1  christos       h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
   4107   1.7  christos       while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
   4108   1.1  christos 	     || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
   4109   1.7  christos 	h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
   4110   1.7  christos 
   4111   1.7  christos       if (hp != NULL)
   4112   1.7  christos 	*hp = h;
   4113   1.7  christos 
   4114   1.1  christos       if (symp != NULL)
   4115   1.1  christos 	*symp = NULL;
   4116   1.7  christos 
   4117   1.7  christos       if (symsecp != NULL)
   4118   1.7  christos 	{
   4119   1.7  christos 	  asection *symsec = NULL;
   4120   1.7  christos 	  if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
   4121   1.7  christos 	      || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
   4122   1.7  christos 	    symsec = h->root.u.def.section;
   4123   1.1  christos 	  *symsecp = symsec;
   4124   1.7  christos 	}
   4125   1.7  christos 
   4126   1.7  christos       if (tls_maskp != NULL)
   4127   1.7  christos 	*tls_maskp = &ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask;
   4128   1.7  christos     }
   4129   1.7  christos   else
   4130   1.7  christos     {
   4131   1.7  christos       Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
   4132  1.10  christos       Elf_Internal_Sym *locsyms = *locsymsp;
   4133   1.7  christos 
   4134   1.1  christos       if (locsyms == NULL)
   4135   1.7  christos 	{
   4136   1.1  christos 	  locsyms = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents;
   4137   1.7  christos 	  if (locsyms == NULL)
   4138   1.7  christos 	    locsyms = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (ibfd, symtab_hdr,
   4139   1.1  christos 					    symtab_hdr->sh_info,
   4140   1.7  christos 					    0, NULL, NULL, NULL);
   4141   1.7  christos 	  if (locsyms == NULL)
   4142   1.1  christos 	    return false;
   4143   1.7  christos 	  *locsymsp = locsyms;
   4144   1.7  christos 	}
   4145   1.1  christos       sym = locsyms + r_symndx;
   4146   1.7  christos 
   4147   1.7  christos       if (hp != NULL)
   4148   1.7  christos 	*hp = NULL;
   4149   1.7  christos 
   4150   1.1  christos       if (symp != NULL)
   4151   1.7  christos 	*symp = sym;
   4152   1.7  christos 
   4153   1.7  christos       if (symsecp != NULL)
   4154   1.1  christos 	*symsecp = bfd_section_from_elf_index (ibfd, sym->st_shndx);
   4155   1.7  christos 
   4156   1.7  christos       if (tls_maskp != NULL)
   4157   1.7  christos 	{
   4158   1.7  christos 	  bfd_signed_vma *local_got;
   4159   1.7  christos 	  unsigned char *tls_mask;
   4160   1.1  christos 
   4161   1.7  christos 	  tls_mask = NULL;
   4162   1.1  christos 	  local_got = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd);
   4163   1.1  christos 	  if (local_got != NULL)
   4164  1.10  christos 	    {
   4165   1.1  christos 	      struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
   4166   1.1  christos 		(local_got + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
   4167   1.7  christos 	      unsigned char *lgot_masks = (unsigned char *)
   4168   1.7  christos 		(local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
   4169   1.1  christos 	      tls_mask = &lgot_masks[r_symndx];
   4170  1.10  christos 	    }
   4171   1.7  christos 	  *tls_maskp = tls_mask;
   4172   1.1  christos 	}
   4173   1.1  christos     }
   4174   1.7  christos   return true;
   4175   1.7  christos }
   4176   1.7  christos 
   4177   1.1  christos /* Analyze inline PLT call relocations to see whether calls to locally
   4179   1.7  christos    defined functions can be converted to direct calls.  */
   4180  1.10  christos 
   4181   1.7  christos bool
   4182   1.7  christos ppc_elf_inline_plt (struct bfd_link_info *info)
   4183   1.7  christos {
   4184   1.7  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
   4185   1.7  christos   bfd *ibfd;
   4186   1.7  christos   asection *sec;
   4187   1.7  christos   bfd_vma low_vma, high_vma, limit;
   4188   1.7  christos 
   4189   1.7  christos   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   4190   1.7  christos   if (htab == NULL)
   4191   1.7  christos     return false;
   4192   1.7  christos 
   4193   1.7  christos   /* A bl insn can reach -0x2000000 to 0x1fffffc.  The limit is
   4194   1.7  christos      reduced somewhat to cater for possible stubs that might be added
   4195   1.7  christos      between the call and its destination.  */
   4196   1.3  christos   limit = 0x1e00000;
   4197   1.7  christos   low_vma = -1;
   4198   1.7  christos   high_vma = 0;
   4199   1.7  christos   for (sec = info->output_bfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
   4200   1.7  christos     if ((sec->flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE)) == (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE))
   4201   1.7  christos       {
   4202   1.7  christos 	if (low_vma > sec->vma)
   4203  1.10  christos 	  low_vma = sec->vma;
   4204   1.7  christos 	if (high_vma < sec->vma + sec->size)
   4205   1.7  christos 	  high_vma = sec->vma + sec->size;
   4206   1.7  christos       }
   4207   1.7  christos 
   4208   1.7  christos   /* If a "bl" can reach anywhere in local code sections, then we can
   4209   1.7  christos      convert all inline PLT sequences to direct calls when the symbol
   4210   1.7  christos      is local.  */
   4211   1.7  christos   if (high_vma - low_vma < limit)
   4212   1.7  christos     {
   4213   1.7  christos       htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt = 1;
   4214   1.7  christos       return true;
   4215   1.7  christos     }
   4216   1.7  christos 
   4217   1.7  christos   /* Otherwise, go looking through relocs for cases where a direct
   4218   1.7  christos      call won't reach.  Mark the symbol on any such reloc to disable
   4219   1.7  christos      the optimization and keep the PLT entry as it seems likely that
   4220   1.7  christos      this will be better than creating trampolines.  Note that this
   4221   1.7  christos      will disable the optimization for all inline PLT calls to a
   4222   1.7  christos      particular symbol, not just those that won't reach.  The
   4223   1.7  christos      difficulty in doing a more precise optimization is that the
   4224   1.7  christos      linker needs to make a decision depending on whether a
   4225   1.7  christos      particular R_PPC_PLTCALL insn can be turned into a direct
   4226   1.7  christos      call, for each of the R_PPC_PLTSEQ and R_PPC_PLT16* insns in
   4227   1.7  christos      the sequence, and there is nothing that ties those relocs
   4228   1.7  christos      together except their symbol.  */
   4229   1.7  christos 
   4230   1.7  christos   for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
   4231   1.7  christos     {
   4232   1.7  christos       Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
   4233   1.7  christos       Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms;
   4234   1.7  christos 
   4235   1.7  christos       if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
   4236   1.7  christos 	continue;
   4237   1.7  christos 
   4238   1.7  christos       local_syms = NULL;
   4239   1.7  christos       symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
   4240  1.10  christos 
   4241   1.7  christos       for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
   4242   1.7  christos 	if (sec->has_pltcall
   4243   1.8       rin 	    && !bfd_is_abs_section (sec->output_section))
   4244   1.7  christos 	  {
   4245   1.7  christos 	    Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel, *relend;
   4246   1.7  christos 
   4247   1.7  christos 	    /* Read the relocations.  */
   4248   1.7  christos 	    relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
   4249   1.7  christos 						  info->keep_memory);
   4250   1.7  christos 	    if (relstart == NULL)
   4251   1.7  christos 	      return false;
   4252   1.7  christos 
   4253   1.7  christos 	    relend = relstart + sec->reloc_count;
   4254   1.7  christos 	    for (rel = relstart; rel < relend; rel++)
   4255   1.7  christos 	      {
   4256   1.7  christos 		enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
   4257   1.7  christos 		unsigned long r_symndx;
   4258   1.7  christos 		asection *sym_sec;
   4259   1.7  christos 		struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
   4260   1.7  christos 		Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
   4261   1.7  christos 		unsigned char *tls_maskp;
   4262  1.10  christos 
   4263   1.7  christos 		r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
   4264  1.10  christos 		if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTCALL)
   4265   1.7  christos 		  continue;
   4266   1.7  christos 
   4267   1.7  christos 		r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
   4268   1.7  christos 		if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, &tls_maskp, &local_syms,
   4269   1.7  christos 				r_symndx, ibfd))
   4270   1.7  christos 		  {
   4271   1.7  christos 		    if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
   4272   1.7  christos 		      free (relstart);
   4273   1.7  christos 		    if (symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
   4274   1.7  christos 		      free (local_syms);
   4275   1.7  christos 		    return false;
   4276   1.7  christos 		  }
   4277   1.7  christos 
   4278   1.7  christos 		if (sym_sec != NULL && sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
   4279   1.7  christos 		  {
   4280   1.7  christos 		    bfd_vma from, to;
   4281   1.7  christos 		    if (h != NULL)
   4282   1.7  christos 		      to = h->root.u.def.value;
   4283   1.7  christos 		    else
   4284   1.7  christos 		      to = sym->st_value;
   4285   1.7  christos 		    to += (rel->r_addend
   4286   1.7  christos 			   + sym_sec->output_offset
   4287   1.7  christos 			   + sym_sec->output_section->vma);
   4288   1.7  christos 		    from = (rel->r_offset
   4289   1.7  christos 			    + sec->output_offset
   4290   1.7  christos 			    + sec->output_section->vma);
   4291   1.7  christos 		    if (to - from + limit < 2 * limit)
   4292   1.7  christos 		      *tls_maskp &= ~PLT_KEEP;
   4293   1.7  christos 		  }
   4294   1.7  christos 	      }
   4295   1.7  christos 	    if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
   4296   1.7  christos 	      free (relstart);
   4297   1.7  christos 	  }
   4298  1.10  christos 
   4299   1.7  christos       if (local_syms != NULL
   4300   1.7  christos 	  && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
   4301   1.7  christos 	{
   4302   1.7  christos 	  if (!info->keep_memory)
   4303   1.7  christos 	    free (local_syms);
   4304   1.7  christos 	  else
   4305   1.7  christos 	    symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
   4306   1.7  christos 	}
   4307   1.7  christos     }
   4308   1.7  christos 
   4309   1.7  christos   return true;
   4310   1.7  christos }
   4311  1.10  christos 
   4312   1.7  christos /* Set plt output section type, htab->tls_get_addr, and call the
   4313  1.10  christos    generic ELF tls_setup function.  */
   4314   1.7  christos 
   4315   1.7  christos asection *
   4316   1.1  christos ppc_elf_tls_setup (bfd *obfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
   4317   1.1  christos {
   4318   1.1  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
   4319  1.10  christos 
   4320   1.1  christos   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   4321   1.1  christos   htab->tls_get_addr = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr",
   4322   1.1  christos 					     false, false, true);
   4323   1.1  christos   if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW)
   4324   1.1  christos     htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt = true;
   4325   1.1  christos 
   4326   1.1  christos   if (!htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt)
   4327   1.1  christos     {
   4328   1.1  christos       struct elf_link_hash_entry *opt, *tga;
   4329   1.1  christos       opt = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr_opt",
   4330   1.1  christos 				  false, false, true);
   4331   1.1  christos       if (opt != NULL
   4332   1.1  christos 	  && (opt->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
   4333   1.1  christos 	      || opt->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak))
   4334   1.7  christos 	{
   4335   1.1  christos 	  /* If glibc supports an optimized __tls_get_addr call stub,
   4336   1.1  christos 	     signalled by the presence of __tls_get_addr_opt, and we'll
   4337   1.1  christos 	     be calling __tls_get_addr via a plt call stub, then
   4338   1.1  christos 	     make __tls_get_addr point to __tls_get_addr_opt.  */
   4339   1.1  christos 	  tga = htab->tls_get_addr;
   4340   1.1  christos 	  if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
   4341   1.1  christos 	      && tga != NULL
   4342   1.1  christos 	      && (tga->type == STT_FUNC
   4343   1.1  christos 		  || tga->needs_plt)
   4344   1.1  christos 	      && !(SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, tga)
   4345   1.7  christos 		   || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, tga)))
   4346   1.1  christos 	    {
   4347   1.1  christos 	      struct plt_entry *ent;
   4348   1.1  christos 	      for (ent = tga->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
   4349   1.1  christos 		if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
   4350   1.1  christos 		  break;
   4351   1.1  christos 	      if (ent != NULL)
   4352   1.1  christos 		{
   4353  1.12  christos 		  tga->root.type = bfd_link_hash_indirect;
   4354   1.1  christos 		  tga->root.u.i.link = &opt->root;
   4355   1.1  christos 		  ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (info, opt, tga);
   4356   1.1  christos 		  opt->mark = 1;
   4357   1.1  christos 		  if (opt->dynindx != -1)
   4358   1.1  christos 		    {
   4359   1.1  christos 		      /* Use __tls_get_addr_opt in dynamic relocations.  */
   4360  1.10  christos 		      opt->dynindx = -1;
   4361   1.1  christos 		      _bfd_elf_strtab_delref (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr,
   4362   1.1  christos 					      opt->dynstr_index);
   4363   1.7  christos 		      if (!bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, opt))
   4364   1.7  christos 			return NULL;
   4365   1.1  christos 		    }
   4366   1.7  christos 		  htab->tls_get_addr = opt;
   4367   1.7  christos 		}
   4368   1.1  christos 	    }
   4369   1.1  christos 	}
   4370   1.1  christos       else
   4371   1.1  christos 	htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt = true;
   4372   1.1  christos     }
   4373   1.1  christos   if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
   4374   1.1  christos       && htab->elf.splt != NULL
   4375   1.1  christos       && htab->elf.splt->output_section != NULL)
   4376  1.10  christos     {
   4377   1.1  christos       elf_section_type (htab->elf.splt->output_section) = SHT_PROGBITS;
   4378   1.1  christos       elf_section_flags (htab->elf.splt->output_section) = SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE;
   4379   1.1  christos     }
   4380   1.1  christos 
   4381   1.1  christos   return _bfd_elf_tls_setup (obfd, info);
   4382   1.1  christos }
   4383   1.1  christos 
   4384   1.1  christos /* Return TRUE iff REL is a branch reloc with a global symbol matching
   4385   1.1  christos    HASH.  */
   4386   1.1  christos 
   4387   1.1  christos static bool
   4388   1.1  christos branch_reloc_hash_match (const bfd *ibfd,
   4389   1.1  christos 			 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
   4390   1.1  christos 			 const struct elf_link_hash_entry *hash)
   4391   1.1  christos {
   4392   1.1  christos   Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
   4393   1.1  christos   enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
   4394   1.1  christos   unsigned int r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
   4395  1.10  christos 
   4396   1.1  christos   if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info && is_branch_reloc (r_type))
   4397  1.10  christos     {
   4398   1.1  christos       struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
   4399   1.1  christos       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
   4400   1.1  christos 
   4401   1.1  christos       h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
   4402   1.1  christos       while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
   4403  1.10  christos 	     || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
   4404   1.1  christos 	h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
   4405   1.1  christos       if (h == hash)
   4406   1.1  christos 	return true;
   4407   1.1  christos     }
   4408   1.1  christos   return false;
   4409   1.1  christos }
   4410   1.1  christos 
   4411   1.1  christos /* Run through all the TLS relocs looking for optimization
   4412   1.3  christos    opportunities.  */
   4413  1.10  christos 
   4414   1.1  christos bool
   4415   1.1  christos ppc_elf_tls_optimize (bfd *obfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   4416   1.1  christos 		      struct bfd_link_info *info)
   4417  1.10  christos {
   4418  1.10  christos   bfd *ibfd;
   4419  1.10  christos   asection *sec;
   4420   1.1  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
   4421   1.1  christos   int pass;
   4422   1.1  christos 
   4423   1.1  christos   if (!bfd_link_executable (info))
   4424   1.1  christos     return true;
   4425   1.1  christos 
   4426   1.1  christos   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   4427   1.1  christos   if (htab == NULL)
   4428   1.3  christos     return false;
   4429   1.1  christos 
   4430   1.1  christos   htab->do_tls_opt = 1;
   4431   1.1  christos 
   4432   1.1  christos   /* Make two passes through the relocs.  First time check that tls
   4433   1.1  christos      relocs involved in setting up a tls_get_addr call are indeed
   4434   1.1  christos      followed by such a call.  If they are not, don't do any tls
   4435   1.1  christos      optimization.  On the second pass twiddle tls_mask flags to
   4436   1.1  christos      notify relocate_section that optimization can be done, and
   4437   1.1  christos      adjust got and plt refcounts.  */
   4438   1.1  christos   for (pass = 0; pass < 2; ++pass)
   4439   1.1  christos     for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
   4440   1.1  christos       {
   4441   1.1  christos 	Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
   4442   1.1  christos 	asection *got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, ".got2");
   4443  1.10  christos 
   4444   1.1  christos 	for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
   4445   1.1  christos 	  if (sec->has_tls_reloc && !bfd_is_abs_section (sec->output_section))
   4446   1.1  christos 	    {
   4447   1.1  christos 	      Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel, *relend;
   4448   1.1  christos 	      int expecting_tls_get_addr = 0;
   4449   1.1  christos 
   4450   1.1  christos 	      /* Read the relocations.  */
   4451   1.7  christos 	      relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
   4452   1.7  christos 						    info->keep_memory);
   4453  1.10  christos 	      if (relstart == NULL)
   4454   1.1  christos 		return false;
   4455   1.1  christos 
   4456   1.1  christos 	      relend = relstart + sec->reloc_count;
   4457   1.1  christos 	      for (rel = relstart; rel < relend; rel++)
   4458   1.1  christos 		{
   4459   1.1  christos 		  enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
   4460   1.1  christos 		  unsigned long r_symndx;
   4461   1.1  christos 		  struct elf_link_hash_entry *h = NULL;
   4462   1.1  christos 		  unsigned char *tls_mask;
   4463   1.1  christos 		  unsigned char tls_set, tls_clear;
   4464   1.1  christos 		  bool is_local;
   4465   1.1  christos 		  bfd_signed_vma *got_count;
   4466   1.1  christos 
   4467   1.1  christos 		  r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
   4468   1.9  christos 		  if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
   4469   1.1  christos 		    {
   4470   1.1  christos 		      struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
   4471   1.1  christos 
   4472   1.1  christos 		      sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
   4473   1.1  christos 		      h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
   4474   1.1  christos 		      while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
   4475   1.1  christos 			     || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
   4476   1.1  christos 			h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
   4477   1.9  christos 		    }
   4478   1.1  christos 
   4479   1.1  christos 		  is_local = SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h);
   4480   1.1  christos 		  r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
   4481   1.1  christos 		  /* If this section has old-style __tls_get_addr calls
   4482   1.1  christos 		     without marker relocs, then check that each
   4483   1.1  christos 		     __tls_get_addr call reloc is preceded by a reloc
   4484   1.1  christos 		     that conceivably belongs to the __tls_get_addr arg
   4485   1.1  christos 		     setup insn.  If we don't find matching arg setup
   4486   1.1  christos 		     relocs, don't do any tls optimization.  */
   4487   1.1  christos 		  if (pass == 0
   4488  1.10  christos 		      && sec->nomark_tls_get_addr
   4489   1.1  christos 		      && h != NULL
   4490   1.1  christos 		      && h == htab->tls_get_addr
   4491   1.1  christos 		      && !expecting_tls_get_addr
   4492   1.1  christos 		      && is_branch_reloc (r_type))
   4493   1.1  christos 		    {
   4494   1.1  christos 		      info->callbacks->minfo ("%H __tls_get_addr lost arg, "
   4495   1.1  christos 					      "TLS optimization disabled\n",
   4496   1.1  christos 					      ibfd, sec, rel->r_offset);
   4497   1.7  christos 		      if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
   4498   1.1  christos 			free (relstart);
   4499   1.1  christos 		      return true;
   4500   1.1  christos 		    }
   4501   1.1  christos 
   4502   1.1  christos 		  expecting_tls_get_addr = 0;
   4503   1.1  christos 		  switch (r_type)
   4504   1.1  christos 		    {
   4505   1.1  christos 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
   4506   1.1  christos 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
   4507   1.1  christos 		      expecting_tls_get_addr = 1;
   4508   1.1  christos 		      /* Fall through.  */
   4509   1.1  christos 
   4510   1.1  christos 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
   4511   1.1  christos 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
   4512   1.1  christos 		      /* These relocs should never be against a symbol
   4513   1.1  christos 			 defined in a shared lib.  Leave them alone if
   4514   1.1  christos 			 that turns out to be the case.  */
   4515   1.7  christos 		      if (!is_local)
   4516   1.1  christos 			continue;
   4517   1.1  christos 
   4518   1.1  christos 		      /* LD -> LE */
   4519   1.1  christos 		      tls_set = 0;
   4520   1.1  christos 		      tls_clear = TLS_LD;
   4521   1.1  christos 		      break;
   4522   1.1  christos 
   4523   1.1  christos 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
   4524   1.9  christos 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
   4525   1.1  christos 		      expecting_tls_get_addr = 1;
   4526   1.1  christos 		      /* Fall through.  */
   4527   1.1  christos 
   4528   1.1  christos 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
   4529   1.1  christos 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
   4530   1.1  christos 		      if (is_local)
   4531   1.1  christos 			/* GD -> LE */
   4532   1.1  christos 			tls_set = 0;
   4533   1.1  christos 		      else
   4534   1.1  christos 			/* GD -> IE */
   4535   1.1  christos 			tls_set = TLS_TLS | TLS_GDIE;
   4536   1.1  christos 		      tls_clear = TLS_GD;
   4537   1.1  christos 		      break;
   4538   1.1  christos 
   4539   1.1  christos 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
   4540   1.1  christos 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
   4541   1.1  christos 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
   4542   1.9  christos 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
   4543   1.9  christos 		      if (is_local)
   4544   1.9  christos 			{
   4545   1.9  christos 			  /* IE -> LE */
   4546   1.1  christos 			  tls_set = 0;
   4547   1.7  christos 			  tls_clear = TLS_TPREL;
   4548   1.7  christos 			  break;
   4549   1.7  christos 			}
   4550   1.7  christos 		      else
   4551   1.7  christos 			continue;
   4552   1.7  christos 
   4553   1.7  christos 		    case R_PPC_TLSLD:
   4554   1.7  christos 		      if (!is_local)
   4555   1.7  christos 			continue;
   4556   1.7  christos 		      /* Fall through.  */
   4557   1.7  christos 		    case R_PPC_TLSGD:
   4558   1.7  christos 		      if (rel + 1 < relend
   4559   1.7  christos 			  && is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
   4560   1.7  christos 			{
   4561   1.7  christos 			  if (pass != 0
   4562   1.7  christos 			      && ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) != R_PPC_PLTSEQ)
   4563   1.7  christos 			    {
   4564   1.7  christos 			      r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info);
   4565   1.7  christos 			      r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel[1].r_info);
   4566   1.7  christos 			      if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
   4567   1.7  christos 				{
   4568   1.7  christos 				  struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
   4569   1.7  christos 
   4570   1.7  christos 				  sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
   4571   1.7  christos 				  h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
   4572   1.7  christos 				  while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
   4573   1.7  christos 					 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
   4574   1.7  christos 				    h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
   4575   1.7  christos 				  if (h != NULL)
   4576   1.7  christos 				    {
   4577   1.7  christos 				      struct plt_entry *ent = NULL;
   4578   1.7  christos 				      bfd_vma addend = 0;
   4579   1.7  christos 
   4580   1.7  christos 				      if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   4581   1.1  christos 					addend = rel->r_addend;
   4582   1.1  christos 				      ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist,
   4583   1.1  christos 							  got2, addend);
   4584   1.1  christos 				      if (ent != NULL
   4585   1.1  christos 					  && ent->plt.refcount > 0)
   4586  1.10  christos 					ent->plt.refcount -= 1;
   4587  1.10  christos 				    }
   4588  1.10  christos 				}
   4589  1.10  christos 			    }
   4590  1.10  christos 			  continue;
   4591  1.10  christos 			}
   4592  1.10  christos 		      expecting_tls_get_addr = 2;
   4593  1.10  christos 		      tls_set = 0;
   4594  1.10  christos 		      tls_clear = 0;
   4595  1.10  christos 		      break;
   4596  1.10  christos 
   4597  1.10  christos 		    case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
   4598  1.10  christos 		      if (pass == 0)
   4599  1.10  christos 			{
   4600  1.10  christos 			  unsigned char buf[4];
   4601  1.10  christos 			  unsigned int insn;
   4602  1.10  christos 			  bfd_vma off = rel->r_offset & ~3;
   4603  1.10  christos 			  if (!bfd_get_section_contents (ibfd, sec, buf,
   4604  1.10  christos 							 off, 4))
   4605  1.10  christos 			    {
   4606  1.10  christos 			      if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
   4607  1.10  christos 				free (relstart);
   4608  1.10  christos 			      return false;
   4609  1.10  christos 			    }
   4610  1.10  christos 			  insn = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buf);
   4611  1.10  christos 			  /* addis rt,2,imm */
   4612  1.10  christos 			  if ((insn & ((0x3fu << 26) | 0x1f << 16))
   4613  1.10  christos 			      != ((15u << 26) | (2 << 16)))
   4614  1.10  christos 			    {
   4615  1.10  christos 			      /* xgettext:c-format */
   4616  1.10  christos 			      info->callbacks->minfo
   4617   1.1  christos 				(_("%H: warning: %s unexpected insn %#x.\n"),
   4618   1.1  christos 				 ibfd, sec, off, "R_PPC_TPREL16_HA", insn);
   4619   1.1  christos 			      htab->do_tls_opt = 0;
   4620   1.1  christos 			    }
   4621   1.1  christos 			}
   4622   1.1  christos 		      continue;
   4623   1.1  christos 
   4624   1.9  christos 		    case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
   4625   1.1  christos 		      htab->do_tls_opt = 0;
   4626   1.1  christos 		      continue;
   4627   1.1  christos 
   4628   1.1  christos 		    default:
   4629   1.1  christos 		      continue;
   4630   1.1  christos 		    }
   4631   1.1  christos 
   4632   1.1  christos 		  if (pass == 0)
   4633   1.1  christos 		    {
   4634   1.1  christos 		      if (!expecting_tls_get_addr
   4635   1.1  christos 			  || !sec->nomark_tls_get_addr)
   4636   1.1  christos 			continue;
   4637   1.1  christos 
   4638   1.1  christos 		      if (rel + 1 < relend
   4639   1.1  christos 			  && branch_reloc_hash_match (ibfd, rel + 1,
   4640   1.1  christos 						      htab->tls_get_addr))
   4641  1.10  christos 			continue;
   4642   1.1  christos 
   4643   1.1  christos 		      /* Uh oh, we didn't find the expected call.  We
   4644   1.1  christos 			 could just mark this symbol to exclude it
   4645   1.1  christos 			 from tls optimization but it's safer to skip
   4646   1.1  christos 			 the entire optimization.  */
   4647   1.1  christos 		      info->callbacks->minfo (_("%H arg lost __tls_get_addr, "
   4648   1.1  christos 						"TLS optimization disabled\n"),
   4649   1.1  christos 					      ibfd, sec, rel->r_offset);
   4650   1.1  christos 		      if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
   4651   1.1  christos 			free (relstart);
   4652   1.1  christos 		      return true;
   4653   1.7  christos 		    }
   4654   1.1  christos 
   4655   1.1  christos 		  if (h != NULL)
   4656   1.1  christos 		    {
   4657   1.1  christos 		      tls_mask = &ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask;
   4658   1.1  christos 		      got_count = &h->got.refcount;
   4659   1.1  christos 		    }
   4660   1.7  christos 		  else
   4661   1.7  christos 		    {
   4662   1.1  christos 		      bfd_signed_vma *lgot_refs;
   4663   1.1  christos 		      struct plt_entry **local_plt;
   4664   1.1  christos 		      unsigned char *lgot_masks;
   4665   1.1  christos 
   4666   1.7  christos 		      lgot_refs = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd);
   4667   1.7  christos 		      if (lgot_refs == NULL)
   4668   1.7  christos 			abort ();
   4669   1.7  christos 		      local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
   4670   1.7  christos 			(lgot_refs + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
   4671   1.7  christos 		      lgot_masks = (unsigned char *)
   4672   1.7  christos 			(local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
   4673   1.7  christos 		      tls_mask = &lgot_masks[r_symndx];
   4674   1.9  christos 		      got_count = &lgot_refs[r_symndx];
   4675   1.7  christos 		    }
   4676   1.7  christos 
   4677   1.7  christos 		  /* If we don't have old-style __tls_get_addr calls
   4678   1.7  christos 		     without TLSGD/TLSLD marker relocs, and we haven't
   4679   1.9  christos 		     found a new-style __tls_get_addr call with a
   4680   1.7  christos 		     marker for this symbol, then we either have a
   4681   1.7  christos 		     broken object file or an -mlongcall style
   4682   1.7  christos 		     indirect call to __tls_get_addr without a marker.
   4683   1.7  christos 		     Disable optimization in this case.  */
   4684   1.7  christos 		  if ((tls_clear & (TLS_GD | TLS_LD)) != 0
   4685   1.7  christos 		      && !sec->nomark_tls_get_addr
   4686   1.7  christos 		      && ((*tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK))
   4687   1.7  christos 			  != (TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK)))
   4688   1.7  christos 		    continue;
   4689   1.7  christos 
   4690   1.7  christos 		  if (expecting_tls_get_addr == 1 + !sec->nomark_tls_get_addr)
   4691   1.7  christos 		    {
   4692   1.7  christos 		      struct plt_entry *ent;
   4693   1.9  christos 		      bfd_vma addend = 0;
   4694   1.9  christos 
   4695   1.7  christos 		      if (bfd_link_pic (info)
   4696   1.1  christos 			  && (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_PPC_PLTREL24
   4697   1.1  christos 			      || ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_PPC_PLTCALL))
   4698   1.1  christos 			addend = rel[1].r_addend;
   4699   1.1  christos 		      ent = find_plt_ent (&htab->tls_get_addr->plt.plist,
   4700   1.1  christos 					  got2, addend);
   4701   1.1  christos 		      if (ent != NULL && ent->plt.refcount > 0)
   4702   1.1  christos 			ent->plt.refcount -= 1;
   4703   1.1  christos 		    }
   4704   1.1  christos 		  if (tls_clear == 0)
   4705   1.1  christos 		    continue;
   4706   1.1  christos 
   4707   1.1  christos 		  if (tls_set == 0)
   4708   1.1  christos 		    {
   4709   1.1  christos 		      /* We managed to get rid of a got entry.  */
   4710   1.1  christos 		      if (*got_count > 0)
   4711  1.10  christos 			*got_count -= 1;
   4712   1.1  christos 		    }
   4713   1.1  christos 
   4714   1.7  christos 		  *tls_mask |= tls_set;
   4715   1.7  christos 		  *tls_mask &= ~tls_clear;
   4716   1.7  christos 		}
   4717   1.7  christos 
   4718  1.10  christos 	      if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
   4719   1.7  christos 		free (relstart);
   4720   1.7  christos 	    }
   4721   1.7  christos       }
   4722   1.7  christos   return true;
   4723   1.7  christos }
   4724  1.10  christos 
   4725  1.10  christos /* Return true if we have dynamic relocs against H or any of its weak
   4727   1.7  christos    aliases, that apply to read-only sections.  Cannot be used after
   4728   1.7  christos    size_dynamic_sections.  */
   4729  1.10  christos 
   4730   1.7  christos static bool
   4731   1.7  christos alias_readonly_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
   4732   1.7  christos {
   4733   1.7  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h);
   4734  1.10  christos   do
   4735   1.7  christos     {
   4736   1.7  christos       if (_bfd_elf_readonly_dynrelocs (&eh->elf))
   4737   1.7  christos 	return true;
   4738   1.7  christos       eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (eh->elf.u.alias);
   4739  1.10  christos     } while (eh != NULL && &eh->elf != h);
   4740   1.7  christos 
   4741  1.10  christos   return false;
   4742  1.10  christos }
   4743   1.1  christos 
   4744   1.1  christos /* Return whether H has pc-relative dynamic relocs.  */
   4745   1.1  christos 
   4746   1.1  christos static bool
   4747   1.1  christos pc_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
   4748   1.1  christos {
   4749   1.1  christos   struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
   4750   1.1  christos 
   4751  1.10  christos   for (p = h->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
   4752   1.1  christos     if (p->pc_count != 0)
   4753   1.1  christos       return true;
   4754   1.1  christos   return false;
   4755   1.1  christos }
   4756   1.1  christos 
   4757   1.1  christos /* Adjust a symbol defined by a dynamic object and referenced by a
   4758   1.1  christos    regular object.  The current definition is in some section of the
   4759   1.1  christos    dynamic object, but we're not including those sections.  We have to
   4760   1.1  christos    change the definition to something the rest of the link can
   4761   1.1  christos    understand.  */
   4762   1.1  christos 
   4763   1.1  christos static bool
   4764   1.1  christos ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
   4765   1.1  christos 			       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
   4766   1.1  christos {
   4767   1.1  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
   4768   1.7  christos   asection *s;
   4769   1.1  christos 
   4770   1.1  christos #ifdef DEBUG
   4771   1.1  christos   fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol called for %s\n",
   4772   1.1  christos 	   h->root.root.string);
   4773   1.1  christos #endif
   4774   1.1  christos 
   4775   1.1  christos   /* Make sure we know what is going on here.  */
   4776   1.1  christos   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   4777   1.1  christos   BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.dynobj != NULL
   4778  1.10  christos 	      && (h->needs_plt
   4779   1.7  christos 		  || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
   4780   1.7  christos 		  || h->is_weakalias
   4781   1.7  christos 		  || (h->def_dynamic
   4782   1.7  christos 		      && h->ref_regular
   4783  1.10  christos 		      && !h->def_regular)));
   4784   1.7  christos 
   4785   1.1  christos   /* Deal with function syms.  */
   4786   1.1  christos   if (h->type == STT_FUNC
   4787   1.1  christos       || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
   4788   1.1  christos       || h->needs_plt)
   4789   1.1  christos     {
   4790   1.1  christos       bool local = (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
   4791   1.1  christos 			   || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h));
   4792   1.1  christos       /* Discard dyn_relocs when non-pic if we've decided that a
   4793   1.7  christos 	 function symbol is local.  */
   4794   1.7  christos       if (!bfd_link_pic (info) && local)
   4795   1.7  christos 	h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
   4796   1.7  christos 
   4797   1.1  christos       /* Clear procedure linkage table information for any symbol that
   4798   1.1  christos 	 won't need a .plt entry.  */
   4799   1.1  christos       struct plt_entry *ent;
   4800   1.1  christos       for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
   4801   1.1  christos 	if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
   4802   1.1  christos 	  break;
   4803   1.1  christos       if (ent == NULL
   4804   1.1  christos 	  || (h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC
   4805   1.1  christos 	      && local
   4806   1.1  christos 	      && (htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
   4807   1.1  christos 		  || (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask
   4808   1.1  christos 		      & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) != PLT_KEEP)))
   4809   1.1  christos 	{
   4810   1.3  christos 	  /* A PLT entry is not required/allowed when:
   4811   1.1  christos 
   4812   1.1  christos 	     1. We are not using ld.so; because then the PLT entry
   4813   1.1  christos 	     can't be set up, so we can't use one.  In this case,
   4814   1.3  christos 	     ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol won't even be called.
   4815   1.3  christos 
   4816   1.3  christos 	     2. GC has rendered the entry unused.
   4817   1.7  christos 
   4818   1.7  christos 	     3. We know for certain that a call to this symbol
   4819   1.7  christos 	     will go to this object, or will remain undefined.  */
   4820   1.7  christos 	  h->plt.plist = NULL;
   4821   1.7  christos 	  h->needs_plt = 0;
   4822   1.7  christos 	  h->pointer_equality_needed = 0;
   4823   1.7  christos 	}
   4824   1.7  christos       else
   4825   1.7  christos 	{
   4826   1.7  christos 	  /* Taking a function's address in a read/write section
   4827  1.10  christos 	     doesn't require us to define the function symbol in the
   4828   1.3  christos 	     executable on a plt call stub.  A dynamic reloc can
   4829  1.10  christos 	     be used instead, giving better runtime performance.
   4830   1.3  christos 	     (Calls via that function pointer don't need to bounce
   4831   1.3  christos 	     through the plt call stub.)  Similarly, use a dynamic
   4832   1.7  christos 	     reloc for a weak reference when possible, allowing the
   4833   1.7  christos 	     resolution of the symbol to be set at load time rather
   4834   1.7  christos 	     than link time.  */
   4835   1.7  christos 	  if ((h->pointer_equality_needed
   4836   1.7  christos 	       || (h->non_got_ref
   4837   1.7  christos 		   && !h->ref_regular_nonweak
   4838   1.7  christos 		   && !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h)))
   4839   1.7  christos 	      && htab->elf.target_os != is_vxworks
   4840  1.10  christos 	      && !ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs
   4841   1.1  christos 	      && !_bfd_elf_readonly_dynrelocs (h))
   4842   1.3  christos 	    {
   4843   1.7  christos 	      h->pointer_equality_needed = 0;
   4844  1.10  christos 	      /* If we haven't seen a branch reloc and the symbol
   4845   1.1  christos 		 isn't an ifunc then we don't need a plt entry.  */
   4846   1.1  christos 	      if (!h->needs_plt && h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC)
   4847   1.1  christos 		h->plt.plist = NULL;
   4848   1.1  christos 	    }
   4849   1.1  christos 	  else if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
   4850   1.1  christos 	    /* We are going to be defining the function symbol on the
   4851   1.1  christos 	       plt stub, so no dyn_relocs needed when non-pic.  */
   4852   1.7  christos 	    h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
   4853   1.1  christos 	}
   4854   1.7  christos       h->protected_def = 0;
   4855   1.7  christos       /* Function symbols can't have copy relocs.  */
   4856   1.7  christos       return true;
   4857   1.7  christos     }
   4858   1.7  christos   else
   4859   1.7  christos     h->plt.plist = NULL;
   4860   1.7  christos 
   4861  1.10  christos   /* If this is a weak symbol, and there is a real definition, the
   4862  1.10  christos      processor independent code will have arranged for us to see the
   4863   1.1  christos      real definition first, and we can just use the same value.  */
   4864   1.1  christos   if (h->is_weakalias)
   4865   1.1  christos     {
   4866   1.1  christos       struct elf_link_hash_entry *def = weakdef (h);
   4867   1.1  christos       BFD_ASSERT (def->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined);
   4868   1.1  christos       h->root.u.def.section = def->root.u.def.section;
   4869   1.1  christos       h->root.u.def.value = def->root.u.def.value;
   4870   1.1  christos       if (def->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynbss
   4871   1.1  christos 	  || def->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynrelro
   4872   1.3  christos 	  || def->root.u.def.section == htab->dynsbss)
   4873   1.3  christos 	h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
   4874   1.3  christos       return true;
   4875  1.10  christos     }
   4876   1.3  christos 
   4877   1.1  christos   /* This is a reference to a symbol defined by a dynamic object which
   4878   1.1  christos      is not a function.  */
   4879   1.1  christos 
   4880   1.1  christos   /* If we are creating a shared library, we must presume that the
   4881   1.3  christos      only references to the symbol are via the global offset table.
   4882   1.3  christos      For such cases we need not do anything here; the relocations will
   4883  1.10  christos      be handled correctly by relocate_section.  */
   4884   1.3  christos   if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   4885   1.3  christos     {
   4886   1.3  christos       h->protected_def = 0;
   4887   1.3  christos       return true;
   4888   1.3  christos     }
   4889   1.3  christos 
   4890   1.3  christos   /* If there are no references to this symbol that do not use the
   4891   1.3  christos      GOT, we don't need to generate a copy reloc.  */
   4892   1.3  christos   if (!h->non_got_ref)
   4893   1.3  christos     {
   4894   1.3  christos       h->protected_def = 0;
   4895   1.3  christos       return true;
   4896   1.3  christos     }
   4897   1.3  christos 
   4898  1.10  christos   /* Protected variables do not work with .dynbss.  The copy in
   4899   1.3  christos      .dynbss won't be used by the shared library with the protected
   4900   1.3  christos      definition for the variable.  Editing to PIC, or text relocations
   4901   1.3  christos      are preferable to an incorrect program.  */
   4902   1.3  christos   if (h->protected_def)
   4903  1.10  christos     {
   4904   1.1  christos       if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
   4905   1.7  christos 	  && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha
   4906   1.1  christos 	  && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo
   4907   1.1  christos 	  && htab->params->pic_fixup == 0
   4908   1.1  christos 	  && info->disable_target_specific_optimizations <= 1)
   4909   1.1  christos 	htab->params->pic_fixup = 1;
   4910   1.1  christos       return true;
   4911   1.1  christos     }
   4912   1.1  christos 
   4913  1.10  christos   /* If -z nocopyreloc was given, we won't generate them either.  */
   4914   1.1  christos   if (info->nocopyreloc)
   4915   1.7  christos     return true;
   4916  1.10  christos 
   4917   1.1  christos    /* If we don't find any dynamic relocs in read-only sections, then
   4918   1.1  christos       we'll be keeping the dynamic relocs and avoiding the copy reloc.
   4919   1.1  christos       We can't do this if there are any small data relocations.  This
   4920   1.1  christos       doesn't work on VxWorks, where we can not have dynamic
   4921   1.1  christos       relocations (other than copy and jump slot relocations) in an
   4922   1.1  christos       executable.  */
   4923   1.1  christos   if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
   4924   1.1  christos       && !ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs
   4925   1.1  christos       && htab->elf.target_os != is_vxworks
   4926   1.1  christos       && !h->def_regular
   4927   1.1  christos       && !alias_readonly_dynrelocs (h))
   4928   1.1  christos     return true;
   4929   1.1  christos 
   4930   1.1  christos   /* We must allocate the symbol in our .dynbss section, which will
   4931   1.1  christos      become part of the .bss section of the executable.  There will be
   4932   1.7  christos      an entry for this symbol in the .dynsym section.  The dynamic
   4933   1.7  christos      object will contain position independent code, so all references
   4934   1.1  christos      from the dynamic object to this symbol will go through the global
   4935   1.7  christos      offset table.  The dynamic linker will use the .dynsym entry to
   4936   1.1  christos      determine the address it must put in the global offset table, so
   4937   1.1  christos      both the dynamic object and the regular object will refer to the
   4938   1.1  christos      same memory location for the variable.
   4939   1.1  christos 
   4940   1.1  christos      Of course, if the symbol is referenced using SDAREL relocs, we
   4941   1.1  christos      must instead allocate it in .sbss.  */
   4942   1.7  christos   if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs)
   4943   1.7  christos     s = htab->dynsbss;
   4944   1.7  christos   else if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
   4945   1.1  christos     s = htab->elf.sdynrelro;
   4946   1.1  christos   else
   4947   1.7  christos     s = htab->elf.sdynbss;
   4948   1.7  christos   BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
   4949   1.1  christos 
   4950   1.7  christos   if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0 && h->size != 0)
   4951   1.1  christos     {
   4952   1.1  christos       asection *srel;
   4953   1.1  christos 
   4954   1.1  christos       /* We must generate a R_PPC_COPY reloc to tell the dynamic
   4955   1.1  christos 	 linker to copy the initial value out of the dynamic object
   4956   1.7  christos 	 and into the runtime process image.  */
   4957  1.10  christos       if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs)
   4958   1.3  christos 	srel = htab->relsbss;
   4959   1.1  christos       else if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
   4960   1.1  christos 	srel = htab->elf.sreldynrelro;
   4961   1.1  christos       else
   4962   1.1  christos 	srel = htab->elf.srelbss;
   4963   1.1  christos       BFD_ASSERT (srel != NULL);
   4964   1.1  christos       srel->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   4965   1.1  christos       h->needs_copy = 1;
   4966   1.1  christos     }
   4967  1.10  christos 
   4968   1.1  christos   /* We no longer want dyn_relocs.  */
   4969   1.1  christos   h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
   4970   1.1  christos   return _bfd_elf_adjust_dynamic_copy (info, h, s);
   4971   1.1  christos }
   4972   1.1  christos 
   4973   1.1  christos /* Generate a symbol to mark plt call stubs.  For non-PIC code the sym is
   4975   1.1  christos    xxxxxxxx.plt_call32.<callee> where xxxxxxxx is a hex number, usually 0,
   4976   1.1  christos    specifying the addend on the plt relocation.  For -fpic code, the sym
   4977   1.1  christos    is xxxxxxxx.plt_pic32.<callee>, and for -fPIC
   4978   1.3  christos    xxxxxxxx.got2.plt_pic32.<callee>.  */
   4979   1.1  christos 
   4980   1.1  christos static bool
   4981   1.1  christos add_stub_sym (struct plt_entry *ent,
   4982   1.1  christos 	      struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
   4983   1.1  christos 	      struct bfd_link_info *info)
   4984   1.1  christos {
   4985   1.1  christos   struct elf_link_hash_entry *sh;
   4986   1.1  christos   size_t len1, len2, len3;
   4987   1.1  christos   char *name;
   4988  1.12  christos   const char *stub;
   4989   1.1  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   4990  1.10  christos 
   4991   1.1  christos   if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   4992   1.1  christos     stub = ".plt_pic32.";
   4993   1.1  christos   else
   4994   1.1  christos     stub = ".plt_call32.";
   4995   1.1  christos 
   4996  1.10  christos   len1 = strlen (h->root.root.string);
   4997   1.1  christos   len2 = strlen (stub);
   4998  1.10  christos   len3 = 0;
   4999   1.1  christos   if (ent->sec)
   5000   1.1  christos     len3 = strlen (ent->sec->name);
   5001   1.1  christos   name = bfd_alloc (info->output_bfd, len1 + len2 + len3 + 9);
   5002   1.1  christos   if (name == NULL)
   5003   1.1  christos     return false;
   5004   1.1  christos   sprintf (name, "%08x", (unsigned) ent->addend & 0xffffffff);
   5005   1.1  christos   if (ent->sec)
   5006   1.1  christos     memcpy (name + 8, ent->sec->name, len3);
   5007   1.1  christos   memcpy (name + 8 + len3, stub, len2);
   5008   1.1  christos   memcpy (name + 8 + len3 + len2, h->root.root.string, len1 + 1);
   5009   1.3  christos   sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, name, true, false, false);
   5010   1.1  christos   if (sh == NULL)
   5011  1.10  christos     return false;
   5012   1.1  christos   if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
   5013   1.1  christos     {
   5014   1.1  christos       sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
   5015   1.1  christos       sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
   5016   1.1  christos       sh->root.u.def.value = ent->glink_offset;
   5017   1.1  christos       sh->ref_regular = 1;
   5018   1.1  christos       sh->def_regular = 1;
   5019   1.1  christos       sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
   5020   1.1  christos       sh->forced_local = 1;
   5021   1.1  christos       sh->non_elf = 0;
   5022   1.1  christos       sh->root.linker_def = 1;
   5023   1.1  christos     }
   5024   1.1  christos   return true;
   5025   1.7  christos }
   5026   1.7  christos 
   5027   1.1  christos /* Allocate NEED contiguous space in .got, and return the offset.
   5028   1.1  christos    Handles allocation of the got header when crossing 32k.  */
   5029   1.1  christos 
   5030   1.1  christos static bfd_vma
   5031   1.1  christos allocate_got (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab, unsigned int need)
   5032   1.1  christos {
   5033   1.1  christos   bfd_vma where;
   5034   1.1  christos   unsigned int max_before_header;
   5035   1.1  christos 
   5036   1.1  christos   if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS)
   5037   1.1  christos     {
   5038   1.7  christos       where = htab->elf.sgot->size;
   5039   1.7  christos       htab->elf.sgot->size += need;
   5040   1.1  christos     }
   5041   1.7  christos   else
   5042   1.7  christos     {
   5043   1.1  christos       max_before_header = htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW ? 32768 : 32764;
   5044   1.7  christos       if (need <= htab->got_gap)
   5045   1.7  christos 	{
   5046   1.1  christos 	  where = max_before_header - htab->got_gap;
   5047   1.1  christos 	  htab->got_gap -= need;
   5048   1.1  christos 	}
   5049   1.1  christos       else
   5050   1.1  christos 	{
   5051   1.7  christos 	  if (htab->elf.sgot->size + need > max_before_header
   5052   1.7  christos 	      && htab->elf.sgot->size <= max_before_header)
   5053   1.7  christos 	    {
   5054   1.7  christos 	      htab->got_gap = max_before_header - htab->elf.sgot->size;
   5055   1.7  christos 	      htab->elf.sgot->size = max_before_header + htab->got_header_size;
   5056   1.7  christos 	    }
   5057   1.7  christos 	  where = htab->elf.sgot->size;
   5058   1.7  christos 	  htab->elf.sgot->size += need;
   5059   1.7  christos 	}
   5060   1.7  christos     }
   5061   1.7  christos   return where;
   5062   1.7  christos }
   5063   1.7  christos 
   5064   1.7  christos /* Calculate size of GOT entries for symbol given its TLS_MASK.
   5065   1.9  christos    TLS_LD is excluded because those go in a special GOT slot.  */
   5066   1.7  christos 
   5067   1.7  christos static inline unsigned int
   5068   1.7  christos got_entries_needed (int tls_mask)
   5069   1.7  christos {
   5070   1.7  christos   unsigned int need;
   5071   1.7  christos   if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) == 0)
   5072   1.7  christos     need = 4;
   5073   1.7  christos   else
   5074   1.7  christos     {
   5075  1.10  christos       need = 0;
   5076   1.7  christos       if ((tls_mask & TLS_GD) != 0)
   5077   1.7  christos 	need += 8;
   5078   1.7  christos       if ((tls_mask & (TLS_TPREL | TLS_GDIE)) != 0)
   5079   1.7  christos 	need += 4;
   5080   1.7  christos       if ((tls_mask & TLS_DTPREL) != 0)
   5081   1.7  christos 	need += 4;
   5082   1.7  christos     }
   5083   1.7  christos   return need;
   5084   1.7  christos }
   5085   1.7  christos 
   5086   1.7  christos /* If H is undefined, make it dynamic if that makes sense.  */
   5087   1.7  christos 
   5088   1.7  christos static bool
   5089  1.10  christos ensure_undef_dynamic (struct bfd_link_info *info,
   5090  1.10  christos 		      struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
   5091  1.10  christos {
   5092  1.10  christos   struct elf_link_hash_table *htab = elf_hash_table (info);
   5093  1.10  christos 
   5094  1.10  christos   if (htab->dynamic_sections_created
   5095  1.10  christos       && ((info->dynamic_undefined_weak != 0
   5096  1.10  christos 	   && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
   5097  1.10  christos 	  || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined)
   5098  1.10  christos       && h->dynindx == -1
   5099  1.10  christos       && !h->forced_local
   5100  1.10  christos       && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) == STV_DEFAULT)
   5101  1.10  christos     return bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h);
   5102   1.7  christos   return true;
   5103   1.7  christos }
   5104   1.1  christos 
   5105   1.1  christos /* Choose whether to use htab->iplt or htab->pltlocal rather than the
   5106  1.10  christos    usual htab->elf.splt section for a PLT entry.  */
   5107   1.1  christos 
   5108   1.1  christos static inline
   5109   1.1  christos bool use_local_plt (struct bfd_link_info *info,
   5110   1.1  christos 			   struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
   5111   1.1  christos {
   5112   1.1  christos   return (h == NULL
   5113   1.1  christos 	  || h->dynindx == -1
   5114   1.1  christos 	  || !elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created);
   5115  1.10  christos }
   5116   1.1  christos 
   5117   1.1  christos /* Allocate space in associated reloc sections for dynamic relocs.  */
   5118   1.1  christos 
   5119   1.3  christos static bool
   5120   1.3  christos allocate_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
   5121   1.3  christos {
   5122   1.3  christos   struct bfd_link_info *info = inf;
   5123   1.3  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh;
   5124   1.3  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
   5125   1.3  christos   struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
   5126   1.1  christos 
   5127   1.1  christos   if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
   5128   1.7  christos     return true;
   5129  1.10  christos 
   5130   1.1  christos   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   5131  1.11  christos   eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
   5132  1.11  christos   if (eh->elf.got.refcount > 0
   5133   1.7  christos       || (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
   5134   1.1  christos 	  && !eh->elf.def_regular
   5135   1.9  christos 	  && eh->elf.protected_def
   5136   1.7  christos 	  && eh->has_addr16_ha
   5137   1.7  christos 	  && eh->has_addr16_lo
   5138   1.7  christos 	  && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0))
   5139   1.7  christos     {
   5140   1.7  christos       /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol.  */
   5141  1.11  christos       if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, &eh->elf))
   5142  1.11  christos 	return false;
   5143  1.11  christos 
   5144  1.11  christos       unsigned int need = got_entries_needed (eh->tls_mask);
   5145   1.1  christos       unsigned int rel_need = need * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) / 4;
   5146   1.1  christos       if ((eh->tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
   5147   1.1  christos 	{
   5148   1.1  christos 	  if (SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &eh->elf))
   5149   1.1  christos 	    /* We'll just use htab->tlsld_got.offset.  This should
   5150   1.1  christos 	       always be the case.  It's a little odd if we have
   5151   1.9  christos 	       a local dynamic reloc against a non-local symbol.  */
   5152   1.9  christos 	    htab->tlsld_got.refcount += 1;
   5153   1.9  christos 	  else
   5154  1.10  christos 	    {
   5155  1.10  christos 	      need += 8;
   5156   1.7  christos 	      rel_need += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   5157   1.7  christos 	    }
   5158   1.7  christos 	}
   5159   1.7  christos       if (need == 0)
   5160   1.7  christos 	eh->elf.got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
   5161   1.7  christos       else
   5162   1.9  christos 	{
   5163   1.7  christos 	  eh->elf.got.offset = allocate_got (htab, need);
   5164   1.3  christos 	  if (((bfd_link_pic (info)
   5165   1.7  christos 		&& !((eh->tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
   5166  1.11  christos 		     && bfd_link_executable (info)
   5167   1.1  christos 		     && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &eh->elf))
   5168   1.1  christos 		&& !bfd_is_abs_symbol (&h->root))
   5169   1.1  christos 	       || (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
   5170   1.1  christos 		   && eh->elf.dynindx != -1
   5171   1.1  christos 		   && !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &eh->elf)))
   5172   1.1  christos 	      && !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, &eh->elf))
   5173   1.7  christos 	    {
   5174   1.7  christos 	      asection *rsec;
   5175   1.7  christos 
   5176   1.7  christos 	      rsec = htab->elf.srelgot;
   5177  1.10  christos 	      if (eh->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
   5178   1.7  christos 		rsec = htab->elf.irelplt;
   5179   1.7  christos 	      rsec->size += rel_need;
   5180   1.7  christos 	    }
   5181   1.7  christos 	}
   5182  1.10  christos     }
   5183   1.7  christos   else
   5184   1.7  christos     eh->elf.got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
   5185   1.7  christos 
   5186   1.7  christos   /* If no dynamic sections we can't have dynamic relocs, except for
   5187  1.10  christos      IFUNCs which are handled even in static executables.  */
   5188   1.7  christos   if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
   5189  1.10  christos       && h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC)
   5190   1.7  christos     h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
   5191   1.1  christos 
   5192   1.1  christos   /* Discard relocs on undefined symbols that must be local.  */
   5193   1.1  christos   else if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
   5194   1.1  christos 	   && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) != STV_DEFAULT)
   5195   1.1  christos     h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
   5196   1.1  christos 
   5197   1.7  christos   /* Also discard relocs on undefined weak syms with non-default
   5198   1.1  christos      visibility, or when dynamic_undefined_weak says so.  */
   5199   1.1  christos   else if (UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
   5200   1.1  christos     h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
   5201   1.1  christos 
   5202   1.1  christos   if (h->dyn_relocs == NULL)
   5203   1.1  christos     ;
   5204   1.1  christos 
   5205   1.1  christos   /* In the shared -Bsymbolic case, discard space allocated for
   5206   1.1  christos      dynamic pc-relative relocs against symbols which turn out to be
   5207   1.1  christos      defined in regular objects.  For the normal shared case, discard
   5208   1.1  christos      space for relocs that have become local due to symbol visibility
   5209  1.10  christos      changes.  */
   5210   1.1  christos   else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   5211   1.1  christos     {
   5212   1.1  christos       /* Relocs that use pc_count are those that appear on a call insn,
   5213   1.1  christos 	 or certain REL relocs (see must_be_dyn_reloc) that can be
   5214   1.7  christos 	 generated via assembly.  We want calls to protected symbols to
   5215   1.7  christos 	 resolve directly to the function rather than going via the plt.
   5216   1.7  christos 	 If people want function pointer comparisons to work as expected
   5217   1.7  christos 	 then they should avoid writing weird assembly.  */
   5218   1.7  christos       if (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h))
   5219   1.7  christos 	{
   5220  1.10  christos 	  struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
   5221   1.7  christos 
   5222   1.7  christos 	  for (pp = &h->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
   5223   1.7  christos 	    {
   5224  1.10  christos 	      p->count -= p->pc_count;
   5225   1.7  christos 	      p->pc_count = 0;
   5226   1.7  christos 	      if (p->count == 0)
   5227   1.7  christos 		*pp = p->next;
   5228   1.7  christos 	      else
   5229   1.7  christos 		pp = &p->next;
   5230   1.7  christos 	    }
   5231   1.7  christos 	}
   5232   1.7  christos 
   5233  1.10  christos       if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks)
   5234   1.7  christos 	{
   5235   1.7  christos 	  struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
   5236   1.7  christos 
   5237  1.10  christos 	  for (pp = &h->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
   5238   1.7  christos 	    {
   5239   1.7  christos 	      if (strcmp (p->sec->output_section->name, ".tls_vars") == 0)
   5240   1.7  christos 		*pp = p->next;
   5241   1.7  christos 	      else
   5242   1.7  christos 		pp = &p->next;
   5243   1.7  christos 	    }
   5244   1.7  christos 	}
   5245  1.10  christos 
   5246  1.10  christos       if (h->dyn_relocs != NULL)
   5247  1.10  christos 	{
   5248  1.10  christos 	  /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol.  */
   5249  1.10  christos 	  if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h))
   5250   1.7  christos 	    return false;
   5251   1.7  christos 	}
   5252   1.7  christos     }
   5253   1.7  christos   else if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS)
   5254   1.7  christos     {
   5255   1.7  christos       /* For the non-pic case, discard space for relocs against
   5256   1.7  christos 	 symbols which turn out to need copy relocs or are not
   5257   1.7  christos 	 dynamic.  */
   5258   1.7  christos       if ((h->dynamic_adjusted
   5259  1.10  christos 	   || (h->ref_regular
   5260   1.7  christos 	       && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
   5261   1.7  christos 	       && (info->dynamic_undefined_weak > 0
   5262  1.10  christos 		   || !_bfd_elf_readonly_dynrelocs (h))))
   5263   1.7  christos 	  && !h->def_regular
   5264   1.7  christos 	  && !ELF_COMMON_DEF_P (h)
   5265  1.10  christos 	  && !(h->protected_def
   5266   1.7  christos 	       && eh->has_addr16_ha
   5267   1.7  christos 	       && eh->has_addr16_lo
   5268   1.7  christos 	       && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0))
   5269  1.10  christos 	{
   5270  1.11  christos 	  /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol.  */
   5271  1.11  christos 	  if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h))
   5272  1.11  christos 	    return false;
   5273  1.11  christos 
   5274  1.11  christos 	  if (h->dynindx == -1)
   5275  1.11  christos 	    h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
   5276  1.11  christos 	}
   5277   1.7  christos       else
   5278   1.7  christos 	h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
   5279   1.7  christos     }
   5280   1.7  christos 
   5281   1.7  christos   /* Allocate space.  */
   5282   1.7  christos   for (p = h->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
   5283   1.7  christos     if (!discarded_section (p->sec))
   5284  1.10  christos       {
   5285   1.7  christos 	asection *sreloc = elf_section_data (p->sec)->sreloc;
   5286   1.7  christos 	if (eh->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
   5287   1.7  christos 	  sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
   5288   1.7  christos 	sreloc->size += p->count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   5289   1.7  christos       }
   5290   1.7  christos 
   5291   1.7  christos   /* Handle PLT relocs.  Done last, after dynindx has settled.
   5292   1.7  christos      We might need a PLT entry when the symbol
   5293   1.7  christos      a) is dynamic, or
   5294   1.7  christos      b) is an ifunc, or
   5295  1.10  christos      c) has plt16 relocs and has been processed by adjust_dynamic_symbol, or
   5296   1.7  christos      d) has plt16 relocs and we are linking statically.  */
   5297   1.7  christos   if ((htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created && h->dynindx != -1)
   5298   1.7  christos       || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
   5299   1.7  christos       || (h->needs_plt && h->dynamic_adjusted)
   5300   1.7  christos       || (h->needs_plt
   5301  1.10  christos 	  && h->def_regular
   5302  1.10  christos 	  && !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
   5303  1.10  christos 	  && !htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
   5304  1.10  christos 	  && (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask
   5305  1.10  christos 	      & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) == PLT_KEEP))
   5306   1.7  christos     {
   5307  1.10  christos       struct plt_entry *ent;
   5308  1.10  christos       bool doneone = false;
   5309   1.7  christos       bfd_vma plt_offset = 0, glink_offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
   5310   1.7  christos 
   5311   1.7  christos       for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
   5312   1.7  christos 	if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
   5313   1.7  christos 	  {
   5314   1.7  christos 	    asection *s;
   5315   1.7  christos 	    bool dyn;
   5316   1.7  christos 
   5317   1.7  christos 	    if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h))
   5318   1.7  christos 	      return false;
   5319   1.7  christos 
   5320   1.7  christos 	    dyn = !use_local_plt (info, h);
   5321   1.7  christos 	    s = htab->elf.splt;
   5322   1.7  christos 	    if (!dyn)
   5323   1.7  christos 	      {
   5324   1.7  christos 		if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
   5325   1.7  christos 		  s = htab->elf.iplt;
   5326   1.7  christos 		else
   5327   1.7  christos 		  s = htab->pltlocal;
   5328   1.7  christos 	      }
   5329   1.7  christos 
   5330   1.7  christos 	    if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW || !dyn)
   5331   1.7  christos 	      {
   5332   1.7  christos 		if (!doneone)
   5333   1.7  christos 		  {
   5334   1.7  christos 		    plt_offset = s->size;
   5335   1.7  christos 		    s->size += 4;
   5336   1.7  christos 		  }
   5337   1.7  christos 		ent->plt.offset = plt_offset;
   5338   1.7  christos 
   5339   1.7  christos 		if (s == htab->pltlocal)
   5340   1.7  christos 		  ent->glink_offset = glink_offset;
   5341   1.7  christos 		else
   5342   1.7  christos 		  {
   5343   1.7  christos 		    s = htab->glink;
   5344   1.7  christos 		    if (!doneone || bfd_link_pic (info))
   5345   1.7  christos 		      {
   5346   1.7  christos 			glink_offset = s->size;
   5347   1.7  christos 			s->size += GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, h);
   5348  1.10  christos 		      }
   5349   1.7  christos 		    if (!doneone
   5350   1.7  christos 			&& !bfd_link_pic (info)
   5351   1.7  christos 			&& h->def_dynamic
   5352   1.7  christos 			&& !h->def_regular)
   5353   1.7  christos 		      {
   5354   1.7  christos 			h->root.u.def.section = s;
   5355   1.7  christos 			h->root.u.def.value = glink_offset;
   5356   1.7  christos 		      }
   5357   1.7  christos 		    ent->glink_offset = glink_offset;
   5358   1.7  christos 
   5359   1.7  christos 		    if (htab->params->emit_stub_syms
   5360   1.7  christos 			&& !add_stub_sym (ent, h, info))
   5361   1.7  christos 		      return false;
   5362   1.7  christos 		  }
   5363   1.7  christos 	      }
   5364   1.7  christos 	    else
   5365   1.7  christos 	      {
   5366   1.7  christos 		if (!doneone)
   5367   1.7  christos 		  {
   5368   1.7  christos 		    /* If this is the first .plt entry, make room
   5369   1.7  christos 		       for the special first entry.  */
   5370   1.7  christos 		    if (s->size == 0)
   5371   1.7  christos 		      s->size += htab->plt_initial_entry_size;
   5372   1.7  christos 
   5373   1.7  christos 		    /* The PowerPC PLT is actually composed of two
   5374   1.7  christos 		       parts, the first part is 2 words (for a load
   5375   1.7  christos 		       and a jump), and then there is a remaining
   5376   1.7  christos 		       word available at the end.  */
   5377   1.7  christos 		    plt_offset = (htab->plt_initial_entry_size
   5378   1.7  christos 				  + (htab->plt_slot_size
   5379   1.7  christos 				     * ((s->size
   5380   1.7  christos 					 - htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
   5381   1.7  christos 					/ htab->plt_entry_size)));
   5382   1.7  christos 
   5383   1.7  christos 		    /* If this symbol is not defined in a regular
   5384   1.1  christos 		       file, and we are not generating a shared
   5385   1.7  christos 		       library, then set the symbol to this location
   5386   1.7  christos 		       in the .plt.  This is to avoid text
   5387   1.7  christos 		       relocations, and is required to make
   5388   1.7  christos 		       function pointers compare as equal between
   5389   1.7  christos 		       the normal executable and the shared library.  */
   5390   1.7  christos 		    if (! bfd_link_pic (info)
   5391   1.7  christos 			&& h->def_dynamic
   5392   1.7  christos 			&& !h->def_regular)
   5393   1.7  christos 		      {
   5394   1.7  christos 			h->root.u.def.section = s;
   5395   1.7  christos 			h->root.u.def.value = plt_offset;
   5396   1.7  christos 		      }
   5397   1.1  christos 
   5398   1.7  christos 		    /* Make room for this entry.  */
   5399   1.7  christos 		    s->size += htab->plt_entry_size;
   5400   1.7  christos 		    /* After the 8192nd entry, room for two entries
   5401   1.7  christos 		       is allocated.  */
   5402   1.7  christos 		    if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD
   5403   1.7  christos 			&& (s->size - htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
   5404   1.7  christos 			/ htab->plt_entry_size
   5405   1.7  christos 			> PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES)
   5406   1.7  christos 		      s->size += htab->plt_entry_size;
   5407   1.7  christos 		  }
   5408   1.7  christos 		ent->plt.offset = plt_offset;
   5409   1.7  christos 	      }
   5410   1.7  christos 
   5411   1.7  christos 	    /* We also need to make an entry in the .rela.plt section.  */
   5412   1.7  christos 	    if (!doneone)
   5413   1.7  christos 	      {
   5414   1.7  christos 		if (!dyn)
   5415   1.7  christos 		  {
   5416   1.7  christos 		    if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
   5417   1.1  christos 		      {
   5418   1.7  christos 			s = htab->elf.irelplt;
   5419   1.7  christos 			s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   5420   1.7  christos 		      }
   5421   1.7  christos 		    else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   5422   1.7  christos 		      {
   5423   1.7  christos 			s = htab->relpltlocal;
   5424   1.7  christos 			s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   5425   1.7  christos 		      }
   5426   1.7  christos 		  }
   5427   1.7  christos 		else
   5428   1.7  christos 		  {
   5429   1.7  christos 		    htab->elf.srelplt->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   5430   1.7  christos 
   5431   1.1  christos 		    if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS)
   5432   1.7  christos 		      {
   5433   1.7  christos 			/* Allocate space for the unloaded relocations.  */
   5434   1.7  christos 			if (!bfd_link_pic (info)
   5435   1.7  christos 			    && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
   5436   1.1  christos 			  {
   5437   1.7  christos 			    if (ent->plt.offset
   5438   1.7  christos 				== (bfd_vma) htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
   5439   1.7  christos 			      {
   5440   1.7  christos 				htab->srelplt2->size
   5441   1.7  christos 				  += (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)
   5442  1.10  christos 				      * VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS);
   5443   1.7  christos 			      }
   5444   1.7  christos 
   5445   1.7  christos 			    htab->srelplt2->size
   5446   1.7  christos 			      += (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)
   5447   1.1  christos 				  * VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS);
   5448   1.7  christos 			  }
   5449   1.1  christos 
   5450   1.7  christos 			/* Every PLT entry has an associated GOT entry in
   5451   1.7  christos 			   .got.plt.  */
   5452   1.1  christos 			htab->elf.sgotplt->size += 4;
   5453   1.1  christos 		      }
   5454   1.7  christos 		  }
   5455   1.1  christos 		doneone = true;
   5456   1.7  christos 	      }
   5457   1.7  christos 	  }
   5458   1.1  christos 	else
   5459   1.1  christos 	  ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
   5460  1.10  christos 
   5461   1.1  christos       if (!doneone)
   5462   1.1  christos 	{
   5463   1.1  christos 	  h->plt.plist = NULL;
   5464   1.1  christos 	  h->needs_plt = 0;
   5465   1.1  christos 	}
   5466   1.1  christos     }
   5467   1.1  christos   else
   5468   1.1  christos     {
   5469   1.1  christos       h->plt.plist = NULL;
   5470   1.1  christos       h->needs_plt = 0;
   5471   1.1  christos     }
   5472   1.1  christos 
   5473   1.1  christos   return true;
   5474   1.1  christos }
   5475   1.1  christos 
   5476   1.1  christos static const unsigned char glink_eh_frame_cie[] =
   5477   1.1  christos {
   5478   1.1  christos   0, 0, 0, 16,				/* length.  */
   5479  1.10  christos   0, 0, 0, 0,				/* id.  */
   5480  1.12  christos   1,					/* CIE version.  */
   5481  1.12  christos   'z', 'R', 0,				/* Augmentation string.  */
   5482   1.1  christos   4,					/* Code alignment.  */
   5483   1.1  christos   0x7c,					/* Data alignment.  */
   5484   1.1  christos   65,					/* RA reg.  */
   5485  1.10  christos   1,					/* Augmentation size.  */
   5486   1.1  christos   DW_EH_PE_pcrel | DW_EH_PE_sdata4,	/* FDE encoding.  */
   5487   1.1  christos   DW_CFA_def_cfa, 1, 0			/* def_cfa: r1 offset 0.  */
   5488   1.1  christos };
   5489  1.12  christos 
   5490   1.1  christos /* Set the sizes of the dynamic sections.  */
   5491   1.1  christos 
   5492   1.1  christos static bool
   5493  1.12  christos ppc_elf_late_size_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
   5494  1.12  christos 			    struct bfd_link_info *info)
   5495   1.1  christos {
   5496   1.1  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
   5497   1.1  christos   asection *s;
   5498   1.1  christos   bool relocs;
   5499   1.3  christos   bfd *ibfd;
   5500   1.1  christos 
   5501   1.1  christos #ifdef DEBUG
   5502   1.1  christos   fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_late_size_sections called\n");
   5503   1.1  christos #endif
   5504   1.1  christos 
   5505  1.12  christos   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   5506   1.1  christos   if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
   5507   1.1  christos     return true;
   5508   1.1  christos 
   5509   1.1  christos   if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
   5510   1.1  christos     {
   5511   1.1  christos       /* Set the contents of the .interp section to the interpreter.  */
   5512   1.1  christos       if (bfd_link_executable (info) && !info->nointerp)
   5513   1.1  christos 	{
   5514   1.1  christos 	  s = bfd_get_linker_section (htab->elf.dynobj, ".interp");
   5515   1.1  christos 	  BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
   5516   1.3  christos 	  s->size = sizeof ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER;
   5517   1.1  christos 	  s->contents = (unsigned char *) ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER;
   5518   1.1  christos 	  s->alloced = 1;
   5519   1.1  christos 	}
   5520   1.1  christos     }
   5521   1.1  christos 
   5522   1.1  christos   if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
   5523   1.1  christos     htab->got_header_size = 16;
   5524   1.1  christos   else if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
   5525  1.10  christos     htab->got_header_size = 12;
   5526  1.10  christos 
   5527   1.1  christos   /* Set up .got offsets for local syms, and space for local dynamic
   5528   1.1  christos      relocs.  */
   5529   1.1  christos   for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
   5530   1.1  christos     {
   5531   1.1  christos       bfd_signed_vma *local_got;
   5532   1.1  christos       bfd_signed_vma *end_local_got;
   5533   1.3  christos       struct plt_entry **local_plt;
   5534   1.1  christos       struct plt_entry **end_local_plt;
   5535   1.3  christos       char *lgot_masks;
   5536   1.1  christos       bfd_size_type locsymcount;
   5537   1.1  christos       Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
   5538   1.1  christos       Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms;
   5539   1.1  christos       Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
   5540  1.11  christos 
   5541   1.1  christos       if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
   5542   1.1  christos 	continue;
   5543   1.1  christos 
   5544   1.1  christos       for (s = ibfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
   5545   1.1  christos 	{
   5546   1.1  christos 	  struct ppc_dyn_relocs *p;
   5547  1.10  christos 
   5548   1.1  christos 	  for (p = ((struct ppc_dyn_relocs *)
   5549   1.1  christos 		    elf_section_data (s)->local_dynrel);
   5550   1.1  christos 	       p != NULL;
   5551   1.1  christos 	       p = p->next)
   5552   1.1  christos 	    {
   5553   1.1  christos 	      if (discarded_section (p->sec))
   5554   1.1  christos 		{
   5555   1.1  christos 		  /* Input section has been discarded, either because
   5556   1.1  christos 		     it is a copy of a linkonce section or due to
   5557   1.3  christos 		     linker script /DISCARD/, so we'll be discarding
   5558   1.7  christos 		     the relocs too.  */
   5559   1.1  christos 		}
   5560   1.1  christos 	      else if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks
   5561   1.1  christos 		       && strcmp (p->sec->output_section->name,
   5562   1.1  christos 				  ".tls_vars") == 0)
   5563   1.7  christos 		{
   5564   1.7  christos 		  /* Relocations in vxworks .tls_vars sections are
   5565   1.7  christos 		     handled specially by the loader.  */
   5566   1.7  christos 		}
   5567   1.7  christos 	      else if (p->count != 0)
   5568   1.1  christos 		{
   5569   1.1  christos 		  asection *sreloc = elf_section_data (p->sec)->sreloc;
   5570   1.1  christos 		  if (p->ifunc)
   5571   1.1  christos 		    sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
   5572   1.1  christos 		  sreloc->size += p->count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   5573   1.1  christos 		  if ((p->sec->output_section->flags
   5574   1.1  christos 		       & (SEC_READONLY | SEC_ALLOC))
   5575   1.1  christos 		      == (SEC_READONLY | SEC_ALLOC))
   5576   1.1  christos 		    {
   5577   1.1  christos 		      info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
   5578   1.1  christos 		      info->callbacks->minfo (_("%pB: dynamic relocation in read-only section `%pA'\n"),
   5579   1.1  christos 					      p->sec->owner, p->sec);
   5580   1.1  christos 		    }
   5581   1.1  christos 		}
   5582  1.10  christos 	    }
   5583  1.10  christos 	}
   5584  1.10  christos 
   5585  1.10  christos       local_got = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd);
   5586  1.10  christos       if (!local_got)
   5587  1.10  christos 	continue;
   5588  1.10  christos 
   5589  1.10  christos       symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
   5590   1.1  christos       locsymcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
   5591  1.10  christos       end_local_got = local_got + locsymcount;
   5592  1.10  christos       local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) end_local_got;
   5593  1.10  christos       end_local_plt = local_plt + locsymcount;
   5594   1.1  christos       lgot_masks = (char *) end_local_plt;
   5595   1.1  christos       local_syms = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents;
   5596   1.7  christos       if (local_syms == NULL && locsymcount != 0)
   5597   1.7  christos 	{
   5598   1.7  christos 	  local_syms = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (ibfd, symtab_hdr, locsymcount,
   5599   1.7  christos 					     0, NULL, NULL, NULL);
   5600   1.1  christos 	  if (local_syms == NULL)
   5601   1.1  christos 	    return false;
   5602   1.1  christos 	}
   5603   1.1  christos 
   5604   1.1  christos       for (isym = local_syms;
   5605   1.9  christos 	   local_got < end_local_got;
   5606   1.9  christos 	   ++local_got, ++lgot_masks, ++isym)
   5607  1.10  christos 	if (*local_got > 0)
   5608  1.10  christos 	  {
   5609   1.3  christos 	    unsigned int need;
   5610   1.7  christos 	    if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
   5611   1.7  christos 	      htab->tlsld_got.refcount += 1;
   5612   1.9  christos 	    need = got_entries_needed (*lgot_masks);
   5613   1.7  christos 	    if (need == 0)
   5614   1.7  christos 	      *local_got = (bfd_vma) -1;
   5615   1.7  christos 	    else
   5616   1.7  christos 	      {
   5617   1.3  christos 		*local_got = allocate_got (htab, need);
   5618   1.1  christos 		if (bfd_link_pic (info)
   5619   1.1  christos 		    && !((*lgot_masks & TLS_TLS) != 0
   5620   1.1  christos 			 && bfd_link_executable (info))
   5621   1.1  christos 		    && isym->st_shndx != SHN_ABS)
   5622   1.1  christos 		  {
   5623  1.10  christos 		    asection *srel;
   5624   1.1  christos 
   5625   1.1  christos 		    need *= sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) / 4;
   5626   1.1  christos 		    srel = htab->elf.srelgot;
   5627   1.7  christos 		    if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
   5628   1.7  christos 		      srel = htab->elf.irelplt;
   5629   1.1  christos 		    srel->size += need;
   5630   1.1  christos 		  }
   5631  1.10  christos 	      }
   5632   1.7  christos 	  }
   5633   1.1  christos 	else
   5634   1.1  christos 	  *local_got = (bfd_vma) -1;
   5635   1.1  christos 
   5636   1.1  christos       if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks)
   5637   1.7  christos 	continue;
   5638   1.7  christos 
   5639   1.7  christos       /* Allocate space for calls to local STT_GNU_IFUNC syms in .iplt.  */
   5640   1.7  christos       lgot_masks = (char *) end_local_plt;
   5641   1.7  christos       for (; local_plt < end_local_plt; ++local_plt, ++lgot_masks)
   5642   1.7  christos 	{
   5643   1.7  christos 	  struct plt_entry *ent;
   5644   1.7  christos 	  bool doneone = false;
   5645   1.7  christos 	  bfd_vma plt_offset = 0, glink_offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
   5646   1.7  christos 
   5647   1.1  christos 	  for (ent = *local_plt; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
   5648   1.1  christos 	    if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
   5649   1.1  christos 	      {
   5650   1.1  christos 		if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
   5651   1.1  christos 		  s = htab->elf.iplt;
   5652   1.1  christos 		else if (htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
   5653   1.1  christos 			 || (*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) != PLT_KEEP)
   5654   1.1  christos 		  {
   5655   1.7  christos 		    ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
   5656   1.1  christos 		    continue;
   5657   1.7  christos 		  }
   5658   1.1  christos 		else
   5659   1.7  christos 		  s = htab->pltlocal;
   5660   1.1  christos 
   5661   1.1  christos 		if (!doneone)
   5662   1.1  christos 		  {
   5663   1.1  christos 		    plt_offset = s->size;
   5664   1.1  christos 		    s->size += 4;
   5665   1.7  christos 		  }
   5666   1.7  christos 		ent->plt.offset = plt_offset;
   5667   1.7  christos 
   5668   1.7  christos 		if (s != htab->pltlocal && (!doneone || bfd_link_pic (info)))
   5669   1.7  christos 		  {
   5670   1.7  christos 		    s = htab->glink;
   5671   1.7  christos 		    glink_offset = s->size;
   5672   1.7  christos 		    s->size += GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, NULL);
   5673   1.7  christos 		  }
   5674   1.7  christos 		ent->glink_offset = glink_offset;
   5675  1.10  christos 
   5676   1.1  christos 		if (!doneone)
   5677   1.1  christos 		  {
   5678   1.1  christos 		    if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
   5679   1.1  christos 		      {
   5680   1.1  christos 			s = htab->elf.irelplt;
   5681  1.10  christos 			s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   5682  1.10  christos 		      }
   5683  1.10  christos 		    else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   5684  1.10  christos 		      {
   5685  1.10  christos 			s = htab->relpltlocal;
   5686  1.10  christos 			s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   5687  1.10  christos 		      }
   5688  1.10  christos 		    doneone = true;
   5689  1.10  christos 		  }
   5690   1.1  christos 	      }
   5691   1.1  christos 	    else
   5692   1.1  christos 	      ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
   5693   1.1  christos 	}
   5694   1.1  christos 
   5695   1.1  christos       if (local_syms != NULL
   5696   1.1  christos 	  && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
   5697   1.1  christos 	{
   5698   1.9  christos 	  if (!info->keep_memory)
   5699   1.7  christos 	    free (local_syms);
   5700   1.1  christos 	  else
   5701   1.1  christos 	    symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
   5702   1.1  christos 	}
   5703   1.1  christos     }
   5704   1.7  christos 
   5705   1.1  christos   /* Allocate space for global sym dynamic relocs.  */
   5706   1.1  christos   elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info), allocate_dynrelocs, info);
   5707   1.1  christos 
   5708   1.1  christos   if (htab->tlsld_got.refcount > 0)
   5709   1.1  christos     {
   5710   1.1  christos       htab->tlsld_got.offset = allocate_got (htab, 8);
   5711   1.1  christos       if (bfd_link_dll (info))
   5712   1.7  christos 	htab->elf.srelgot->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   5713   1.1  christos     }
   5714   1.7  christos   else
   5715   1.1  christos     htab->tlsld_got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
   5716   1.1  christos 
   5717   1.7  christos   if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL && htab->plt_type != PLT_VXWORKS)
   5718   1.1  christos     {
   5719   1.1  christos       unsigned int g_o_t = 32768;
   5720   1.1  christos 
   5721   1.1  christos       /* If we haven't allocated the header, do so now.  When we get here,
   5722   1.3  christos 	 for old plt/got the got size will be 0 to 32764 (not allocated),
   5723   1.1  christos 	 or 32780 to 65536 (header allocated).  For new plt/got, the
   5724   1.1  christos 	 corresponding ranges are 0 to 32768 and 32780 to 65536.  */
   5725   1.3  christos       if (htab->elf.sgot->size <= 32768)
   5726   1.3  christos 	{
   5727   1.3  christos 	  g_o_t = htab->elf.sgot->size;
   5728   1.3  christos 	  if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
   5729   1.3  christos 	    g_o_t += 4;
   5730   1.3  christos 	  htab->elf.sgot->size += htab->got_header_size;
   5731   1.3  christos 	}
   5732   1.3  christos 
   5733   1.3  christos       htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value = g_o_t;
   5734   1.3  christos     }
   5735   1.3  christos   if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   5736   1.3  christos     {
   5737   1.3  christos       struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
   5738   1.1  christos 
   5739   1.1  christos       sda->root.u.def.section = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section;
   5740   1.1  christos       sda->root.u.def.value = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value;
   5741   1.1  christos     }
   5742   1.1  christos   if (info->emitrelocations)
   5743   1.1  christos     {
   5744   1.1  christos       struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
   5745   1.1  christos 
   5746   1.7  christos       if (sda != NULL && sda->ref_regular)
   5747   1.7  christos 	sda->root.u.def.section->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
   5748   1.1  christos       sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
   5749   1.3  christos       if (sda != NULL && sda->ref_regular)
   5750   1.3  christos 	sda->root.u.def.section->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
   5751   1.1  christos     }
   5752   1.1  christos 
   5753   1.3  christos   if (htab->glink != NULL
   5754   1.1  christos       && htab->glink->size != 0
   5755   1.1  christos       && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
   5756   1.1  christos     {
   5757  1.10  christos       htab->glink_pltresolve = htab->glink->size;
   5758   1.1  christos       /* Space for the branch table.  */
   5759  1.10  christos       htab->glink->size
   5760   1.1  christos 	+= htab->elf.srelplt->size / (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) / 4) - 4;
   5761   1.1  christos       /* Pad out to align the start of PLTresolve.  */
   5762   1.1  christos       htab->glink->size += -htab->glink->size & (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
   5763   1.1  christos 						 ? 63 : 15);
   5764   1.1  christos       htab->glink->size += GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
   5765   1.1  christos 
   5766   1.1  christos       if (htab->params->emit_stub_syms)
   5767   1.1  christos 	{
   5768   1.1  christos 	  struct elf_link_hash_entry *sh;
   5769   1.1  christos 	  sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__glink",
   5770   1.3  christos 				     true, false, false);
   5771   1.1  christos 	  if (sh == NULL)
   5772   1.1  christos 	    return false;
   5773  1.10  christos 	  if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
   5774   1.1  christos 	    {
   5775  1.10  christos 	      sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
   5776   1.1  christos 	      sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
   5777   1.1  christos 	      sh->root.u.def.value = htab->glink_pltresolve;
   5778   1.1  christos 	      sh->ref_regular = 1;
   5779   1.1  christos 	      sh->def_regular = 1;
   5780   1.1  christos 	      sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
   5781   1.1  christos 	      sh->forced_local = 1;
   5782   1.1  christos 	      sh->non_elf = 0;
   5783   1.1  christos 	      sh->root.linker_def = 1;
   5784   1.1  christos 	    }
   5785   1.1  christos 	  sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__glink_PLTresolve",
   5786   1.3  christos 				     true, false, false);
   5787   1.1  christos 	  if (sh == NULL)
   5788   1.1  christos 	    return false;
   5789   1.1  christos 	  if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
   5790   1.1  christos 	    {
   5791   1.1  christos 	      sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
   5792   1.1  christos 	      sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
   5793   1.1  christos 	      sh->root.u.def.value = htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
   5794   1.1  christos 	      sh->ref_regular = 1;
   5795   1.1  christos 	      sh->def_regular = 1;
   5796   1.1  christos 	      sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
   5797   1.1  christos 	      sh->forced_local = 1;
   5798   1.1  christos 	      sh->non_elf = 0;
   5799   1.3  christos 	      sh->root.linker_def = 1;
   5800   1.1  christos 	    }
   5801   1.1  christos 	}
   5802   1.1  christos     }
   5803   1.1  christos 
   5804   1.1  christos   if (htab->glink != NULL
   5805   1.1  christos       && htab->glink->size != 0
   5806   1.1  christos       && htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
   5807   1.1  christos       && !bfd_is_abs_section (htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section)
   5808   1.1  christos       && _bfd_elf_eh_frame_present (info))
   5809  1.10  christos     {
   5810   1.1  christos       s = htab->glink_eh_frame;
   5811   1.1  christos       s->size = sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie) + 20;
   5812  1.10  christos       if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   5813   1.1  christos 	{
   5814   1.1  christos 	  s->size += 4;
   5815   1.1  christos 	  if (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 8 >= 256)
   5816   1.1  christos 	    s->size += 4;
   5817   1.7  christos 	}
   5818   1.7  christos     }
   5819   1.1  christos 
   5820   1.1  christos   /* We've now determined the sizes of the various dynamic sections.
   5821   1.1  christos      Allocate memory for them.  */
   5822   1.1  christos   relocs = false;
   5823   1.1  christos   for (s = htab->elf.dynobj->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
   5824  1.10  christos     {
   5825   1.1  christos       bool strip_section = true;
   5826   1.1  christos 
   5827   1.1  christos       if ((s->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0)
   5828   1.7  christos 	continue;
   5829   1.7  christos 
   5830   1.1  christos       if (s == htab->elf.splt
   5831   1.1  christos 	  || s == htab->elf.sgot)
   5832   1.7  christos 	{
   5833   1.1  christos 	  /* We'd like to strip these sections if they aren't needed, but if
   5834   1.7  christos 	     we've exported dynamic symbols from them we must leave them.
   5835   1.7  christos 	     It's too late to tell BFD to get rid of the symbols.  */
   5836   1.3  christos 	  if (htab->elf.hplt != NULL)
   5837   1.3  christos 	    strip_section = false;
   5838   1.3  christos 	  /* Strip this section if we don't need it; see the
   5839   1.3  christos 	     comment below.  */
   5840   1.3  christos 	}
   5841   1.1  christos       else if (s == htab->elf.iplt
   5842   1.1  christos 	       || s == htab->pltlocal
   5843   1.3  christos 	       || s == htab->glink
   5844   1.1  christos 	       || s == htab->glink_eh_frame
   5845  1.10  christos 	       || s == htab->elf.sgotplt
   5846   1.1  christos 	       || s == htab->sbss
   5847   1.1  christos 	       || s == htab->elf.sdynbss
   5848   1.1  christos 	       || s == htab->elf.sdynrelro
   5849   1.1  christos 	       || s == htab->dynsbss)
   5850  1.10  christos 	{
   5851   1.1  christos 	  /* Strip these too.  */
   5852   1.1  christos 	}
   5853   1.1  christos       else if (s == htab->sdata[0].section
   5854   1.1  christos 	       || s == htab->sdata[1].section)
   5855   1.1  christos 	{
   5856   1.1  christos 	  strip_section = (s->flags & SEC_KEEP) == 0;
   5857   1.1  christos 	}
   5858   1.1  christos       else if (startswith (bfd_section_name (s), ".rela"))
   5859   1.1  christos 	{
   5860   1.1  christos 	  if (s->size != 0)
   5861   1.1  christos 	    {
   5862   1.1  christos 	      /* Remember whether there are any relocation sections.  */
   5863   1.1  christos 	      relocs = true;
   5864   1.1  christos 
   5865   1.1  christos 	      /* We use the reloc_count field as a counter if we need
   5866   1.1  christos 		 to copy relocs into the output file.  */
   5867   1.1  christos 	      s->reloc_count = 0;
   5868   1.1  christos 	    }
   5869   1.1  christos 	}
   5870   1.1  christos       else
   5871   1.1  christos 	{
   5872   1.1  christos 	  /* It's not one of our sections, so don't allocate space.  */
   5873   1.1  christos 	  continue;
   5874   1.1  christos 	}
   5875   1.1  christos 
   5876   1.1  christos       if (s->size == 0 && strip_section)
   5877   1.1  christos 	{
   5878   1.1  christos 	  /* If we don't need this section, strip it from the
   5879   1.1  christos 	     output file.  This is mostly to handle .rela.bss and
   5880   1.1  christos 	     .rela.plt.  We must create both sections in
   5881   1.1  christos 	     create_dynamic_sections, because they must be created
   5882   1.1  christos 	     before the linker maps input sections to output
   5883   1.1  christos 	     sections.  The linker does that before
   5884  1.10  christos 	     adjust_dynamic_symbol is called, and it is that
   5885  1.12  christos 	     function which decides whether anything needs to go
   5886   1.1  christos 	     into these sections.  */
   5887   1.1  christos 	  s->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
   5888   1.1  christos 	  continue;
   5889   1.1  christos 	}
   5890   1.1  christos 
   5891   1.1  christos       if ((s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0)
   5892   1.1  christos 	continue;
   5893   1.1  christos 
   5894   1.1  christos       /* Allocate memory for the section contents.  */
   5895   1.1  christos       s->contents = bfd_zalloc (htab->elf.dynobj, s->size);
   5896   1.1  christos       if (s->contents == NULL)
   5897   1.1  christos 	return false;
   5898  1.10  christos       s->alloced = 1;
   5899  1.10  christos     }
   5900  1.10  christos 
   5901   1.1  christos   if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
   5902   1.3  christos     {
   5903   1.3  christos       /* Add some entries to the .dynamic section.  We fill in the
   5904   1.3  christos 	 values later, in ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections, but we
   5905   1.1  christos 	 must add the entries now so that we get the correct size for
   5906   1.1  christos 	 the .dynamic section.  The DT_DEBUG entry is filled in by the
   5907  1.10  christos 	 dynamic linker and used by the debugger.  */
   5908   1.3  christos #define add_dynamic_entry(TAG, VAL) \
   5909   1.1  christos   _bfd_elf_add_dynamic_entry (info, TAG, VAL)
   5910   1.1  christos 
   5911   1.3  christos       if (!_bfd_elf_maybe_vxworks_add_dynamic_tags (output_bfd, info,
   5912  1.10  christos 						    relocs))
   5913   1.1  christos 	return false;
   5914   1.1  christos 
   5915   1.1  christos       if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
   5916   1.1  christos 	  && htab->glink != NULL
   5917   1.1  christos 	  && htab->glink->size != 0)
   5918   1.1  christos 	{
   5919   1.1  christos 	  if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_PPC_GOT, 0))
   5920   1.1  christos 	    return false;
   5921   1.1  christos 	  if (!htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt
   5922   1.1  christos 	      && htab->tls_get_addr != NULL
   5923   1.1  christos 	      && htab->tls_get_addr->plt.plist != NULL
   5924   1.1  christos 	      && !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PPC_OPT, PPC_OPT_TLS))
   5925   1.1  christos 	    return false;
   5926   1.1  christos 	}
   5927   1.1  christos    }
   5928   1.1  christos #undef add_dynamic_entry
   5929   1.1  christos 
   5930   1.1  christos   if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
   5931   1.1  christos       && htab->glink_eh_frame->contents != NULL)
   5932   1.1  christos     {
   5933   1.1  christos       unsigned char *p = htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
   5934   1.1  christos       bfd_vma val;
   5935   1.1  christos 
   5936   1.1  christos       memcpy (p, glink_eh_frame_cie, sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie));
   5937   1.1  christos       /* CIE length (rewrite in case little-endian).  */
   5938   1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie) - 4, p);
   5939   1.1  christos       p += sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie);
   5940   1.1  christos       /* FDE length.  */
   5941   1.1  christos       val = htab->glink_eh_frame->size - 4 - sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie);
   5942   1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
   5943   1.3  christos       p += 4;
   5944   1.1  christos       /* CIE pointer.  */
   5945   1.1  christos       val = p - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
   5946   1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
   5947   1.1  christos       p += 4;
   5948   1.1  christos       /* Offset to .glink.  Set later.  */
   5949   1.1  christos       p += 4;
   5950   1.1  christos       /* .glink size.  */
   5951   1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, htab->glink->size, p);
   5952   1.1  christos       p += 4;
   5953   1.1  christos       /* Augmentation.  */
   5954   1.1  christos       p += 1;
   5955   1.1  christos 
   5956   1.1  christos       if (bfd_link_pic (info)
   5957   1.1  christos 	  && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
   5958   1.1  christos 	{
   5959   1.1  christos 	  bfd_vma adv = (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 8) >> 2;
   5960   1.1  christos 	  if (adv < 64)
   5961   1.1  christos 	    *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + adv;
   5962   1.1  christos 	  else if (adv < 256)
   5963   1.1  christos 	    {
   5964   1.1  christos 	      *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc1;
   5965   1.1  christos 	      *p++ = adv;
   5966   1.1  christos 	    }
   5967   1.1  christos 	  else if (adv < 65536)
   5968   1.1  christos 	    {
   5969   1.1  christos 	      *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc2;
   5970   1.1  christos 	      bfd_put_16 (htab->elf.dynobj, adv, p);
   5971   1.1  christos 	      p += 2;
   5972   1.1  christos 	    }
   5973   1.1  christos 	  else
   5974   1.1  christos 	    {
   5975   1.1  christos 	      *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc4;
   5976   1.1  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, adv, p);
   5977  1.10  christos 	      p += 4;
   5978   1.1  christos 	    }
   5979   1.1  christos 	  *p++ = DW_CFA_register;
   5980   1.3  christos 	  *p++ = 65;
   5981   1.3  christos 	  p++;
   5982   1.3  christos 	  *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + 4;
   5983   1.3  christos 	  *p++ = DW_CFA_restore_extended;
   5984   1.3  christos 	  *p++ = 65;
   5985   1.3  christos 	}
   5986   1.3  christos       BFD_ASSERT ((bfd_vma) ((p + 3 - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents) & -4)
   5987   1.3  christos 		  == htab->glink_eh_frame->size);
   5988   1.3  christos     }
   5989   1.3  christos 
   5990   1.3  christos   return true;
   5991   1.3  christos }
   5992   1.3  christos 
   5993   1.3  christos /* Arrange to have _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_ stripped from the output
   5994   1.3  christos    if it looks like nothing is using them.  */
   5995   1.3  christos 
   5996   1.3  christos static void
   5997   1.3  christos maybe_strip_sdasym (bfd *output_bfd, elf_linker_section_t *lsect)
   5998   1.3  christos {
   5999   1.3  christos   struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = lsect->sym;
   6000   1.3  christos 
   6001   1.3  christos   if (sda != NULL && !sda->ref_regular && sda->dynindx == -1)
   6002   1.3  christos     {
   6003   1.3  christos       asection *s;
   6004   1.3  christos 
   6005   1.3  christos       s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, lsect->name);
   6006   1.3  christos       if (s == NULL || bfd_section_removed_from_list (output_bfd, s))
   6007   1.3  christos 	{
   6008   1.3  christos 	  s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, lsect->bss_name);
   6009   1.3  christos 	  if (s == NULL || bfd_section_removed_from_list (output_bfd, s))
   6010   1.3  christos 	    {
   6011   1.3  christos 	      sda->def_regular = 0;
   6012   1.3  christos 	      /* This is somewhat magic.  See elf_link_output_extsym.  */
   6013   1.3  christos 	      sda->ref_dynamic = 1;
   6014   1.3  christos 	      sda->forced_local = 0;
   6015   1.3  christos 	    }
   6016   1.3  christos 	}
   6017   1.3  christos     }
   6018   1.3  christos }
   6019   1.3  christos 
   6020   1.1  christos void
   6021   1.1  christos ppc_elf_maybe_strip_sdata_syms (struct bfd_link_info *info)
   6022  1.10  christos {
   6023   1.1  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   6024   1.1  christos 
   6025   1.1  christos   if (htab != NULL)
   6026   1.1  christos     {
   6027   1.1  christos       maybe_strip_sdasym (info->output_bfd, &htab->sdata[0]);
   6028   1.1  christos       maybe_strip_sdasym (info->output_bfd, &htab->sdata[1]);
   6029  1.10  christos     }
   6030   1.1  christos }
   6031   1.1  christos 
   6032   1.1  christos 
   6033   1.1  christos /* Return TRUE if symbol should be hashed in the `.gnu.hash' section.  */
   6034   1.1  christos 
   6035   1.1  christos static bool
   6036   1.1  christos ppc_elf_hash_symbol (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
   6037   1.1  christos {
   6038   1.1  christos   if (h->plt.plist != NULL
   6039   1.1  christos       && !h->def_regular
   6040   1.1  christos       && (!h->pointer_equality_needed
   6041   1.1  christos 	  || !h->ref_regular_nonweak))
   6042   1.1  christos     return false;
   6043   1.1  christos 
   6044   1.3  christos   return _bfd_elf_hash_symbol (h);
   6045   1.1  christos }
   6046   1.1  christos 
   6047   1.1  christos #define ARRAY_SIZE(a) (sizeof (a) / sizeof ((a)[0]))
   6049   1.1  christos 
   6050   1.1  christos /* Relaxation trampolines.  r12 is available for clobbering (r11, is
   6051   1.1  christos    used for some functions that are allowed to break the ABI).  */
   6052   1.1  christos static const int shared_stub_entry[] =
   6053   1.1  christos   {
   6054   1.1  christos     0x7c0802a6, /* mflr 0 */
   6055   1.1  christos     0x429f0005, /* bcl 20, 31, .Lxxx */
   6056   1.1  christos     0x7d8802a6, /* mflr 12 */
   6057   1.1  christos     0x3d8c0000, /* addis 12, 12, (xxx-.Lxxx)@ha */
   6058   1.3  christos     0x398c0000, /* addi 12, 12, (xxx-.Lxxx)@l */
   6059   1.3  christos     0x7c0803a6, /* mtlr 0 */
   6060   1.3  christos     0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr 12 */
   6061   1.3  christos     0x4e800420, /* bctr */
   6062   1.3  christos   };
   6063   1.3  christos 
   6064   1.3  christos static const int stub_entry[] =
   6065   1.3  christos   {
   6066   1.3  christos     0x3d800000, /* lis 12,xxx@ha */
   6067   1.3  christos     0x398c0000, /* addi 12,12,xxx@l */
   6068   1.3  christos     0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr 12 */
   6069  1.10  christos     0x4e800420, /* bctr */
   6070   1.1  christos   };
   6071   1.1  christos 
   6072   1.1  christos struct ppc_elf_relax_info
   6073  1.10  christos {
   6074   1.1  christos   unsigned int workaround_size;
   6075   1.3  christos   unsigned int picfixup_size;
   6076   1.1  christos };
   6077   1.3  christos 
   6078   1.1  christos /* This function implements long branch trampolines, and the ppc476
   6079   1.1  christos    icache bug workaround.  Any section needing trampolines or patch
   6080   1.1  christos    space for the workaround has its size extended so that we can
   6081   1.1  christos    add trampolines at the end of the section.  */
   6082   1.1  christos 
   6083   1.1  christos static bool
   6084   1.1  christos ppc_elf_relax_section (bfd *abfd,
   6085   1.1  christos 		       asection *isec,
   6086   1.1  christos 		       struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
   6087   1.1  christos 		       bool *again)
   6088   1.1  christos {
   6089   1.3  christos   struct one_branch_fixup
   6090   1.3  christos   {
   6091   1.3  christos     struct one_branch_fixup *next;
   6092   1.1  christos     asection *tsec;
   6093  1.10  christos     /* Final link, can use the symbol offset.  For a
   6094   1.1  christos        relocatable link we use the symbol's index.  */
   6095   1.3  christos     bfd_vma toff;
   6096   1.1  christos     bfd_vma trampoff;
   6097  1.10  christos   };
   6098   1.1  christos 
   6099  1.10  christos   Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
   6100   1.1  christos   bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
   6101   1.3  christos   Elf_Internal_Sym *isymbuf = NULL;
   6102   1.1  christos   Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs = NULL;
   6103   1.1  christos   Elf_Internal_Rela *irel, *irelend = NULL;
   6104  1.11  christos   struct one_branch_fixup *branch_fixups = NULL;
   6105   1.3  christos   struct ppc_elf_relax_info *relax_info = NULL;
   6106   1.3  christos   unsigned changes = 0;
   6107  1.10  christos   bool workaround_change;
   6108   1.1  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
   6109   1.1  christos   bfd_size_type trampbase, trampoff, newsize, picfixup_size;
   6110   1.1  christos   asection *got2;
   6111   1.1  christos   bool maybe_pasted;
   6112   1.3  christos 
   6113  1.10  christos   *again = false;
   6114   1.3  christos 
   6115   1.3  christos   /* No need to do anything with non-alloc or non-code sections.  */
   6116   1.3  christos   if ((isec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0
   6117  1.10  christos       || (isec->flags & SEC_CODE) == 0
   6118   1.3  christos       || (isec->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0
   6119   1.3  christos       || (isec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0
   6120   1.3  christos       || isec->size < 4)
   6121   1.3  christos     return true;
   6122   1.3  christos 
   6123   1.3  christos   /* We cannot represent the required PIC relocs in the output, so don't
   6124   1.3  christos      do anything.  The linker doesn't support mixing -shared and -r
   6125   1.3  christos      anyway.  */
   6126   1.3  christos   if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info) && bfd_link_pic (link_info))
   6127   1.3  christos     return true;
   6128   1.3  christos 
   6129   1.3  christos   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (link_info);
   6130   1.3  christos   if (htab == NULL)
   6131   1.3  christos     return true;
   6132   1.3  christos 
   6133   1.3  christos   isec->size = (isec->size + 3) & -4;
   6134   1.3  christos   if (isec->rawsize == 0)
   6135   1.3  christos     isec->rawsize = isec->size;
   6136  1.10  christos   trampbase = isec->size;
   6137   1.3  christos 
   6138   1.3  christos   BFD_ASSERT (isec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_NONE
   6139   1.3  christos 	      || isec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET);
   6140   1.3  christos   isec->sec_info_type = SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET;
   6141   1.1  christos 
   6142   1.1  christos   if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
   6143   1.1  christos       || htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
   6144   1.1  christos     {
   6145   1.3  christos       if (elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info == NULL)
   6146   1.3  christos 	{
   6147   1.1  christos 	  elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info
   6148   1.1  christos 	    = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (struct ppc_elf_relax_info));
   6149   1.1  christos 	  if (elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info == NULL)
   6150   1.3  christos 	    return false;
   6151   1.3  christos 	}
   6152   1.3  christos       relax_info = elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info;
   6153   1.3  christos       trampbase -= relax_info->workaround_size;
   6154   1.3  christos     }
   6155   1.3  christos 
   6156   1.3  christos   maybe_pasted = (strcmp (isec->output_section->name, ".init") == 0
   6157   1.3  christos 		  || strcmp (isec->output_section->name, ".fini") == 0);
   6158   1.3  christos   /* Space for a branch around any trampolines.  */
   6159   1.3  christos   trampoff = trampbase;
   6160   1.3  christos   if (maybe_pasted && trampbase == isec->rawsize)
   6161   1.3  christos     trampoff += 4;
   6162   1.1  christos 
   6163   1.3  christos   symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
   6164   1.1  christos   picfixup_size = 0;
   6165   1.3  christos   if (htab->params->branch_trampolines
   6166   1.3  christos       || htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
   6167   1.1  christos     {
   6168   1.3  christos       /* Get a copy of the native relocations.  */
   6169   1.3  christos       if (isec->reloc_count != 0)
   6170   1.3  christos 	{
   6171   1.3  christos 	  internal_relocs = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, isec, NULL, NULL,
   6172   1.3  christos 						       link_info->keep_memory);
   6173  1.11  christos 	  if (internal_relocs == NULL)
   6174   1.3  christos 	    goto error_return;
   6175   1.3  christos 	}
   6176   1.3  christos 
   6177   1.7  christos       got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got2");
   6178   1.3  christos 
   6179   1.3  christos       irelend = internal_relocs + isec->reloc_count;
   6180   1.3  christos       for (irel = internal_relocs; irel < irelend; irel++)
   6181   1.3  christos 	{
   6182   1.3  christos 	  unsigned long r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info);
   6183   1.3  christos 	  bfd_vma toff, roff;
   6184   1.3  christos 	  asection *tsec;
   6185   1.3  christos 	  struct one_branch_fixup *f;
   6186   1.7  christos 	  size_t insn_offset = 0;
   6187   1.3  christos 	  bfd_vma max_branch_offset = 0, val, reladdr;
   6188   1.3  christos 	  bfd_byte *hit_addr;
   6189   1.1  christos 	  unsigned long t0;
   6190   1.3  christos 	  struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
   6191   1.3  christos 	  Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
   6192   1.3  christos 	  struct plt_entry **plist;
   6193   1.3  christos 	  unsigned char sym_type;
   6194   1.3  christos 
   6195   1.1  christos 	  switch (r_type)
   6196   1.3  christos 	    {
   6197   1.3  christos 	    case R_PPC_REL24:
   6198   1.3  christos 	    case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
   6199   1.3  christos 	    case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
   6200   1.1  christos 	    case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
   6201   1.3  christos 	      max_branch_offset = 1 << 25;
   6202   1.3  christos 	      break;
   6203   1.3  christos 
   6204   1.1  christos 	    case R_PPC_REL14:
   6205   1.3  christos 	    case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
   6206   1.7  christos 	    case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
   6207   1.7  christos 	      max_branch_offset = 1 << 15;
   6208   1.7  christos 	      break;
   6209   1.7  christos 
   6210   1.7  christos 	    case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
   6211   1.1  christos 	      if (htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
   6212   1.7  christos 		break;
   6213   1.7  christos 	      continue;
   6214   1.3  christos 
   6215   1.3  christos 	    default:
   6216   1.9  christos 	      continue;
   6217   1.9  christos 	    }
   6218   1.3  christos 
   6219   1.3  christos 	  /* Get the value of the symbol referred to by the reloc.  */
   6220   1.3  christos 	  if (!get_sym_h (&h, &isym, &tsec, NULL, &isymbuf,
   6221   1.1  christos 			  ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info), abfd))
   6222   1.1  christos 	    goto error_return;
   6223   1.3  christos 
   6224   1.7  christos 	  if (isym != NULL)
   6225   1.7  christos 	    {
   6226   1.3  christos 	      if (tsec != NULL)
   6227   1.3  christos 		;
   6228   1.3  christos 	      else if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_ABS)
   6229   1.7  christos 		tsec = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
   6230   1.7  christos 	      else
   6231   1.7  christos 		continue;
   6232   1.3  christos 
   6233   1.3  christos 	      toff = isym->st_value;
   6234   1.3  christos 	      sym_type = ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info);
   6235   1.3  christos 	    }
   6236   1.3  christos 	  else
   6237   1.3  christos 	    {
   6238   1.3  christos 	      if (tsec != NULL)
   6239   1.3  christos 		toff = h->root.u.def.value;
   6240   1.3  christos 	      else if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
   6241   1.3  christos 		       || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
   6242   1.3  christos 		{
   6243   1.3  christos 		  unsigned long indx;
   6244   1.3  christos 
   6245   1.3  christos 		  indx = ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info) - symtab_hdr->sh_info;
   6246   1.3  christos 		  tsec = bfd_und_section_ptr;
   6247   1.3  christos 		  toff = bfd_link_relocatable (link_info) ? indx : 0;
   6248   1.3  christos 		}
   6249   1.3  christos 	      else
   6250   1.3  christos 		continue;
   6251   1.3  christos 
   6252   1.3  christos 	      /* If this branch is to __tls_get_addr then we may later
   6253   1.3  christos 		 optimise away the call.  We won't be needing a long-
   6254   1.3  christos 		 branch stub in that case.  */
   6255   1.3  christos 	      if (bfd_link_executable (link_info)
   6256   1.3  christos 		  && h == htab->tls_get_addr
   6257   1.3  christos 		  && irel != internal_relocs)
   6258   1.3  christos 		{
   6259   1.3  christos 		  unsigned long t_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (irel[-1].r_info);
   6260   1.3  christos 		  unsigned long t_rtype = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel[-1].r_info);
   6261   1.3  christos 		  unsigned int tls_mask = 0;
   6262   1.3  christos 
   6263   1.3  christos 		  /* The previous reloc should be one of R_PPC_TLSGD or
   6264   1.3  christos 		     R_PPC_TLSLD, or for older object files, a reloc
   6265   1.3  christos 		     on the __tls_get_addr arg setup insn.  Get tls
   6266   1.3  christos 		     mask bits from the symbol on that reloc.  */
   6267   1.3  christos 		  if (t_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
   6268   1.3  christos 		    {
   6269   1.3  christos 		      bfd_vma *local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (abfd);
   6270   1.3  christos 
   6271   1.3  christos 		      if (local_got_offsets != NULL)
   6272   1.3  christos 			{
   6273   1.3  christos 			  struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
   6274   1.1  christos 			    (local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
   6275   1.3  christos 			  char *lgot_masks = (char *)
   6276   1.3  christos 			    (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
   6277   1.3  christos 			  tls_mask = lgot_masks[t_symndx];
   6278   1.1  christos 			}
   6279   1.3  christos 		    }
   6280   1.3  christos 		  else
   6281   1.3  christos 		    {
   6282   1.3  christos 		      struct elf_link_hash_entry *th
   6283   1.3  christos 			= elf_sym_hashes (abfd)[t_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
   6284   1.3  christos 
   6285   1.3  christos 		      while (th->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
   6286   1.3  christos 			     || th->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
   6287   1.3  christos 			th = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) th->root.u.i.link;
   6288   1.3  christos 
   6289   1.3  christos 		      tls_mask
   6290   1.3  christos 			= ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) th)->tls_mask;
   6291   1.3  christos 		    }
   6292   1.1  christos 
   6293   1.3  christos 		  /* The mask bits tell us if the call will be
   6294   1.3  christos 		     optimised away.  */
   6295   1.1  christos 		  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0
   6296   1.3  christos 		      && (t_rtype == R_PPC_TLSGD
   6297   1.1  christos 			  || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16
   6298   1.3  christos 			  || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO))
   6299   1.3  christos 		    continue;
   6300   1.3  christos 		  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0
   6301   1.3  christos 		      && (t_rtype == R_PPC_TLSLD
   6302   1.3  christos 			  || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16
   6303   1.3  christos 			  || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO))
   6304   1.3  christos 		    continue;
   6305   1.1  christos 		}
   6306   1.3  christos 
   6307   1.3  christos 	      sym_type = h->type;
   6308   1.3  christos 	    }
   6309   1.3  christos 
   6310   1.3  christos 	  if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA)
   6311   1.3  christos 	    {
   6312   1.3  christos 	      if (h != NULL
   6313   1.1  christos 		  && !h->def_regular
   6314   1.3  christos 		  && h->protected_def
   6315   1.3  christos 		  && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha
   6316   1.3  christos 		  && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo)
   6317   1.3  christos 		picfixup_size += 12;
   6318   1.3  christos 	      continue;
   6319   1.3  christos 	    }
   6320   1.3  christos 
   6321   1.3  christos 	  /* The condition here under which we call find_plt_ent must
   6322   1.3  christos 	     match that in relocate_section.  If we call find_plt_ent here
   6323   1.3  christos 	     but not in relocate_section, or vice versa, then the branch
   6324   1.3  christos 	     destination used here may be incorrect.  */
   6325   1.3  christos 	  plist = NULL;
   6326   1.1  christos 	  if (h != NULL)
   6327   1.3  christos 	    {
   6328   1.3  christos 	      /* We know is_branch_reloc (r_type) is true.  */
   6329   1.3  christos 	      if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
   6330   1.3  christos 		  || r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24)
   6331   1.1  christos 		plist = &h->plt.plist;
   6332   1.3  christos 	    }
   6333   1.3  christos 	  else if (sym_type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
   6334   1.3  christos 		   && elf_local_got_offsets (abfd) != NULL)
   6335   1.3  christos 	    {
   6336   1.1  christos 	      bfd_vma *local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (abfd);
   6337   1.3  christos 	      struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
   6338   1.3  christos 		(local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
   6339   1.3  christos 	      plist = local_plt + ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info);
   6340   1.3  christos 	    }
   6341   1.3  christos 	  if (plist != NULL)
   6342   1.3  christos 	    {
   6343   1.3  christos 	      bfd_vma addend = 0;
   6344   1.3  christos 	      struct plt_entry *ent;
   6345   1.3  christos 
   6346   1.3  christos 	      if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24 && bfd_link_pic (link_info))
   6347   1.7  christos 		addend = irel->r_addend;
   6348   1.3  christos 	      ent = find_plt_ent (plist, got2, addend);
   6349   1.3  christos 	      if (ent != NULL)
   6350   1.1  christos 		{
   6351   1.1  christos 		  if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
   6352   1.1  christos 		      || h == NULL
   6353   1.3  christos 		      || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
   6354   1.3  christos 		      || h->dynindx == -1)
   6355   1.3  christos 		    {
   6356   1.3  christos 		      tsec = htab->glink;
   6357   1.3  christos 		      toff = ent->glink_offset;
   6358   1.3  christos 		    }
   6359   1.9  christos 		  else
   6360   1.9  christos 		    {
   6361   1.9  christos 		      tsec = htab->elf.splt;
   6362   1.9  christos 		      toff = ent->plt.offset;
   6363   1.9  christos 		    }
   6364   1.9  christos 		}
   6365   1.9  christos 	    }
   6366   1.9  christos 
   6367   1.9  christos 	  /* If the branch and target are in the same section, you have
   6368   1.9  christos 	     no hope of adding stubs.  We'll error out later should the
   6369   1.9  christos 	     branch overflow.  */
   6370   1.3  christos 	  if (tsec == isec)
   6371   1.3  christos 	    continue;
   6372   1.3  christos 
   6373   1.3  christos 	  /* toff is used for the symbol index when the symbol is
   6374   1.3  christos 	     undefined and we're doing a relocatable link, so we can't
   6375   1.3  christos 	     support addends.  It would be possible to do so by
   6376   1.3  christos 	     putting the addend in one_branch_fixup but addends on
   6377   1.3  christos 	     branches are rare so it hardly seems worth supporting.  */
   6378   1.3  christos 	  if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
   6379   1.3  christos 	      && tsec == bfd_und_section_ptr
   6380   1.3  christos 	      && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24
   6381   1.3  christos 	      && irel->r_addend != 0)
   6382   1.3  christos 	    continue;
   6383   1.3  christos 
   6384   1.3  christos 	  /* There probably isn't any reason to handle symbols in
   6385   1.3  christos 	     SEC_MERGE sections;  SEC_MERGE doesn't seem a likely
   6386   1.3  christos 	     attribute for a code section, and we are only looking at
   6387   1.3  christos 	     branches.  However, implement it correctly here as a
   6388   1.3  christos 	     reference for other target relax_section functions.  */
   6389   1.3  christos 	  if (0 && tsec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
   6390   1.3  christos 	    {
   6391   1.3  christos 	      /* At this stage in linking, no SEC_MERGE symbol has been
   6392   1.3  christos 		 adjusted, so all references to such symbols need to be
   6393   1.9  christos 		 passed through _bfd_merged_section_offset.  (Later, in
   6394   1.9  christos 		 relocate_section, all SEC_MERGE symbols *except* for
   6395   1.3  christos 		 section symbols have been adjusted.)
   6396   1.3  christos 
   6397   1.3  christos 		 gas may reduce relocations against symbols in SEC_MERGE
   6398   1.3  christos 		 sections to a relocation against the section symbol when
   6399   1.3  christos 		 the original addend was zero.  When the reloc is against
   6400   1.3  christos 		 a section symbol we should include the addend in the
   6401   1.1  christos 		 offset passed to _bfd_merged_section_offset, since the
   6402   1.9  christos 		 location of interest is the original symbol.  On the
   6403   1.9  christos 		 other hand, an access to "sym+addend" where "sym" is not
   6404   1.3  christos 		 a section symbol should not include the addend;  Such an
   6405   1.3  christos 		 access is presumed to be an offset from "sym";  The
   6406   1.3  christos 		 location of interest is just "sym".  */
   6407   1.3  christos 	      if (sym_type == STT_SECTION
   6408   1.1  christos 		  && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
   6409   1.1  christos 		toff += irel->r_addend;
   6410   1.3  christos 
   6411   1.3  christos 	      toff
   6412   1.3  christos 		= _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, &tsec,
   6413   1.3  christos 					      elf_section_data (tsec)->sec_info,
   6414   1.3  christos 					      toff);
   6415   1.3  christos 
   6416   1.3  christos 	      if (sym_type != STT_SECTION
   6417   1.1  christos 		  && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
   6418   1.3  christos 		toff += irel->r_addend;
   6419  1.11  christos 	    }
   6420   1.1  christos 	  /* PLTREL24 addends are special.  */
   6421   1.9  christos 	  else if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
   6422   1.9  christos 	    toff += irel->r_addend;
   6423   1.9  christos 
   6424   1.9  christos 	  /* Attempted -shared link of non-pic code loses.  */
   6425   1.9  christos 	  if ((!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
   6426   1.9  christos 	       && tsec == bfd_und_section_ptr)
   6427   1.9  christos 	      || tsec->output_section == NULL
   6428   1.9  christos 	      || (tsec->owner != NULL
   6429   1.9  christos 		  && (tsec->owner->flags & BFD_PLUGIN) != 0))
   6430   1.9  christos 	    continue;
   6431   1.3  christos 
   6432   1.3  christos 	  roff = irel->r_offset;
   6433   1.3  christos 	  reladdr = isec->output_section->vma + isec->output_offset + roff;
   6434   1.3  christos 
   6435   1.3  christos 	  /* Avoid creating a lot of unnecessary fixups when
   6436   1.3  christos 	     relocatable if the output section size is such that a
   6437   1.3  christos 	     fixup can be created at final link.
   6438  1.11  christos 	     The max_branch_offset adjustment allows for some number
   6439   1.3  christos 	     of other fixups being needed at final link.  */
   6440   1.3  christos 	  if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
   6441   1.3  christos 	      && (isec->output_section->rawsize - (isec->output_offset + roff)
   6442   1.3  christos 		  < max_branch_offset - (max_branch_offset >> 4)))
   6443   1.3  christos 	    continue;
   6444   1.3  christos 
   6445   1.1  christos 	  /* If the branch is in range, no need to do anything.  */
   6446   1.3  christos 	  if (tsec != bfd_und_section_ptr
   6447   1.3  christos 	      && (!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
   6448   1.3  christos 		  /* A relocatable link may have sections moved during
   6449   1.3  christos 		     final link, so do not presume they remain in range.  */
   6450   1.1  christos 		  || tsec->output_section == isec->output_section))
   6451   1.3  christos 	    {
   6452   1.3  christos 	      bfd_vma symaddr;
   6453   1.3  christos 
   6454   1.3  christos 	      symaddr = tsec->output_section->vma + tsec->output_offset + toff;
   6455   1.1  christos 	      if (symaddr - reladdr + max_branch_offset
   6456   1.3  christos 		  < 2 * max_branch_offset)
   6457   1.3  christos 		continue;
   6458   1.3  christos 	    }
   6459   1.3  christos 
   6460   1.3  christos 	  /* Look for an existing fixup to this address.  */
   6461   1.1  christos 	  for (f = branch_fixups; f ; f = f->next)
   6462   1.3  christos 	    if (f->tsec == tsec && f->toff == toff)
   6463   1.3  christos 	      break;
   6464   1.3  christos 
   6465   1.3  christos 	  if (f == NULL)
   6466   1.3  christos 	    {
   6467   1.3  christos 	      size_t size;
   6468   1.3  christos 	      unsigned long stub_rtype;
   6469   1.3  christos 
   6470   1.3  christos 	      val = trampoff - roff;
   6471   1.3  christos 	      if (val >= max_branch_offset)
   6472   1.3  christos 		/* Oh dear, we can't reach a trampoline.  Don't try to add
   6473   1.7  christos 		   one.  We'll report an error later.  */
   6474   1.3  christos 		continue;
   6475   1.3  christos 
   6476   1.3  christos 	      if (bfd_link_pic (link_info))
   6477   1.3  christos 		{
   6478   1.3  christos 		  size = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (shared_stub_entry);
   6479   1.3  christos 		  insn_offset = 12;
   6480   1.1  christos 		}
   6481   1.3  christos 	      else
   6482   1.3  christos 		{
   6483   1.3  christos 		  size = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (stub_entry);
   6484   1.3  christos 		  insn_offset = 0;
   6485   1.3  christos 		}
   6486   1.3  christos 	      stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX;
   6487   1.3  christos 	      if (tsec == htab->elf.splt
   6488   1.3  christos 		  || tsec == htab->glink)
   6489   1.3  christos 		{
   6490   1.3  christos 		  stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX_PLT;
   6491   1.3  christos 		  if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24)
   6492   1.3  christos 		    stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24;
   6493   1.3  christos 		}
   6494   1.3  christos 
   6495   1.3  christos 	      /* Hijack the old relocation.  Since we need two
   6496   1.3  christos 		 relocations for this use a "composite" reloc.  */
   6497   1.1  christos 	      irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info),
   6498   1.3  christos 					   stub_rtype);
   6499   1.3  christos 	      irel->r_offset = trampoff + insn_offset;
   6500   1.1  christos 	      if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
   6501   1.1  christos 		  && stub_rtype != R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24)
   6502   1.1  christos 		irel->r_addend = 0;
   6503   1.3  christos 
   6504   1.3  christos 	      /* Record the fixup so we don't do it again this section.  */
   6505   1.3  christos 	      f = bfd_malloc (sizeof (*f));
   6506   1.3  christos 	      f->next = branch_fixups;
   6507   1.3  christos 	      f->tsec = tsec;
   6508   1.3  christos 	      f->toff = toff;
   6509   1.1  christos 	      f->trampoff = trampoff;
   6510   1.1  christos 	      branch_fixups = f;
   6511  1.11  christos 
   6512  1.11  christos 	      trampoff += size;
   6513  1.11  christos 	      changes++;
   6514  1.11  christos 	    }
   6515  1.11  christos 	  else
   6516  1.11  christos 	    {
   6517   1.3  christos 	      val = f->trampoff - roff;
   6518   1.3  christos 	      if (val >= max_branch_offset)
   6519   1.1  christos 		continue;
   6520   1.3  christos 
   6521   1.3  christos 	      /* Nop out the reloc, since we're finalizing things here.  */
   6522   1.3  christos 	      irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_NONE);
   6523   1.1  christos 	    }
   6524   1.3  christos 
   6525   1.1  christos 	  link_info->callbacks->minfo
   6526   1.1  christos 	    (_("%pB: Adjusting branch at 0x%V towards \"%s\" in section %s\n"),
   6527   1.1  christos 	     abfd, reladdr,
   6528   1.3  christos 	     (h && h->root.root.string? h->root.root.string : "<unknown>"),
   6529   1.3  christos 	     f->tsec->name);
   6530   1.3  christos 
   6531   1.3  christos 	  /* Get the section contents.  */
   6532   1.3  christos 	  if (contents == NULL)
   6533   1.3  christos 	    {
   6534   1.3  christos 	      /* Get cached copy if it exists.  */
   6535   1.3  christos 	      if (elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != NULL)
   6536   1.3  christos 		contents = elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents;
   6537   1.3  christos 	      /* Go get them off disk.  */
   6538   1.3  christos 	      else if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, isec, &contents))
   6539   1.3  christos 		goto error_return;
   6540   1.1  christos 	    }
   6541   1.3  christos 
   6542   1.3  christos 	  /* Fix up the existing branch to hit the trampoline.  */
   6543   1.3  christos 	  hit_addr = contents + roff;
   6544   1.3  christos 	  switch (r_type)
   6545   1.3  christos 	    {
   6546   1.3  christos 	    case R_PPC_REL24:
   6547   1.3  christos 	    case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
   6548   1.3  christos 	    case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
   6549   1.3  christos 	      t0 = bfd_get_32 (abfd, hit_addr);
   6550   1.1  christos 	      t0 &= ~0x3fffffc;
   6551   1.1  christos 	      t0 |= val & 0x3fffffc;
   6552   1.3  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (abfd, t0, hit_addr);
   6553   1.1  christos 	      break;
   6554   1.3  christos 
   6555   1.3  christos 	    case R_PPC_REL14:
   6556   1.1  christos 	    case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
   6557   1.1  christos 	    case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
   6558   1.3  christos 	      t0 = bfd_get_32 (abfd, hit_addr);
   6559   1.1  christos 	      t0 &= ~0xfffc;
   6560  1.10  christos 	      t0 |= val & 0xfffc;
   6561   1.3  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (abfd, t0, hit_addr);
   6562   1.3  christos 	      break;
   6563   1.3  christos 	    }
   6564   1.3  christos 	}
   6565   1.3  christos 
   6566   1.3  christos       while (branch_fixups != NULL)
   6567   1.3  christos 	{
   6568   1.3  christos 	  struct one_branch_fixup *f = branch_fixups;
   6569   1.1  christos 	  branch_fixups = branch_fixups->next;
   6570   1.3  christos 	  free (f);
   6571   1.3  christos 	}
   6572   1.3  christos     }
   6573   1.3  christos 
   6574   1.3  christos   workaround_change = false;
   6575   1.1  christos   newsize = trampoff;
   6576   1.3  christos   if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
   6577   1.3  christos       && (!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
   6578   1.3  christos 	  || isec->output_section->alignment_power >= htab->params->pagesize_p2))
   6579   1.3  christos     {
   6580   1.3  christos       bfd_vma addr, end_addr;
   6581   1.3  christos       unsigned int crossings;
   6582   1.3  christos       bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2;
   6583   1.3  christos 
   6584  1.10  christos       addr = isec->output_section->vma + isec->output_offset;
   6585   1.3  christos       end_addr = addr + trampoff;
   6586   1.3  christos       addr &= -pagesize;
   6587   1.3  christos       crossings = ((end_addr & -pagesize) - addr) >> htab->params->pagesize_p2;
   6588   1.1  christos       if (crossings != 0)
   6589   1.3  christos 	{
   6590   1.3  christos 	  /* Keep space aligned, to ensure the patch code itself does
   6591   1.1  christos 	     not cross a page.  Don't decrease size calculated on a
   6592   1.3  christos 	     previous pass as otherwise we might never settle on a layout.  */
   6593   1.3  christos 	  newsize = 15 - ((end_addr - 1) & 15);
   6594   1.3  christos 	  newsize += crossings * 16;
   6595   1.3  christos 	  if (relax_info->workaround_size < newsize)
   6596   1.3  christos 	    {
   6597   1.3  christos 	      relax_info->workaround_size = newsize;
   6598   1.3  christos 	      workaround_change = true;
   6599   1.1  christos 	    }
   6600   1.3  christos 	  /* Ensure relocate_section is called.  */
   6601   1.3  christos 	  isec->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
   6602   1.1  christos 	}
   6603   1.1  christos       newsize = trampoff + relax_info->workaround_size;
   6604   1.1  christos     }
   6605   1.1  christos 
   6606   1.1  christos   if (htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
   6607   1.1  christos     {
   6608   1.1  christos       picfixup_size -= relax_info->picfixup_size;
   6609   1.1  christos       if (picfixup_size != 0)
   6610   1.1  christos 	relax_info->picfixup_size += picfixup_size;
   6611   1.1  christos       newsize += relax_info->picfixup_size;
   6612   1.1  christos     }
   6613   1.1  christos 
   6614   1.1  christos   if (changes != 0 || picfixup_size != 0 || workaround_change)
   6615   1.1  christos     isec->size = newsize;
   6616   1.1  christos 
   6617   1.1  christos   if (isymbuf != NULL
   6618   1.1  christos       && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) isymbuf)
   6619   1.1  christos     {
   6620   1.1  christos       if (! link_info->keep_memory)
   6621   1.1  christos 	free (isymbuf);
   6622   1.1  christos       else
   6623   1.1  christos 	{
   6624   1.1  christos 	  /* Cache the symbols for elf_link_input_bfd.  */
   6625   1.1  christos 	  symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) isymbuf;
   6626   1.1  christos 	}
   6627   1.3  christos     }
   6628   1.1  christos 
   6629   1.1  christos   if (contents != NULL
   6630   1.1  christos       && elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
   6631   1.1  christos     {
   6632  1.12  christos       if (!changes && !link_info->keep_memory)
   6633  1.12  christos 	free (contents);
   6634  1.12  christos       else
   6635  1.12  christos 	{
   6636  1.12  christos 	  /* Cache the section contents for elf_link_input_bfd.  */
   6637   1.1  christos 	  elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents = contents;
   6638  1.12  christos 	}
   6639   1.1  christos     }
   6640  1.12  christos 
   6641   1.1  christos   changes += picfixup_size;
   6642   1.1  christos   if (changes != 0)
   6643  1.10  christos     {
   6644   1.1  christos       /* Append sufficient NOP relocs so we can write out relocation
   6645   1.1  christos 	 information for the trampolines.  */
   6646   1.3  christos       size_t old_size = isec->reloc_count * sizeof (*internal_relocs);
   6647  1.10  christos       size_t extra_size = changes * sizeof (*internal_relocs);
   6648   1.1  christos       internal_relocs = bfd_realloc (internal_relocs, old_size + extra_size);
   6649   1.1  christos       elf_section_data (isec)->relocs = internal_relocs;
   6650   1.3  christos       if (!internal_relocs)
   6651   1.3  christos 	goto error_return;
   6652   1.3  christos       memset ((char *) internal_relocs + old_size, 0, extra_size);
   6653   1.3  christos       isec->reloc_count += changes;
   6654   1.3  christos       Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (isec);
   6655   1.3  christos       rel_hdr->sh_size += changes * rel_hdr->sh_entsize;
   6656  1.10  christos     }
   6657   1.1  christos   else if (elf_section_data (isec)->relocs != internal_relocs)
   6658  1.10  christos     free (internal_relocs);
   6659   1.1  christos 
   6660  1.10  christos   *again = changes != 0 || workaround_change;
   6661   1.1  christos   return true;
   6662  1.10  christos 
   6663   1.1  christos  error_return:
   6664   1.1  christos   while (branch_fixups != NULL)
   6665   1.1  christos     {
   6666   1.1  christos       struct one_branch_fixup *f = branch_fixups;
   6667   1.1  christos       branch_fixups = branch_fixups->next;
   6668   1.1  christos       free (f);
   6669   1.1  christos     }
   6670   1.1  christos   if ((unsigned char *) isymbuf != symtab_hdr->contents)
   6671   1.1  christos     free (isymbuf);
   6672   1.1  christos   if (elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
   6673   1.1  christos     free (contents);
   6674   1.1  christos   if (elf_section_data (isec)->relocs != internal_relocs)
   6675   1.1  christos     free (internal_relocs);
   6676   1.1  christos   return false;
   6677   1.1  christos }
   6678   1.1  christos 
   6679   1.1  christos /* What to do when ld finds relocations against symbols defined in
   6681   1.1  christos    discarded sections.  */
   6682   1.1  christos 
   6683   1.1  christos static unsigned int
   6684   1.1  christos ppc_elf_action_discarded (asection *sec)
   6685   1.1  christos {
   6686   1.1  christos   if (strcmp (".fixup", sec->name) == 0)
   6687   1.1  christos     return 0;
   6688   1.1  christos 
   6689   1.1  christos   if (strcmp (".got2", sec->name) == 0)
   6690   1.1  christos     return 0;
   6691   1.1  christos 
   6692   1.1  christos   return _bfd_elf_default_action_discarded (sec);
   6693   1.1  christos }
   6694   1.1  christos 
   6695   1.1  christos /* Fill in the address for a pointer generated in a linker section.  */
   6697   1.1  christos 
   6698   1.1  christos static bfd_vma
   6699   1.1  christos elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (bfd *input_bfd,
   6700   1.1  christos 				   elf_linker_section_t *lsect,
   6701   1.1  christos 				   struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
   6702   1.1  christos 				   bfd_vma relocation,
   6703   1.1  christos 				   const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
   6704   1.1  christos {
   6705   1.1  christos   elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_ptr;
   6706   1.1  christos 
   6707   1.1  christos   BFD_ASSERT (lsect != NULL);
   6708   1.1  christos 
   6709   1.1  christos   if (h != NULL)
   6710   1.1  christos     {
   6711   1.1  christos       /* Handle global symbol.  */
   6712   1.1  christos       struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh;
   6713   1.1  christos 
   6714   1.1  christos       eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
   6715   1.1  christos       BFD_ASSERT (eh->elf.def_regular);
   6716   1.1  christos       linker_section_ptr = eh->linker_section_pointer;
   6717   1.1  christos     }
   6718   1.1  christos   else
   6719   1.1  christos     {
   6720   1.1  christos       /* Handle local symbol.  */
   6721   1.1  christos       unsigned long r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
   6722   1.1  christos 
   6723   1.1  christos       BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (input_bfd));
   6724   1.1  christos       BFD_ASSERT (elf_local_ptr_offsets (input_bfd) != NULL);
   6725   1.1  christos       linker_section_ptr = elf_local_ptr_offsets (input_bfd)[r_symndx];
   6726   1.1  christos     }
   6727   1.1  christos 
   6728   1.1  christos   linker_section_ptr = elf_find_pointer_linker_section (linker_section_ptr,
   6729   1.1  christos 							rel->r_addend,
   6730   1.1  christos 							lsect);
   6731   1.1  christos   BFD_ASSERT (linker_section_ptr != NULL);
   6732   1.1  christos 
   6733   1.1  christos   /* Offset will always be a multiple of four, so use the bottom bit
   6734   1.1  christos      as a "written" flag.  */
   6735   1.1  christos   if ((linker_section_ptr->offset & 1) == 0)
   6736   1.1  christos     {
   6737   1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (lsect->section->owner,
   6738   1.1  christos 		  relocation + linker_section_ptr->addend,
   6739   1.1  christos 		  lsect->section->contents + linker_section_ptr->offset);
   6740   1.1  christos       linker_section_ptr->offset += 1;
   6741   1.1  christos     }
   6742   1.1  christos 
   6743   1.1  christos   relocation = (lsect->section->output_section->vma
   6744   1.1  christos 		+ lsect->section->output_offset
   6745   1.1  christos 		+ linker_section_ptr->offset - 1
   6746   1.7  christos 		- SYM_VAL (lsect->sym));
   6747   1.7  christos 
   6748   1.1  christos #ifdef DEBUG
   6749   1.1  christos   fprintf (stderr,
   6750   1.1  christos 	   "Finish pointer in linker section %s, offset = %ld (0x%lx)\n",
   6751   1.1  christos 	   lsect->name, (long) relocation, (long) relocation);
   6752   1.1  christos #endif
   6753   1.7  christos 
   6754   1.7  christos   return relocation;
   6755   1.7  christos }
   6756   1.7  christos 
   6757   1.7  christos #define PPC_LO(v) ((v) & 0xffff)
   6758   1.7  christos #define PPC_HI(v) (((v) >> 16) & 0xffff)
   6759   1.7  christos #define PPC_HA(v) PPC_HI ((v) + 0x8000)
   6760   1.7  christos 
   6761   1.7  christos static void
   6762   1.7  christos write_glink_stub (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, struct plt_entry *ent,
   6763   1.7  christos 		  asection *plt_sec, unsigned char *p,
   6764   1.7  christos 		  struct bfd_link_info *info)
   6765   1.7  christos {
   6766   1.7  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   6767   1.7  christos   bfd *output_bfd = info->output_bfd;
   6768   1.7  christos   bfd_vma plt;
   6769   1.7  christos   unsigned char *end = p + GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, h);
   6770   1.7  christos 
   6771   1.7  christos   if (h != NULL
   6772   1.7  christos       && h == htab->tls_get_addr
   6773   1.7  christos       && !htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt)
   6774   1.7  christos     {
   6775   1.7  christos       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_3, p);
   6776   1.1  christos       p += 4;
   6777   1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_3 + 4, p);
   6778   1.1  christos       p += 4;
   6779   1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MR_0_3, p);
   6780   1.1  christos       p += 4;
   6781   1.3  christos       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, CMPWI_11_0, p);
   6782   1.1  christos       p += 4;
   6783   1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_3_12_2, p);
   6784   1.1  christos       p += 4;
   6785   1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BEQLR, p);
   6786   1.1  christos       p += 4;
   6787   1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MR_3_0, p);
   6788   1.1  christos       p += 4;
   6789   1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, p);
   6790   1.1  christos       p += 4;
   6791   1.1  christos     }
   6792   1.1  christos 
   6793   1.1  christos   plt = ((ent->plt.offset & ~1)
   6794   1.1  christos 	 + plt_sec->output_section->vma
   6795   1.7  christos 	 + plt_sec->output_offset);
   6796   1.1  christos 
   6797   1.1  christos   if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   6798   1.1  christos     {
   6799   1.1  christos       bfd_vma got = 0;
   6800   1.1  christos 
   6801   1.1  christos       if (ent->addend >= 32768)
   6802   1.1  christos 	got = (ent->addend
   6803   1.1  christos 	       + ent->sec->output_section->vma
   6804   1.1  christos 	       + ent->sec->output_offset);
   6805   1.1  christos       else if (htab->elf.hgot != NULL)
   6806   1.1  christos 	got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
   6807   1.1  christos 
   6808   1.7  christos       plt -= got;
   6809   1.7  christos 
   6810   1.7  christos       if (plt + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
   6811   1.7  christos 	bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_30 + PPC_LO (plt), p);
   6812   1.7  christos       else
   6813   1.7  christos 	{
   6814   1.7  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_30 + PPC_HA (plt), p);
   6815   1.7  christos 	  p += 4;
   6816   1.7  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_11 + PPC_LO (plt), p);
   6817   1.1  christos 	}
   6818   1.1  christos     }
   6819   1.1  christos   else
   6820   1.1  christos     {
   6821   1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LIS_11 + PPC_HA (plt), p);
   6822   1.1  christos       p += 4;
   6823  1.10  christos       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_11 + PPC_LO (plt), p);
   6824   1.1  christos     }
   6825   1.1  christos   p += 4;
   6826   1.1  christos   bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_11, p);
   6827   1.1  christos   p += 4;
   6828   1.1  christos   bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCTR, p);
   6829   1.1  christos   p += 4;
   6830   1.1  christos   while (p < end)
   6831   1.1  christos     {
   6832   1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? BA : NOP, p);
   6833   1.1  christos       p += 4;
   6834   1.1  christos     }
   6835   1.1  christos }
   6836   1.1  christos 
   6837   1.1  christos /* Return true if symbol is defined statically.  */
   6838   1.1  christos 
   6839   1.1  christos static bool
   6840   1.1  christos is_static_defined (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
   6841   1.9  christos {
   6842   1.1  christos   return ((h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
   6843   1.1  christos 	   || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
   6844   1.1  christos 	  && h->root.u.def.section != NULL
   6845   1.1  christos 	  && h->root.u.def.section->output_section != NULL);
   6846   1.1  christos }
   6847   1.1  christos 
   6848   1.1  christos /* If INSN is an opcode that may be used with an @tls operand, return
   6849   1.1  christos    the transformed insn for TLS optimisation, otherwise return 0.  If
   6850   1.1  christos    REG is non-zero only match an insn with RB or RA equal to REG.  */
   6851   1.1  christos 
   6852   1.1  christos unsigned int
   6853   1.1  christos _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tls_transform (unsigned int insn, unsigned int reg)
   6854   1.1  christos {
   6855   1.1  christos   unsigned int rtra;
   6856   1.1  christos 
   6857   1.1  christos   if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) != 31 << 26)
   6858   1.1  christos     return 0;
   6859   1.9  christos 
   6860   1.1  christos   if (reg == 0 || ((insn >> 11) & 0x1f) == reg)
   6861   1.1  christos     rtra = insn & ((1 << 26) - (1 << 16));
   6862   1.9  christos   else if (((insn >> 16) & 0x1f) == reg)
   6863   1.1  christos     rtra = (insn & (0x1f << 21)) | ((insn & (0x1f << 11)) << 5);
   6864   1.1  christos   else
   6865   1.9  christos     return 0;
   6866   1.1  christos 
   6867   1.1  christos   if ((insn & (0x3ff << 1)) == 266 << 1)
   6868   1.1  christos     /* add -> addi.  */
   6869   1.1  christos     insn = 14 << 26;
   6870   1.1  christos   else if ((insn & (0x1f << 1)) == 23 << 1
   6871   1.1  christos 	   && ((insn & (0x1f << 6)) < 14 << 6
   6872   1.1  christos 	       || ((insn & (0x1f << 6)) >= 16 << 6
   6873   1.1  christos 		   && (insn & (0x1f << 6)) < 24 << 6)))
   6874   1.1  christos     /* load and store indexed -> dform.  */
   6875   1.1  christos     insn = (32u | ((insn >> 6) & 0x1f)) << 26;
   6876   1.1  christos   else if ((insn & (((0x1a << 5) | 0x1f) << 1)) == 21 << 1)
   6877   1.1  christos     /* ldx, ldux, stdx, stdux -> ld, ldu, std, stdu.  */
   6878   1.1  christos     insn = ((58u | ((insn >> 6) & 4)) << 26) | ((insn >> 6) & 1);
   6879   1.1  christos   else if ((insn & (((0x1f << 5) | 0x1f) << 1)) == 341 << 1)
   6880   1.9  christos     /* lwax -> lwa.  */
   6881   1.9  christos     insn = (58u << 26) | 2;
   6882   1.9  christos   else
   6883   1.9  christos     return 0;
   6884   1.9  christos   insn |= rtra;
   6885   1.9  christos   return insn;
   6886   1.9  christos }
   6887   1.9  christos 
   6888   1.9  christos /* If INSN is an opcode that may be used with an @tprel operand, return
   6889   1.9  christos    the transformed insn for an undefined weak symbol, ie. with the
   6890   1.9  christos    thread pointer REG operand removed.  Otherwise return 0.  */
   6891   1.9  christos 
   6892   1.9  christos unsigned int
   6893   1.9  christos _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tprel_transform (unsigned int insn, unsigned int reg)
   6894   1.9  christos {
   6895   1.9  christos   if ((insn & (0x1f << 16)) == reg << 16
   6896   1.1  christos       && ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 14u << 26 /* addi */
   6897   1.9  christos 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 15u << 26 /* addis */
   6898   1.1  christos 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 32u << 26 /* lwz */
   6899   1.1  christos 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 34u << 26 /* lbz */
   6900   1.1  christos 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 36u << 26 /* stw */
   6901   1.1  christos 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 38u << 26 /* stb */
   6902   1.1  christos 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 40u << 26 /* lhz */
   6903   1.9  christos 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 42u << 26 /* lha */
   6904   1.9  christos 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 44u << 26 /* sth */
   6905   1.9  christos 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 46u << 26 /* lmw */
   6906   1.1  christos 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 47u << 26 /* stmw */
   6907   1.1  christos 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 48u << 26 /* lfs */
   6908   1.1  christos 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 50u << 26 /* lfd */
   6909   1.9  christos 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 52u << 26 /* stfs */
   6910   1.1  christos 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 54u << 26 /* stfd */
   6911   1.1  christos 	  || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* lwa,ld,lmd */
   6912   1.1  christos 	      && (insn & 3) != 1)
   6913   1.1  christos 	  || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std, stmd */
   6914   1.1  christos 	      && ((insn & 3) == 0 || (insn & 3) == 3))))
   6915   1.1  christos     {
   6916   1.1  christos       insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
   6917  1.10  christos     }
   6918   1.1  christos   else if ((insn & (0x1f << 21)) == reg << 21
   6919   1.1  christos 	   && ((insn & (0x3eu << 26)) == 24u << 26 /* ori, oris */
   6920   1.9  christos 	       || (insn & (0x3eu << 26)) == 26u << 26 /* xori,xoris */
   6921   1.9  christos 	       || (insn & (0x3eu << 26)) == 28u << 26 /* andi,andis */))
   6922   1.9  christos     {
   6923   1.9  christos       insn &= ~(0x1f << 21);
   6924   1.1  christos       insn |= (insn & (0x1f << 16)) << 5;
   6925   1.1  christos       if ((insn & (0x3eu << 26)) == 26u << 26 /* xori,xoris */)
   6926  1.10  christos 	insn -= 2 >> 26;  /* convert to ori,oris */
   6927   1.1  christos     }
   6928   1.1  christos   else
   6929   1.9  christos     insn = 0;
   6930   1.9  christos   return insn;
   6931   1.3  christos }
   6932   1.1  christos 
   6933   1.1  christos static bool
   6934  1.11  christos is_insn_ds_form (unsigned int insn)
   6935  1.11  christos {
   6936  1.11  christos   return ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* ld,ldu,lwa */
   6937  1.11  christos 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std,stdu,stq */
   6938  1.11  christos 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 57u << 26 /* lfdp */
   6939  1.11  christos 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 61u << 26 /* stfdp */);
   6940  1.11  christos }
   6941  1.11  christos 
   6942  1.11  christos static bool
   6943  1.11  christos is_insn_dq_form (unsigned int insn)
   6944  1.11  christos {
   6945  1.11  christos   return ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 56u << 26 /* lq */
   6946  1.11  christos 	  || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (61u << 26) /* lxv, stxv */
   6947  1.11  christos 	      && (insn & 3) == 1));
   6948  1.11  christos }
   6949  1.11  christos 
   6950  1.11  christos static bool
   6951   1.1  christos swap_reloc_out (bfd *obfd, Elf_Internal_Rela *rel, bfd_byte *loc, asection *s)
   6952   1.1  christos {
   6953   1.1  christos   if ((size_t) (loc - s->contents) >= s->size)
   6954   1.1  christos     return false;
   6955   1.1  christos   bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (obfd, rel, loc);
   6956   1.1  christos   return true;
   6957   1.1  christos }
   6958   1.1  christos 
   6959   1.1  christos static bool
   6960   1.1  christos count_and_swap_reloc_out (bfd *obfd, Elf_Internal_Rela *rel, asection *s)
   6961   1.1  christos {
   6962   1.1  christos   bfd_byte *loc = s->contents;
   6963   1.1  christos   loc += s->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   6964   1.1  christos   return swap_reloc_out (obfd, rel, loc, s);
   6965   1.1  christos }
   6966   1.1  christos 
   6967   1.1  christos /* The RELOCATE_SECTION function is called by the ELF backend linker
   6968   1.1  christos    to handle the relocations for a section.
   6969   1.1  christos 
   6970   1.1  christos    The relocs are always passed as Rela structures; if the section
   6971   1.1  christos    actually uses Rel structures, the r_addend field will always be
   6972   1.1  christos    zero.
   6973   1.1  christos 
   6974   1.1  christos    This function is responsible for adjust the section contents as
   6975   1.1  christos    necessary, and (if using Rela relocs and generating a
   6976   1.1  christos    relocatable output file) adjusting the reloc addend as
   6977   1.1  christos    necessary.
   6978   1.1  christos 
   6979   1.1  christos    This function does not have to worry about setting the reloc
   6980  1.10  christos    address or the reloc symbol index.
   6981   1.1  christos 
   6982   1.1  christos    LOCAL_SYMS is a pointer to the swapped in local symbols.
   6983   1.1  christos 
   6984   1.1  christos    LOCAL_SECTIONS is an array giving the section in the input file
   6985   1.1  christos    corresponding to the st_shndx field of each local symbol.
   6986   1.1  christos 
   6987   1.1  christos    The global hash table entry for the global symbols can be found
   6988   1.1  christos    via elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd).
   6989   1.1  christos 
   6990   1.1  christos    When generating relocatable output, this function must handle
   6991   1.1  christos    STB_LOCAL/STT_SECTION symbols specially.  The output symbol is
   6992   1.1  christos    going to be the section symbol corresponding to the output
   6993   1.1  christos    section, which means that the addend must be adjusted
   6994   1.3  christos    accordingly.  */
   6995   1.1  christos 
   6996   1.1  christos static int
   6997   1.3  christos ppc_elf_relocate_section (bfd *output_bfd,
   6998   1.1  christos 			  struct bfd_link_info *info,
   6999  1.10  christos 			  bfd *input_bfd,
   7000   1.7  christos 			  asection *input_section,
   7001  1.10  christos 			  bfd_byte *contents,
   7002   1.3  christos 			  Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs,
   7003   1.3  christos 			  Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
   7004   1.1  christos 			  asection **local_sections)
   7005   1.1  christos {
   7006   1.7  christos   Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
   7007   1.1  christos   struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
   7008   1.1  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
   7009   1.1  christos   Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
   7010   1.3  christos   Elf_Internal_Rela *wrel;
   7011   1.1  christos   Elf_Internal_Rela *relend;
   7012   1.1  christos   Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
   7013   1.9  christos   asection *got2;
   7014   1.9  christos   bfd_vma *local_got_offsets;
   7015   1.9  christos   bool ret = true;
   7016  1.10  christos   bfd_vma d_offset = (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd) ? 2 : 0);
   7017   1.9  christos   bool is_vxworks_tls;
   7018   1.9  christos   unsigned int picfixup_size = 0;
   7019   1.1  christos   struct ppc_elf_relax_info *relax_info = NULL;
   7020   1.1  christos 
   7021   1.1  christos #ifdef DEBUG
   7022   1.1  christos   _bfd_error_handler ("ppc_elf_relocate_section called for %pB section %pA, "
   7023   1.1  christos 		      "%ld relocations%s",
   7024   1.1  christos 		      input_bfd, input_section,
   7025   1.1  christos 		      (long) input_section->reloc_count,
   7026   1.1  christos 		      (bfd_link_relocatable (info)) ? " (relocatable)" : "");
   7027   1.1  christos #endif
   7028   1.1  christos 
   7029   1.1  christos   if (!is_ppc_elf (input_bfd))
   7030   1.1  christos     {
   7031  1.10  christos       bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
   7032   1.1  christos       return false;
   7033   1.1  christos     }
   7034   1.3  christos 
   7035   1.3  christos   got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (input_bfd, ".got2");
   7036   1.3  christos 
   7037   1.1  christos   /* Initialize howto table if not already done.  */
   7038   1.3  christos   if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
   7039   1.1  christos     ppc_elf_howto_init ();
   7040   1.1  christos 
   7041   1.1  christos   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   7042   1.1  christos   local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (input_bfd);
   7043   1.1  christos   symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (input_bfd);
   7044   1.1  christos   sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd);
   7045   1.1  christos   /* We have to handle relocations in vxworks .tls_vars sections
   7046   1.1  christos      specially, because the dynamic loader is 'weird'.  */
   7047   1.1  christos   is_vxworks_tls = (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks && bfd_link_pic (info)
   7048   1.1  christos 		    && !strcmp (input_section->output_section->name,
   7049   1.1  christos 				".tls_vars"));
   7050   1.1  christos   if (input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET)
   7051  1.10  christos     relax_info = elf_section_data (input_section)->sec_info;
   7052  1.10  christos   rel = wrel = relocs;
   7053   1.1  christos   relend = relocs + input_section->reloc_count;
   7054   1.7  christos   for (; rel < relend; wrel++, rel++)
   7055   1.3  christos     {
   7056   1.1  christos       enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
   7057   1.3  christos       bfd_vma addend;
   7058   1.1  christos       bfd_reloc_status_type r;
   7059   1.1  christos       Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
   7060   1.1  christos       asection *sec;
   7061   1.1  christos       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
   7062  1.10  christos       const char *sym_name;
   7063  1.10  christos       reloc_howto_type *howto;
   7064   1.1  christos       unsigned long r_symndx;
   7065   1.1  christos       bfd_vma relocation;
   7066   1.1  christos       bfd_vma branch_bit, from;
   7067   1.1  christos       bool unresolved_reloc, save_unresolved_reloc;
   7068   1.1  christos       bool warned;
   7069   1.1  christos       unsigned int tls_type, tls_mask, tls_gd;
   7070   1.1  christos       struct plt_entry **ifunc, **plt_list;
   7071   1.1  christos       struct reloc_howto_struct alt_howto;
   7072   1.1  christos 
   7073   1.1  christos     again:
   7074   1.1  christos       r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
   7075   1.1  christos       sym = NULL;
   7076  1.10  christos       sec = NULL;
   7077   1.3  christos       h = NULL;
   7078   1.1  christos       unresolved_reloc = false;
   7079   1.1  christos       warned = false;
   7080   1.1  christos       r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
   7081   1.3  christos 
   7082   1.1  christos       if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
   7083   1.1  christos 	{
   7084   1.1  christos 	  sym = local_syms + r_symndx;
   7085   1.1  christos 	  sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
   7086   1.1  christos 	  sym_name = bfd_elf_sym_name (input_bfd, symtab_hdr, sym, sec);
   7087   1.1  christos 
   7088   1.1  christos 	  relocation = _bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (output_bfd, sym, &sec, rel);
   7089   1.1  christos 	}
   7090   1.1  christos       else
   7091   1.1  christos 	{
   7092   1.1  christos 	  bool ignored;
   7093   1.1  christos 
   7094   1.3  christos 	  RELOC_FOR_GLOBAL_SYMBOL (info, input_bfd, input_section, rel,
   7095   1.3  christos 				   r_symndx, symtab_hdr, sym_hashes,
   7096   1.9  christos 				   h, sec, relocation,
   7097   1.3  christos 				   unresolved_reloc, warned, ignored);
   7098   1.3  christos 
   7099   1.3  christos 	  sym_name = h->root.root.string;
   7100   1.3  christos 	}
   7101   1.3  christos 
   7102   1.7  christos       if (sec != NULL && discarded_section (sec))
   7103   1.3  christos 	{
   7104   1.3  christos 	  /* For relocs against symbols from removed linkonce sections,
   7105   1.3  christos 	     or sections discarded by a linker script, we just want the
   7106   1.3  christos 	     section contents zeroed.  Avoid any special processing.  */
   7107   1.3  christos 	  howto = NULL;
   7108   1.3  christos 	  if (r_type < R_PPC_max)
   7109   1.3  christos 	    howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
   7110   1.1  christos 
   7111   1.1  christos 	  _bfd_clear_contents (howto, input_bfd, input_section,
   7112   1.3  christos 			       contents, rel->r_offset);
   7113   1.1  christos 	  wrel->r_offset = rel->r_offset;
   7114   1.1  christos 	  wrel->r_info = 0;
   7115   1.1  christos 	  wrel->r_addend = 0;
   7116   1.1  christos 
   7117   1.1  christos 	  /* For ld -r, remove relocations in debug sections against
   7118   1.1  christos 	     symbols defined in discarded sections.  Not done for
   7119   1.1  christos 	     non-debug to preserve relocs in .eh_frame which the
   7120   1.1  christos 	     eh_frame editing code expects to be present.  */
   7121   1.1  christos 	  if (bfd_link_relocatable (info)
   7122   1.3  christos 	      && (input_section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING))
   7123   1.3  christos 	    wrel--;
   7124   1.3  christos 
   7125   1.3  christos 	  continue;
   7126   1.1  christos 	}
   7127   1.1  christos 
   7128   1.1  christos       if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
   7129   1.1  christos 	{
   7130   1.1  christos 	  if (got2 != NULL
   7131   1.1  christos 	      && r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
   7132   1.1  christos 	      && rel->r_addend != 0)
   7133   1.1  christos 	    {
   7134   1.1  christos 	      /* R_PPC_PLTREL24 is rather special.  If non-zero, the
   7135   1.1  christos 		 addend specifies the GOT pointer offset within .got2.  */
   7136   1.1  christos 	      rel->r_addend += got2->output_offset;
   7137   1.1  christos 	    }
   7138   1.1  christos 	  if (r_type != R_PPC_RELAX_PLT
   7139   1.1  christos 	      && r_type != R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24
   7140   1.1  christos 	      && r_type != R_PPC_RELAX)
   7141   1.1  christos 	    goto copy_reloc;
   7142   1.1  christos 	}
   7143   1.1  christos 
   7144   1.1  christos       /* TLS optimizations.  Replace instruction sequences and relocs
   7145   1.1  christos 	 based on information we collected in tls_optimize.  We edit
   7146   1.1  christos 	 RELOCS so that --emit-relocs will output something sensible
   7147   1.1  christos 	 for the final instruction stream.  */
   7148   1.1  christos       tls_mask = 0;
   7149   1.1  christos       tls_gd = 0;
   7150   1.1  christos       if (h != NULL)
   7151   1.1  christos 	tls_mask = ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h)->tls_mask;
   7152   1.1  christos       else if (local_got_offsets != NULL)
   7153   1.1  christos 	{
   7154   1.1  christos 	  struct plt_entry **local_plt;
   7155   1.1  christos 	  char *lgot_masks;
   7156   1.1  christos 	  local_plt
   7157   1.1  christos 	    = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
   7158   1.1  christos 	  lgot_masks = (char *) (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
   7159   1.1  christos 	  tls_mask = lgot_masks[r_symndx];
   7160   1.1  christos 	}
   7161   1.1  christos 
   7162   1.1  christos       /* Ensure reloc mapping code below stays sane.  */
   7163   1.1  christos       if ((R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16 & 3)    != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)
   7164  1.10  christos 	  || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO & 3)
   7165  1.10  christos 	  || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI & 3)
   7166   1.1  christos 	  || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA & 3)
   7167   1.1  christos 	  || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16 & 3)    != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16 & 3)
   7168   1.1  christos 	  || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO & 3)
   7169   1.7  christos 	  || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI & 3)
   7170   1.3  christos 	  || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA & 3))
   7171   1.1  christos 	abort ();
   7172   1.1  christos       switch (r_type)
   7173   1.7  christos 	{
   7174   1.3  christos 	default:
   7175   1.1  christos 	  break;
   7176   1.1  christos 
   7177   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
   7178   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
   7179   1.1  christos 	  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
   7180   1.1  christos 	      && (tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0
   7181   1.1  christos 	      && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4))
   7182  1.10  christos 	    {
   7183  1.10  christos 	      bfd_vma insn;
   7184   1.1  christos 
   7185   1.1  christos 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
   7186   1.1  christos 				 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
   7187   1.7  christos 	      insn &= 31 << 21;
   7188   1.1  christos 	      insn |= 0x3c020000;	/* addis 0,2,0 */
   7189   1.1  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn,
   7190   1.1  christos 			  contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
   7191   1.7  christos 	      r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA;
   7192   1.1  christos 	      rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
   7193   1.1  christos 	    }
   7194   1.1  christos 	  break;
   7195   1.1  christos 
   7196   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_TLS:
   7197   1.1  christos 	  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
   7198   1.1  christos 	      && (tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0
   7199   1.1  christos 	      && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4))
   7200   1.1  christos 	    {
   7201   1.1  christos 	      bfd_vma insn;
   7202   1.1  christos 
   7203   1.9  christos 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
   7204  1.10  christos 	      insn = _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tls_transform (insn, 2);
   7205  1.10  christos 	      if (insn == 0)
   7206   1.1  christos 		abort ();
   7207   1.1  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
   7208   1.1  christos 	      r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO;
   7209   1.1  christos 	      rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
   7210   1.1  christos 
   7211  1.10  christos 	      /* Was PPC_TLS which sits on insn boundary, now
   7212  1.10  christos 		 PPC_TPREL16_LO which is at low-order half-word.  */
   7213   1.1  christos 	      rel->r_offset += d_offset;
   7214   1.1  christos 	    }
   7215   1.1  christos 	  break;
   7216   1.1  christos 
   7217   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
   7218   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
   7219   1.1  christos 	  tls_gd = TLS_GDIE;
   7220   1.3  christos 	  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0
   7221   1.7  christos 	      && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4))
   7222   1.1  christos 	    goto tls_gdld_hi;
   7223   1.1  christos 	  break;
   7224   1.1  christos 
   7225   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
   7226   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
   7227   1.1  christos 	  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0
   7228   1.1  christos 	      && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4))
   7229   1.1  christos 	    {
   7230   1.9  christos 	    tls_gdld_hi:
   7231  1.10  christos 	      if ((tls_mask & tls_gd) != 0)
   7232  1.10  christos 		r_type = (((r_type - (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)) & 3)
   7233   1.1  christos 			  + R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16);
   7234   1.1  christos 	      else
   7235   1.1  christos 		{
   7236   1.1  christos 		  rel->r_offset -= d_offset;
   7237   1.1  christos 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + rel->r_offset);
   7238  1.10  christos 		  r_type = R_PPC_NONE;
   7239  1.10  christos 		}
   7240   1.1  christos 	      rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
   7241   1.1  christos 	    }
   7242   1.1  christos 	  break;
   7243   1.1  christos 
   7244   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
   7245   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
   7246   1.1  christos 	  tls_gd = TLS_GDIE;
   7247   1.1  christos 	  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0
   7248   1.1  christos 	      && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4))
   7249   1.1  christos 	    goto tls_ldgd_opt;
   7250   1.1  christos 	  break;
   7251   1.9  christos 
   7252   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
   7253   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
   7254   1.1  christos 	  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0
   7255   1.1  christos 	      && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4))
   7256   1.3  christos 	    {
   7257   1.3  christos 	      unsigned int insn1, insn2;
   7258   1.3  christos 	      bfd_vma offset;
   7259   1.3  christos 
   7260   1.7  christos 	    tls_ldgd_opt:
   7261   1.3  christos 	      offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
   7262   1.1  christos 	      /* If not using the newer R_PPC_TLSGD/LD to mark
   7263   1.1  christos 		 __tls_get_addr calls, we must trust that the call
   7264   1.1  christos 		 stays with its arg setup insns, ie. that the next
   7265   1.3  christos 		 reloc is the __tls_get_addr call associated with
   7266   1.9  christos 		 the current reloc.  Edit both insns.  */
   7267  1.10  christos 	      if (input_section->nomark_tls_get_addr
   7268  1.10  christos 		  && rel + 1 < relend
   7269   1.1  christos 		  && branch_reloc_hash_match (input_bfd, rel + 1,
   7270   1.1  christos 					      htab->tls_get_addr))
   7271   1.1  christos 		offset = rel[1].r_offset;
   7272   1.7  christos 	      /* We read the low GOT_TLS insn because we need to keep
   7273   1.1  christos 		 the destination reg.  It may be something other than
   7274   1.1  christos 		 the usual r3, and moved to r3 before the call by
   7275   1.1  christos 		 intervening code.  */
   7276   1.1  christos 	      insn1 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
   7277   1.1  christos 				  contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
   7278   1.1  christos 	      if ((tls_mask & tls_gd) != 0)
   7279   1.1  christos 		{
   7280   1.1  christos 		  /* IE */
   7281   1.3  christos 		  insn1 &= (0x1f << 21) | (0x1f << 16);
   7282   1.3  christos 		  insn1 |= 32u << 26;	/* lwz */
   7283   1.1  christos 		  if (offset != (bfd_vma) -1
   7284   1.1  christos 		      && offset_in_range (input_section, offset, 4))
   7285   1.1  christos 		    {
   7286   1.1  christos 		      rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
   7287   1.1  christos 		      insn2 = 0x7c631214;	/* add 3,3,2 */
   7288   1.1  christos 		      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
   7289   1.1  christos 		    }
   7290   1.1  christos 		  r_type = (((r_type - (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)) & 3)
   7291   1.1  christos 			    + R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16);
   7292   1.1  christos 		  rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
   7293   1.1  christos 		}
   7294   1.1  christos 	      else
   7295   1.1  christos 		{
   7296   1.1  christos 		  /* LE */
   7297   1.1  christos 		  insn1 &= 0x1f << 21;
   7298   1.1  christos 		  insn1 |= 0x3c020000;	/* addis r,2,0 */
   7299   1.1  christos 		  if (tls_gd == 0)
   7300   1.1  christos 		    {
   7301  1.10  christos 		      /* Was an LD reloc.  */
   7302  1.10  christos 		      for (r_symndx = 0;
   7303   1.1  christos 			   r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info;
   7304   1.1  christos 			   r_symndx++)
   7305   1.1  christos 			if (local_sections[r_symndx] == sec)
   7306   1.1  christos 			  break;
   7307   1.1  christos 		      if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
   7308   1.7  christos 			r_symndx = STN_UNDEF;
   7309   1.1  christos 		      rel->r_addend = htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
   7310   1.1  christos 		      if (r_symndx != STN_UNDEF)
   7311   1.7  christos 			rel->r_addend -= (local_syms[r_symndx].st_value
   7312   1.1  christos 					  + sec->output_offset
   7313   1.1  christos 					  + sec->output_section->vma);
   7314   1.1  christos 		    }
   7315   1.1  christos 		  r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA;
   7316   1.1  christos 		  rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
   7317   1.3  christos 		  if (offset != (bfd_vma) -1
   7318   1.1  christos 		      && offset_in_range (input_section, offset, 4))
   7319   1.1  christos 		    {
   7320   1.1  christos 		      rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_TPREL16_LO);
   7321   1.1  christos 		      rel[1].r_offset = offset + d_offset;
   7322   1.1  christos 		      rel[1].r_addend = rel->r_addend;
   7323   1.7  christos 		      insn2 = 0x38630000;	/* addi 3,3,0 */
   7324  1.10  christos 		      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
   7325  1.10  christos 		    }
   7326   1.1  christos 		}
   7327   1.1  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn1,
   7328   1.1  christos 			  contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
   7329   1.1  christos 	      if (tls_gd == 0)
   7330   1.7  christos 		{
   7331   1.7  christos 		  /* We changed the symbol on an LD reloc.  Start over
   7332   1.7  christos 		     in order to get h, sym, sec etc. right.  */
   7333   1.7  christos 		  goto again;
   7334   1.7  christos 		}
   7335   1.7  christos 	    }
   7336   1.7  christos 	  break;
   7337   1.9  christos 
   7338   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_TLSGD:
   7339   1.1  christos 	  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0
   7340   1.1  christos 	      && rel + 1 < relend
   7341   1.1  christos 	      && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4))
   7342   1.1  christos 	    {
   7343   1.1  christos 	      unsigned int insn2;
   7344   1.1  christos 	      bfd_vma offset = rel->r_offset;
   7345   1.1  christos 
   7346   1.1  christos 	      if (is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
   7347   1.1  christos 		{
   7348   1.1  christos 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + offset);
   7349   1.1  christos 		  rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
   7350   1.1  christos 		  break;
   7351   1.7  christos 		}
   7352   1.1  christos 
   7353   1.1  christos 	      if ((tls_mask & TLS_GDIE) != 0)
   7354   1.1  christos 		{
   7355   1.1  christos 		  /* IE */
   7356   1.1  christos 		  r_type = R_PPC_NONE;
   7357   1.1  christos 		  insn2 = 0x7c631214;	/* add 3,3,2 */
   7358   1.1  christos 		}
   7359   1.7  christos 	      else
   7360  1.10  christos 		{
   7361  1.10  christos 		  /* LE */
   7362   1.1  christos 		  r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO;
   7363   1.1  christos 		  rel->r_offset += d_offset;
   7364   1.1  christos 		  insn2 = 0x38630000;	/* addi 3,3,0 */
   7365   1.7  christos 		}
   7366   1.7  christos 	      rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
   7367   1.7  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
   7368   1.7  christos 	      /* Zap the reloc on the _tls_get_addr call too.  */
   7369   1.7  christos 	      BFD_ASSERT (offset == rel[1].r_offset);
   7370   1.7  christos 	      rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
   7371   1.7  christos 	    }
   7372   1.1  christos 	  break;
   7373   1.1  christos 
   7374   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_TLSLD:
   7375   1.1  christos 	  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0
   7376   1.1  christos 	      && rel + 1 < relend
   7377   1.1  christos 	      && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4))
   7378   1.1  christos 	    {
   7379   1.1  christos 	      unsigned int insn2;
   7380   1.1  christos 
   7381   1.1  christos 	      if (is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
   7382   1.1  christos 		{
   7383   1.1  christos 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + rel->r_offset);
   7384   1.1  christos 		  rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
   7385   1.1  christos 		  break;
   7386   1.1  christos 		}
   7387   1.1  christos 
   7388   1.7  christos 	      for (r_symndx = 0;
   7389   1.1  christos 		   r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info;
   7390   1.1  christos 		   r_symndx++)
   7391   1.1  christos 		if (local_sections[r_symndx] == sec)
   7392   1.1  christos 		  break;
   7393   1.3  christos 	      if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
   7394   1.1  christos 		r_symndx = STN_UNDEF;
   7395   1.1  christos 	      rel->r_addend = htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
   7396   1.1  christos 	      if (r_symndx != STN_UNDEF)
   7397   1.1  christos 		rel->r_addend -= (local_syms[r_symndx].st_value
   7398   1.1  christos 				  + sec->output_offset
   7399   1.1  christos 				  + sec->output_section->vma);
   7400   1.1  christos 
   7401   1.1  christos 	      rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_TPREL16_LO);
   7402   1.1  christos 	      rel->r_offset += d_offset;
   7403   1.1  christos 	      insn2 = 0x38630000;	/* addi 3,3,0 */
   7404   1.1  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2,
   7405   1.1  christos 			  contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
   7406   1.1  christos 	      /* Zap the reloc on the _tls_get_addr call too.  */
   7407   1.1  christos 	      BFD_ASSERT (rel->r_offset - d_offset == rel[1].r_offset);
   7408   1.1  christos 	      rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
   7409   1.7  christos 	      goto again;
   7410   1.1  christos 	    }
   7411   1.1  christos 	  break;
   7412   1.1  christos 	}
   7413   1.1  christos 
   7414  1.10  christos       /* Handle other relocations that tweak non-addend part of insn.  */
   7415  1.10  christos       branch_bit = 0;
   7416  1.10  christos       switch (r_type)
   7417   1.1  christos 	{
   7418  1.10  christos 	default:
   7419  1.10  christos 	  break;
   7420  1.10  christos 
   7421   1.1  christos 	  /* Branch taken prediction relocations.  */
   7422  1.10  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
   7423  1.10  christos 	case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
   7424  1.10  christos 	  branch_bit = BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
   7425  1.10  christos 	  /* Fall through.  */
   7426  1.10  christos 
   7427  1.10  christos 	  /* Branch not taken prediction relocations.  */
   7428  1.10  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
   7429   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
   7430  1.10  christos 	  if (offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4))
   7431  1.10  christos 	    {
   7432   1.7  christos 	      unsigned int insn;
   7433   1.7  christos 
   7434   1.7  christos 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
   7435  1.10  christos 	      insn &= ~BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
   7436  1.10  christos 	      insn |= branch_bit;
   7437  1.10  christos 
   7438   1.7  christos 	      from = (rel->r_offset
   7439  1.10  christos 		      + input_section->output_offset
   7440  1.10  christos 		      + input_section->output_section->vma);
   7441  1.10  christos 
   7442  1.10  christos 	      /* Invert 'y' bit if not the default.  */
   7443  1.10  christos 	      if ((bfd_signed_vma) (relocation + rel->r_addend - from) < 0)
   7444  1.10  christos 		insn ^= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
   7445  1.10  christos 
   7446  1.10  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
   7447  1.10  christos 	    }
   7448  1.10  christos 	  break;
   7449  1.10  christos 
   7450  1.10  christos 	case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
   7451  1.10  christos 	  if (offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4))
   7452  1.10  christos 	    {
   7453  1.10  christos 	      unsigned int insn;
   7454  1.10  christos 
   7455  1.10  christos 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
   7456  1.10  christos 				 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
   7457  1.10  christos 	      if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 15u << 26
   7458   1.7  christos 		  && (insn & (0x1f << 16)) != 0)
   7459   1.1  christos 		{
   7460   1.1  christos 		  if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
   7461   1.3  christos 		    {
   7462   1.3  christos 		      /* Convert addis to lis.  */
   7463   1.3  christos 		      insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
   7464   1.3  christos 		      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn,
   7465   1.3  christos 				  contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
   7466   1.3  christos 		    }
   7467   1.3  christos 		}
   7468   1.3  christos 	      else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   7469   1.3  christos 		info->callbacks->einfo
   7470   1.3  christos 		  (_("%P: %H: error: %s with unexpected instruction %x\n"),
   7471   1.3  christos 		   input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   7472   1.3  christos 		   "R_PPC_PLT16_HA", insn);
   7473  1.10  christos 	    }
   7474  1.10  christos 	  break;
   7475   1.3  christos 	}
   7476   1.7  christos 
   7477   1.3  christos       if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
   7478   1.9  christos 	  && h != NULL
   7479   1.3  christos 	  && !h->def_regular
   7480   1.3  christos 	  && h->protected_def
   7481   1.3  christos 	  && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha
   7482   1.3  christos 	  && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo
   7483   1.3  christos 	  && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
   7484   1.3  christos 	{
   7485   1.3  christos 	  /* Convert lis;addi or lis;load/store accessing a protected
   7486   1.3  christos 	     variable defined in a shared library to PIC.  */
   7487   1.3  christos 	  unsigned int insn;
   7488   1.3  christos 
   7489   1.3  christos 	  if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA
   7490   1.3  christos 	      && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4))
   7491   1.3  christos 	    {
   7492   1.7  christos 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
   7493   1.3  christos 				 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
   7494   1.3  christos 	      if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (15u << 26)
   7495   1.7  christos 		  && (insn & (0x1f << 16)) == 0 /* lis */)
   7496   1.3  christos 		{
   7497   1.7  christos 		  bfd_byte *p;
   7498   1.7  christos 		  bfd_vma off;
   7499   1.3  christos 		  bfd_vma got_addr;
   7500   1.3  christos 
   7501   1.3  christos 		  p = (contents + input_section->size
   7502   1.3  christos 		       - relax_info->workaround_size
   7503   1.3  christos 		       - relax_info->picfixup_size
   7504   1.7  christos 		       + picfixup_size);
   7505   1.7  christos 		  off = (p - contents) - (rel->r_offset - d_offset);
   7506   1.3  christos 		  if (off > 0x1fffffc || (off & 3) != 0)
   7507   1.3  christos 		    info->callbacks->einfo
   7508   1.3  christos 		      (_("%H: fixup branch overflow\n"),
   7509   1.3  christos 		       input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
   7510   1.3  christos 
   7511   1.3  christos 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | off,
   7512   1.7  christos 			      contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
   7513   1.3  christos 		  got_addr = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
   7514   1.7  christos 			      + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset
   7515   1.3  christos 			      + (h->got.offset & ~1));
   7516   1.3  christos 		  wrel->r_offset = (p - contents) + d_offset;
   7517   1.3  christos 		  wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
   7518   1.3  christos 		  wrel->r_addend = got_addr;
   7519   1.3  christos 		  insn &= ~0xffff;
   7520   1.3  christos 		  insn |= ((unsigned int) (got_addr + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
   7521   1.3  christos 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
   7522   1.3  christos 
   7523   1.3  christos 		  /* Convert lis to lwz, loading address from GOT.  */
   7524   1.3  christos 		  insn &= ~0xffff;
   7525   1.3  christos 		  insn ^= (32u ^ 15u) << 26;
   7526   1.3  christos 		  insn |= (insn & (0x1f << 21)) >> 5;
   7527   1.3  christos 		  insn |= got_addr & 0xffff;
   7528   1.3  christos 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p + 4);
   7529   1.3  christos 
   7530   1.7  christos 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | ((-4 - off) & 0x3ffffff), p + 8);
   7531   1.7  christos 		  picfixup_size += 12;
   7532   1.7  christos 
   7533   1.7  christos 		  /* Use one of the spare relocs, so --emit-relocs
   7534   1.7  christos 		     output is reasonable.  */
   7535   1.3  christos 		  memmove (rel + 1, rel, (relend - rel - 1) * sizeof (*rel));
   7536   1.3  christos 		  wrel++, rel++;
   7537  1.10  christos 		  rel->r_offset = wrel[-1].r_offset + 4;
   7538  1.10  christos 		  rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
   7539  1.10  christos 		  rel->r_addend = wrel[-1].r_addend;
   7540   1.3  christos 
   7541   1.7  christos 		  /* Continue on as if we had a got reloc, to output
   7542   1.3  christos 		     dynamic reloc.  */
   7543   1.9  christos 		  r_type = R_PPC_GOT16_LO;
   7544   1.9  christos 		}
   7545   1.9  christos 	      else
   7546   1.9  christos 		_bfd_error_handler
   7547   1.9  christos 		  /* xgettext:c-format */
   7548   1.9  christos 		  (_("%pB(%pA+%#" PRIx64 "): error: "
   7549   1.9  christos 		     "%s with unexpected instruction %#x"),
   7550   1.9  christos 		   input_bfd, input_section, (uint64_t) rel->r_offset,
   7551   1.9  christos 		   "R_PPC_ADDR16_HA", insn);
   7552   1.9  christos 	    }
   7553   1.9  christos 	  else if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_LO
   7554   1.9  christos 		   && offset_in_range (input_section,
   7555   1.9  christos 				       rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4))
   7556   1.9  christos 	    {
   7557   1.9  christos 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
   7558   1.3  christos 				 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
   7559   1.9  christos 	      if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 14u << 26    /* addi */
   7560   1.3  christos 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 32u << 26 /* lwz */
   7561   1.3  christos 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 34u << 26 /* lbz */
   7562   1.3  christos 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 36u << 26 /* stw */
   7563   1.3  christos 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 38u << 26 /* stb */
   7564  1.10  christos 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 40u << 26 /* lhz */
   7565   1.3  christos 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 42u << 26 /* lha */
   7566   1.3  christos 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 44u << 26 /* sth */
   7567   1.3  christos 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 46u << 26 /* lmw */
   7568   1.7  christos 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 47u << 26 /* stmw */
   7569   1.7  christos 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 48u << 26 /* lfs */
   7570   1.7  christos 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 50u << 26 /* lfd */
   7571   1.7  christos 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 52u << 26 /* stfs */
   7572   1.7  christos 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 54u << 26 /* stfd */
   7573   1.3  christos 		  || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* lwa,ld,lmd */
   7574   1.3  christos 		      && (insn & 3) != 1)
   7575   1.3  christos 		  || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std, stmd */
   7576   1.3  christos 		      && ((insn & 3) == 0 || (insn & 3) == 3)))
   7577   1.1  christos 		{
   7578  1.10  christos 		  /* Arrange to apply the reloc addend, if any.  */
   7579   1.1  christos 		  relocation = 0;
   7580   1.1  christos 		  unresolved_reloc = false;
   7581   1.1  christos 		  rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, r_type);
   7582   1.1  christos 		}
   7583   1.1  christos 	      else
   7584   1.1  christos 		_bfd_error_handler
   7585   1.1  christos 		  /* xgettext:c-format */
   7586   1.1  christos 		  (_("%pB(%pA+%#" PRIx64 "): error: "
   7587   1.1  christos 		     "%s with unexpected instruction %#x"),
   7588   1.1  christos 		   input_bfd, input_section, (uint64_t) rel->r_offset,
   7589   1.1  christos 		   "R_PPC_ADDR16_LO", insn);
   7590   1.1  christos 	    }
   7591   1.1  christos 	}
   7592   1.1  christos 
   7593   1.1  christos       ifunc = NULL;
   7594   1.1  christos       if (htab->elf.target_os != is_vxworks)
   7595   1.1  christos 	{
   7596   1.1  christos 	  struct plt_entry *ent;
   7597   1.1  christos 
   7598   1.1  christos 	  if (h != NULL)
   7599   1.3  christos 	    {
   7600   1.7  christos 	      if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
   7601   1.7  christos 		ifunc = &h->plt.plist;
   7602   1.7  christos 	    }
   7603   1.7  christos 	  else if (local_got_offsets != NULL
   7604   1.1  christos 		   && ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
   7605   1.1  christos 	    {
   7606   1.7  christos 	      struct plt_entry **local_plt;
   7607   1.7  christos 
   7608   1.7  christos 	      local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets
   7609   1.7  christos 						 + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
   7610   1.7  christos 	      ifunc = local_plt + r_symndx;
   7611   1.1  christos 	    }
   7612   1.1  christos 
   7613   1.1  christos 	  ent = NULL;
   7614   1.1  christos 	  if (ifunc != NULL
   7615   1.1  christos 	      && (!bfd_link_pic (info)
   7616   1.7  christos 		  || is_branch_reloc (r_type)
   7617   1.7  christos 		  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
   7618   1.7  christos 		  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
   7619   1.7  christos 		  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
   7620   1.7  christos 	    {
   7621   1.7  christos 	      addend = 0;
   7622   1.1  christos 	      if (bfd_link_pic (info)
   7623   1.7  christos 		  && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
   7624   1.7  christos 		      || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
   7625   1.7  christos 		      || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
   7626   1.7  christos 		      || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
   7627   1.7  christos 		addend = rel->r_addend;
   7628   1.7  christos 	      ent = find_plt_ent (ifunc, got2, addend);
   7629   1.7  christos 	    }
   7630   1.7  christos 	  if (ent != NULL)
   7631   1.7  christos 	    {
   7632   1.7  christos 	      if (bfd_link_pic (info)
   7633   1.7  christos 		  && ent->sec != got2
   7634   1.7  christos 		  && htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW
   7635   1.7  christos 		  && (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
   7636   1.1  christos 		      || h == NULL
   7637   1.1  christos 		      || h->dynindx == -1))
   7638  1.10  christos 		{
   7639   1.1  christos 		  /* Uh oh, we are going to create a pic glink stub
   7640   1.1  christos 		     for an ifunc (here for h == NULL and later in
   7641   1.3  christos 		     finish_dynamic_symbol for h != NULL), and
   7642   1.3  christos 		     apparently are using code compiled with
   7643   1.1  christos 		     -mbss-plt.  The difficulty is that -mbss-plt code
   7644   1.1  christos 		     gives no indication via a magic PLTREL24 addend
   7645   1.1  christos 		     whether r30 is equal to _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ or
   7646   1.1  christos 		     is pointing into a .got2 section (and how far
   7647   1.7  christos 		     into .got2).  */
   7648   1.7  christos 		    info->callbacks->einfo
   7649   1.1  christos 		      /* xgettext:c-format */
   7650   1.1  christos 		      (_("%X%H: unsupported bss-plt -fPIC ifunc %s\n"),
   7651   1.1  christos 		       input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset, sym_name);
   7652   1.1  christos 		}
   7653   1.1  christos 
   7654   1.7  christos 	      unresolved_reloc = false;
   7655   1.1  christos 	      if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
   7656   1.1  christos 		  || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
   7657   1.1  christos 		  || h == NULL
   7658   1.7  christos 		  || h->dynindx == -1)
   7659   1.7  christos 		relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
   7660   1.7  christos 			      + htab->glink->output_offset
   7661   1.1  christos 			      + (ent->glink_offset & ~1));
   7662   1.1  christos 	      else
   7663  1.10  christos 		relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
   7664  1.10  christos 			      + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
   7665  1.10  christos 			      + ent->plt.offset);
   7666  1.10  christos 	    }
   7667  1.10  christos 	}
   7668  1.10  christos 
   7669  1.10  christos       addend = rel->r_addend;
   7670  1.10  christos       save_unresolved_reloc = unresolved_reloc;
   7671  1.10  christos       howto = NULL;
   7672   1.1  christos       if (r_type < R_PPC_max)
   7673   1.1  christos 	howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
   7674  1.10  christos 
   7675   1.3  christos       tls_type = 0;
   7676   1.1  christos       switch (r_type)
   7677   1.1  christos 	{
   7678   1.1  christos 	default:
   7679   1.1  christos 	de_fault:
   7680   1.1  christos 	  if (howto)
   7681   1.1  christos 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   7682   1.1  christos 	    _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: %s unsupported"),
   7683   1.1  christos 				input_bfd, howto->name);
   7684   1.3  christos 	  else
   7685   1.1  christos 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   7686   1.1  christos 	    _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: reloc %#x unsupported"),
   7687   1.1  christos 				input_bfd, r_type);
   7688   1.1  christos 
   7689   1.1  christos 	  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
   7690   1.1  christos 	  ret = false;
   7691   1.1  christos 	  goto copy_reloc;
   7692   1.1  christos 
   7693   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_NONE:
   7694   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_TLS:
   7695   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_TLSGD:
   7696   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_TLSLD:
   7697   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF:
   7698   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT:
   7699   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY:
   7700   1.1  christos 	  goto copy_reloc;
   7701   1.1  christos 
   7702   1.1  christos 	  /* GOT16 relocations.  Like an ADDR16 using the symbol's
   7703   1.1  christos 	     address in the GOT as relocation value instead of the
   7704   1.1  christos 	     symbol's value itself.  Also, create a GOT entry for the
   7705   1.1  christos 	     symbol and put the symbol value there.  */
   7706   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
   7707   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
   7708   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
   7709   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
   7710   1.1  christos 	  tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
   7711   1.1  christos 	  goto dogot;
   7712   1.1  christos 
   7713   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
   7714   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
   7715   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
   7716   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
   7717   1.1  christos 	  tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
   7718   1.1  christos 	  goto dogot;
   7719   1.1  christos 
   7720   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
   7721   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
   7722   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
   7723   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
   7724   1.1  christos 	  tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
   7725   1.1  christos 	  goto dogot;
   7726   1.1  christos 
   7727   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:
   7728   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:
   7729   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI:
   7730   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
   7731   1.7  christos 	  tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
   7732   1.1  christos 	  goto dogot;
   7733   1.1  christos 
   7734   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT16:
   7735   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT16_LO:
   7736   1.9  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT16_HI:
   7737   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT16_HA:
   7738   1.1  christos 	  tls_mask = 0;
   7739   1.1  christos 	dogot:
   7740   1.7  christos 	  {
   7741   1.7  christos 	    /* Relocation is to the entry for this symbol in the global
   7742   1.7  christos 	       offset table.  */
   7743   1.7  christos 	    bfd_vma off;
   7744   1.1  christos 	    bfd_vma *offp;
   7745   1.1  christos 	    unsigned long indx;
   7746   1.1  christos 
   7747   1.1  christos 	    if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL)
   7748   1.1  christos 	      abort ();
   7749   1.1  christos 
   7750   1.1  christos 	    indx = 0;
   7751   1.1  christos 	    if (tls_type == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)
   7752  1.10  christos 		&& SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
   7753   1.1  christos 	      offp = &htab->tlsld_got.offset;
   7754   1.1  christos 	    else if (h != NULL)
   7755   1.1  christos 	      {
   7756   1.1  christos 		if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
   7757   1.1  christos 		    || h->dynindx == -1
   7758   1.1  christos 		    || SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h)
   7759   1.1  christos 		    || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
   7760   1.1  christos 		  /* This is actually a static link, or it is a
   7761   1.1  christos 		     -Bsymbolic link and the symbol is defined
   7762   1.1  christos 		     locally, or the symbol was forced to be local
   7763   1.1  christos 		     because of a version file.  */
   7764   1.1  christos 		  ;
   7765   1.1  christos 		else
   7766   1.1  christos 		  {
   7767   1.1  christos 		    indx = h->dynindx;
   7768   1.1  christos 		    unresolved_reloc = false;
   7769   1.1  christos 		  }
   7770   1.1  christos 		offp = &h->got.offset;
   7771   1.7  christos 	      }
   7772   1.7  christos 	    else
   7773   1.9  christos 	      {
   7774   1.7  christos 		if (local_got_offsets == NULL)
   7775   1.1  christos 		  abort ();
   7776   1.1  christos 		offp = &local_got_offsets[r_symndx];
   7777   1.1  christos 	      }
   7778   1.9  christos 
   7779   1.9  christos 	    /* The offset must always be a multiple of 4.  We use the
   7780   1.1  christos 	       least significant bit to record whether we have already
   7781   1.1  christos 	       processed this entry.  */
   7782   1.1  christos 	    off = *offp;
   7783   1.1  christos 	    if ((off & 1) != 0)
   7784   1.1  christos 	      off &= ~1;
   7785   1.1  christos 	    else
   7786   1.1  christos 	      {
   7787   1.1  christos 		unsigned int tls_m = ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
   7788   1.1  christos 				      ? tls_mask & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD | TLS_DTPREL
   7789   1.1  christos 						    | TLS_TPREL | TLS_GDIE)
   7790   1.1  christos 				      : 0);
   7791   1.1  christos 
   7792   1.1  christos 		if (offp == &htab->tlsld_got.offset)
   7793   1.1  christos 		  tls_m = TLS_LD;
   7794   1.1  christos 		else if ((tls_m & TLS_LD) != 0
   7795   1.1  christos 			 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
   7796   1.1  christos 		  tls_m &= ~TLS_LD;
   7797   1.1  christos 
   7798   1.1  christos 		/* We might have multiple got entries for this sym.
   7799   1.1  christos 		   Initialize them all.  */
   7800   1.1  christos 		do
   7801   1.1  christos 		  {
   7802   1.1  christos 		    int tls_ty = 0;
   7803   1.9  christos 
   7804   1.1  christos 		    if ((tls_m & TLS_LD) != 0)
   7805   1.1  christos 		      {
   7806   1.1  christos 			tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
   7807   1.1  christos 			tls_m &= ~TLS_LD;
   7808   1.1  christos 		      }
   7809   1.1  christos 		    else if ((tls_m & TLS_GD) != 0)
   7810   1.7  christos 		      {
   7811   1.7  christos 			tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
   7812   1.7  christos 			tls_m &= ~TLS_GD;
   7813   1.9  christos 		      }
   7814   1.9  christos 		    else if ((tls_m & TLS_DTPREL) != 0)
   7815   1.7  christos 		      {
   7816  1.10  christos 			tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
   7817  1.10  christos 			tls_m &= ~TLS_DTPREL;
   7818  1.10  christos 		      }
   7819  1.10  christos 		    else if ((tls_m & (TLS_TPREL | TLS_GDIE)) != 0)
   7820   1.1  christos 		      {
   7821   1.7  christos 			tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
   7822   1.1  christos 			tls_m = 0;
   7823   1.3  christos 		      }
   7824   1.7  christos 
   7825   1.7  christos 		    /* Generate relocs for the dynamic linker.  */
   7826   1.7  christos 		    if (indx != 0
   7827   1.7  christos 			|| (bfd_link_pic (info)
   7828   1.7  christos 			    && (h == NULL
   7829   1.7  christos 				|| !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
   7830   1.7  christos 			    && !(tls_ty != 0
   7831   1.7  christos 				 && bfd_link_executable (info)
   7832   1.7  christos 				 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
   7833   1.1  christos 			    && (h != NULL
   7834   1.1  christos 				? !bfd_is_abs_symbol (&h->root)
   7835   1.1  christos 				: sym->st_shndx != SHN_ABS)))
   7836   1.1  christos 		      {
   7837   1.1  christos 			asection *rsec = htab->elf.srelgot;
   7838   1.1  christos 
   7839   1.1  christos 			if (ifunc != NULL)
   7840  1.11  christos 			  {
   7841  1.11  christos 			    rsec = htab->elf.irelplt;
   7842  1.11  christos 			    if (indx == 0)
   7843   1.1  christos 			      htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
   7844   1.1  christos 			    else if (is_static_defined (h))
   7845   1.1  christos 			      htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
   7846   1.1  christos 			  }
   7847   1.1  christos 			outrel.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
   7848   1.1  christos 					   + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset
   7849   1.1  christos 					   + off);
   7850   1.1  christos 			outrel.r_addend = 0;
   7851   1.1  christos 			if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
   7852   1.1  christos 			  {
   7853   1.1  christos 			    outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPMOD32);
   7854   1.1  christos 			    if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_GD))
   7855   1.1  christos 			      {
   7856   1.1  christos 				BFD_ASSERT (count_and_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd,
   7857   1.1  christos 								      &outrel,
   7858   1.1  christos 								      rsec));
   7859   1.1  christos 				outrel.r_offset += 4;
   7860   1.1  christos 				outrel.r_info
   7861   1.1  christos 				  = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPREL32);
   7862   1.3  christos 			      }
   7863   1.3  christos 			  }
   7864   1.3  christos 			else if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL))
   7865   1.3  christos 			  outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPREL32);
   7866   1.3  christos 			else if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL))
   7867   1.3  christos 			  outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_TPREL32);
   7868   1.1  christos 			else if (indx != 0)
   7869  1.11  christos 			  outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_GLOB_DAT);
   7870  1.11  christos 			else if (ifunc != NULL)
   7871   1.1  christos 			  outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
   7872   1.1  christos 			else
   7873   1.1  christos 			  outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
   7874   1.1  christos 			if (indx == 0 && tls_ty != (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
   7875   1.1  christos 			  {
   7876   1.1  christos 			    outrel.r_addend += relocation;
   7877   1.1  christos 			    if (tls_ty & (TLS_GD | TLS_DTPREL | TLS_TPREL))
   7878   1.1  christos 			      {
   7879   1.7  christos 				if (htab->elf.tls_sec == NULL)
   7880   1.1  christos 				  outrel.r_addend = 0;
   7881   1.3  christos 				else
   7882   1.3  christos 				  outrel.r_addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma;
   7883   1.3  christos 			      }
   7884   1.3  christos 			  }
   7885   1.7  christos 			BFD_ASSERT (count_and_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd,
   7886   1.7  christos 							      &outrel, rsec));
   7887   1.7  christos 		      }
   7888   1.7  christos 
   7889   1.7  christos 		    /* Init the .got section contents if we're not
   7890   1.3  christos 		       emitting a reloc.  */
   7891   1.3  christos 		    else
   7892   1.1  christos 		      {
   7893   1.7  christos 			bfd_vma value = relocation;
   7894   1.1  christos 
   7895   1.7  christos 			if (tls_ty != 0)
   7896   1.7  christos 			  {
   7897   1.1  christos 			    if (htab->elf.tls_sec == NULL)
   7898   1.1  christos 			      value = 0;
   7899   1.1  christos 			    else
   7900   1.7  christos 			      {
   7901   1.7  christos 				if (tls_ty & TLS_LD)
   7902   1.1  christos 				  value = 0;
   7903   1.1  christos 				else
   7904   1.1  christos 				  value -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
   7905   1.1  christos 				if (tls_ty & TLS_TPREL)
   7906   1.1  christos 				  value += DTP_OFFSET - TP_OFFSET;
   7907   1.1  christos 			      }
   7908   1.1  christos 
   7909   1.1  christos 			    if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
   7910   1.1  christos 			      {
   7911   1.1  christos 				bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, value,
   7912   1.1  christos 					    htab->elf.sgot->contents + off + 4);
   7913   1.1  christos 				value = 1;
   7914   1.1  christos 			      }
   7915   1.1  christos 			  }
   7916   1.1  christos 			bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, value,
   7917   1.1  christos 				    htab->elf.sgot->contents + off);
   7918   1.1  christos 		      }
   7919   1.1  christos 
   7920   1.1  christos 		    off += 4;
   7921   1.1  christos 		    if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
   7922   1.9  christos 		      off += 4;
   7923   1.1  christos 		  }
   7924   1.1  christos 		while (tls_m != 0);
   7925   1.1  christos 
   7926   1.1  christos 		off = *offp;
   7927   1.1  christos 		*offp = off | 1;
   7928   1.1  christos 	      }
   7929   1.1  christos 
   7930   1.1  christos 	    if (off >= (bfd_vma) -2)
   7931   1.1  christos 	      abort ();
   7932   1.1  christos 
   7933   1.1  christos 	    if ((tls_type & TLS_TLS) != 0)
   7934   1.1  christos 	      {
   7935   1.1  christos 		if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
   7936   1.1  christos 		  {
   7937   1.3  christos 		    if ((tls_mask & TLS_LD) != 0
   7938   1.3  christos 			&& !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
   7939   1.3  christos 		      off += 8;
   7940   1.3  christos 		    if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_GD))
   7941   1.7  christos 		      {
   7942   1.7  christos 			if ((tls_mask & TLS_GD) != 0)
   7943   1.1  christos 			  off += 8;
   7944   1.1  christos 			if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL))
   7945   1.1  christos 			  {
   7946   1.1  christos 			    if ((tls_mask & TLS_DTPREL) != 0)
   7947   1.1  christos 			      off += 4;
   7948   1.1  christos 			  }
   7949   1.1  christos 		      }
   7950   1.1  christos 		  }
   7951   1.1  christos 	      }
   7952   1.7  christos 
   7953   1.7  christos 	    /* If here for a picfixup, we're done.  */
   7954   1.1  christos 	    if (r_type != ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
   7955   1.1  christos 	      goto copy_reloc;
   7956   1.1  christos 
   7957   1.1  christos 	    relocation = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
   7958   1.3  christos 			  + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset
   7959   1.1  christos 			  + off
   7960   1.3  christos 			  - SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot));
   7961   1.1  christos 
   7962   1.1  christos 	    /* Addends on got relocations don't make much sense.
   7963   1.1  christos 	       x+off@got is actually x@got+off, and since the got is
   7964   1.1  christos 	       generated by a hash table traversal, the value in the
   7965   1.1  christos 	       got at entry m+n bears little relation to the entry m.  */
   7966   1.6  christos 	    if (addend != 0)
   7967   1.6  christos 	      info->callbacks->einfo
   7968   1.6  christos 		/* xgettext:c-format */
   7969   1.6  christos 		(_("%H: non-zero addend on %s reloc against `%s'\n"),
   7970   1.6  christos 		 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   7971  1.10  christos 		 howto->name,
   7972   1.3  christos 		 sym_name);
   7973   1.1  christos 	  }
   7974   1.7  christos 	  break;
   7975   1.7  christos 
   7976   1.7  christos 	  /* Relocations that need no special processing.  */
   7977   1.7  christos 	case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
   7978   1.7  christos 	  /* It makes no sense to point a local relocation
   7979   1.7  christos 	     at a symbol not in this object.  */
   7980   1.7  christos 	  if (unresolved_reloc)
   7981   1.7  christos 	    {
   7982   1.7  christos 	      (*info->callbacks->undefined_symbol) (info,
   7983   1.7  christos 						    h->root.root.string,
   7984   1.7  christos 						    input_bfd,
   7985   1.7  christos 						    input_section,
   7986   1.7  christos 						    rel->r_offset,
   7987   1.7  christos 						    true);
   7988   1.7  christos 	      goto copy_reloc;
   7989   1.1  christos 	    }
   7990   1.1  christos 	  if (h != NULL && h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && bfd_link_pic (info))
   7991   1.1  christos 	    {
   7992   1.1  christos 	      /* @local on an ifunc does not really make sense since
   7993   1.1  christos 		 the ifunc resolver can take you anywhere.  More
   7994   1.1  christos 		 seriously, calls to ifuncs must go through a plt call
   7995   1.3  christos 		 stub, and for pic the plt call stubs uses r30 to
   7996   1.3  christos 		 access the PLT.  The problem is that a call that is
   7997   1.1  christos 		 local won't have the +32k reloc addend trick marking
   7998   1.1  christos 		 -fPIC code, so the linker won't know whether r30 is
   7999   1.1  christos 		 _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ or pointing into a .got2 section.  */
   8000   1.1  christos 	      /* xgettext:c-format */
   8001   1.1  christos 	      info->callbacks->einfo (_("%X%H: @local call to ifunc %s\n"),
   8002   1.1  christos 				      input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   8003   1.1  christos 				      h->root.root.string);
   8004   1.1  christos 	    }
   8005   1.1  christos 	  break;
   8006   1.1  christos 
   8007  1.10  christos 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16:
   8008  1.10  christos 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:
   8009   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI:
   8010   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:
   8011   1.1  christos 	  if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
   8012   1.1  christos 	    addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
   8013   1.1  christos 	  break;
   8014   1.1  christos 
   8015   1.7  christos 	  /* Relocations that may need to be propagated if this is a shared
   8016   1.1  christos 	     object.  */
   8017   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_TPREL16:
   8018   1.7  christos 	case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
   8019   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
   8020   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
   8021   1.3  christos 	  if (h != NULL
   8022   1.3  christos 	      && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
   8023   1.1  christos 	      && h->dynindx == -1
   8024   1.7  christos 	      && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4))
   8025   1.7  christos 	    {
   8026   1.1  christos 	      /* Make this relocation against an undefined weak symbol
   8027   1.1  christos 		 resolve to zero.  This is really just a tweak, since
   8028   1.1  christos 		 code using weak externs ought to check that they are
   8029   1.3  christos 		 defined before using them.  */
   8030   1.3  christos 	      bfd_byte *p = contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset;
   8031   1.1  christos 	      unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
   8032   1.1  christos 	      insn = _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tprel_transform (insn, 2);
   8033   1.1  christos 	      if (insn != 0)
   8034   1.3  christos 		bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
   8035   1.3  christos 	      break;
   8036   1.1  christos 	    }
   8037   1.1  christos 	  if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
   8038   1.1  christos 	    addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
   8039   1.1  christos 	  /* The TPREL16 relocs shouldn't really be used in shared
   8040   1.1  christos 	     libs or with non-local symbols as that will result in
   8041   1.1  christos 	     DT_TEXTREL being set, but support them anyway.  */
   8042   1.1  christos 	  goto dodyn;
   8043   1.1  christos 
   8044   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_TPREL32:
   8045   1.1  christos 	  if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
   8046   1.1  christos 	    addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
   8047   1.3  christos 	  goto dodyn;
   8048   1.1  christos 
   8049   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_DTPREL32:
   8050   1.1  christos 	  if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
   8051   1.1  christos 	    addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
   8052   1.1  christos 	  goto dodyn;
   8053   1.1  christos 
   8054   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_DTPMOD32:
   8055   1.1  christos 	  relocation = 1;
   8056   1.1  christos 	  addend = 0;
   8057   1.1  christos 	  goto dodyn;
   8058   1.1  christos 
   8059   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL16:
   8060   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL16_LO:
   8061   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL16_HI:
   8062   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
   8063   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA:
   8064   1.1  christos 	  break;
   8065   1.1  christos 
   8066   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL32:
   8067   1.1  christos 	  if (h == NULL || h == htab->elf.hgot)
   8068   1.1  christos 	    break;
   8069   1.1  christos 	  /* fall through */
   8070   1.1  christos 
   8071   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR32:
   8072   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR16:
   8073   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO:
   8074   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR16_HI:
   8075   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
   8076   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_UADDR32:
   8077   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_UADDR16:
   8078   1.1  christos 	  goto dodyn;
   8079   1.1  christos 
   8080   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_REL8:
   8081   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_REL15:
   8082   1.3  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_REL24:
   8083   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL24:
   8084   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL14:
   8085   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
   8086   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
   8087   1.1  christos 	  /* If these relocations are not to a named symbol, they can be
   8088   1.1  christos 	     handled right here, no need to bother the dynamic linker.  */
   8089   1.1  christos 	  if (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
   8090   1.1  christos 	      || h == htab->elf.hgot)
   8091   1.7  christos 	    break;
   8092   1.7  christos 	  /* fall through */
   8093  1.10  christos 
   8094   1.7  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR24:
   8095   1.7  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR14:
   8096   1.7  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
   8097  1.10  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
   8098   1.1  christos 	  if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
   8099   1.1  christos 	    break;
   8100   1.3  christos 	  /* fall through */
   8101   1.7  christos 
   8102   1.7  christos 	dodyn:
   8103   1.1  christos 	  if ((input_section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0
   8104   1.1  christos 	      || is_vxworks_tls)
   8105   1.1  christos 	    break;
   8106   1.1  christos 
   8107   1.1  christos 	  if (bfd_link_pic (info)
   8108   1.1  christos 	      ? ((h == NULL
   8109   1.1  christos 		  || h->dyn_relocs != NULL)
   8110   1.1  christos 		 && ((h != NULL && pc_dynrelocs (h))
   8111   1.1  christos 		     || must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type)))
   8112   1.1  christos 	      : (h != NULL
   8113   1.1  christos 		 && h->dyn_relocs != NULL))
   8114   1.1  christos 	    {
   8115   1.1  christos 	      int skip;
   8116   1.1  christos 	      asection *sreloc;
   8117   1.1  christos 	      long indx = 0;
   8118   1.1  christos 
   8119   1.1  christos #ifdef DEBUG
   8120   1.1  christos 	      fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_relocate_section needs to "
   8121   1.1  christos 		       "create relocation for %s\n",
   8122   1.1  christos 		       (h && h->root.root.string
   8123   1.9  christos 			? h->root.root.string : "<unknown>"));
   8124   1.9  christos #endif
   8125   1.9  christos 
   8126   1.9  christos 	      /* When generating a shared object, these relocations
   8127   1.9  christos 		 are copied into the output file to be resolved at run
   8128   1.9  christos 		 time.  */
   8129   1.9  christos 	      skip = 0;
   8130   1.9  christos 	      outrel.r_offset = _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info,
   8131   1.1  christos 							 input_section,
   8132   1.1  christos 							 rel->r_offset);
   8133   1.7  christos 	      if (outrel.r_offset == (bfd_vma) -1
   8134   1.1  christos 		  || outrel.r_offset == (bfd_vma) -2)
   8135   1.7  christos 		skip = (int) outrel.r_offset;
   8136   1.7  christos 	      outrel.r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
   8137  1.10  christos 				  + input_section->output_offset);
   8138   1.7  christos 
   8139   1.1  christos 	      /* Optimize unaligned reloc use.  */
   8140   1.1  christos 	      if ((r_type == R_PPC_ADDR32 && (outrel.r_offset & 3) != 0)
   8141   1.1  christos 		  || (r_type == R_PPC_UADDR32 && (outrel.r_offset & 3) == 0))
   8142   1.1  christos 		r_type ^= R_PPC_ADDR32 ^ R_PPC_UADDR32;
   8143   1.1  christos 	      if ((r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16 && (outrel.r_offset & 1) != 0)
   8144   1.1  christos 		  || (r_type == R_PPC_UADDR16 && (outrel.r_offset & 1) == 0))
   8145   1.1  christos 		r_type ^= R_PPC_ADDR16 ^ R_PPC_UADDR16;
   8146   1.1  christos 
   8147   1.1  christos 	      if (skip)
   8148   1.1  christos 		memset (&outrel, 0, sizeof outrel);
   8149   1.1  christos 	      else if (!SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
   8150   1.1  christos 		{
   8151   1.1  christos 		  indx = h->dynindx;
   8152   1.1  christos 		  BFD_ASSERT (indx != -1);
   8153   1.1  christos 		  unresolved_reloc = false;
   8154   1.1  christos 		  outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, r_type);
   8155   1.1  christos 		  outrel.r_addend = rel->r_addend;
   8156   1.1  christos 		}
   8157   1.1  christos 	      else
   8158   1.1  christos 		{
   8159   1.1  christos 		  outrel.r_addend = relocation + rel->r_addend;
   8160   1.1  christos 
   8161   1.1  christos 		  if (r_type != R_PPC_ADDR32)
   8162   1.7  christos 		    {
   8163   1.7  christos 		      if (ifunc != NULL)
   8164   1.1  christos 			{
   8165   1.1  christos 			  /* If we get here when building a static
   8166   1.1  christos 			     executable, then the libc startup function
   8167   1.1  christos 			     responsible for applying indirect function
   8168  1.10  christos 			     relocations is going to complain about
   8169   1.1  christos 			     the reloc type.
   8170   1.1  christos 			     If we get here when building a dynamic
   8171   1.1  christos 			     executable, it will be because we have
   8172   1.1  christos 			     a text relocation.  The dynamic loader
   8173   1.1  christos 			     will set the text segment writable and
   8174   1.1  christos 			     non-executable to apply text relocations.
   8175  1.10  christos 			     So we'll segfault when trying to run the
   8176   1.1  christos 			     indirection function to resolve the reloc.  */
   8177   1.1  christos 			  info->callbacks->einfo
   8178   1.1  christos 			    /* xgettext:c-format */
   8179   1.1  christos 			    (_("%H: relocation %s for indirect "
   8180   1.1  christos 			       "function %s unsupported\n"),
   8181   1.1  christos 			     input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   8182   1.1  christos 			     howto->name,
   8183   1.1  christos 			     sym_name);
   8184   1.1  christos 			  ret = false;
   8185   1.1  christos 			}
   8186   1.1  christos 		      else if (r_symndx == STN_UNDEF || bfd_is_abs_section (sec))
   8187   1.1  christos 			;
   8188   1.9  christos 		      else if (sec == NULL || sec->owner == NULL)
   8189   1.9  christos 			{
   8190   1.9  christos 			  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
   8191   1.9  christos 			  ret = false;
   8192   1.9  christos 			}
   8193   1.9  christos 		      else
   8194   1.1  christos 			{
   8195   1.1  christos 			  asection *osec;
   8196   1.9  christos 
   8197   1.9  christos 			  /* We are turning this relocation into one
   8198   1.9  christos 			     against a section symbol.  It would be
   8199   1.9  christos 			     proper to subtract the symbol's value,
   8200   1.9  christos 			     osec->vma, from the emitted reloc addend,
   8201   1.9  christos 			     but ld.so expects buggy relocs.
   8202   1.1  christos 			     FIXME: Why not always use a zero index?  */
   8203   1.9  christos 			  osec = sec->output_section;
   8204   1.9  christos 			  if ((osec->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
   8205   1.9  christos 			    {
   8206   1.9  christos 			      osec = htab->elf.tls_sec;
   8207   1.9  christos 			      indx = 0;
   8208   1.9  christos 			    }
   8209   1.1  christos 			  else
   8210   1.1  christos 			    {
   8211   1.1  christos 			      indx = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx;
   8212   1.1  christos 			      if (indx == 0)
   8213   1.1  christos 				{
   8214   1.1  christos 				  osec = htab->elf.text_index_section;
   8215   1.1  christos 				  indx = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx;
   8216   1.1  christos 				}
   8217   1.1  christos 			      BFD_ASSERT (indx != 0);
   8218   1.1  christos 			    }
   8219   1.7  christos 
   8220   1.7  christos 			  /* ld.so doesn't expect buggy TLS relocs.
   8221   1.7  christos 			     Don't leave the symbol value in the
   8222   1.7  christos 			     addend for them.  */
   8223   1.7  christos 			  if (IS_PPC_TLS_RELOC (r_type))
   8224   1.7  christos 			    outrel.r_addend -= osec->vma;
   8225   1.7  christos 			}
   8226   1.7  christos 
   8227   1.7  christos 		      outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, r_type);
   8228   1.7  christos 		    }
   8229  1.10  christos 		  else if (ifunc != NULL)
   8230   1.7  christos 		    outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
   8231  1.11  christos 		  else
   8232  1.11  christos 		    outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
   8233   1.1  christos 		}
   8234   1.1  christos 
   8235   1.3  christos 	      sreloc = elf_section_data (input_section)->sreloc;
   8236   1.1  christos 	      if (ifunc)
   8237   1.7  christos 		{
   8238   1.7  christos 		  sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
   8239   1.7  christos 		  if (indx == 0)
   8240   1.1  christos 		    htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
   8241   1.1  christos 		  else if (is_static_defined (h))
   8242   1.1  christos 		    htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
   8243   1.1  christos 		}
   8244   1.1  christos 	      if (sreloc == NULL)
   8245   1.1  christos 		return false;
   8246   1.1  christos 
   8247   1.1  christos 	      BFD_ASSERT (count_and_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &outrel,
   8248   1.1  christos 						    sreloc));
   8249   1.1  christos 
   8250   1.1  christos 	      if (skip == -1)
   8251   1.1  christos 		goto copy_reloc;
   8252   1.1  christos 
   8253   1.1  christos 	      /* This reloc will be computed at runtime.  Clear the memory
   8254   1.1  christos 		 so that it contains a predictable value for prelink.  */
   8255   1.1  christos 	      if (!skip)
   8256   1.1  christos 		{
   8257   1.3  christos 		  relocation = howto->pc_relative ? outrel.r_offset : 0;
   8258   1.1  christos 		  addend = 0;
   8259   1.1  christos 		  break;
   8260   1.1  christos 		}
   8261   1.1  christos 	    }
   8262   1.1  christos 	  break;
   8263   1.1  christos 
   8264   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_RELAX_PLT:
   8265   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24:
   8266   1.1  christos 	  if (h != NULL)
   8267   1.7  christos 	    {
   8268   1.7  christos 	      struct plt_entry *ent;
   8269   1.1  christos 	      bfd_vma got2_addend = 0;
   8270   1.1  christos 
   8271   1.7  christos 	      if (r_type == R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24)
   8272   1.1  christos 		{
   8273   1.1  christos 		  if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   8274  1.10  christos 		    got2_addend = addend;
   8275  1.10  christos 		  addend = 0;
   8276  1.10  christos 		}
   8277  1.10  christos 	      ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist, got2, got2_addend);
   8278  1.10  christos 	      if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
   8279  1.10  christos 		relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
   8280  1.10  christos 			      + htab->glink->output_offset
   8281  1.10  christos 			      + ent->glink_offset);
   8282  1.10  christos 	      else
   8283  1.10  christos 		relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
   8284   1.3  christos 			      + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
   8285  1.10  christos 			      + ent->plt.offset);
   8286  1.10  christos 	    }
   8287  1.10  christos 	  /* Fall through.  */
   8288  1.10  christos 
   8289  1.10  christos 	case R_PPC_RELAX:
   8290  1.10  christos 	  if (bfd_link_pic (info)
   8291  1.10  christos 	      ? offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - 12,
   8292  1.10  christos 				 ARRAY_SIZE (shared_stub_entry) * 4)
   8293  1.10  christos 	      : offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset,
   8294  1.10  christos 				 ARRAY_SIZE (stub_entry) * 4))
   8295  1.10  christos 	    {
   8296  1.10  christos 	      const int *stub;
   8297  1.10  christos 	      size_t size;
   8298  1.10  christos 	      size_t insn_offset = rel->r_offset;
   8299  1.10  christos 	      unsigned int insn;
   8300  1.10  christos 
   8301  1.10  christos 	      if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   8302   1.1  christos 		{
   8303  1.10  christos 		  relocation -= (input_section->output_section->vma
   8304  1.10  christos 				 + input_section->output_offset
   8305  1.10  christos 				 + rel->r_offset - 4);
   8306   1.3  christos 		  stub = shared_stub_entry;
   8307  1.10  christos 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[0], contents + insn_offset - 12);
   8308  1.10  christos 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[1], contents + insn_offset - 8);
   8309  1.10  christos 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[2], contents + insn_offset - 4);
   8310  1.10  christos 		  stub += 3;
   8311  1.10  christos 		  size = ARRAY_SIZE (shared_stub_entry) - 3;
   8312  1.10  christos 		}
   8313  1.10  christos 	      else
   8314  1.10  christos 		{
   8315  1.10  christos 		  stub = stub_entry;
   8316  1.10  christos 		  size = ARRAY_SIZE (stub_entry);
   8317  1.10  christos 		}
   8318  1.10  christos 
   8319  1.10  christos 	      relocation += addend;
   8320  1.10  christos 	      if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
   8321  1.10  christos 		relocation = 0;
   8322  1.10  christos 
   8323  1.10  christos 	      /* First insn is HA, second is LO.  */
   8324  1.10  christos 	      insn = *stub++;
   8325  1.10  christos 	      insn |= ((relocation + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
   8326  1.10  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset);
   8327  1.10  christos 	      insn_offset += 4;
   8328  1.10  christos 
   8329  1.10  christos 	      insn = *stub++;
   8330  1.10  christos 	      insn |= relocation & 0xffff;
   8331  1.10  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset);
   8332  1.10  christos 	      insn_offset += 4;
   8333  1.10  christos 	      size -= 2;
   8334  1.10  christos 
   8335  1.10  christos 	      while (size != 0)
   8336  1.10  christos 		{
   8337  1.10  christos 		  insn = *stub++;
   8338  1.10  christos 		  --size;
   8339  1.10  christos 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset);
   8340  1.10  christos 		  insn_offset += 4;
   8341   1.1  christos 		}
   8342   1.1  christos 
   8343   1.1  christos 	      /* Rewrite the reloc and convert one of the trailing nop
   8344   1.1  christos 		 relocs to describe this relocation.  */
   8345   1.1  christos 	      BFD_ASSERT (ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_NONE);
   8346   1.1  christos 	      /* The relocs are at the bottom 2 bytes */
   8347   1.1  christos 	      wrel->r_offset = rel->r_offset + d_offset;
   8348  1.10  christos 	      wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
   8349   1.1  christos 	      wrel->r_addend = rel->r_addend;
   8350   1.1  christos 	      memmove (wrel + 1, wrel, (relend - wrel - 1) * sizeof (*wrel));
   8351   1.1  christos 	      wrel++, rel++;
   8352   1.1  christos 	      wrel->r_offset += 4;
   8353   1.1  christos 	      wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
   8354   1.1  christos 	    }
   8355   1.1  christos 	  else
   8356   1.1  christos 	    goto de_fault;
   8357   1.1  christos 	  continue;
   8358   1.1  christos 
   8359   1.1  christos 	  /* Indirect .sdata relocation.  */
   8360   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16:
   8361   1.1  christos 	  BFD_ASSERT (htab->sdata[0].section != NULL);
   8362  1.10  christos 	  if (!is_static_defined (htab->sdata[0].sym))
   8363   1.1  christos 	    {
   8364   1.1  christos 	      unresolved_reloc = true;
   8365   1.1  christos 	      break;
   8366   1.1  christos 	    }
   8367   1.1  christos 	  relocation
   8368   1.1  christos 	    = elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (input_bfd, &htab->sdata[0],
   8369   1.1  christos 						 h, relocation, rel);
   8370   1.1  christos 	  addend = 0;
   8371   1.1  christos 	  break;
   8372   1.1  christos 
   8373   1.1  christos 	  /* Indirect .sdata2 relocation.  */
   8374   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16:
   8375   1.1  christos 	  BFD_ASSERT (htab->sdata[1].section != NULL);
   8376   1.1  christos 	  if (!is_static_defined (htab->sdata[1].sym))
   8377   1.1  christos 	    {
   8378  1.10  christos 	      unresolved_reloc = true;
   8379   1.1  christos 	      break;
   8380   1.1  christos 	    }
   8381   1.9  christos 	  relocation
   8382   1.9  christos 	    = elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (input_bfd, &htab->sdata[1],
   8383   1.1  christos 						 h, relocation, rel);
   8384   1.1  christos 	  addend = 0;
   8385   1.1  christos 	  break;
   8386   1.1  christos 
   8387   1.1  christos 	  /* Handle the TOC16 reloc.  We want to use the offset within the .got
   8388   1.1  christos 	     section, not the actual VMA.  This is appropriate when generating
   8389   1.1  christos 	     an embedded ELF object, for which the .got section acts like the
   8390   1.3  christos 	     AIX .toc section.  */
   8391   1.3  christos 	case R_PPC_TOC16:			/* phony GOT16 relocations */
   8392   1.3  christos 	  if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
   8393   1.3  christos 	    {
   8394   1.1  christos 	      unresolved_reloc = true;
   8395   1.7  christos 	      break;
   8396   1.1  christos 	    }
   8397   1.1  christos 	  BFD_ASSERT (strcmp (bfd_section_name (sec), ".got") == 0
   8398   1.1  christos 		      || strcmp (bfd_section_name (sec), ".cgot") == 0);
   8399   1.1  christos 
   8400   1.1  christos 	  addend -= sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset + 0x8000;
   8401   1.1  christos 	  break;
   8402   1.1  christos 
   8403   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
   8404   1.1  christos 	  if (h != NULL && ifunc == NULL)
   8405  1.10  christos 	    {
   8406   1.1  christos 	      struct plt_entry *ent;
   8407   1.1  christos 
   8408   1.1  christos 	      ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist, got2,
   8409   1.1  christos 				  bfd_link_pic (info) ? addend : 0);
   8410   1.1  christos 	      if (ent == NULL
   8411   1.7  christos 		  || htab->elf.splt == NULL)
   8412   1.7  christos 		{
   8413   1.1  christos 		  /* We didn't make a PLT entry for this symbol.  This
   8414   1.1  christos 		     happens when statically linking PIC code, or when
   8415   1.1  christos 		     using -Bsymbolic.  */
   8416   1.1  christos 		}
   8417   1.1  christos 	      else
   8418   1.1  christos 		{
   8419   1.1  christos 		  /* Relocation is to the entry for this symbol in the
   8420   1.1  christos 		     procedure linkage table.  */
   8421   1.1  christos 		  unresolved_reloc = false;
   8422   1.1  christos 		  if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
   8423   1.7  christos 		    relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
   8424   1.7  christos 				  + htab->glink->output_offset
   8425   1.7  christos 				  + ent->glink_offset);
   8426   1.7  christos 		  else
   8427   1.7  christos 		    relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
   8428   1.7  christos 				  + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
   8429   1.7  christos 				  + ent->plt.offset);
   8430   1.7  christos 		}
   8431   1.7  christos 	    }
   8432   1.7  christos 
   8433   1.7  christos 	  /* R_PPC_PLTREL24 is rather special.  If non-zero, the
   8434   1.7  christos 	     addend specifies the GOT pointer offset within .got2.
   8435   1.7  christos 	     Don't apply it to the relocation field.  */
   8436   1.7  christos 	  addend = 0;
   8437   1.7  christos 	  break;
   8438   1.7  christos 
   8439   1.7  christos 	case R_PPC_PLTSEQ:
   8440  1.10  christos 	case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
   8441   1.7  christos 	case R_PPC_PLT16_LO:
   8442   1.7  christos 	case R_PPC_PLT16_HI:
   8443   1.7  christos 	case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
   8444   1.7  christos 	  plt_list = NULL;
   8445   1.7  christos 	  if (h != NULL)
   8446   1.7  christos 	    plt_list = &h->plt.plist;
   8447   1.7  christos 	  else if (ifunc != NULL)
   8448   1.7  christos 	    plt_list = ifunc;
   8449   1.7  christos 	  else if (local_got_offsets != NULL)
   8450   1.7  christos 	    {
   8451  1.10  christos 	      struct plt_entry **local_plt;
   8452   1.7  christos 	      local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets
   8453  1.10  christos 						 + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
   8454   1.7  christos 	      plt_list = local_plt + r_symndx;
   8455   1.7  christos 	    }
   8456   1.7  christos 	  unresolved_reloc = true;
   8457   1.7  christos 	  if (plt_list != NULL)
   8458   1.7  christos 	    {
   8459   1.7  christos 	      struct plt_entry *ent;
   8460   1.7  christos 
   8461   1.7  christos 	      ent = find_plt_ent (plt_list, got2,
   8462   1.7  christos 				  bfd_link_pic (info) ? addend : 0);
   8463   1.7  christos 	      if (ent != NULL && ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
   8464   1.7  christos 		{
   8465   1.7  christos 		  asection *plt;
   8466   1.7  christos 
   8467   1.7  christos 		  unresolved_reloc = false;
   8468   1.7  christos 		  plt = htab->elf.splt;
   8469   1.7  christos 		  if (use_local_plt (info, h))
   8470   1.7  christos 		    {
   8471   1.7  christos 		      if (ifunc != NULL)
   8472   1.7  christos 			plt = htab->elf.iplt;
   8473   1.7  christos 		      else
   8474   1.7  christos 			plt = htab->pltlocal;
   8475   1.7  christos 		    }
   8476   1.7  christos 		  relocation = (plt->output_section->vma
   8477   1.7  christos 				+ plt->output_offset
   8478   1.7  christos 				+ ent->plt.offset);
   8479   1.7  christos 		  if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   8480   1.1  christos 		    {
   8481   1.1  christos 		      bfd_vma got = 0;
   8482   1.1  christos 
   8483   1.1  christos 		      if (ent->addend >= 32768)
   8484   1.1  christos 			got = (ent->addend
   8485   1.1  christos 			       + ent->sec->output_section->vma
   8486   1.1  christos 			       + ent->sec->output_offset);
   8487   1.1  christos 		      else
   8488   1.1  christos 			got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
   8489   1.1  christos 		      relocation -= got;
   8490  1.10  christos 		    }
   8491   1.1  christos 		}
   8492   1.1  christos 	    }
   8493   1.1  christos 	  addend = 0;
   8494   1.1  christos 	  break;
   8495   1.9  christos 
   8496   1.3  christos 	  /* Relocate against _SDA_BASE_.  */
   8497   1.3  christos 	case R_PPC_SDAREL16:
   8498   1.1  christos 	  {
   8499   1.7  christos 	    const char *name;
   8500   1.7  christos 	    struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
   8501   1.7  christos 
   8502   1.7  christos 	    if (sec == NULL
   8503   1.1  christos 		|| sec->output_section == NULL
   8504   1.1  christos 		|| !is_static_defined (sda))
   8505   1.1  christos 	      {
   8506   1.1  christos 		unresolved_reloc = true;
   8507   1.1  christos 		break;
   8508   1.1  christos 	      }
   8509   1.1  christos 	    addend -= SYM_VAL (sda);
   8510   1.1  christos 
   8511   1.1  christos 	    name = bfd_section_name (sec->output_section);
   8512   1.1  christos 	    if (!(strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
   8513   1.1  christos 		  || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0))
   8514   1.1  christos 	      {
   8515   1.1  christos 		_bfd_error_handler
   8516   1.1  christos 		  /* xgettext:c-format */
   8517   1.1  christos 		  (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
   8518   1.1  christos 		     "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
   8519   1.1  christos 		   input_bfd,
   8520   1.1  christos 		   sym_name,
   8521  1.10  christos 		   howto->name,
   8522   1.1  christos 		   name);
   8523   1.1  christos 	      }
   8524   1.1  christos 	  }
   8525   1.1  christos 	  break;
   8526   1.9  christos 
   8527   1.3  christos 	  /* Relocate against _SDA2_BASE_.  */
   8528   1.3  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL:
   8529   1.1  christos 	  {
   8530   1.7  christos 	    const char *name;
   8531   1.7  christos 	    struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
   8532   1.7  christos 
   8533   1.7  christos 	    if (sec == NULL
   8534   1.1  christos 		|| sec->output_section == NULL
   8535   1.1  christos 		|| !is_static_defined (sda))
   8536   1.1  christos 	      {
   8537   1.1  christos 		unresolved_reloc = true;
   8538   1.1  christos 		break;
   8539   1.1  christos 	      }
   8540   1.1  christos 	    addend -= SYM_VAL (sda);
   8541   1.1  christos 
   8542   1.1  christos 	    name = bfd_section_name (sec->output_section);
   8543   1.3  christos 	    if (!(strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0
   8544  1.10  christos 		  || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0))
   8545  1.10  christos 	      {
   8546  1.10  christos 		_bfd_error_handler
   8547  1.10  christos 		  /* xgettext:c-format */
   8548  1.10  christos 		  (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
   8549   1.1  christos 		     "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
   8550   1.1  christos 		   input_bfd,
   8551   1.3  christos 		   sym_name,
   8552  1.10  christos 		   howto->name,
   8553  1.10  christos 		   name);
   8554  1.10  christos 	      }
   8555  1.10  christos 	  }
   8556  1.10  christos 	  break;
   8557   1.1  christos 
   8558   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_LO16A:
   8559   1.3  christos 	  relocation = relocation + addend;
   8560  1.10  christos 	  r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   8561  1.10  christos 				   contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
   8562  1.10  christos 				   split16a_type,
   8563  1.10  christos 				   htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
   8564  1.10  christos 	  goto report_reloc;
   8565   1.1  christos 
   8566   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_LO16D:
   8567   1.3  christos 	  relocation = relocation + addend;
   8568  1.10  christos 	  r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   8569  1.10  christos 				   contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
   8570  1.10  christos 				   split16d_type,
   8571  1.10  christos 				   htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
   8572  1.10  christos 	  goto report_reloc;
   8573   1.1  christos 
   8574   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_HI16A:
   8575   1.3  christos 	  relocation = (relocation + addend) >> 16;
   8576  1.10  christos 	  r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   8577  1.10  christos 				   contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
   8578  1.10  christos 				   split16a_type,
   8579  1.10  christos 				   htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
   8580  1.10  christos 	  goto report_reloc;
   8581   1.1  christos 
   8582   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_HI16D:
   8583   1.3  christos 	  relocation = (relocation + addend) >> 16;
   8584  1.10  christos 	  r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   8585  1.10  christos 				   contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
   8586  1.10  christos 				   split16d_type,
   8587  1.10  christos 				   htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
   8588  1.10  christos 	  goto report_reloc;
   8589   1.1  christos 
   8590   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_HA16A:
   8591   1.1  christos 	  relocation = (relocation + addend + 0x8000) >> 16;
   8592   1.1  christos 	  r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   8593   1.1  christos 				   contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
   8594   1.1  christos 				   split16a_type,
   8595  1.10  christos 				   htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
   8596  1.10  christos 	  goto report_reloc;
   8597  1.10  christos 
   8598  1.10  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_HA16D:
   8599  1.10  christos 	  relocation = (relocation + addend + 0x8000) >> 16;
   8600  1.10  christos 	  r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   8601  1.10  christos 				   contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
   8602  1.10  christos 				   split16d_type,
   8603  1.10  christos 				   htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
   8604  1.10  christos 	  goto report_reloc;
   8605  1.10  christos 
   8606   1.1  christos 	  /* Relocate against either _SDA_BASE_, _SDA2_BASE_, or 0.  */
   8607  1.10  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_SDA21:
   8608  1.10  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21:
   8609  1.10  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA:
   8610  1.10  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO:
   8611  1.10  christos 	  if (!offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4))
   8612   1.1  christos 	    {
   8613  1.10  christos 	      r = bfd_reloc_outofrange;
   8614  1.10  christos 	      goto report_reloc;
   8615  1.10  christos 	    }
   8616  1.10  christos 	  else
   8617  1.10  christos 	    {
   8618  1.10  christos 	      const char *name;
   8619  1.10  christos 	      int reg;
   8620  1.10  christos 	      unsigned int insn;
   8621  1.10  christos 	      struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = NULL;
   8622  1.10  christos 
   8623  1.10  christos 	      if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
   8624  1.10  christos 		{
   8625  1.10  christos 		  unresolved_reloc = true;
   8626  1.10  christos 		  break;
   8627  1.10  christos 		}
   8628  1.10  christos 
   8629  1.10  christos 	      name = bfd_section_name (sec->output_section);
   8630  1.10  christos 	      if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
   8631  1.10  christos 		  || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)
   8632  1.10  christos 		{
   8633  1.10  christos 		  reg = 13;
   8634  1.10  christos 		  sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
   8635  1.10  christos 		}
   8636  1.10  christos 	      else if (strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0
   8637  1.10  christos 		       || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0)
   8638  1.10  christos 		{
   8639  1.10  christos 		  reg = 2;
   8640  1.10  christos 		  sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
   8641  1.10  christos 		}
   8642  1.10  christos 	      else if (strcmp (name, ".PPC.EMB.sdata0") == 0
   8643  1.10  christos 		       || strcmp (name, ".PPC.EMB.sbss0") == 0)
   8644  1.10  christos 		{
   8645  1.10  christos 		  reg = 0;
   8646   1.1  christos 		}
   8647  1.10  christos 	      else
   8648  1.10  christos 		{
   8649  1.10  christos 		  _bfd_error_handler
   8650  1.10  christos 		    /* xgettext:c-format */
   8651  1.10  christos 		    (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
   8652  1.10  christos 		       "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
   8653  1.10  christos 		     input_bfd,
   8654  1.10  christos 		     sym_name,
   8655  1.10  christos 		     howto->name,
   8656   1.1  christos 		     name);
   8657  1.10  christos 
   8658  1.10  christos 		  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
   8659   1.1  christos 		  ret = false;
   8660  1.10  christos 		  goto copy_reloc;
   8661  1.10  christos 		}
   8662  1.10  christos 
   8663  1.10  christos 	      if (sda != NULL)
   8664  1.10  christos 		{
   8665  1.10  christos 		  if (!is_static_defined (sda))
   8666  1.10  christos 		    {
   8667  1.10  christos 		      unresolved_reloc = true;
   8668  1.10  christos 		      break;
   8669   1.9  christos 		    }
   8670  1.10  christos 		  addend -= SYM_VAL (sda);
   8671  1.10  christos 		}
   8672  1.10  christos 
   8673  1.10  christos 	      if (r_type == R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA)
   8674  1.10  christos 		break;
   8675  1.10  christos 
   8676  1.10  christos 	      /* The PowerPC Embedded Application Binary Interface
   8677   1.3  christos 		 version 1.0 insanely chose to specify R_PPC_EMB_SDA21
   8678  1.10  christos 		 operating on a 24-bit field at r_offset.  GNU as and
   8679  1.10  christos 		 GNU ld have always assumed R_PPC_EMB_SDA21 operates on
   8680  1.10  christos 		 a 32-bit bit insn at r_offset.  Cope with object file
   8681  1.10  christos 		 producers that possibly comply with the EABI in
   8682  1.10  christos 		 generating an odd r_offset for big-endian objects.  */
   8683  1.10  christos 	      if (r_type == R_PPC_EMB_SDA21)
   8684  1.10  christos 		rel->r_offset &= ~1;
   8685  1.10  christos 
   8686  1.10  christos 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
   8687  1.10  christos 	      if (reg == 0
   8688  1.10  christos 		  && (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21
   8689  1.10  christos 		      || r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO))
   8690  1.10  christos 		{
   8691  1.10  christos 		  relocation = relocation + addend;
   8692  1.10  christos 		  addend = 0;
   8693  1.10  christos 
   8694  1.10  christos 		  /* Force e_li insn, keeping RT from original insn.  */
   8695  1.10  christos 		  insn &= 0x1f << 21;
   8696  1.10  christos 		  insn |= 28u << 26;
   8697  1.10  christos 
   8698  1.10  christos 		  /* We have an li20 field, bits 17..20, 11..15, 21..31.  */
   8699  1.10  christos 		  /* Top 4 bits of value to 17..20.  */
   8700  1.10  christos 		  insn |= (relocation & 0xf0000) >> 5;
   8701  1.10  christos 		  /* Next 5 bits of the value to 11..15.  */
   8702   1.1  christos 		  insn |= (relocation & 0xf800) << 5;
   8703   1.1  christos 		  /* And the final 11 bits of the value to bits 21 to 31.  */
   8704   1.1  christos 		  insn |= relocation & 0x7ff;
   8705   1.1  christos 
   8706   1.1  christos 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
   8707   1.1  christos 
   8708   1.1  christos 		  r = bfd_reloc_ok;
   8709   1.1  christos 		  if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21
   8710  1.10  christos 		      && ((relocation + 0x80000) & 0xffffffff) > 0x100000)
   8711  1.10  christos 		    r = bfd_reloc_overflow;
   8712  1.10  christos 		  goto report_reloc;
   8713  1.10  christos 		}
   8714  1.10  christos 	      /* Fill in register field.  */
   8715  1.10  christos 	      insn = (insn & ~RA_REGISTER_MASK) | (reg << RA_REGISTER_SHIFT);
   8716  1.10  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
   8717   1.1  christos 	    }
   8718  1.10  christos 	  break;
   8719  1.10  christos 
   8720  1.10  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A:
   8721  1.10  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D:
   8722  1.10  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A:
   8723   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D:
   8724  1.10  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A:
   8725  1.10  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D:
   8726  1.10  christos 	  if (!offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4))
   8727  1.10  christos 	    r = bfd_reloc_outofrange;
   8728  1.10  christos 	  else
   8729  1.10  christos 	    {
   8730  1.10  christos 	      bfd_vma value;
   8731  1.10  christos 	      const char *name;
   8732  1.10  christos 	      struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = NULL;
   8733  1.10  christos 
   8734  1.10  christos 	      if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
   8735  1.10  christos 		{
   8736  1.10  christos 		  unresolved_reloc = true;
   8737  1.10  christos 		  break;
   8738  1.10  christos 		}
   8739  1.10  christos 
   8740  1.10  christos 	      name = bfd_section_name (sec->output_section);
   8741  1.10  christos 	      if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
   8742  1.10  christos 		  || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)
   8743  1.10  christos 		sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
   8744  1.10  christos 	      else if (strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0
   8745  1.10  christos 		       || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0)
   8746   1.1  christos 		sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
   8747  1.10  christos 	      else
   8748  1.10  christos 		{
   8749  1.10  christos 		  _bfd_error_handler
   8750  1.10  christos 		    /* xgettext:c-format */
   8751  1.10  christos 		    (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
   8752  1.10  christos 		       "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
   8753   1.1  christos 		     input_bfd,
   8754  1.10  christos 		     sym_name,
   8755  1.10  christos 		     howto->name,
   8756  1.10  christos 		     name);
   8757  1.10  christos 
   8758  1.10  christos 		  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
   8759  1.10  christos 		  ret = false;
   8760  1.10  christos 		  goto copy_reloc;
   8761  1.10  christos 		}
   8762  1.10  christos 
   8763  1.10  christos 	      if (sda == NULL || !is_static_defined (sda))
   8764  1.10  christos 		{
   8765  1.10  christos 		  unresolved_reloc = true;
   8766  1.10  christos 		  break;
   8767  1.10  christos 		}
   8768  1.10  christos 	      value = relocation + addend - SYM_VAL (sda);
   8769  1.10  christos 
   8770  1.10  christos 	      if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A)
   8771  1.10  christos 		r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section,
   8772  1.10  christos 					 rel->r_offset,
   8773  1.10  christos 					 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
   8774  1.10  christos 					 split16a_type,
   8775  1.10  christos 					 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
   8776  1.10  christos 	      else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D)
   8777  1.10  christos 		r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section,
   8778  1.10  christos 					 rel->r_offset,
   8779  1.10  christos 					 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
   8780  1.10  christos 					 split16d_type,
   8781  1.10  christos 					 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
   8782  1.10  christos 	      else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A)
   8783  1.10  christos 		{
   8784  1.10  christos 		  value = value >> 16;
   8785  1.10  christos 		  r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section,
   8786  1.10  christos 					   rel->r_offset,
   8787  1.10  christos 					   contents + rel->r_offset, value,
   8788  1.10  christos 					   split16a_type,
   8789  1.10  christos 					   htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
   8790  1.10  christos 		}
   8791  1.10  christos 	      else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D)
   8792  1.10  christos 		{
   8793  1.10  christos 		  value = value >> 16;
   8794  1.10  christos 		  r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section,
   8795  1.10  christos 					   rel->r_offset,
   8796  1.10  christos 					   contents + rel->r_offset, value,
   8797  1.10  christos 					   split16d_type,
   8798  1.10  christos 					   htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
   8799  1.10  christos 		}
   8800  1.10  christos 	      else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A)
   8801  1.10  christos 		{
   8802  1.10  christos 		  value = (value + 0x8000) >> 16;
   8803  1.10  christos 		  r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section,
   8804  1.10  christos 					   rel->r_offset,
   8805  1.10  christos 					   contents + rel->r_offset, value,
   8806   1.1  christos 					   split16a_type,
   8807   1.7  christos 					   htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
   8808  1.10  christos 		}
   8809  1.10  christos 	      else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D)
   8810  1.10  christos 		{
   8811  1.10  christos 		  value = (value + 0x8000) >> 16;
   8812  1.10  christos 		  r = ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section,
   8813  1.10  christos 					   rel->r_offset,
   8814  1.10  christos 					   contents + rel->r_offset, value,
   8815  1.10  christos 					   split16d_type,
   8816  1.10  christos 					   htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
   8817   1.7  christos 		}
   8818   1.1  christos 	      else
   8819   1.1  christos 		abort ();
   8820   1.1  christos 	    }
   8821   1.1  christos 	  goto report_reloc;
   8822   1.1  christos 
   8823   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20:
   8824   1.1  christos 	  if (!offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4))
   8825  1.10  christos 	    r = bfd_reloc_outofrange;
   8826   1.1  christos 	  else
   8827   1.1  christos 	    {
   8828   1.1  christos 	      ppc_elf_vle_split20 (output_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset,
   8829   1.1  christos 				   relocation);
   8830   1.1  christos 	      r = bfd_reloc_ok;
   8831   1.1  christos 	    }
   8832   1.1  christos 	  goto report_reloc;
   8833   1.1  christos 
   8834   1.1  christos 	  /* Relocate against the beginning of the section.  */
   8835   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF:
   8836   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO:
   8837   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI:
   8838   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA:
   8839   1.1  christos 	  if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
   8840   1.1  christos 	    {
   8841   1.1  christos 	      unresolved_reloc = true;
   8842   1.1  christos 	      break;
   8843   1.1  christos 	    }
   8844   1.1  christos 	  addend -= sec->output_section->vma;
   8845   1.1  christos 	  break;
   8846   1.1  christos 
   8847   1.1  christos 	  /* Negative relocations.  */
   8848   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32:
   8849   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16:
   8850   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO:
   8851   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI:
   8852   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:
   8853   1.7  christos 	  addend -= 2 * relocation;
   8854   1.7  christos 	  break;
   8855   1.7  christos 
   8856   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_COPY:
   8857   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GLOB_DAT:
   8858  1.10  christos 	case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT:
   8859   1.3  christos 	case R_PPC_RELATIVE:
   8860   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_IRELATIVE:
   8861   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_PLT32:
   8862   1.7  christos 	case R_PPC_PLTREL32:
   8863   1.7  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR30:
   8864   1.7  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16:
   8865   1.7  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO:
   8866   1.7  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI:
   8867  1.10  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:
   8868  1.10  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD:
   8869  1.10  christos 	  /* xgettext:c-format */
   8870  1.10  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: %s unsupported"),
   8871  1.10  christos 			      input_bfd, howto->name);
   8872  1.10  christos 
   8873  1.10  christos 	  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
   8874  1.10  christos 	  ret = false;
   8875  1.10  christos 	  goto copy_reloc;
   8876  1.10  christos 	}
   8877  1.10  christos 
   8878  1.10  christos       switch (r_type)
   8879  1.10  christos 	{
   8880  1.10  christos 	default:
   8881  1.10  christos 	  break;
   8882  1.10  christos 
   8883  1.10  christos 	case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
   8884  1.10  christos 	  if (htab->do_tls_opt
   8885  1.10  christos 	      && relocation + addend + 0x8000 < 0x10000
   8886  1.10  christos 	      && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset & ~3, 4))
   8887  1.10  christos 
   8888  1.10  christos 	    {
   8889  1.10  christos 	      bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
   8890  1.10  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, p);
   8891  1.10  christos 	    }
   8892  1.10  christos 	  break;
   8893  1.10  christos 
   8894  1.10  christos 	case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
   8895  1.10  christos 	  if (htab->do_tls_opt
   8896  1.10  christos 	      && relocation + addend + 0x8000 < 0x10000
   8897   1.7  christos 	      && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset & ~3, 4))
   8898   1.7  christos 	    {
   8899   1.7  christos 	      bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
   8900  1.10  christos 	      unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
   8901  1.10  christos 	      insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
   8902  1.10  christos 	      insn |= 2 << 16;
   8903  1.10  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
   8904  1.10  christos 	    }
   8905  1.10  christos 	  break;
   8906  1.10  christos 	}
   8907  1.10  christos 
   8908  1.10  christos       switch (r_type)
   8909  1.10  christos 	{
   8910   1.7  christos 	default:
   8911   1.7  christos 	  break;
   8912   1.7  christos 
   8913   1.9  christos 	case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
   8914   1.7  christos 	  if (unresolved_reloc)
   8915   1.7  christos 	    {
   8916   1.7  christos 	      if (offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4))
   8917   1.7  christos 		{
   8918   1.7  christos 		  bfd_byte *p = contents + rel->r_offset;
   8919   1.7  christos 		  unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
   8920   1.7  christos 		  insn &= 1;
   8921   1.7  christos 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | insn, p);
   8922   1.7  christos 		  unresolved_reloc = save_unresolved_reloc;
   8923  1.10  christos 		  r_type = R_PPC_REL24;
   8924  1.10  christos 		  howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
   8925  1.10  christos 		}
   8926  1.10  christos 	    }
   8927  1.10  christos 	  else if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW)
   8928  1.10  christos 	    info->callbacks->einfo
   8929  1.10  christos 	      (_("%X%P: %H: %s relocation unsupported for bss-plt\n"),
   8930  1.10  christos 	       input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   8931   1.7  christos 	       howto->name);
   8932   1.7  christos 	  break;
   8933   1.7  christos 
   8934   1.9  christos 	case R_PPC_PLTSEQ:
   8935   1.7  christos 	case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
   8936   1.7  christos 	case R_PPC_PLT16_LO:
   8937   1.7  christos 	  if (unresolved_reloc)
   8938   1.7  christos 	    {
   8939   1.7  christos 	      if (offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset & ~3, 4))
   8940   1.1  christos 		{
   8941   1.1  christos 		  bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
   8942   1.1  christos 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, p);
   8943   1.1  christos 		  unresolved_reloc = false;
   8944   1.1  christos 		  r_type = R_PPC_NONE;
   8945   1.1  christos 		  howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
   8946   1.1  christos 		}
   8947   1.1  christos 	    }
   8948   1.3  christos 	  else if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW)
   8949   1.1  christos 	    info->callbacks->einfo
   8950   1.1  christos 	      (_("%X%P: %H: %s relocation unsupported for bss-plt\n"),
   8951   1.1  christos 	       input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   8952   1.1  christos 	       howto->name);
   8953   1.1  christos 	  break;
   8954   1.1  christos 	}
   8955   1.1  christos 
   8956   1.1  christos       /* Do any further special processing.  */
   8957   1.1  christos       switch (r_type)
   8958   1.1  christos 	{
   8959   1.1  christos 	default:
   8960   1.7  christos 	  break;
   8961   1.1  christos 
   8962   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
   8963   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
   8964   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA:
   8965   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA:
   8966   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
   8967   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:
   8968   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:
   8969   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:
   8970   1.1  christos 	  /* It's just possible that this symbol is a weak symbol
   8971   1.1  christos 	     that's not actually defined anywhere.  In that case,
   8972   1.1  christos 	     'sec' would be NULL, and we should leave the symbol
   8973   1.1  christos 	     alone (it will be set to zero elsewhere in the link).  */
   8974   1.1  christos 	  if (sec == NULL)
   8975   1.1  christos 	    break;
   8976   1.1  christos 	  /* Fall through.  */
   8977   1.1  christos 
   8978   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
   8979   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT16_HA:
   8980   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
   8981   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
   8982   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
   8983   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
   8984   1.1  christos 	  /* Add 0x10000 if sign bit in 0:15 is set.
   8985   1.1  christos 	     Bits 0:15 are not used.  */
   8986   1.1  christos 	  addend += 0x8000;
   8987   1.1  christos 	  break;
   8988   1.1  christos 
   8989   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR16:
   8990   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO:
   8991   1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT16:
   8992  1.10  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT16_LO:
   8993  1.10  christos 	case R_PPC_SDAREL16:
   8994  1.10  christos 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF:
   8995  1.10  christos 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO:
   8996  1.10  christos 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16:
   8997  1.10  christos 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:
   8998  1.10  christos 	case R_PPC_TPREL16:
   8999  1.10  christos 	case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
   9000  1.10  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
   9001  1.10  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
   9002  1.10  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
   9003  1.10  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
   9004  1.10  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:
   9005  1.10  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:
   9006  1.10  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
   9007  1.10  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
   9008  1.10  christos 	  if (offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset - d_offset, 4))
   9009  1.10  christos 	    {
   9010  1.10  christos 	      /* The 32-bit ABI lacks proper relocations to deal with
   9011  1.10  christos 		 certain 64-bit instructions.  Prevent damage to bits
   9012  1.10  christos 		 that make up part of the insn opcode.  */
   9013  1.10  christos 	      unsigned int insn, mask, lobit;
   9014  1.10  christos 
   9015  1.10  christos 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
   9016  1.10  christos 				 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
   9017  1.10  christos 	      mask = 0;
   9018  1.10  christos 	      if (is_insn_ds_form (insn))
   9019  1.10  christos 		mask = 3;
   9020  1.10  christos 	      else if (is_insn_dq_form (insn))
   9021  1.10  christos 		mask = 15;
   9022  1.10  christos 	      else
   9023   1.1  christos 		break;
   9024   1.1  christos 	      relocation += addend;
   9025   1.1  christos 	      addend = insn & mask;
   9026   1.1  christos 	      lobit = mask & relocation;
   9027   1.1  christos 	      if (lobit != 0)
   9028   1.1  christos 		{
   9029   1.1  christos 		  relocation ^= lobit;
   9030   1.1  christos 		  info->callbacks->einfo
   9031   1.1  christos 		    /* xgettext:c-format */
   9032   1.1  christos 		    (_("%H: error: %s against `%s' not a multiple of %u\n"),
   9033   1.1  christos 		     input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   9034   1.1  christos 		     howto->name, sym_name, mask + 1);
   9035   1.1  christos 		  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
   9036   1.1  christos 		  ret = false;
   9037   1.1  christos 		}
   9038   1.1  christos 	    }
   9039   1.1  christos 	  break;
   9040   1.1  christos 	}
   9041   1.1  christos 
   9042   1.1  christos #ifdef DEBUG
   9043   1.1  christos       fprintf (stderr, "\ttype = %s (%d), name = %s, symbol index = %ld, "
   9044   1.7  christos 	       "offset = %ld, addend = %ld\n",
   9045   1.7  christos 	       howto->name,
   9046   1.1  christos 	       (int) r_type,
   9047   1.1  christos 	       sym_name,
   9048   1.1  christos 	       r_symndx,
   9049  1.10  christos 	       (long) rel->r_offset,
   9050   1.1  christos 	       (long) addend);
   9051   1.1  christos #endif
   9052   1.3  christos 
   9053   1.3  christos       if (unresolved_reloc
   9054   1.3  christos 	  && !((input_section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING) != 0
   9055   1.3  christos 	       && h->def_dynamic)
   9056   1.3  christos 	  && _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section,
   9057  1.10  christos 				      rel->r_offset) != (bfd_vma) -1)
   9058  1.10  christos 	{
   9059   1.3  christos 	  info->callbacks->einfo
   9060   1.3  christos 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   9061   1.3  christos 	    (_("%H: unresolvable %s relocation against symbol `%s'\n"),
   9062   1.3  christos 	     input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   9063   1.3  christos 	     howto->name,
   9064   1.3  christos 	     sym_name);
   9065   1.3  christos 	  ret = false;
   9066   1.3  christos 	}
   9067   1.9  christos 
   9068   1.3  christos       /* 16-bit fields in insns mostly have signed values, but a
   9069   1.9  christos 	 few insns have 16-bit unsigned values.  Really, we should
   9070   1.9  christos 	 have different reloc types.  */
   9071   1.9  christos       if (howto->complain_on_overflow != complain_overflow_dont
   9072   1.3  christos 	  && howto->dst_mask == 0xffff
   9073   1.3  christos 	  && (input_section->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0
   9074   1.3  christos 	  && offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset & ~3, 4))
   9075   1.3  christos 	{
   9076   1.3  christos 	  enum complain_overflow complain = complain_overflow_signed;
   9077   1.3  christos 
   9078   1.3  christos 	  if ((elf_section_flags (input_section) & SHF_PPC_VLE) == 0)
   9079   1.3  christos 	    {
   9080   1.3  christos 	      unsigned int insn;
   9081   1.3  christos 
   9082   1.3  christos 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3));
   9083   1.3  christos 	      if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 10u << 26 /* cmpli */)
   9084   1.3  christos 		complain = complain_overflow_bitfield;
   9085  1.10  christos 	      else if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 28u << 26 /* andi */
   9086   1.3  christos 		       || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 24u << 26 /* ori */
   9087   1.3  christos 		       || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 26u << 26 /* xori */)
   9088   1.3  christos 		complain = complain_overflow_unsigned;
   9089   1.3  christos 	    }
   9090   1.3  christos 	  if (howto->complain_on_overflow != complain)
   9091   1.3  christos 	    {
   9092   1.3  christos 	      alt_howto = *howto;
   9093   1.3  christos 	      alt_howto.complain_on_overflow = complain;
   9094   1.3  christos 	      howto = &alt_howto;
   9095   1.3  christos 	    }
   9096   1.3  christos 	}
   9097   1.3  christos 
   9098   1.3  christos       if (r_type == R_PPC_REL16DX_HA)
   9099   1.3  christos 	{
   9100   1.3  christos 	  /* Split field reloc isn't handled by _bfd_final_link_relocate.  */
   9101   1.3  christos 	  if (offset_in_range (input_section, rel->r_offset, 4))
   9102   1.3  christos 	    r = bfd_reloc_outofrange;
   9103   1.3  christos 	  else
   9104   1.3  christos 	    {
   9105   1.3  christos 	      unsigned int insn;
   9106   1.1  christos 
   9107  1.10  christos 	      relocation += addend;
   9108   1.1  christos 	      relocation -= (rel->r_offset
   9109   1.1  christos 			     + input_section->output_offset
   9110   1.1  christos 			     + input_section->output_section->vma);
   9111   1.1  christos 	      relocation >>= 16;
   9112   1.3  christos 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
   9113   1.3  christos 	      insn &= ~0x1fffc1;
   9114   1.3  christos 	      insn |= (relocation & 0xffc1) | ((relocation & 0x3e) << 15);
   9115   1.3  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
   9116   1.3  christos 	      r = bfd_reloc_ok;
   9117   1.3  christos 	    }
   9118   1.3  christos 	}
   9119   1.6  christos       else
   9120   1.6  christos 	r = _bfd_final_link_relocate (howto, input_bfd, input_section, contents,
   9121   1.6  christos 				      rel->r_offset, relocation, addend);
   9122   1.1  christos 
   9123   1.1  christos     report_reloc:
   9124   1.1  christos       if (r != bfd_reloc_ok)
   9125   1.1  christos 	{
   9126   1.7  christos 	  if (r == bfd_reloc_overflow)
   9127   1.7  christos 	    {
   9128   1.1  christos 	      /* On code like "if (foo) foo();" don't report overflow
   9129   1.1  christos 		 on a branch to zero when foo is undefined.  */
   9130  1.10  christos 	      if (!warned
   9131   1.1  christos 		  && !(h != NULL
   9132   1.1  christos 		       && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
   9133   1.3  christos 			   || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined)
   9134   1.3  christos 		       && is_branch_reloc (r_type)))
   9135   1.3  christos 		info->callbacks->reloc_overflow
   9136   1.3  christos 		  (info, (h ? &h->root : NULL), sym_name, howto->name,
   9137   1.3  christos 		   rel->r_addend, input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
   9138   1.3  christos 	    }
   9139   1.3  christos 	  else
   9140   1.3  christos 	    {
   9141   1.3  christos 	      info->callbacks->einfo
   9142   1.3  christos 		/* xgettext:c-format */
   9143   1.3  christos 		(_("%H: %s reloc against `%s': error %d\n"),
   9144   1.3  christos 		 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   9145   1.3  christos 		 howto->name, sym_name, (int) r);
   9146   1.3  christos 	      ret = false;
   9147   1.3  christos 	    }
   9148   1.3  christos 	}
   9149   1.3  christos     copy_reloc:
   9150   1.3  christos       if (wrel != rel)
   9151   1.3  christos 	*wrel = *rel;
   9152   1.3  christos     }
   9153   1.3  christos 
   9154   1.3  christos   if (wrel != rel)
   9155   1.3  christos     {
   9156   1.3  christos       Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
   9157   1.3  christos       size_t deleted = rel - wrel;
   9158   1.1  christos 
   9159   1.1  christos       rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (input_section->output_section);
   9160   1.1  christos       rel_hdr->sh_size -= rel_hdr->sh_entsize * deleted;
   9161   1.1  christos       if (rel_hdr->sh_size == 0)
   9162   1.1  christos 	{
   9163   1.1  christos 	  /* It is too late to remove an empty reloc section.  Leave
   9164   1.3  christos 	     one NONE reloc.
   9165   1.3  christos 	     ??? What is wrong with an empty section???  */
   9166   1.3  christos 	  rel_hdr->sh_size = rel_hdr->sh_entsize;
   9167   1.3  christos 	  deleted -= 1;
   9168   1.3  christos 	  wrel++;
   9169   1.3  christos 	}
   9170   1.3  christos       relend = wrel;
   9171   1.3  christos       rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (input_section);
   9172   1.3  christos       rel_hdr->sh_size -= rel_hdr->sh_entsize * deleted;
   9173   1.3  christos       input_section->reloc_count -= deleted;
   9174   1.3  christos     }
   9175   1.3  christos 
   9176   1.3  christos #ifdef DEBUG
   9177   1.3  christos   fprintf (stderr, "\n");
   9178   1.3  christos #endif
   9179   1.3  christos 
   9180   1.3  christos   if (input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET
   9181   1.3  christos       && input_section->size != input_section->rawsize
   9182   1.3  christos       && (strcmp (input_section->output_section->name, ".init") == 0
   9183   1.3  christos 	  || strcmp (input_section->output_section->name, ".fini") == 0))
   9184   1.3  christos     {
   9185   1.3  christos       /* Branch around the trampolines.  */
   9186   1.3  christos       unsigned int insn = B + input_section->size - input_section->rawsize;
   9187   1.3  christos       bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + input_section->rawsize);
   9188   1.3  christos     }
   9189   1.3  christos 
   9190   1.3  christos   if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
   9191   1.3  christos       && input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET
   9192   1.3  christos       && (!bfd_link_relocatable (info)
   9193   1.3  christos 	  || (input_section->output_section->alignment_power
   9194   1.3  christos 	      >= htab->params->pagesize_p2)))
   9195   1.3  christos     {
   9196   1.3  christos       bfd_vma start_addr, end_addr, addr;
   9197   1.3  christos       bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2;
   9198   1.3  christos 
   9199   1.3  christos       if (relax_info->workaround_size != 0)
   9200   1.3  christos 	{
   9201   1.3  christos 	  bfd_byte *p;
   9202   1.3  christos 	  unsigned int n;
   9203   1.3  christos 	  bfd_byte fill[4];
   9204   1.3  christos 
   9205   1.3  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, BA, fill);
   9206   1.3  christos 	  p = contents + input_section->size - relax_info->workaround_size;
   9207   1.3  christos 	  n = relax_info->workaround_size >> 2;
   9208   1.3  christos 	  while (n--)
   9209   1.3  christos 	    {
   9210   1.3  christos 	      memcpy (p, fill, 4);
   9211   1.3  christos 	      p += 4;
   9212   1.3  christos 	    }
   9213   1.3  christos 	}
   9214   1.3  christos 
   9215  1.10  christos       /* The idea is: Replace the last instruction on a page with a
   9216   1.3  christos 	 branch to a patch area.  Put the insn there followed by a
   9217   1.3  christos 	 branch back to the next page.  Complicated a little by
   9218   1.3  christos 	 needing to handle moved conditional branches, and by not
   9219   1.3  christos 	 wanting to touch data-in-text.  */
   9220   1.3  christos 
   9221  1.10  christos       start_addr = (input_section->output_section->vma
   9222   1.3  christos 		    + input_section->output_offset);
   9223   1.3  christos       end_addr = (start_addr + input_section->size
   9224   1.3  christos 		  - relax_info->workaround_size);
   9225   1.3  christos       for (addr = ((start_addr & -pagesize) + pagesize - 4);
   9226   1.3  christos 	   addr < end_addr;
   9227   1.3  christos 	   addr += pagesize)
   9228   1.3  christos 	{
   9229   1.3  christos 	  bfd_vma offset = addr - start_addr;
   9230   1.3  christos 	  Elf_Internal_Rela *lo, *hi;
   9231   1.3  christos 	  bool is_data;
   9232   1.3  christos 	  bfd_vma patch_off, patch_addr;
   9233   1.3  christos 	  unsigned int insn;
   9234   1.3  christos 
   9235   1.3  christos 	  /* Do we have a data reloc at this offset?  If so, leave
   9236   1.3  christos 	     the word alone.  */
   9237   1.3  christos 	  is_data = false;
   9238   1.3  christos 	  lo = relocs;
   9239   1.3  christos 	  hi = relend;
   9240  1.10  christos 	  rel = NULL;
   9241   1.3  christos 	  while (lo < hi)
   9242   1.3  christos 	    {
   9243   1.3  christos 	      rel = lo + (hi - lo) / 2;
   9244   1.3  christos 	      if (rel->r_offset < offset)
   9245   1.3  christos 		lo = rel + 1;
   9246   1.3  christos 	      else if (rel->r_offset > offset + 3)
   9247   1.3  christos 		hi = rel;
   9248   1.3  christos 	      else
   9249   1.3  christos 		{
   9250   1.3  christos 		  switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
   9251   1.3  christos 		    {
   9252   1.3  christos 		    case R_PPC_ADDR32:
   9253   1.3  christos 		    case R_PPC_UADDR32:
   9254   1.3  christos 		    case R_PPC_REL32:
   9255   1.3  christos 		    case R_PPC_ADDR30:
   9256   1.3  christos 		      is_data = true;
   9257   1.3  christos 		      break;
   9258   1.3  christos 		    default:
   9259   1.3  christos 		      break;
   9260   1.3  christos 		    }
   9261   1.3  christos 		  break;
   9262   1.3  christos 		}
   9263   1.3  christos 	    }
   9264   1.3  christos 	  if (is_data)
   9265   1.3  christos 	    continue;
   9266   1.3  christos 
   9267   1.3  christos 	  /* Some instructions can be left alone too.  Unconditional
   9268   1.3  christos 	     branches, except for bcctr with BO=0x14 (bctr, bctrl),
   9269   1.3  christos 	     avoid the icache failure.
   9270   1.3  christos 
   9271   1.3  christos 	     The problem occurs due to prefetch across a page boundary
   9272   1.3  christos 	     where stale instructions can be fetched from the next
   9273   1.3  christos 	     page, and the mechanism for flushing these bad
   9274   1.3  christos 	     instructions fails under certain circumstances.  The
   9275   1.3  christos 	     unconditional branches:
   9276   1.3  christos 	     1) Branch: b, bl, ba, bla,
   9277   1.3  christos 	     2) Branch Conditional: bc, bca, bcl, bcla,
   9278   1.3  christos 	     3) Branch Conditional to Link Register: bclr, bclrl,
   9279   1.3  christos 	     where (2) and (3) have BO=0x14 making them unconditional,
   9280   1.3  christos 	     prevent the bad prefetch because the prefetch itself is
   9281   1.3  christos 	     affected by these instructions.  This happens even if the
   9282   1.3  christos 	     instruction is not executed.
   9283   1.3  christos 
   9284   1.3  christos 	     A bctr example:
   9285   1.3  christos 	     .
   9286   1.3  christos 	     .	lis 9,new_page@ha
   9287   1.3  christos 	     .	addi 9,9,new_page@l
   9288   1.3  christos 	     .	mtctr 9
   9289   1.3  christos 	     .	bctr
   9290   1.3  christos 	     .	nop
   9291   1.3  christos 	     .	nop
   9292   1.3  christos 	     . new_page:
   9293   1.3  christos 	     .
   9294   1.3  christos 	     The bctr is not predicted taken due to ctr not being
   9295   1.9  christos 	     ready, so prefetch continues on past the bctr into the
   9296   1.9  christos 	     new page which might have stale instructions.  If they
   9297   1.7  christos 	     fail to be flushed, then they will be executed after the
   9298   1.9  christos 	     bctr executes.  Either of the following modifications
   9299   1.3  christos 	     prevent the bad prefetch from happening in the first
   9300   1.7  christos 	     place:
   9301   1.3  christos 	     .
   9302   1.3  christos 	     .	lis 9,new_page@ha	 lis 9,new_page@ha
   9303   1.3  christos 	     .	addi 9,9,new_page@l	 addi 9,9,new_page@l
   9304   1.3  christos 	     .	mtctr 9			 mtctr 9
   9305   1.3  christos 	     .	bctr			 bctr
   9306   1.3  christos 	     .	nop			 b somewhere_else
   9307   1.3  christos 	     .	b somewhere_else	 nop
   9308   1.3  christos 	     . new_page:		new_page:
   9309   1.3  christos 	     .  */
   9310   1.3  christos 	  insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + offset);
   9311   1.3  christos 	  if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (18u << 26)	    /* b,bl,ba,bla */
   9312   1.3  christos 	      || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (16u << 26)	    /* bc,bcl,bca,bcla*/
   9313   1.3  christos 		  && (insn & (0x14 << 21)) == (0x14 << 21)) /*	 with BO=0x14 */
   9314   1.3  christos 	      || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (19u << 26)
   9315   1.3  christos 		  && (insn & (0x3ff << 1)) == (16u << 1)    /* bclr,bclrl */
   9316   1.3  christos 		  && (insn & (0x14 << 21)) == (0x14 << 21)))/*	 with BO=0x14 */
   9317   1.3  christos 	    continue;
   9318   1.3  christos 
   9319   1.3  christos 	  patch_addr = (start_addr + input_section->size
   9320   1.3  christos 			- relax_info->workaround_size);
   9321   1.3  christos 	  patch_addr = (patch_addr + 15) & -16;
   9322   1.3  christos 	  patch_off = patch_addr - start_addr;
   9323   1.3  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B + patch_off - offset, contents + offset);
   9324   1.3  christos 
   9325   1.3  christos 	  if (rel != NULL
   9326   1.3  christos 	      && rel->r_offset >= offset
   9327   1.3  christos 	      && rel->r_offset < offset + 4)
   9328   1.3  christos 	    {
   9329   1.3  christos 	      asection *sreloc;
   9330   1.3  christos 
   9331   1.3  christos 	      /* If the insn we are patching had a reloc, adjust the
   9332   1.3  christos 		 reloc r_offset so that the reloc applies to the moved
   9333   1.3  christos 		 location.  This matters for -r and --emit-relocs.  */
   9334   1.3  christos 	      if (rel + 1 != relend)
   9335   1.3  christos 		{
   9336   1.3  christos 		  Elf_Internal_Rela tmp = *rel;
   9337   1.3  christos 
   9338   1.3  christos 		  /* Keep the relocs sorted by r_offset.  */
   9339   1.3  christos 		  memmove (rel, rel + 1, (relend - (rel + 1)) * sizeof (*rel));
   9340   1.3  christos 		  relend[-1] = tmp;
   9341   1.3  christos 		}
   9342   1.3  christos 	      relend[-1].r_offset += patch_off - offset;
   9343   1.3  christos 
   9344   1.3  christos 	      /* Adjust REL16 addends too.  */
   9345   1.3  christos 	      switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info))
   9346   1.3  christos 		{
   9347   1.3  christos 		case R_PPC_REL16:
   9348   1.3  christos 		case R_PPC_REL16_LO:
   9349   1.3  christos 		case R_PPC_REL16_HI:
   9350   1.3  christos 		case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
   9351   1.3  christos 		  relend[-1].r_addend += patch_off - offset;
   9352   1.3  christos 		  break;
   9353   1.3  christos 		default:
   9354   1.3  christos 		  break;
   9355   1.3  christos 		}
   9356   1.3  christos 
   9357   1.3  christos 	      /* If we are building a PIE or shared library with
   9358   1.3  christos 		 non-PIC objects, perhaps we had a dynamic reloc too?
   9359   1.3  christos 		 If so, the dynamic reloc must move with the insn.  */
   9360   1.3  christos 	      sreloc = elf_section_data (input_section)->sreloc;
   9361   1.3  christos 	      if (sreloc != NULL)
   9362   1.3  christos 		{
   9363   1.3  christos 		  Elf32_External_Rela *slo, *shi, *srelend;
   9364   1.3  christos 		  bfd_vma soffset;
   9365   1.3  christos 
   9366   1.3  christos 		  slo = (Elf32_External_Rela *) sreloc->contents;
   9367   1.3  christos 		  shi = srelend = slo + sreloc->reloc_count;
   9368   1.3  christos 		  soffset = (offset + input_section->output_section->vma
   9369   1.3  christos 			     + input_section->output_offset);
   9370   1.3  christos 		  while (slo < shi)
   9371   1.3  christos 		    {
   9372   1.3  christos 		      Elf32_External_Rela *srel = slo + (shi - slo) / 2;
   9373   1.3  christos 		      bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_in (output_bfd, (bfd_byte *) srel,
   9374   1.3  christos 						&outrel);
   9375   1.3  christos 		      if (outrel.r_offset < soffset)
   9376   1.3  christos 			slo = srel + 1;
   9377   1.3  christos 		      else if (outrel.r_offset > soffset + 3)
   9378   1.3  christos 			shi = srel;
   9379   1.3  christos 		      else
   9380   1.3  christos 			{
   9381   1.3  christos 			  if (srel + 1 != srelend)
   9382   1.9  christos 			    {
   9383   1.3  christos 			      memmove (srel, srel + 1,
   9384   1.3  christos 				       (srelend - (srel + 1)) * sizeof (*srel));
   9385   1.3  christos 			      srel = srelend - 1;
   9386   1.3  christos 			    }
   9387   1.3  christos 			  outrel.r_offset += patch_off - offset;
   9388   1.3  christos 			  bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel,
   9389   1.3  christos 						     (bfd_byte *) srel);
   9390   1.3  christos 			  break;
   9391   1.3  christos 			}
   9392   1.3  christos 		    }
   9393   1.3  christos 		}
   9394   1.3  christos 	    }
   9395   1.3  christos 	  else
   9396   1.3  christos 	    rel = NULL;
   9397   1.3  christos 
   9398   1.3  christos 	  if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (16u << 26) /* bc */
   9399   1.3  christos 	      && (insn & 2) == 0 /* relative */)
   9400   1.3  christos 	    {
   9401   1.3  christos 	      bfd_vma delta = ((insn & 0xfffc) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000;
   9402   1.3  christos 
   9403   1.3  christos 	      delta += offset - patch_off;
   9404   1.3  christos 	      if (bfd_link_relocatable (info) && rel != NULL)
   9405   1.3  christos 		delta = 0;
   9406   1.3  christos 	      if (!bfd_link_relocatable (info) && rel != NULL)
   9407   1.3  christos 		{
   9408   1.3  christos 		  enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
   9409   1.3  christos 
   9410   1.3  christos 		  r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info);
   9411   1.3  christos 		  if (r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN)
   9412   1.3  christos 		    insn |= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
   9413   1.3  christos 		  else if (r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN)
   9414   1.3  christos 		    insn &= ~BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
   9415   1.3  christos 		  else
   9416   1.3  christos 		    BFD_ASSERT (r_type == R_PPC_REL14);
   9417   1.3  christos 
   9418   1.3  christos 		  if ((r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN
   9419   1.3  christos 		       || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN)
   9420   1.3  christos 		      && delta + 0x8000 < 0x10000
   9421   1.3  christos 		      && (bfd_signed_vma) delta < 0)
   9422   1.3  christos 		    insn ^= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
   9423   1.3  christos 		}
   9424   1.3  christos 	      if (delta + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
   9425   1.3  christos 		{
   9426   1.3  christos 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
   9427   1.3  christos 			      (insn & ~0xfffc) | (delta & 0xfffc),
   9428   1.3  christos 			      contents + patch_off);
   9429   1.3  christos 		  patch_off += 4;
   9430   1.3  christos 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
   9431   1.3  christos 			      B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc),
   9432   1.3  christos 			      contents + patch_off);
   9433   1.3  christos 		  patch_off += 4;
   9434   1.3  christos 		}
   9435   1.3  christos 	      else
   9436   1.3  christos 		{
   9437   1.3  christos 		  if (rel != NULL)
   9438   1.3  christos 		    {
   9439   1.3  christos 		      unsigned int r_sym = ELF32_R_SYM (relend[-1].r_info);
   9440   1.3  christos 
   9441   1.3  christos 		      relend[-1].r_offset += 8;
   9442   1.3  christos 		      relend[-1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_sym, R_PPC_REL24);
   9443   1.3  christos 		    }
   9444   1.3  christos 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
   9445   1.3  christos 			      (insn & ~0xfffc) | 8,
   9446   1.3  christos 			      contents + patch_off);
   9447   1.3  christos 		  patch_off += 4;
   9448   1.3  christos 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
   9449   1.3  christos 			      B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc),
   9450   1.3  christos 			      contents + patch_off);
   9451   1.3  christos 		  patch_off += 4;
   9452   1.3  christos 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
   9453   1.3  christos 			      B | ((delta - 8) & 0x3fffffc),
   9454   1.3  christos 			      contents + patch_off);
   9455   1.3  christos 		  patch_off += 4;
   9456   1.1  christos 		}
   9457   1.1  christos 	    }
   9458   1.1  christos 	  else
   9459   1.7  christos 	    {
   9460   1.1  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + patch_off);
   9461  1.10  christos 	      patch_off += 4;
   9462   1.7  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
   9463   1.1  christos 			  B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc),
   9464   1.7  christos 			  contents + patch_off);
   9465   1.7  christos 	      patch_off += 4;
   9466   1.1  christos 	    }
   9467  1.10  christos 	  BFD_ASSERT (patch_off <= input_section->size);
   9468   1.1  christos 	  relax_info->workaround_size = input_section->size - patch_off;
   9469  1.10  christos 	}
   9470   1.1  christos     }
   9471   1.1  christos 
   9472   1.1  christos   return ret;
   9473  1.10  christos }
   9474  1.10  christos 
   9475   1.1  christos /* Write out the PLT relocs and entries for H.  */
   9477   1.1  christos 
   9478   1.1  christos static bool
   9479   1.1  christos write_global_sym_plt (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
   9480   1.7  christos {
   9481   1.7  christos   struct bfd_link_info *info = (struct bfd_link_info *) inf;
   9482   1.1  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   9483  1.10  christos   struct plt_entry *ent;
   9484   1.1  christos   bool doneone;
   9485   1.1  christos 
   9486   1.1  christos   doneone = false;
   9487   1.1  christos   for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
   9488   1.1  christos     if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
   9489   1.1  christos       {
   9490   1.1  christos 	bool dyn = !use_local_plt (info, h);
   9491   1.1  christos 
   9492   1.1  christos 	if (!doneone)
   9493   1.1  christos 	  {
   9494   1.1  christos 	    Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
   9495   1.1  christos 	    bfd_byte *loc;
   9496  1.10  christos 	    bfd_vma reloc_index;
   9497   1.1  christos 	    asection *plt = htab->elf.splt;
   9498   1.1  christos 	    asection *relplt = htab->elf.srelplt;
   9499   1.1  christos 
   9500   1.1  christos 	    if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW || !dyn)
   9501   1.1  christos 	      reloc_index = ent->plt.offset / 4;
   9502   1.1  christos 	    else
   9503   1.1  christos 	      {
   9504   1.1  christos 		reloc_index = ((ent->plt.offset - htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
   9505   1.3  christos 			       / htab->plt_slot_size);
   9506   1.1  christos 		if (reloc_index > PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES
   9507   1.1  christos 		    && htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
   9508   1.1  christos 		  reloc_index -= (reloc_index - PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES) / 2;
   9509   1.3  christos 	      }
   9510   1.1  christos 
   9511   1.7  christos 	    /* This symbol has an entry in the procedure linkage table.
   9512   1.1  christos 	       Set it up.  */
   9513   1.7  christos 	    if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS && dyn)
   9514   1.7  christos 	      {
   9515   1.1  christos 		bfd_vma got_offset;
   9516   1.7  christos 		const bfd_vma *plt_entry;
   9517   1.1  christos 
   9518   1.1  christos 		/* The first three entries in .got.plt are reserved.  */
   9519   1.1  christos 		got_offset = (reloc_index + 3) * 4;
   9520   1.1  christos 
   9521   1.1  christos 		/* Use the right PLT. */
   9522   1.7  christos 		plt_entry = bfd_link_pic (info) ? ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt_entry
   9523   1.1  christos 			    : ppc_elf_vxworks_plt_entry;
   9524   1.7  christos 
   9525   1.7  christos 		/* Fill in the .plt on VxWorks.  */
   9526   1.1  christos 		if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   9527   1.7  christos 		  {
   9528   1.1  christos 		    bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
   9529   1.1  christos 				plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_offset),
   9530   1.7  christos 				plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 0);
   9531   1.7  christos 		    bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
   9532   1.7  christos 				plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_offset),
   9533   1.7  christos 				plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 4);
   9534   1.1  christos 		  }
   9535   1.1  christos 		else
   9536   1.1  christos 		  {
   9537   1.1  christos 		    bfd_vma got_loc = got_offset + SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
   9538   1.1  christos 
   9539   1.1  christos 		    bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
   9540   1.1  christos 				plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_loc),
   9541   1.7  christos 				plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 0);
   9542   1.1  christos 		    bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
   9543   1.7  christos 				plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_loc),
   9544   1.1  christos 				plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 4);
   9545   1.1  christos 		  }
   9546   1.1  christos 
   9547   1.1  christos 		bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[2],
   9548   1.1  christos 			    plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 8);
   9549   1.1  christos 		bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[3],
   9550   1.7  christos 			    plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 12);
   9551   1.1  christos 
   9552   1.1  christos 		/* This instruction is an immediate load.  The value loaded is
   9553   1.7  christos 		   the byte offset of the R_PPC_JMP_SLOT relocation from the
   9554   1.7  christos 		   start of the .rela.plt section.  The value is stored in the
   9555   1.7  christos 		   low-order 16 bits of the load instruction.  */
   9556   1.7  christos 		/* NOTE: It appears that this is now an index rather than a
   9557   1.7  christos 		   prescaled offset.  */
   9558   1.1  christos 		bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
   9559   1.1  christos 			    plt_entry[4] | reloc_index,
   9560   1.1  christos 			    plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 16);
   9561   1.1  christos 		/* This instruction is a PC-relative branch whose target is
   9562   1.7  christos 		   the start of the PLT section.  The address of this branch
   9563   1.7  christos 		   instruction is 20 bytes beyond the start of this PLT entry.
   9564   1.7  christos 		   The address is encoded in bits 6-29, inclusive.  The value
   9565   1.7  christos 		   stored is right-shifted by two bits, permitting a 26-bit
   9566   1.1  christos 		   offset.  */
   9567   1.3  christos 		bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
   9568   1.1  christos 			    (plt_entry[5]
   9569   1.1  christos 			     | (-(ent->plt.offset + 20) & 0x03fffffc)),
   9570   1.1  christos 			    plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 20);
   9571   1.1  christos 		bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[6],
   9572   1.1  christos 			    plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 24);
   9573   1.1  christos 		bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[7],
   9574   1.1  christos 			    plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 28);
   9575   1.1  christos 
   9576   1.7  christos 		/* Fill in the GOT entry corresponding to this PLT slot with
   9577   1.7  christos 		   the address immediately after the "bctr" instruction
   9578   1.1  christos 		   in this PLT entry.  */
   9579   1.1  christos 		bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, (plt->output_section->vma
   9580   1.1  christos 					       + plt->output_offset
   9581   1.1  christos 					       + ent->plt.offset + 16),
   9582  1.11  christos 			    htab->elf.sgotplt->contents + got_offset);
   9583  1.11  christos 
   9584   1.1  christos 		if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
   9585   1.1  christos 		  {
   9586   1.1  christos 		    /* Fill in a couple of entries in .rela.plt.unloaded.  */
   9587   1.7  christos 		    loc = htab->srelplt2->contents
   9588   1.7  christos 		      + ((VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS + reloc_index
   9589   1.1  christos 			  * VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS)
   9590   1.1  christos 			 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
   9591   1.1  christos 
   9592   1.1  christos 		    /* Provide the @ha relocation for the first instruction.  */
   9593  1.11  christos 		    rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
   9594  1.11  christos 				     + plt->output_offset
   9595   1.1  christos 				     + ent->plt.offset + 2);
   9596   1.1  christos 		    rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx,
   9597   1.1  christos 						R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
   9598   1.1  christos 		    rela.r_addend = got_offset;
   9599   1.7  christos 		    BFD_ASSERT (swap_reloc_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc,
   9600   1.7  christos 						htab->srelplt2));
   9601   1.1  christos 		    loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   9602   1.1  christos 
   9603   1.1  christos 		    /* Provide the @l relocation for the second instruction.  */
   9604   1.1  christos 		    rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
   9605  1.11  christos 				     + plt->output_offset
   9606  1.11  christos 				     + ent->plt.offset + 6);
   9607   1.1  christos 		    rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx,
   9608   1.1  christos 						R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
   9609   1.1  christos 		    rela.r_addend = got_offset;
   9610   1.1  christos 		    BFD_ASSERT (swap_reloc_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc,
   9611   1.1  christos 						htab->srelplt2));
   9612   1.1  christos 		    loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   9613   1.1  christos 
   9614   1.7  christos 		    /* Provide a relocation for the GOT entry corresponding to this
   9615   1.7  christos 		       PLT slot.  Point it at the middle of the .plt entry.  */
   9616   1.1  christos 		    rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgotplt->output_section->vma
   9617   1.7  christos 				     + htab->elf.sgotplt->output_offset
   9618   1.1  christos 				     + got_offset);
   9619   1.1  christos 		    rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hplt->indx,
   9620   1.1  christos 						R_PPC_ADDR32);
   9621   1.7  christos 		    rela.r_addend = ent->plt.offset + 16;
   9622  1.10  christos 		    BFD_ASSERT (swap_reloc_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc,
   9623   1.7  christos 						htab->srelplt2));
   9624   1.7  christos 		  }
   9625   1.7  christos 
   9626   1.7  christos 		/* VxWorks uses non-standard semantics for R_PPC_JMP_SLOT.
   9627   1.7  christos 		   In particular, the offset for the relocation is not the
   9628   1.7  christos 		   address of the PLT entry for this function, as specified
   9629   1.7  christos 		   by the ABI.  Instead, the offset is set to the address of
   9630   1.7  christos 		   the GOT slot for this function.  See EABI 4.4.4.1.  */
   9631   1.7  christos 		rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgotplt->output_section->vma
   9632   1.7  christos 				 + htab->elf.sgotplt->output_offset
   9633   1.7  christos 				 + got_offset);
   9634   1.7  christos 		rela.r_addend = 0;
   9635   1.7  christos 	      }
   9636   1.7  christos 	    else
   9637   1.7  christos 	      {
   9638   1.7  christos 		rela.r_addend = 0;
   9639   1.1  christos 		if (!dyn)
   9640   1.7  christos 		  {
   9641   1.1  christos 		    if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
   9642   1.7  christos 		      {
   9643   1.7  christos 			plt = htab->elf.iplt;
   9644   1.1  christos 			relplt = htab->elf.irelplt;
   9645   1.1  christos 		      }
   9646   1.1  christos 		    else
   9647   1.7  christos 		      {
   9648   1.7  christos 			plt = htab->pltlocal;
   9649   1.7  christos 			relplt = bfd_link_pic (info) ? htab->relpltlocal : NULL;
   9650   1.7  christos 		      }
   9651  1.10  christos 		    if (h->def_regular
   9652   1.7  christos 			&& (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
   9653   1.7  christos 			    || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak))
   9654   1.7  christos 		      rela.r_addend = SYM_VAL (h);
   9655   1.7  christos 		  }
   9656   1.7  christos 
   9657   1.7  christos 		if (relplt == NULL)
   9658   1.7  christos 		  {
   9659   1.7  christos 		    loc = plt->contents + ent->plt.offset;
   9660   1.7  christos 		    bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, rela.r_addend, loc);
   9661   1.7  christos 		  }
   9662   1.7  christos 		else
   9663   1.7  christos 		  {
   9664   1.1  christos 		    rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
   9665   1.1  christos 				     + plt->output_offset
   9666   1.1  christos 				     + ent->plt.offset);
   9667   1.7  christos 
   9668   1.1  christos 		    if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD || !dyn)
   9669   1.7  christos 		      {
   9670  1.10  christos 			/* We don't need to fill in the .plt.  The ppc dynamic
   9671   1.7  christos 			   linker will fill it in.  */
   9672   1.7  christos 		      }
   9673   1.7  christos 		    else
   9674   1.7  christos 		      {
   9675   1.7  christos 			bfd_vma val = (htab->glink_pltresolve + ent->plt.offset
   9676   1.7  christos 				       + htab->glink->output_section->vma
   9677   1.7  christos 				       + htab->glink->output_offset);
   9678   1.7  christos 			bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, val,
   9679   1.7  christos 				    plt->contents + ent->plt.offset);
   9680   1.7  christos 		      }
   9681   1.1  christos 		  }
   9682   1.7  christos 	      }
   9683   1.7  christos 
   9684   1.7  christos 	    if (relplt != NULL)
   9685   1.7  christos 	      {
   9686   1.7  christos 		/* Fill in the entry in the .rela.plt section.  */
   9687   1.1  christos 		if (!dyn)
   9688  1.11  christos 		  {
   9689  1.11  christos 		    if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
   9690   1.1  christos 		      rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
   9691  1.10  christos 		    else
   9692   1.1  christos 		      rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
   9693   1.1  christos 		    loc = relplt->contents + (relplt->reloc_count++
   9694  1.10  christos 					      * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
   9695   1.1  christos 		    htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
   9696   1.1  christos 		  }
   9697   1.7  christos 		else
   9698   1.7  christos 		  {
   9699  1.10  christos 		    rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_PPC_JMP_SLOT);
   9700   1.1  christos 		    loc = relplt->contents + (reloc_index
   9701   1.7  christos 					      * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
   9702   1.7  christos 		    if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && is_static_defined (h))
   9703   1.7  christos 		      htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
   9704   1.7  christos 		  }
   9705   1.1  christos 		BFD_ASSERT (swap_reloc_out (info->output_bfd, &rela,
   9706   1.1  christos 					    loc, relplt));
   9707   1.7  christos 	      }
   9708   1.7  christos 	    doneone = true;
   9709   1.1  christos 	  }
   9710   1.3  christos 
   9711   1.1  christos 	if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW || !dyn)
   9712   1.1  christos 	  {
   9713   1.1  christos 	    unsigned char *p;
   9714   1.1  christos 	    asection *plt = htab->elf.splt;
   9715   1.1  christos 
   9716   1.1  christos 	    if (!dyn)
   9717  1.10  christos 	      {
   9718   1.7  christos 		if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
   9719   1.7  christos 		  plt = htab->elf.iplt;
   9720   1.7  christos 		else
   9721   1.7  christos 		  break;
   9722  1.10  christos 	      }
   9723   1.7  christos 
   9724   1.7  christos 	    p = (unsigned char *) htab->glink->contents + ent->glink_offset;
   9725   1.7  christos 	    write_glink_stub (h, ent, plt, p, info);
   9726   1.7  christos 
   9727   1.7  christos 	    if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
   9728   1.7  christos 	      /* We only need one non-PIC glink stub.  */
   9729  1.10  christos 	      break;
   9730   1.7  christos 	  }
   9731   1.7  christos 	else
   9732   1.7  christos 	  break;
   9733   1.7  christos       }
   9734   1.7  christos   return true;
   9735   1.7  christos }
   9736   1.7  christos 
   9737   1.7  christos /* Finish up PLT handling.  */
   9738   1.7  christos 
   9739   1.7  christos bool
   9740   1.7  christos ppc_finish_symbols (struct bfd_link_info *info)
   9741   1.7  christos {
   9742   1.7  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   9743   1.7  christos   bfd *ibfd;
   9744   1.7  christos 
   9745   1.7  christos   if (!htab)
   9746   1.7  christos     return true;
   9747   1.7  christos 
   9748   1.7  christos   elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf, write_global_sym_plt, info);
   9749   1.7  christos 
   9750   1.7  christos   for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
   9751   1.7  christos     {
   9752   1.7  christos       bfd_vma *local_got, *end_local_got;
   9753   1.7  christos       struct plt_entry **local_plt, **lplt, **end_local_plt;
   9754   1.7  christos       Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
   9755   1.7  christos       bfd_size_type locsymcount;
   9756   1.7  christos       Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms = NULL;
   9757   1.7  christos       struct plt_entry *ent;
   9758   1.7  christos 
   9759   1.7  christos       if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
   9760   1.7  christos 	continue;
   9761   1.7  christos 
   9762   1.7  christos       local_got = elf_local_got_offsets (ibfd);
   9763   1.7  christos       if (!local_got)
   9764   1.7  christos 	continue;
   9765   1.9  christos 
   9766   1.7  christos       symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
   9767   1.7  christos       locsymcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
   9768   1.7  christos       end_local_got = local_got + locsymcount;
   9769   1.7  christos       local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) end_local_got;
   9770  1.10  christos       end_local_plt = local_plt + locsymcount;
   9771   1.7  christos       for (lplt = local_plt; lplt < end_local_plt; ++lplt)
   9772  1.10  christos 	for (ent = *lplt; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
   9773   1.7  christos 	  {
   9774   1.7  christos 	    if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
   9775   1.7  christos 	      {
   9776   1.7  christos 		Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
   9777   1.7  christos 		asection *sym_sec;
   9778   1.7  christos 		asection *plt, *relplt;
   9779   1.7  christos 		bfd_byte *loc;
   9780   1.7  christos 		bfd_vma val;
   9781   1.7  christos 		Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
   9782   1.7  christos 		unsigned char *p;
   9783   1.7  christos 
   9784   1.7  christos 		if (!get_sym_h (NULL, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
   9785   1.7  christos 				lplt - local_plt, ibfd))
   9786   1.7  christos 		  {
   9787   1.7  christos 		    if (symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
   9788   1.7  christos 		      free (local_syms);
   9789   1.7  christos 		    return false;
   9790   1.7  christos 		  }
   9791   1.7  christos 
   9792   1.7  christos 		val = sym->st_value;
   9793   1.7  christos 		if (sym_sec != NULL && sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
   9794   1.7  christos 		  val += sym_sec->output_offset + sym_sec->output_section->vma;
   9795   1.7  christos 
   9796   1.7  christos 		if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
   9797   1.7  christos 		  {
   9798   1.7  christos 		    htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
   9799   1.7  christos 		    plt = htab->elf.iplt;
   9800   1.7  christos 		    relplt = htab->elf.irelplt;
   9801   1.7  christos 		    rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
   9802   1.7  christos 		  }
   9803   1.7  christos 		else
   9804   1.7  christos 		  {
   9805   1.7  christos 		    plt = htab->pltlocal;
   9806  1.11  christos 		    if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   9807  1.11  christos 		      {
   9808   1.7  christos 			relplt = htab->relpltlocal;
   9809   1.9  christos 			rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
   9810   1.7  christos 		      }
   9811   1.7  christos 		    else
   9812   1.7  christos 		      {
   9813   1.7  christos 			loc = plt->contents + ent->plt.offset;
   9814   1.7  christos 			bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, val, loc);
   9815   1.7  christos 			continue;
   9816   1.7  christos 		      }
   9817   1.7  christos 		  }
   9818   1.7  christos 
   9819   1.7  christos 		rela.r_offset = (ent->plt.offset
   9820   1.7  christos 				 + plt->output_offset
   9821   1.7  christos 				 + plt->output_section->vma);
   9822   1.7  christos 		rela.r_addend = val;
   9823  1.10  christos 		BFD_ASSERT (count_and_swap_reloc_out (info->output_bfd, &rela,
   9824   1.7  christos 						      relplt));
   9825   1.7  christos 
   9826   1.7  christos 		p = (unsigned char *) htab->glink->contents + ent->glink_offset;
   9827   1.7  christos 		write_glink_stub (NULL, ent, htab->elf.iplt, p, info);
   9828   1.7  christos 	      }
   9829  1.10  christos 	  }
   9830   1.7  christos 
   9831   1.7  christos       if (local_syms != NULL
   9832   1.7  christos 	  && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
   9833   1.7  christos 	{
   9834   1.7  christos 	  if (!info->keep_memory)
   9835   1.7  christos 	    free (local_syms);
   9836   1.7  christos 	  else
   9837   1.7  christos 	    symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
   9838   1.7  christos 	}
   9839   1.7  christos     }
   9840   1.7  christos   return true;
   9841   1.7  christos }
   9842   1.7  christos 
   9843   1.7  christos /* Finish up dynamic symbol handling.  We set the contents of various
   9844   1.7  christos    dynamic sections here.  */
   9845   1.7  christos 
   9846   1.7  christos static bool
   9847   1.7  christos ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *output_bfd,
   9848   1.7  christos 			       struct bfd_link_info *info,
   9849   1.7  christos 			       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
   9850   1.7  christos 			       Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
   9851   1.7  christos {
   9852   1.7  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   9853   1.7  christos   struct plt_entry *ent;
   9854   1.7  christos 
   9855   1.7  christos #ifdef DEBUG
   9856   1.7  christos   fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol called for %s",
   9857   1.7  christos 	   h->root.root.string);
   9858   1.7  christos #endif
   9859   1.7  christos 
   9860   1.7  christos   if (!h->def_regular
   9861   1.7  christos       || (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && !bfd_link_pic (info)))
   9862   1.7  christos     for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
   9863   1.7  christos       if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
   9864   1.7  christos 	{
   9865   1.7  christos 	  if (!h->def_regular)
   9866   1.7  christos 	    {
   9867   1.7  christos 	      /* Mark the symbol as undefined, rather than as
   9868   1.7  christos 		 defined in the .plt section.  Leave the value if
   9869   1.7  christos 		 there were any relocations where pointer equality
   9870   1.7  christos 		 matters (this is a clue for the dynamic linker, to
   9871   1.7  christos 		 make function pointer comparisons work between an
   9872   1.7  christos 		 application and shared library), otherwise set it
   9873   1.7  christos 		 to zero.  */
   9874   1.7  christos 	      sym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
   9875   1.7  christos 	      if (!h->pointer_equality_needed)
   9876   1.7  christos 		sym->st_value = 0;
   9877   1.7  christos 	      else if (!h->ref_regular_nonweak)
   9878   1.7  christos 		{
   9879   1.7  christos 		  /* This breaks function pointer comparisons, but
   9880   1.7  christos 		     that is better than breaking tests for a NULL
   9881   1.7  christos 		     function pointer.  */
   9882   1.7  christos 		  sym->st_value = 0;
   9883   1.7  christos 		}
   9884   1.7  christos 	    }
   9885   1.7  christos 	  else
   9886   1.1  christos 	    {
   9887   1.1  christos 	      /* Set the value of ifunc symbols in a non-pie
   9888   1.1  christos 		 executable to the glink entry.  This is to avoid
   9889   1.1  christos 		 text relocations.  We can't do this for ifunc in
   9890   1.1  christos 		 allocate_dynrelocs, as we do for normal dynamic
   9891   1.1  christos 		 function symbols with plt entries, because we need
   9892   1.1  christos 		 to keep the original value around for the ifunc
   9893   1.1  christos 		 relocation.  */
   9894   1.1  christos 	      sym->st_shndx
   9895   1.1  christos 		= (_bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section
   9896   1.1  christos 		   (info->output_bfd, htab->glink->output_section));
   9897   1.1  christos 	      sym->st_value = (ent->glink_offset
   9898   1.1  christos 			       + htab->glink->output_offset
   9899   1.1  christos 			       + htab->glink->output_section->vma);
   9900   1.1  christos 	    }
   9901   1.1  christos 	  break;
   9902   1.7  christos 	}
   9903   1.7  christos 
   9904   1.1  christos   if (h->needs_copy)
   9905   1.7  christos     {
   9906   1.1  christos       asection *s;
   9907   1.1  christos       Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
   9908   1.1  christos 
   9909   1.1  christos       /* This symbols needs a copy reloc.  Set it up.  */
   9910   1.1  christos 
   9911  1.11  christos #ifdef DEBUG
   9912   1.1  christos       fprintf (stderr, ", copy");
   9913   1.1  christos #endif
   9914   1.1  christos 
   9915   1.1  christos       BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1);
   9916   1.1  christos 
   9917   1.1  christos       if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs)
   9918  1.10  christos 	s = htab->relsbss;
   9919   1.1  christos       else if (h->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynrelro)
   9920   1.1  christos 	s = htab->elf.sreldynrelro;
   9921   1.1  christos       else
   9922   1.3  christos 	s = htab->elf.srelbss;
   9923   1.3  christos       BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
   9924   1.3  christos 
   9925   1.1  christos       rela.r_offset = SYM_VAL (h);
   9926   1.3  christos       rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_PPC_COPY);
   9927   1.3  christos       rela.r_addend = 0;
   9928   1.7  christos       BFD_ASSERT (count_and_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rela, s));
   9929   1.3  christos     }
   9930   1.3  christos 
   9931   1.1  christos #ifdef DEBUG
   9932   1.1  christos   fprintf (stderr, "\n");
   9933   1.1  christos #endif
   9934   1.1  christos 
   9935   1.1  christos   return true;
   9936   1.1  christos }
   9937   1.1  christos 
   9938   1.1  christos static enum elf_reloc_type_class
   9940   1.1  christos ppc_elf_reloc_type_class (const struct bfd_link_info *info,
   9941   1.1  christos 			  const asection *rel_sec,
   9942   1.1  christos 			  const Elf_Internal_Rela *rela)
   9943   1.1  christos {
   9944   1.1  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   9945   1.1  christos 
   9946  1.10  christos   if (rel_sec == htab->elf.irelplt)
   9947   1.1  christos     return reloc_class_ifunc;
   9948   1.1  christos 
   9949   1.1  christos   switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rela->r_info))
   9950   1.1  christos     {
   9951   1.1  christos     case R_PPC_RELATIVE:
   9952   1.1  christos       return reloc_class_relative;
   9953   1.1  christos     case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT:
   9954  1.10  christos       return reloc_class_plt;
   9955   1.1  christos     case R_PPC_COPY:
   9956   1.1  christos       return reloc_class_copy;
   9957   1.1  christos     default:
   9958   1.1  christos       return reloc_class_normal;
   9959   1.1  christos     }
   9960   1.1  christos }
   9961   1.7  christos 
   9962   1.1  christos /* Finish up the dynamic sections.  */
   9964   1.1  christos 
   9965   1.1  christos static bool
   9966   1.1  christos ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
   9967   1.1  christos 				 struct bfd_link_info *info)
   9968   1.1  christos {
   9969   1.1  christos   asection *sdyn;
   9970   1.1  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
   9971   1.1  christos   bfd_vma got;
   9972   1.7  christos   bfd *dynobj;
   9973   1.1  christos   bool ret = true;
   9974   1.1  christos 
   9975   1.1  christos #ifdef DEBUG
   9976   1.1  christos   fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections called\n");
   9977   1.1  christos #endif
   9978   1.1  christos 
   9979   1.1  christos   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   9980   1.1  christos   dynobj = htab->elf.dynobj;
   9981   1.1  christos   sdyn = bfd_get_linker_section (dynobj, ".dynamic");
   9982   1.1  christos 
   9983   1.1  christos   got = 0;
   9984   1.1  christos   if (htab->elf.hgot != NULL)
   9985   1.1  christos     got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
   9986  1.10  christos 
   9987   1.7  christos   if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
   9988   1.1  christos     {
   9989   1.7  christos       Elf32_External_Dyn *dyncon, *dynconend;
   9990   1.1  christos 
   9991   1.1  christos       BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.splt != NULL && sdyn != NULL);
   9992   1.1  christos 
   9993   1.1  christos       dyncon = (Elf32_External_Dyn *) sdyn->contents;
   9994   1.7  christos       dynconend = (Elf32_External_Dyn *) (sdyn->contents + sdyn->size);
   9995   1.1  christos       for (; dyncon < dynconend; dyncon++)
   9996   1.1  christos 	{
   9997   1.1  christos 	  Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
   9998   1.7  christos 	  asection *s;
   9999   1.1  christos 
   10000   1.1  christos 	  bfd_elf32_swap_dyn_in (dynobj, dyncon, &dyn);
   10001   1.1  christos 
   10002   1.1  christos 	  switch (dyn.d_tag)
   10003   1.1  christos 	    {
   10004   1.1  christos 	    case DT_PLTGOT:
   10005   1.1  christos 	      if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks)
   10006   1.7  christos 		s = htab->elf.sgotplt;
   10007   1.7  christos 	      else
   10008   1.7  christos 		s = htab->elf.splt;
   10009   1.7  christos 	      dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
   10010   1.7  christos 	      break;
   10011   1.7  christos 
   10012   1.7  christos 	    case DT_PLTRELSZ:
   10013   1.7  christos 	      dyn.d_un.d_val = htab->elf.srelplt->size;
   10014   1.7  christos 	      break;
   10015   1.1  christos 
   10016   1.1  christos 	    case DT_JMPREL:
   10017   1.1  christos 	      s = htab->elf.srelplt;
   10018  1.10  christos 	      dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
   10019   1.1  christos 	      break;
   10020   1.1  christos 
   10021   1.1  christos 	    case DT_PPC_GOT:
   10022   1.1  christos 	      dyn.d_un.d_ptr = got;
   10023   1.1  christos 	      break;
   10024   1.1  christos 
   10025   1.1  christos 	    case DT_TEXTREL:
   10026   1.1  christos 	      if (htab->local_ifunc_resolver)
   10027   1.1  christos 		info->callbacks->einfo
   10028   1.7  christos 		  (_("%X%P: text relocations and GNU indirect "
   10029   1.7  christos 		     "functions will result in a segfault at runtime\n"));
   10030   1.1  christos 	      else if (htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver)
   10031   1.7  christos 		info->callbacks->einfo
   10032   1.7  christos 		  (_("%P: warning: text relocations and GNU indirect "
   10033   1.1  christos 		     "functions may result in a segfault at runtime\n"));
   10034   1.1  christos 	      continue;
   10035   1.1  christos 
   10036   1.1  christos 	    default:
   10037   1.1  christos 	      if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks
   10038   1.1  christos 		  && elf_vxworks_finish_dynamic_entry (output_bfd, &dyn))
   10039   1.1  christos 		break;
   10040   1.1  christos 	      continue;
   10041   1.1  christos 	    }
   10042   1.1  christos 
   10043   1.1  christos 	  bfd_elf32_swap_dyn_out (output_bfd, &dyn, dyncon);
   10044   1.1  christos 	}
   10045   1.1  christos     }
   10046   1.1  christos 
   10047   1.1  christos   if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL
   10048   1.1  christos       && htab->elf.sgot->output_section != bfd_abs_section_ptr)
   10049   1.1  christos     {
   10050   1.1  christos       if (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sgot
   10051   1.1  christos 	  || htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sgotplt)
   10052   1.1  christos 	{
   10053   1.1  christos 	  unsigned char *p = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->contents;
   10054   1.1  christos 
   10055   1.1  christos 	  p += htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value;
   10056   1.1  christos 	  if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
   10057   1.7  christos 	    {
   10058   1.7  christos 	      /* Add a blrl instruction at _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_-4
   10059   1.7  christos 		 so that a function can easily find the address of
   10060   1.7  christos 		 _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_.  */
   10061   1.7  christos 	      BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value - 4
   10062   1.1  christos 			  < htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->size);
   10063  1.10  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, 0x4e800021, p - 4);
   10064   1.1  christos 	    }
   10065   1.1  christos 
   10066   1.7  christos 	  if (sdyn != NULL)
   10067   1.1  christos 	    {
   10068   1.1  christos 	      bfd_vma val = sdyn->output_section->vma + sdyn->output_offset;
   10069   1.1  christos 	      BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value
   10070  1.10  christos 			  < htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->size);
   10071   1.7  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, val, p);
   10072   1.7  christos 	    }
   10073   1.7  christos 	}
   10074   1.1  christos       else
   10075   1.7  christos 	{
   10076   1.1  christos 	  /* xgettext:c-format */
   10077   1.3  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler (_("%s not defined in linker created %pA"),
   10078   1.1  christos 			      htab->elf.hgot->root.root.string,
   10079   1.1  christos 			      (htab->elf.sgotplt != NULL
   10080   1.1  christos 			       ? htab->elf.sgotplt : htab->elf.sgot));
   10081   1.3  christos 	  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
   10082   1.1  christos 	  ret = false;
   10083   1.1  christos 	}
   10084   1.1  christos 
   10085   1.1  christos       elf_section_data (htab->elf.sgot->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_entsize = 4;
   10086   1.1  christos     }
   10087   1.1  christos 
   10088   1.1  christos   /* Fill in the first entry in the VxWorks procedure linkage table.  */
   10089   1.1  christos   if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks
   10090   1.1  christos       && htab->elf.splt != NULL
   10091   1.1  christos       && htab->elf.splt->size != 0
   10092   1.1  christos       && htab->elf.splt->output_section != bfd_abs_section_ptr)
   10093   1.1  christos     {
   10094   1.1  christos       asection *splt = htab->elf.splt;
   10095   1.1  christos       /* Use the right PLT. */
   10096   1.1  christos       const bfd_vma *plt_entry = (bfd_link_pic (info)
   10097   1.1  christos 				  ? ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt0_entry
   10098   1.1  christos 				  : ppc_elf_vxworks_plt0_entry);
   10099   1.1  christos 
   10100   1.1  christos       if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
   10101   1.1  christos 	{
   10102   1.3  christos 	  bfd_vma got_value = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
   10103   1.1  christos 
   10104   1.1  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_value),
   10105   1.1  christos 		      splt->contents +  0);
   10106   1.1  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_value),
   10107   1.1  christos 		      splt->contents +  4);
   10108   1.1  christos 	}
   10109   1.1  christos       else
   10110   1.7  christos 	{
   10111   1.7  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0], splt->contents +  0);
   10112   1.1  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1], splt->contents +  4);
   10113   1.1  christos 	}
   10114   1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[2], splt->contents +  8);
   10115  1.11  christos       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[3], splt->contents + 12);
   10116   1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[4], splt->contents + 16);
   10117   1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[5], splt->contents + 20);
   10118   1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[6], splt->contents + 24);
   10119   1.7  christos       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[7], splt->contents + 28);
   10120   1.7  christos 
   10121   1.1  christos       if (! bfd_link_pic (info))
   10122   1.1  christos 	{
   10123   1.1  christos 	  Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
   10124  1.11  christos 	  bfd_byte *loc;
   10125   1.1  christos 
   10126   1.1  christos 	  loc = htab->srelplt2->contents;
   10127   1.1  christos 
   10128   1.1  christos 	  /* Output the @ha relocation for the first instruction.  */
   10129   1.1  christos 	  rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
   10130   1.1  christos 			   + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
   10131   1.1  christos 			   + 2);
   10132   1.1  christos 	  rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
   10133   1.1  christos 	  rela.r_addend = 0;
   10134   1.1  christos 	  BFD_ASSERT (swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc, htab->srelplt2));
   10135   1.1  christos 	  loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   10136   1.1  christos 
   10137   1.1  christos 	  /* Output the @l relocation for the second instruction.  */
   10138   1.1  christos 	  rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
   10139   1.1  christos 			   + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
   10140   1.1  christos 			   + 6);
   10141   1.1  christos 	  rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
   10142   1.1  christos 	  rela.r_addend = 0;
   10143   1.1  christos 	  BFD_ASSERT (swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc, htab->srelplt2));
   10144   1.1  christos 	  loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   10145   1.1  christos 
   10146   1.1  christos 	  /* Fix up the remaining relocations.  They may have the wrong
   10147   1.1  christos 	     symbol index for _G_O_T_ or _P_L_T_ depending on the order
   10148   1.1  christos 	     in which symbols were output.  */
   10149   1.1  christos 	  while (loc < htab->srelplt2->contents + htab->srelplt2->size)
   10150   1.1  christos 	    {
   10151   1.1  christos 	      Elf_Internal_Rela rel;
   10152   1.1  christos 
   10153   1.1  christos 	      bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
   10154   1.1  christos 	      rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
   10155   1.1  christos 	      bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
   10156   1.1  christos 	      loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   10157   1.1  christos 
   10158   1.1  christos 	      bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
   10159   1.1  christos 	      rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
   10160   1.1  christos 	      bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
   10161   1.1  christos 	      loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   10162   1.1  christos 
   10163   1.1  christos 	      bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
   10164   1.1  christos 	      rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hplt->indx, R_PPC_ADDR32);
   10165   1.1  christos 	      bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
   10166   1.1  christos 	      loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   10167   1.1  christos 	    }
   10168   1.1  christos 	}
   10169   1.1  christos     }
   10170   1.1  christos 
   10171   1.1  christos   if (htab->glink != NULL
   10172   1.1  christos       && htab->glink->contents != NULL
   10173   1.1  christos       && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
   10174   1.1  christos     {
   10175   1.1  christos       unsigned char *p;
   10176   1.1  christos       unsigned char *endp;
   10177   1.1  christos       bfd_vma res0;
   10178   1.1  christos 
   10179   1.1  christos       /*
   10180   1.1  christos        * PIC glink code is the following:
   10181   1.1  christos        *
   10182   1.1  christos        * # ith PLT code stub.
   10183   1.1  christos        *   addis 11,30,(plt+(i-1)*4-got)@ha
   10184   1.1  christos        *   lwz 11,(plt+(i-1)*4-got)@l(11)
   10185   1.1  christos        *   mtctr 11
   10186   1.1  christos        *   bctr
   10187   1.7  christos        *
   10188   1.1  christos        * # A table of branches, one for each plt entry.
   10189   1.7  christos        * # The idea is that the plt call stub loads ctr and r11 with these
   10190   1.7  christos        * # addresses, so (r11 - res_0) gives the plt index * 4.
   10191   1.1  christos        * res_0:	b PLTresolve
   10192   1.1  christos        * res_1:	b PLTresolve
   10193   1.7  christos        * .
   10194   1.1  christos        * # Some number of entries towards the end can be nops
   10195   1.7  christos        * res_n_m3: nop
   10196   1.1  christos        * res_n_m2: nop
   10197   1.1  christos        * res_n_m1:
   10198   1.1  christos        *
   10199   1.1  christos        * PLTresolve:
   10200   1.1  christos        *    addis 11,11,(1f-res_0)@ha
   10201   1.1  christos        *    mflr 0
   10202   1.1  christos        *    bcl 20,31,1f
   10203   1.1  christos        * 1: addi 11,11,(1b-res_0)@l
   10204   1.1  christos        *    mflr 12
   10205   1.1  christos        *    mtlr 0
   10206   1.1  christos        *    sub 11,11,12		# r11 = index * 4
   10207   1.1  christos        *    addis 12,12,(got+4-1b)@ha
   10208   1.1  christos        *    lwz 0,(got+4-1b)@l(12)	# got[1] address of dl_runtime_resolve
   10209   1.7  christos        *    lwz 12,(got+8-1b)@l(12)	# got[2] contains the map address
   10210   1.7  christos        *    mtctr 0
   10211   1.1  christos        *    add 0,11,11
   10212   1.1  christos        *    add 11,0,11			# r11 = index * 12 = reloc offset.
   10213   1.7  christos        *    bctr
   10214   1.7  christos        *
   10215   1.1  christos        * Non-PIC glink code is a little simpler.
   10216   1.1  christos        *
   10217   1.1  christos        * # ith PLT code stub.
   10218   1.1  christos        *   lis 11,(plt+(i-1)*4)@ha
   10219   1.1  christos        *   lwz 11,(plt+(i-1)*4)@l(11)
   10220   1.1  christos        *   mtctr 11
   10221   1.1  christos        *   bctr
   10222   1.1  christos        *
   10223   1.1  christos        * The branch table is the same, then comes
   10224   1.3  christos        *
   10225   1.1  christos        * PLTresolve:
   10226   1.1  christos        *    lis 12,(got+4)@ha
   10227   1.1  christos        *    addis 11,11,(-res_0)@ha
   10228   1.1  christos        *    lwz 0,(got+4)@l(12)		# got[1] address of dl_runtime_resolve
   10229   1.1  christos        *    addi 11,11,(-res_0)@l	# r11 = index * 4
   10230   1.1  christos        *    mtctr 0
   10231   1.1  christos        *    add 0,11,11
   10232   1.1  christos        *    lwz 12,(got+8)@l(12)	# got[2] contains the map address
   10233   1.1  christos        *    add 11,0,11			# r11 = index * 12 = reloc offset.
   10234   1.1  christos        *    bctr
   10235   1.1  christos        */
   10236   1.1  christos 
   10237   1.1  christos       /* Build the branch table, one for each plt entry (less one),
   10238   1.1  christos 	 and perhaps some padding.  */
   10239   1.3  christos       p = htab->glink->contents;
   10240   1.3  christos       p += htab->glink_pltresolve;
   10241   1.3  christos       endp = htab->glink->contents;
   10242   1.3  christos       endp += htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
   10243   1.3  christos       while (p < endp - (htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? 0 : 8 * 4))
   10244   1.3  christos 	{
   10245   1.3  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B + endp - p, p);
   10246   1.3  christos 	  p += 4;
   10247   1.3  christos 	}
   10248   1.3  christos       while (p < endp)
   10249   1.3  christos 	{
   10250   1.3  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, p);
   10251   1.3  christos 	  p += 4;
   10252   1.3  christos 	}
   10253   1.3  christos 
   10254   1.3  christos       res0 = (htab->glink_pltresolve
   10255   1.3  christos 	      + htab->glink->output_section->vma
   10256   1.3  christos 	      + htab->glink->output_offset);
   10257   1.3  christos 
   10258   1.3  christos       if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround)
   10259   1.3  christos 	{
   10260   1.3  christos 	  /* Ensure that a call stub at the end of a page doesn't
   10261   1.3  christos 	     result in prefetch over the end of the page into the
   10262   1.3  christos 	     glink branch table.  */
   10263   1.3  christos 	  bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2;
   10264   1.3  christos 	  bfd_vma page_addr;
   10265   1.3  christos 	  bfd_vma glink_start = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
   10266   1.3  christos 				 + htab->glink->output_offset);
   10267   1.3  christos 
   10268   1.3  christos 	  for (page_addr = res0 & -pagesize;
   10269   1.3  christos 	       page_addr > glink_start;
   10270   1.3  christos 	       page_addr -= pagesize)
   10271   1.3  christos 	    {
   10272   1.1  christos 	      /* We have a plt call stub that may need fixing.  */
   10273   1.7  christos 	      bfd_byte *loc;
   10274   1.3  christos 	      unsigned int insn;
   10275   1.1  christos 
   10276   1.1  christos 	      loc = htab->glink->contents + page_addr - 4 - glink_start;
   10277   1.1  christos 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc);
   10278   1.1  christos 	      if (insn == BCTR)
   10279   1.1  christos 		{
   10280   1.1  christos 		  /* By alignment, we know that there must be at least
   10281   1.1  christos 		     one other call stub before this one.  */
   10282   1.7  christos 		  insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc - 16);
   10283   1.7  christos 		  if (insn == BCTR)
   10284   1.7  christos 		    bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B | (-16 & 0x3fffffc), loc);
   10285   1.7  christos 		  else
   10286   1.7  christos 		    bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B | (-20 & 0x3fffffc), loc);
   10287   1.7  christos 		}
   10288   1.7  christos 	    }
   10289   1.7  christos 	}
   10290   1.7  christos 
   10291   1.7  christos       /* Last comes the PLTresolve stub.  */
   10292   1.7  christos       endp = p + GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
   10293   1.7  christos       if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   10294   1.7  christos 	{
   10295   1.7  christos 	  bfd_vma bcl;
   10296   1.7  christos 
   10297   1.7  christos 	  bcl = (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 3*4
   10298   1.1  christos 		 + htab->glink->output_section->vma
   10299   1.1  christos 		 + htab->glink->output_offset);
   10300   1.7  christos 
   10301   1.7  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_11 + PPC_HA (bcl - res0), p);
   10302   1.7  christos 	  p += 4;
   10303   1.7  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MFLR_0, p);
   10304   1.1  christos 	  p += 4;
   10305   1.1  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCL_20_31, p);
   10306   1.1  christos 	  p += 4;
   10307   1.7  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDI_11_11 + PPC_LO (bcl - res0), p);
   10308   1.7  christos 	  p += 4;
   10309   1.7  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MFLR_12, p);
   10310   1.7  christos 	  p += 4;
   10311   1.1  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTLR_0, p);
   10312   1.7  christos 	  p += 4;
   10313   1.7  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, SUB_11_11_12, p);
   10314   1.7  christos 	  p += 4;
   10315   1.1  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_12_12 + PPC_HA (got + 4 - bcl), p);
   10316   1.1  christos 	  p += 4;
   10317   1.1  christos 	  if (PPC_HA (got + 4 - bcl) == PPC_HA (got + 8 - bcl))
   10318   1.7  christos 	    {
   10319   1.7  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4 - bcl), p);
   10320   1.7  christos 	      p += 4;
   10321   1.7  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + PPC_LO (got + 8 - bcl), p);
   10322   1.7  christos 	      p += 4;
   10323   1.7  christos 	    }
   10324   1.7  christos 	  else
   10325   1.7  christos 	    {
   10326   1.7  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZU_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4 - bcl), p);
   10327   1.7  christos 	      p += 4;
   10328   1.7  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + 4, p);
   10329   1.7  christos 	      p += 4;
   10330   1.7  christos 	    }
   10331   1.7  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_0, p);
   10332   1.7  christos 	  p += 4;
   10333   1.1  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_0_11_11, p);
   10334   1.7  christos 	}
   10335   1.1  christos       else
   10336   1.7  christos 	{
   10337   1.7  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LIS_12 + PPC_HA (got + 4), p);
   10338   1.7  christos 	  p += 4;
   10339   1.7  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_11 + PPC_HA (-res0), p);
   10340   1.7  christos 	  p += 4;
   10341   1.7  christos 	  if (PPC_HA (got + 4) == PPC_HA (got + 8))
   10342   1.7  christos 	    bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4), p);
   10343   1.7  christos 	  else
   10344   1.7  christos 	    bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZU_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4), p);
   10345   1.7  christos 	  p += 4;
   10346   1.7  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDI_11_11 + PPC_LO (-res0), p);
   10347   1.7  christos 	  p += 4;
   10348   1.1  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_0, p);
   10349   1.7  christos 	  p += 4;
   10350   1.1  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_0_11_11, p);
   10351   1.1  christos 	  p += 4;
   10352   1.1  christos 	  if (PPC_HA (got + 4) == PPC_HA (got + 8))
   10353   1.1  christos 	    bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + PPC_LO (got + 8), p);
   10354   1.1  christos 	  else
   10355   1.1  christos 	    bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + 4, p);
   10356   1.1  christos 	}
   10357   1.1  christos       p += 4;
   10358   1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_11_0_11, p);
   10359   1.1  christos       p += 4;
   10360   1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCTR, p);
   10361   1.1  christos       p += 4;
   10362   1.1  christos       while (p < endp)
   10363   1.1  christos 	{
   10364   1.1  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd,
   10365   1.1  christos 		      htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? BA : NOP, p);
   10366   1.1  christos 	  p += 4;
   10367   1.1  christos 	}
   10368   1.1  christos       BFD_ASSERT (p == endp);
   10369   1.1  christos     }
   10370   1.1  christos 
   10371   1.1  christos   if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
   10372   1.1  christos       && htab->glink_eh_frame->contents != NULL)
   10373   1.1  christos     {
   10374   1.1  christos       unsigned char *p = htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
   10375  1.10  christos       bfd_vma val;
   10376   1.1  christos 
   10377   1.1  christos       p += sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie);
   10378   1.1  christos       /* FDE length.  */
   10379   1.1  christos       p += 4;
   10380   1.1  christos       /* CIE pointer.  */
   10381   1.3  christos       p += 4;
   10382   1.1  christos       /* Offset to .glink.  */
   10383   1.3  christos       val = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
   10384   1.1  christos 	     + htab->glink->output_offset);
   10385   1.1  christos       val -= (htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section->vma
   10386   1.1  christos 	      + htab->glink_eh_frame->output_offset);
   10387   1.1  christos       val -= p - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
   10388   1.7  christos       bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
   10389   1.3  christos 
   10390   1.1  christos       if (htab->glink_eh_frame->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_EH_FRAME
   10391   1.1  christos 	  && !_bfd_elf_write_section_eh_frame (output_bfd, info,
   10392   1.1  christos 					       htab->glink_eh_frame,
   10393   1.1  christos 					       htab->glink_eh_frame->contents))
   10394   1.1  christos 	return false;
   10395   1.1  christos     }
   10396   1.1  christos 
   10397   1.1  christos   return ret;
   10398   1.1  christos }
   10399   1.1  christos 
   10400   1.1  christos #define TARGET_LITTLE_SYM	powerpc_elf32_le_vec
   10402   1.1  christos #define TARGET_LITTLE_NAME	"elf32-powerpcle"
   10403   1.1  christos #define TARGET_BIG_SYM		powerpc_elf32_vec
   10404   1.1  christos #define TARGET_BIG_NAME		"elf32-powerpc"
   10405   1.3  christos #define ELF_ARCH		bfd_arch_powerpc
   10406   1.1  christos #define ELF_TARGET_ID		PPC32_ELF_DATA
   10407   1.1  christos #define ELF_MACHINE_CODE	EM_PPC
   10408   1.1  christos #define ELF_MAXPAGESIZE		0x10000
   10409   1.1  christos #define ELF_COMMONPAGESIZE	0x1000
   10410   1.1  christos #define elf_info_to_howto	ppc_elf_info_to_howto
   10411   1.1  christos 
   10412   1.1  christos #ifdef  EM_CYGNUS_POWERPC
   10413   1.1  christos #define ELF_MACHINE_ALT1	EM_CYGNUS_POWERPC
   10414   1.1  christos #endif
   10415   1.1  christos 
   10416   1.1  christos #ifdef EM_PPC_OLD
   10417   1.1  christos #define ELF_MACHINE_ALT2	EM_PPC_OLD
   10418   1.1  christos #endif
   10419   1.1  christos 
   10420   1.1  christos #define elf_backend_plt_not_loaded	1
   10421   1.1  christos #define elf_backend_want_dynrelro	1
   10422   1.7  christos #define elf_backend_can_gc_sections	1
   10423   1.1  christos #define elf_backend_can_refcount	1
   10424   1.1  christos #define elf_backend_rela_normal		1
   10425   1.1  christos #define elf_backend_caches_rawsize	1
   10426  1.12  christos 
   10427   1.1  christos #define bfd_elf32_mkobject			ppc_elf_mkobject
   10428   1.1  christos #define bfd_elf32_bfd_merge_private_bfd_data	ppc_elf_merge_private_bfd_data
   10429   1.1  christos #define bfd_elf32_bfd_relax_section		ppc_elf_relax_section
   10430   1.1  christos #define bfd_elf32_bfd_reloc_type_lookup		ppc_elf_reloc_type_lookup
   10431   1.1  christos #define bfd_elf32_bfd_reloc_name_lookup		ppc_elf_reloc_name_lookup
   10432   1.7  christos #define bfd_elf32_bfd_set_private_flags		ppc_elf_set_private_flags
   10433   1.1  christos #define bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create	ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create
   10434   1.1  christos #define bfd_elf32_get_synthetic_symtab		ppc_elf_get_synthetic_symtab
   10435   1.1  christos 
   10436   1.1  christos #define elf_backend_object_p			ppc_elf_object_p
   10437   1.1  christos #define elf_backend_gc_mark_hook		ppc_elf_gc_mark_hook
   10438   1.1  christos #define elf_backend_section_from_shdr		ppc_elf_section_from_shdr
   10439   1.1  christos #define elf_backend_relocate_section		ppc_elf_relocate_section
   10440   1.1  christos #define elf_backend_create_dynamic_sections	ppc_elf_create_dynamic_sections
   10441   1.1  christos #define elf_backend_check_relocs		ppc_elf_check_relocs
   10442   1.1  christos #define elf_backend_relocs_compatible		_bfd_elf_relocs_compatible
   10443   1.1  christos #define elf_backend_copy_indirect_symbol	ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol
   10444   1.1  christos #define elf_backend_adjust_dynamic_symbol	ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol
   10445   1.1  christos #define elf_backend_add_symbol_hook		ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook
   10446   1.1  christos #define elf_backend_late_size_sections		ppc_elf_late_size_sections
   10447   1.1  christos #define elf_backend_hash_symbol			ppc_elf_hash_symbol
   10448   1.1  christos #define elf_backend_finish_dynamic_symbol	ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol
   10449   1.1  christos #define elf_backend_finish_dynamic_sections	ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections
   10450   1.1  christos #define elf_backend_fake_sections		ppc_elf_fake_sections
   10451   1.1  christos #define elf_backend_additional_program_headers	ppc_elf_additional_program_headers
   10452   1.1  christos #define elf_backend_modify_segment_map		ppc_elf_modify_segment_map
   10453   1.1  christos #define elf_backend_grok_prstatus		ppc_elf_grok_prstatus
   10454   1.3  christos #define elf_backend_grok_psinfo			ppc_elf_grok_psinfo
   10455   1.1  christos #define elf_backend_write_core_note		ppc_elf_write_core_note
   10456   1.1  christos #define elf_backend_reloc_type_class		ppc_elf_reloc_type_class
   10457   1.1  christos #define elf_backend_begin_write_processing	ppc_elf_begin_write_processing
   10458   1.1  christos #define elf_backend_final_write_processing	ppc_elf_final_write_processing
   10459   1.1  christos #define elf_backend_write_section		ppc_elf_write_section
   10460   1.1  christos #define elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr		ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr
   10461   1.1  christos #define elf_backend_plt_sym_val			ppc_elf_plt_sym_val
   10462   1.1  christos #define elf_backend_action_discarded		ppc_elf_action_discarded
   10463   1.1  christos #define elf_backend_init_index_section		_bfd_elf_init_1_index_section
   10464   1.1  christos #define elf_backend_lookup_section_flags_hook	ppc_elf_lookup_section_flags
   10465   1.1  christos 
   10466   1.1  christos #include "elf32-target.h"
   10467   1.1  christos 
   10468   1.1  christos /* FreeBSD Target */
   10469   1.1  christos 
   10470   1.1  christos #undef  TARGET_LITTLE_SYM
   10471   1.1  christos #undef  TARGET_LITTLE_NAME
   10472   1.3  christos 
   10473   1.1  christos #undef  TARGET_BIG_SYM
   10474   1.1  christos #define TARGET_BIG_SYM  powerpc_elf32_fbsd_vec
   10475   1.1  christos #undef  TARGET_BIG_NAME
   10476   1.1  christos #define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf32-powerpc-freebsd"
   10477   1.1  christos 
   10478  1.10  christos #undef  ELF_OSABI
   10479  1.10  christos #define ELF_OSABI	ELFOSABI_FREEBSD
   10480  1.10  christos 
   10481   1.1  christos #undef  elf32_bed
   10482   1.1  christos #define elf32_bed	elf32_powerpc_fbsd_bed
   10483   1.7  christos 
   10484   1.1  christos #include "elf32-target.h"
   10485   1.1  christos 
   10486   1.1  christos /* VxWorks Target */
   10487   1.1  christos 
   10488   1.1  christos #undef TARGET_LITTLE_SYM
   10489   1.1  christos #undef TARGET_LITTLE_NAME
   10490   1.1  christos 
   10491   1.1  christos #undef TARGET_BIG_SYM
   10492   1.1  christos #define TARGET_BIG_SYM		powerpc_elf32_vxworks_vec
   10493   1.1  christos #undef TARGET_BIG_NAME
   10494   1.1  christos #define TARGET_BIG_NAME		"elf32-powerpc-vxworks"
   10495   1.1  christos 
   10496   1.1  christos #undef  ELF_OSABI
   10497   1.1  christos 
   10498   1.1  christos #undef ELF_TARGET_OS
   10499   1.1  christos #define ELF_TARGET_OS		is_vxworks
   10500   1.1  christos 
   10501   1.1  christos /* VxWorks uses the elf default section flags for .plt.  */
   10502   1.1  christos static const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
   10503   1.1  christos ppc_elf_vxworks_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
   10504   1.1  christos {
   10505   1.7  christos   if (sec->name == NULL)
   10506   1.1  christos     return NULL;
   10507   1.1  christos 
   10508   1.1  christos   if (strcmp (sec->name, ".plt") == 0)
   10509   1.1  christos     return _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec);
   10510   1.1  christos 
   10511   1.1  christos   return ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec);
   10512   1.1  christos }
   10513   1.1  christos 
   10514   1.1  christos /* Like ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create, but overrides
   10515  1.10  christos    appropriately for VxWorks.  */
   10516   1.1  christos static struct bfd_link_hash_table *
   10517   1.1  christos ppc_elf_vxworks_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
   10518   1.1  christos {
   10519   1.7  christos   struct bfd_link_hash_table *ret;
   10520   1.7  christos 
   10521   1.1  christos   ret = ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create (abfd);
   10522   1.1  christos   if (ret)
   10523   1.1  christos     {
   10524   1.7  christos       struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab
   10525   1.7  christos 	= (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *)ret;
   10526  1.10  christos       htab->plt_type = PLT_VXWORKS;
   10527   1.1  christos       htab->plt_entry_size = VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE;
   10528   1.7  christos       htab->plt_slot_size = VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE;
   10529   1.1  christos       htab->plt_initial_entry_size = VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE;
   10530   1.1  christos     }
   10531  1.10  christos   return ret;
   10532   1.9  christos }
   10533   1.1  christos 
   10534   1.9  christos /* Tweak magic VxWorks symbols as they are loaded.  */
   10535   1.9  christos static bool
   10536   1.1  christos ppc_elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook (bfd *abfd,
   10537   1.1  christos 				 struct bfd_link_info *info,
   10538   1.1  christos 				 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
   10539   1.1  christos 				 const char **namep,
   10540   1.1  christos 				 flagword *flagsp,
   10541   1.1  christos 				 asection **secp,
   10542   1.1  christos 				 bfd_vma *valp)
   10543   1.1  christos {
   10544   1.1  christos   if (!elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook (abfd, info, sym, namep, flagsp, secp,
   10545   1.1  christos 				    valp))
   10546   1.1  christos     return false;
   10547   1.1  christos 
   10548   1.1  christos   return ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook (abfd, info, sym, namep, flagsp, secp, valp);
   10549   1.1  christos }
   10550   1.1  christos 
   10551   1.1  christos static bool
   10552   1.7  christos ppc_elf_vxworks_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd)
   10553   1.7  christos {
   10554   1.1  christos   ppc_final_write_processing (abfd);
   10555   1.1  christos   return elf_vxworks_final_write_processing (abfd);
   10556   1.1  christos }
   10557   1.1  christos 
   10558   1.1  christos /* On VxWorks, we emit relocations against _PROCEDURE_LINKAGE_TABLE_, so
   10559   1.1  christos    define it.  */
   10560   1.1  christos #undef elf_backend_want_plt_sym
   10561   1.1  christos #define elf_backend_want_plt_sym		1
   10562   1.1  christos #undef elf_backend_want_got_plt
   10563   1.1  christos #define elf_backend_want_got_plt		1
   10564   1.1  christos #undef elf_backend_got_symbol_offset
   10565   1.1  christos #define elf_backend_got_symbol_offset		0
   10566   1.1  christos #undef elf_backend_plt_not_loaded
   10567   1.1  christos #define elf_backend_plt_not_loaded		0
   10568   1.1  christos #undef elf_backend_plt_readonly
   10569   1.1  christos #define elf_backend_plt_readonly		1
   10570   1.1  christos #undef elf_backend_got_header_size
   10571   1.1  christos #define elf_backend_got_header_size		12
   10572   1.1  christos #undef elf_backend_dtrel_excludes_plt
   10573   1.1  christos #define elf_backend_dtrel_excludes_plt		1
   10574   1.1  christos 
   10575   1.1  christos #undef bfd_elf32_get_synthetic_symtab
   10576   1.1  christos 
   10577   1.1  christos #undef bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create
   10578   1.1  christos #define bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create \
   10579   1.1  christos   ppc_elf_vxworks_link_hash_table_create
   10580                 #undef elf_backend_add_symbol_hook
   10581                 #define elf_backend_add_symbol_hook \
   10582                   ppc_elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook
   10583                 #undef elf_backend_link_output_symbol_hook
   10584                 #define elf_backend_link_output_symbol_hook \
   10585                   elf_vxworks_link_output_symbol_hook
   10586                 #undef elf_backend_final_write_processing
   10587                 #define elf_backend_final_write_processing \
   10588                   ppc_elf_vxworks_final_write_processing
   10589                 #undef elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr
   10590                 #define elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr \
   10591                   ppc_elf_vxworks_get_sec_type_attr
   10592                 #undef elf_backend_emit_relocs
   10593                 #define elf_backend_emit_relocs \
   10594                   elf_vxworks_emit_relocs
   10595                 
   10596                 #undef elf32_bed
   10597                 #define elf32_bed				ppc_elf_vxworks_bed
   10598                 
   10599                 #include "elf32-target.h"
   10600